Annual Statements Open main menu

GREAT SOUTHERN BANCORP, INC. - Annual Report: 2018 (Form 10-K)



UNITED STATES
SECURITIES AND EXCHANGE COMMISSION
Washington, D.C. 20549

FORM 10-K

ANNUAL REPORT PURSUANT TO SECTION 13 OR 15(d) OF THE
SECURITIES ACT OF 1934

For the fiscal year ended December 31, 2018

Commission file number 0-18082

GREAT SOUTHERN BANCORP, INC.
(Exact name of registrant as specified in its charter)

Maryland
43-1524856
(State or other jurisdiction of incorporation or organization)
(IRS Employer Identification No.)
 
 
1451 E. Battlefield, Springfield, Missouri
65804
(Address of principal executive offices)
(Zip Code)
 
 


(417) 887-4400
Registrant's telephone number, including area code


Securities registered pursuant to Section 12(b) of the Act:
Title of Each Class
Name of Each Exchange on Which Registered
Common Stock, par value $0.01 per share
The NASDAQ Stock Market LLC

Securities registered pursuant to Section 12(g) of the Act: None.
Indicate by check mark if the registrant is a well-known seasoned issuer, as defined in Rule 405 of the Securities Act.
Yes [  ]   No [X]
Indicate by check mark if the registrant is not required to file reports pursuant to Section 13 or Section 15(d) of the Act.
Yes [  ]   No [X]
Indicate by check mark whether the registrant (1) has filed all reports required to be filed by Section 13 or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934 during the preceding 12 months (or for such shorter period that the registrant was required to file such reports), and (2) has been subject to such filing requirements for the past 90 days.
Yes [X]  No [  ]
Indicate by check mark whether the registrant has submitted electronically every Interactive Data File required to be submitted pursuant to Rule 405 of Regulation S-T (§ 232.405 of this chapter) during the preceding 12 months (or for such shorter period that the registrant was required to submit such files).
Yes [X]  No [  ]
Indicate by check mark if disclosure of delinquent filers pursuant to Item 405 of Regulation S-K is not contained herein, and will not be contained, to the best of the registrant's knowledge, in definitive proxy or information statements incorporated by reference in Part III of this Form 10-K or any amendment to this Form 10-K. [  ]
 
Indicate by check mark whether the registrant is a large accelerated filer, an accelerated filer, a non-accelerated filer, a smaller reporting company, or an emerging growth company. See definitions of "large accelerated filer," "accelerated filer," "smaller reporting company" and "emerging growth company" in Rule 12b-2 of the Exchange Act.
 
Large accelerated filer [  ]       Accelerated filer [X]       Non-accelerated filer [  ]
Smaller reporting company [   ]Emerging growth company [   ]
If an emerging growth company, indicate by check mark if the registrant has elected not to use the extended transition period for complying with any new or revised
financial accounting standards provided pursuant to Section 13(a) of the Exchange Act. [  ]
Indicated by check mark whether the registrant is a shell company (as defined in Rule 12b-2 of the Act).
Yes [  ]   No [X]
The aggregate market value of the common stock of the registrant held by non-affiliates of the Registrant on June 30, 2018, computed by reference to the closing price of such shares on that date, was $626,952,383.  At March 5, 2019, 14,169,682 shares of the Registrant's common stock were outstanding.
 



1




TABLE OF CONTENTS
 

 
 
 
Page 
ITEM 1.
BUSINESS
 
1
ITEM 1A.
RISK FACTORS
 
46
ITEM 1B.
UNRESOLVED STAFF COMMENTS
 
57
ITEM 2.
PROPERTIES.
 
57
ITEM 3.
LEGAL PROCEEDINGS.
 
57
ITEM 4.
MINE SAFETY DISCLOSURES.
 
57
ITEM 4A.
EXECUTIVE OFFICERS OF THE REGISTRANT.
 
57
ITEM 5.
MARKET FOR REGISTRANT'S COMMON EQUITY, RELATED
STOCKHOLDER MATTERS AND ISSUER PURCHASES OF EQUITY
SECURITIES
 
58
ITEM 6.
SELECTED FINANCIAL DATA
 
59
ITEM 7.
MANAGEMENT'S DISCUSSION AND ANALYSIS OF FINANCIAL
CONDITION AND RESULTS OF OPERATIONS
 
62
ITEM 7A.
QUANTITATIVE AND QUALITATIVE DISCLOSURES ABOUT MARKET RISK
 
95
ITEM 8.
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS AND SUPPLEMENTARY DATA
 
99

ITEM 9.
CHANGES IN AND DISAGREEMENTS WITH ACCOUNTANTS ON
ACCOUNTING AND FINANCIAL DISCLOSURE
 
171
ITEM 9A.
CONTROLS AND PROCEDURES.
 
171
ITEM 9B.
OTHER INFORMATION.
 
173
ITEM 10.
DIRECTORS, EXECUTIVE OFFICERS AND CORPORATE GOVERNANCE.
 
174
ITEM 11.
EXECUTIVE COMPENSATION.
 
174
ITEM 12.
SECURITY OWNERSHIP OF CERTAIN BENEFICIAL OWNERS AND
MANAGEMENT AND RELATED STOCKHOLDER MATTERS
 
174
ITEM 13.
CERTAIN RELATIONSHIPS AND RELATED TRANSACTIONS, AND
DIRECTOR INDEPENDENCE.
 
174
ITEM 14.
PRINCIPAL ACCOUNTING FEES AND SERVICES.
 
175
ITEM 15.
EXHIBITS, FINANCIAL STATEMENT SCHEDULES.
 
176

SIGNATURES

2





PART I

ITEM 1.  BUSINESS.

THE COMPANY

Great Southern Bancorp, Inc.

Great Southern Bancorp, Inc. ("Bancorp" or "Company") is a bank holding company, a financial holding company and the parent of Great Southern Bank ("Great Southern" or the "Bank"). Bancorp was incorporated under the laws of the State of Delaware in July 1989 as a unitary savings and loan holding company. The Company became a one-bank holding company on June 30, 1998, upon the conversion of Great Southern to a Missouri-chartered trust company. In 2004, Bancorp was re-incorporated under the laws of the State of Maryland.

As a Maryland corporation, the Company is authorized to engage in any activity that is permitted by the Maryland General Corporation Law and not prohibited by law or regulatory policy. The Company currently conducts its business as a financial holding company. Through the financial holding company structure, it is possible to expand the size and scope of the financial services offered by the Company beyond those offered by the Bank. The financial holding company structure provides the Company with greater flexibility than the Bank has to diversify its business activities, through existing or newly formed subsidiaries, or through acquisitions of or mergers with other financial institutions as well as other companies. At December 31, 2018, Bancorp's consolidated assets were $4.68 billion, consolidated net loans were $3.99 billion, consolidated deposits were $3.73 billion and consolidated total stockholders' equity was $532.0 million. For details about the Company’s assets, revenues and profits for each of the last five fiscal years, see Item 6. “Selected Financial Data.”  The assets of the Company consist primarily of the stock of Great Southern and cash.

Through the Bank and subsidiaries of the Bank, the Company also offers insurance and related services, which are discussed further below.  The activities of the Company are funded by retained earnings and through dividends from Great Southern. Activities of the Company may also be funded through borrowings from third parties, sales of additional securities or through income generated by other activities of the Company.

The executive offices of the Company are located at 1451 East Battlefield, Springfield, Missouri 65804, and its telephone number at that address is (417) 887-4400.

Great Southern Bank

Great Southern was formed as a Missouri-chartered mutual savings and loan association in 1923, and, in 1989, converted to a Missouri-chartered stock savings and loan association. In 1994, Great Southern changed to a federal savings bank charter and then, on June 30, 1998, changed to a Missouri-chartered trust company (the equivalent of a commercial bank charter). Headquartered in Springfield, Missouri, Great Southern offers a broad range of banking services through its 99 banking centers located in southern and central Missouri; the Kansas City, Missouri area; the St. Louis, Missouri area; eastern Kansas; northwestern Arkansas; the Minneapolis, Minnesota area and eastern, western and central Iowa. At December 31, 2018, the Bank had total assets of $4.67 billion, net loans of $3.99 billion, deposits of $3.78 billion and equity capital of $580.0 million, or 12.4% of total assets. Its deposits are insured by the Deposit Insurance Fund ("DIF") to the maximum levels permitted by the FDIC.

The size and complexity of the Bank’s operations increased substantially in 2009 with the completion of two Federal Deposit Insurance Corporation ("FDIC")-assisted transactions, and again in 2011, 2012 and 2014 with the completion of another FDIC-assisted transaction in each of those years.  In 2009, the Bank entered into two separate purchase and assumption agreements (including loss sharing) with the FDIC to assume all of the deposits (excluding brokered deposits) and certain liabilities and acquire certain assets of TeamBank, N.A. and Vantus Bank.  In these two transactions we acquired assets with a fair value of approximately $499.9 million (approximately 18.8% of the Company’s total consolidated assets at acquisition) and $294.2 million (approximately 8.8% of the Company’s total consolidated assets at acquisition), respectively, and assumed liabilities with a fair value of $610.2 million (approximately 24.9% of the Company’s total consolidated assets at acquisition) and $440.0 million (approximately 13.2% of the Company’s total consolidated assets at acquisition), respectively.  They also resulted in gains of $43.9 million and $45.9 million, respectively, which were included in Noninterest Income in the Company’s Consolidated Statement of Income for the year ended December 31, 2009.  Prior to these acquisitions, the Company operated banking centers in Missouri with loan production offices in Arkansas and Kansas.  These acquisitions added 31 banking centers and expanded our footprint to cover five states – Iowa, Kansas, Missouri, Arkansas and Nebraska.  In 2011, the Bank entered into a purchase and assumption agreement (including loss sharing) with the FDIC to assume all of the deposits and certain liabilities and acquire certain assets of Sun Security Bank, which added locations in southern Missouri and St. Louis.  In this transaction we acquired assets with a fair value of approximately $248.9 million (approximately 7.3% of the Company’s total consolidated assets at acquisition) and assumed liabilities with a fair value of $345.8

3





million (approximately 10.1% of the Company’s total consolidated assets at acquisition).  It also resulted in a gain of $16.5 million which was included in Noninterest Income in the Company’s Consolidated Statement of Income for the year ended December 31, 2011. In 2012, the Bank entered into a purchase and assumption agreement (including loss sharing) with the FDIC to assume all of the deposits and certain liabilities and acquire certain assets of Inter Savings Bank, FSB (“InterBank”), which added four locations in the greater Minneapolis, Minnesota area and represented a new market for the Company.  In this transaction we acquired assets with a fair value of approximately $364.2 million (approximately 9.4% of the Company’s total consolidated assets at acquisition) and assumed liabilities with a fair value of approximately $458.7 million (approximately 11.9% of the Company’s total consolidated assets at acquisition).  It also resulted in a gain of $31.3 million which was included in Noninterest Income in the Company’s Consolidated Statement of Income for the year ended December 31, 2012.

In 2014, the Bank entered into a purchase and assumption agreement (without loss sharing) with the FDIC to assume all of the deposits and certain liabilities and acquire certain assets of Valley Bank (“Valley”), which added five locations in the Quad Cities area of eastern Iowa and six locations in central Iowa, primarily in the Des Moines market area.  These represented new markets for the Company in eastern Iowa and enhanced our market presence in central Iowa.  In this transaction we acquired assets with a fair value of approximately $378.7 million (approximately 10.0% of the Company’s total consolidated assets at acquisition) and assumed liabilities with a fair value of approximately $367.9 million (approximately 9.8% of the Company’s total consolidated assets at acquisition).  It also resulted in a gain of $10.8 million which was included in Noninterest Income in the Company’s Consolidated Statement of Income for the year ended December 31, 2014.

Also in 2014, the Bank entered into a purchase and assumption agreement to acquire certain assets and depository accounts from Neosho, Mo.-based Boulevard Bank (“Boulevard”), which added one location in the Neosho, Mo. market, where the Company already operated.  In this transaction, which was completed in 2014, we acquired assets (primarily cash and cash equivalents) with a fair value of approximately $92.5 million (approximately 2.6% of the Company’s total consolidated assets at acquisition) and assumed liabilities (all deposits and related accrued interest) with a fair value of approximately $93.3 million (approximately 2.6% of the Company’s total consolidated assets at acquisition).  This acquisition resulted in recognition of $790,000 of goodwill.

The Company also opened commercial loan production offices in Dallas, Texas and Tulsa, Oklahoma during 2014.  The primary products offered in these offices are commercial real estate, commercial business and commercial construction loans.

In 2015, the Company announced plans to consolidate operations of 16 banking centers into other nearby Great Southern banking center locations.  As part of an ongoing performance review of its entire banking center network, Great Southern evaluated each location for a number of criteria, including access and availability of services to affected customers, the proximity of other Great Southern banking centers, profitability and transaction volumes, and market dynamics.  Subsequent to this announcement, the Bank entered into separate definitive agreements to sell two of the 16 banking centers, including all of the associated deposits (totaling approximately $20 million), to separate bank purchasers.  One of those sale transactions was completed on February 19, 2016 and the other was completed on March 18, 2016.  The closing of the remaining 14 facilities, which resulted in the transfer of approximately $127 million in deposits and banking center operations to other Great Southern locations, occurred at the close of business on January 8, 2016.

Also in 2015, the Company announced that it entered into a purchase and assumption agreement to acquire 12 branches, including related loans, and to assume related deposits in the St. Louis, Mo., area from Cincinnati-based Fifth Third Bank. The acquisition was completed at the close of business on January 29, 2016.  The deposits assumed totaled approximately $228 million and had a weighted average rate of approximately 0.28%.  The loans acquired totaled approximately $159 million and had a weighted average yield of approximately 3.92%.

The loss sharing agreements related to the FDIC-assisted transactions in 2009, 2011 and 2012 added to the complexity of our operations by creating the need for new employees and processes to ensure compliance with the loss sharing agreements and the collection of problem assets acquired.  See Note 4 included in Item 8. “Financial Statements and Supplementary Information” for a more detailed discussion of these FDIC-assisted transactions and the loss sharing agreements.  The loss sharing agreements related to the 2009 and 2011 FDIC-assisted transactions were terminated during 2016.  The loss sharing agreements related to the 2012 FDIC-assisted transaction were terminated during 2017.  See “Loss Share Agreements” below for additional information regarding the termination of these agreements.

The Company opened a commercial loan production office in Chicago, Illinois during 2017.  The primary products offered in this office are commercial real estate, commercial business and commercial construction loans.

In March 2018, the Bank entered into a definitive agreement to sell its four banking centers, including all of the associated deposits (totaling approximately $56 million), in the Omaha, Nebraska market to Lincoln, Nebraska-based West Gate Bank.  This sale transaction was completed in July 2018.

4





The Company opened two commercial loan production offices – one in Denver, Colorado and one in Atlanta, Georgia – in late 2018.  The primary products offered in these offices are commercial real estate, commercial business and commercial construction loans.

Great Southern is principally engaged in the business of originating commercial real estate loans, construction loans, other commercial loans, residential real estate loans and consumer loans and funding these loans by attracting deposits from the general public, obtaining brokered deposits and through borrowings from the Federal Home Loan Bank of Des Moines (the "FHLBank") and others.

For many years, Great Southern has followed a strategy of emphasizing loan origination through residential, commercial and consumer lending activities in its market areas. The goal of this strategy is to be one of the leading providers of financial services in Great Southern’s market areas, while simultaneously diversifying assets and reducing interest rate risk by originating and holding adjustable-rate loans and fixed-rate loans, primarily with terms of five years or less, in its portfolio and by selling longer-term fixed-rate single-family mortgage loans in the secondary market. The Bank continues to emphasize real estate lending while also expanding and increasing its originations of commercial business and consumer loans.

The corporate office of the Bank is located at 1451 East Battlefield, Springfield, Missouri 65804 and its telephone number at that address is (417) 887-4400.

Forward-Looking Statements

When used in this Annual Report and in other documents filed or furnished by Great Southern Bancorp, Inc. (the “Company”) with the Securities and Exchange Commission (the "SEC"), in the Company's press releases or other public or stockholder communications, and in oral statements made with the approval of an authorized executive officer, the words or phrases "will likely result," "are expected to," "will continue," "is anticipated," "estimate," "project," "intends" or similar expressions are intended to identify "forward-looking statements" within the meaning of the Private Securities Litigation Reform Act of 1995. Such statements are subject to certain risks and uncertainties, including, among other things, (i) the possibility that the changes in non-interest income, non-interest expense and interest expense actually resulting from Great Southern Bank's recently completed transaction with West Gate Bank might be materially different from estimated amounts; (ii) the possibility that the actual reduction in the Company’s effective tax rate expected to result from H. R. 1, formerly known as the “Tax Cuts and Jobs Act” (the “Tax Reform Legislation”) might be different from the reduction estimated by the Company; (iii) expected revenues, cost savings, earnings accretion, synergies and other benefits from the Company's  merger and acquisition activities might not be realized within the anticipated time frames or at all, and costs or difficulties relating to integration matters, including but not limited to customer and employee retention, might be greater than expected; (iv) changes in economic conditions, either nationally or in the Company's market areas; (v) fluctuations in interest rates; (vi) the risks of lending and investing activities, including changes in the level and direction of loan delinquencies and write-offs and changes in estimates of the adequacy of the allowance for loan losses; (vii) the possibility of other-than-temporary impairments of securities held in the Company's securities portfolio; (viii) the Company's ability to access cost-effective funding; (ix) fluctuations in real estate values and both residential and commercial real estate market conditions; (x) demand for loans and deposits in the Company's market areas; (xi) the ability to adapt successfully to technological changes to meet customers' needs and developments in the marketplace; (xii) the possibility that security measures implemented might not be sufficient to mitigate the risk of a cyber attack or cyber theft, and that such security measures might not protect against systems failures or interruptions; (xiii) legislative or regulatory changes that adversely affect the Company's business, including, without limitation, the Dodd-Frank Wall Street Reform and Consumer Protection Act of 2010 and its implementing regulations, the overdraft protection regulations and customers' responses thereto and the Tax Reform Legislation; (xiv) changes in accounting principles, policies or guidelines; (xv) monetary and fiscal policies of the Federal Reserve Board and the U.S. Government and other governmental initiatives affecting the financial services industry; (xvi) results of examinations of the Company and Great Southern Bank by their regulators, including the possibility that the regulators may, among other things, require the Company to limit its business activities, changes its business mix, increase its allowance for loan losses, write-down assets or increase its capital levels, or affect its ability to borrow funds or maintain or increase deposits, which could adversely affect its liquidity and earnings; (xvii) costs and effects of litigation, including settlements and judgments; and (xviii) competition. The Company wishes to advise readers that the factors listed above and other risks described from time to time in documents filed or furnished by the Company with the SEC could affect the Company's financial performance and could cause the Company's actual results for future periods to differ materially from any opinions or statements expressed with respect to future periods in any current statements.

The Company does not undertake -and specifically declines any obligation- to publicly release the result of any revisions which may be made to any forward-looking statements to reflect events or circumstances after the date of such statements or to reflect the occurrence of anticipated or unanticipated events.

5






Internet Website

Bancorp maintains a website at www.greatsouthernbank.com. The information contained on that website is not included as part of, or incorporated by reference into, this Annual Report on Form 10-K. Bancorp currently makes available on or through its website Bancorp's Annual Report on Form 10-K, Quarterly Reports on Form 10-Q and Current Reports on Form 8-K and amendments, if any, to these reports. These materials are also available free of charge (other than a user's regular internet access charges) on the Securities and Exchange Commission's website at www.sec.gov.

Market Areas

The Company currently operates 99 full-service retail banking offices, serving more than 160,000 households in six states – Missouri, Arkansas, Iowa, Kansas, Minnesota and Nebraska.  The Company also operates commercial loan production offices in Atlanta, Chicago, Dallas, Denver, Omaha, Neb., and Tulsa, Okla., and a mortgage lending office in Springfield, Mo.

The Company regularly evaluates its banking center network and lines of business to ensure that it is serving customers in the best way possible. The banking center network constantly evolves with changes in customer needs and preferences, emerging technology and local market developments. In response to these changes, the Company opens banking centers and invests resources where customer demand leads, and from time to time, consolidates banking centers when market conditions dictate.

Great Southern's largest concentration of deposits and loans are in the Springfield, Mo., and St. Louis, Mo., market areas. In the last several years, the Company's deposit and loan portfolios have become more diversified because of its participation in five FDIC-assisted acquisitions and organic growth. The FDIC-assisted acquisitions significantly expanded the Company's geographic footprint, which prior to 2009 was primarily in southwest and central Missouri, by adding operations in Iowa, Kansas, Minnesota and Nebraska. In 2018, the Company sold four banking centers in the Omaha, Neb., metropolitan market to a Nebraska-based bank. A commercial loan production office remains in Omaha. In April 2019, the Fayetteville, Ark., banking center was consolidated into the Rogers, Ark., office, leaving one office in Arkansas. Besides the Springfield and St. Louis market areas, the Company has deposit and loan concentrations in the following market areas: Kansas City, Mo.; Sioux City, Iowa; Des Moines, Iowa; Northwest Arkansas; Minneapolis, Minn.; and Eastern Iowa in the area known as the "Quad Cities."  Deposits and loans are also generated in banking centers in rural markets in Missouri, Iowa, and Kansas. 

At December 31, 2018, the Company's total deposits were $3.7 billion. At that date, the Company had deposits in Missouri of $2.7 billion, including the two largest deposit concentrations in Springfield and St. Louis areas, with $1.6 billion and $523 million, respectively. The Company also had deposits of $544 million in Iowa, $259 million in Kansas, $245 million in Minnesota, $19 million in Nebraska and $18 million in Arkansas. 

Lending Activities

General

From its beginnings in 1923 through the early 1980s, Great Southern primarily made long-term, fixed-rate residential real estate loans that it retained in its loan portfolio. Beginning in the early 1980s, Great Southern increased its efforts to originate short-term and adjustable-rate loans. Beginning in the mid-1980s, Great Southern increased its efforts to originate commercial real estate and other residential loans, primarily with adjustable rates or shorter-term fixed rates. In addition, some competitor banking organizations merged with larger institutions and changed their business practices or moved operations away from the Springfield, Mo. area, and others consolidated operations from the Springfield, Mo. area to larger cities. This provided Great Southern expanded opportunities in residential and commercial real estate lending as well as in the origination of commercial business and consumer loans, primarily in indirect automobile lending.

In addition to origination of these loans, the Bank has expanded and enlarged its relationships with smaller banks and other peer banks to purchase participations (at par, generally with no servicing costs) in loans these other banks originate but are unable to retain in their portfolios due to capital or borrower relationship size limitations.  The Bank uses the same underwriting guidelines in evaluating these participations as it does in its direct loan originations. At December 31, 2018, the balance of participation loans purchased and held in the portfolio, excluding FDIC-acquired loans, was $198.8 million, or 5.1% of the total loan portfolio. All of these participation loans were performing at December 31, 2018, with the exception of one loan in the amount of $1.1 million.

One of the principal historical lending activities of Great Southern is the origination of fixed and adjustable-rate conventional residential real estate loans to enable borrowers to purchase or refinance owner-occupied homes. Great Southern originates a variety of conventional, residential real estate mortgage loans, principally in compliance with Freddie Mac and Fannie Mae standards for resale in the secondary market. Great Southern promptly sells most of the fixed-rate residential mortgage loans that it originates.  To date, Great Southern has not experienced difficulties selling these loans in the secondary market and has had minimal requests for

6





repurchase.  Depending on market conditions, the ongoing servicing of these loans is at times retained by Great Southern, but generally servicing is released to the purchaser of the loan. Great Southern retains in its portfolio substantially all of the adjustable-rate mortgage loans that it originates. 

Another principal lending activity of Great Southern is the origination of commercial real estate, multi-family and commercial construction loans. Since the early 1990s, commercial real estate, multi-family and commercial construction loans have represented the largest percentage of the loan portfolio.  At December 31, 2018, commercial real estate, multi-family and commercial construction loans, excluding loans acquired in FDIC-assisted transactions, accounted for approximately 28%, 16% and 22%, respectively, of the total portfolio.  Of the portfolio of acquired loans, commercial real estate loans (net of fair value discounts) accounted for approximately 1% of the total portfolio at December 31, 2018.

In addition, Great Southern in recent years has increased its emphasis on the origination of other commercial loans, home equity loans and consumer loans, and also issues of letters of credit.  Letters of credit are contingent obligations and are not included in the Bank's loan portfolio.  See "-- Other Commercial Lending," "- Classified Assets," and "Loan Delinquencies and Defaults" below.

The percentage of collateral value Great Southern will loan on real estate and other property varies based on factors including, but not limited to, the type of property and its location and the borrower's credit history. As a general rule, Great Southern will loan up to 95% of the appraised value on one-to four-family residential properties. Typically, private mortgage insurance is required for loan amounts above the 80% level. At December 31, 2018 and 2017, loans secured by second liens on residential properties were $118.5 million, or 2.9%, and $126.7 million, or 3.3%, respectively, of our total loan portfolio.  For commercial real estate and other residential real property loans, Great Southern may loan up to 85% of the appraised value. The origination of loans secured by other property is considered and determined on an individual basis by management with the assistance of any industry guides and other information which may be available.  Collateral values are reappraised or reassessed as loans are renewed or when significant events indicating potential impairment occur.  On a quarterly basis, management reviews impaired loans to determine whether updated appraisals or reassessments are necessary based on loan performance, collateral type and guarantor support.  While not specifically required by our policy, we seek to obtain cross-collateralization of loans to a borrower when it is available and it is most frequently done on commercial real estate loans.

Loan applications are approved at various levels of authority, depending on the type, amount and loan-to-value ratio of the loan. Loan commitments of more than $750,000 (or loans exceeding the Freddie Mac loan limit in the case of fixed-rate, one- to four-family residential loans for resale) must be approved by Great Southern's loan committee. The loan committee is comprised of the Chief Executive Officer of the Bank, the Chief Credit Officer of the Bank (chairman of the committee), and other senior officers of the Bank involved in lending activities.  All loans, regardless of size or type, are required to conform to certain minimum underwriting standards to assure portfolio quality.  These standards and procedures include, but are not limited to, an analysis of the borrower’s financial condition, collateral, repayment ability, verification of liquid assets and credit history as required by loan type.  It has been, and continues to be, our practice to verify information from potential borrowers regarding assets, income or payment ability and credit ratings as applicable and as required by the authority approving the loan.  Underwriting standards also include loan-to-value ratios which vary depending on collateral type, debt service coverage ratios or debt payment to income ratios, where applicable, credit histories, use of guaranties and other recommended terms relating to equity requirements, amortization, and maturity.  Generally, deviations from approved underwriting standards can only be allowed when doing so is not in violation of regulations or statutes and when appropriate lending authority is obtained.  The loan committee reviews all new loan originations in excess of lender approval authorities.  For secured loans originated and held, most lenders have approval authorities of $250,000 or below while fifteen senior lenders have approval authority of varying amounts up to $1 million.  Lender approval authorities are also subject to loans-to-one borrower limits of $500,000 or below for most lenders and of varying amounts up to $3 million for fourteen senior lenders.  These standards, as well as our collateral requirements, have not significantly changed in recent years.

In general, state banking laws restrict loans to a single borrower and related entities to no more than 25% of a bank's unimpaired capital and unimpaired surplus, plus an additional 10% if the loan is collateralized by certain readily marketable collateral. (Real estate is not included in the definition of "readily marketable collateral.”)  As computed on the basis of the Bank's unimpaired capital and surplus at December 31, 2018, this limit was approximately $149.9 million. See "Government Supervision and Regulation." At December 31, 2018, the Bank was in compliance with the loans-to-one borrower limit. At December 31, 2018, the Bank's largest relationship for purposes of this limit, which consists of nine loans, totaled $50.4 million. This amount represents the total commitment for this relationship at December 31, 2018; the outstanding balance at that date was $36.9 million.  The collateral for the loans consists of multiple healthcare facilities, apartment complexes and a retail development.  Some of the projects are currently under construction, so all funds have not been disbursed on these loan.  In addition, we obtained personal guarantees from the principal owner of the borrowing entities for each of these loans.  All loans included in this relationship were current at December 31, 2018.  In addition at December 31, 2018, we had three other loan relationships that each exceeded $40 million.  All loans included in these relationships were current at December 31, 2018.  Our policy does not set a loans-to-one borrower limit that is below the legal

7





limits described; however, we do recognize the need to limit credit risk to any one borrower or group of related borrowers upon consideration of various risk factors.  Extensions of credit to borrowers whose past due loans were charged-off or whose loans are classified as substandard require special lending approval.

Great Southern is permitted under applicable regulations to originate or purchase loans and loan participations secured by real estate located in any part of the United States.  In addition to the market areas where the Company has offices, the Bank has made or purchased loans, secured primarily by commercial real estate, in other states, primarily Michigan, Wisconsin, Florida, and Arizona.  At December 31, 2018, loans in these states comprised less than 2% each, respectively, of the total loan portfolio.

Loan Portfolio Composition

The following tables set forth information concerning the composition of the Bank's loan portfolio in dollar amounts and in percentages (before deductions for loans in process, deferred fees and discounts and allowance for loan losses) as of the dates indicated. The tables are based on information prepared in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles and are qualified by reference to the Company's Consolidated Financial Statements and the notes thereto contained in Item 8 of this report.

The loans acquired in the four FDIC-assisted transactions completed in 2009 through 2012, which were acquired at discounts and were previously covered by loss sharing agreements between the FDIC and the Bank, and the loans acquired in 2014 from the former Valley Bank, which were acquired at discounts and were never covered by a loss sharing agreement, are shown combined below in tables separate from the legacy Great Southern portfolio. All of these acquired loan portfolios were initially recorded at their fair values at the acquisition date and are recorded by the Company at their discounted value. The following tables reflect the loan balances excluding discounts.


















8





Legacy Great Southern Loan Portfolio Composition:

   
December 31,
 
   
2018
   
2017
   
2016
   
2015
   
2014
 
   
Amount
   
%
   
Amount
   
%
   
Amount
   
%
   
Amount
   
%
   
Amount
   
%
 
   
(Dollars In Thousands)
 
Real Estate Loans:
                                                           
One- to four- family(1)
 
$
400,954
     
8.3
%
 
$
318,186
     
7.3
%
 
$
353,709
     
8.6
%
 
$
272,411
     
7.9
%
 
$
245,180
     
8.3
%
Other residential
   
784,894
     
16.3
     
745,645
     
17.1
     
663,378
     
16.1
     
419,550
     
12.1
     
392,415
     
13.2
 
Commercial(2)
   
1,385,375
     
28.7
     
1,256,986
     
28.8
     
1,211,644
     
29.4
     
1,080,836
     
31.3
     
986,936
     
33.3
 
Residential construction:
                                                                               
One- to four- family
   
26,683
     
0.5
     
23,266
     
0.5
     
26,764
     
0.6
     
36,430
     
1.1
     
49,631
     
1.7
 
Other residential
   
376,575
     
7.8
     
208,883
     
4.8
     
202,202
     
4.9
     
133,718
     
3.9
     
59,664
     
2.0
 
Commercial
   
1,098,420
     
22.8
     
919,029
     
21.1
     
641,195
     
15.6
     
551,115
     
16.0
     
404,683
     
13.7
 
                                                                                 
Total real estate loans
   
4,072,901
     
84.4
     
3,471,995
     
79.6
     
3,098,892
     
75.2
     
2,494,060
     
72.3
     
2,138,509
     
72.2
 
                                                                                 
Other Loans:
                                                                               
Consumer loans:
                                                                               
Automobile, boat, etc.
   
309,201
     
6.4
     
418,594
     
9.6
     
563,086
     
13.7
     
513,798
     
14.9
     
400,392
     
13.5
 
Home equity and improvement
   
121,352
     
2.5
     
115,439
     
2.7
     
108,753
     
2.6
     
83,966
     
2.4
     
66,275
     
2.2
 
Other
   
1,677
     
     
1,916
     
     
1,148
     
     
926
     
     
987
     
0.1
 
Total consumer loans
   
432,230
     
8.9
     
535,949
     
12.3
     
672,987
     
16.3
     
598,690
     
17.3
     
467,654
     
15.8
 
                                                                                 
Other commercial loans
   
322,119
     
6.7
     
353,553
     
8.1
     
348,955
     
8.5
     
357,581
     
10.4
     
354,012
     
12.0
 
                                                                                 
Total other loans
   
754,349
     
15.6
     
889,502
     
20.4
     
1,021,942
     
24.8
     
956,271
     
27.7
     
821,666
     
27.8
 
                                                                                 
Total loans
   
4,827,250
     
100.0
%
   
4,361,497
     
100.0
%
   
4,120,834
     
100.0
%
   
3,450,331
     
100.0
%
   
2,960,175
     
100.0
%
                                                                                 
Less:
                                                                               
Loans in process
   
958,436
             
793,664
             
585,305
             
418,702
             
323,572
         
Deferred fees and discounts
   
7,400
             
6,500
             
4,869
             
3,528
             
3,276
         
Allowance for loan losses
   
37,988
             
36,033
             
36,775
             
36,646
             
36,300
         
                                                                                 
Total legacy loans receivable, net
 
$
3,823,426
           
$
3,525,300
           
$
3,493,885
           
$
2,991,455
           
$
2,597,027
         
                                                                                 
(1) Includes loans held for sale.
(2) Total commercial real estate loans included industrial revenue bonds of $13.9 million, $21.7 million, $24.7 million, $37.4 million and $41.1 million at December 31, 2018, 2017, 2016, 2015 and 2014.
 


9





Loans Acquired and Accounted for Under ASC 310-30 Portfolio Composition:

   
December 31,
 
   
2018
   
2017
   
2016
   
2015
   
2014
 
   
Amount
   
%
   
Amount
   
%
   
Amount
   
%
   
Amount
   
%
   
Amount
   
%
 
   
(Dollars In Thousands)
 
Real Estate Loans:
                                                           
  Residential
                                                           
    One- to four- family
 
$
102,153
     
55.4
%
 
$
132,432
     
57.1
%
 
$
169,541
     
54.7
%
 
$
213,317
     
52.3
%
 
$
256,099
     
47.7
%
    Other residential
   
13,396
     
7.3
     
15,501
     
6.7
     
30,605
     
9.9
     
38,487
     
9.4
     
53,914
     
10.0
 
  Commercial(1)
   
34,853
     
18.9
     
41,218
     
17.8
     
56,548
     
18.2
     
79,461
     
19.5
     
119,279
     
22.2
 
  Construction
   
5,588
     
3.0
     
5,509
     
2.4
     
4,508
     
1.5
     
11,087
     
2.7
     
20,324
     
3.8
 
 
                                                                               
    Total real estate loans
   
155,990
     
84.6
     
194,660
     
84.0
     
261,202
     
84.3
     
342,352
     
83.9
     
449,616
     
83.7
 
 
                                                                               
Other Loans:
                                                                               
  Consumer loans:
                                                                               
    Student loans
   
     
     
     
     
     
     
481
     
0.1
     
543
     
0.1
 
    Home equity and
      improvement
   
21,490
     
11.7
     
27,778
     
12.0
     
35,688
     
11.5
     
43,507
     
10.7
     
52,436
     
9.8
 
    Other
   
2,110
     
1.1
     
3,367
     
1.4
     
4,739
     
1.5
     
6,578
     
1.6
     
9,308
     
1.7
 
                                                                                 
      Total consumer loans
   
23,600
     
12.8
     
31,145
     
13.4
     
40,427
     
13.0
     
50,566
     
12.4
     
62,287
     
11.6
 
                                                                                 
  Other commercial loans
   
4,861
     
2.6
     
6,016
     
2.6
     
8,448
     
2.7
     
15,331
     
3.7
     
25,160
     
4.7
 
 
                                                                               
      Total other loans
   
28,461
     
15.4
     
37,161
     
16.0
     
48,875
     
15.7
     
65,897
     
16.1
     
87,447
     
16.3
 
 
                                                                               
         Total loans(2)
   
184,451
     
100.0
%
   
231,821
     
100.0
%
   
310,077
     
100.0
%
   
408,249
     
100.0
%
   
537,063
     
100.0
%
                                                                                 
Less:
                                                                               
   Loans in process
   
5
             
5
             
8
             
17
             
631
         
   Allowance for loan losses
   
421
             
459
             
625
             
1,503
             
2,135
         
   Fair value discounts
   
16,800
             
22,152
             
26,918
             
45,387
             
77,897
         
                                                                                 
Total loans receivable, net
 
$
167,225
           
$
209,205
           
$
282,526
           
$
361,342
           
$
456,400
         

(1)
Total commercial real estate loans included industrial revenue bonds of $1.4 million, $2.2 million, $2.5 million, $3.2 million and $3.7 million at December 31, 2018, 2017, 2016, 2015, and 2014, respectively.
(2)
At December 31, 2018 and 2017, none of these acquired loans were covered by an FDIC loss sharing agreement.

Through December 31, 2018, gross loan balances (due from borrowers) related to TeamBank were reduced approximately $425.6 million since the transaction date because of $293.0 million of principal repayments, $61.7 million of transfers to foreclosed assets and $70.9 million of charge-downs to customer loan balances.  Gross loan balances (due from borrowers) related to Vantus Bank were reduced approximately $317.5 million since the transaction date because of $271.9 million of principal repayments, $16.7 million of transfers to foreclosed assets and $28.9 million of charge-downs to customer loan balances.  Gross loan balances (due from borrowers) related to Sun Security Bank were reduced approximately $213.3 million since the transaction date because of $153.9 million of principal repayments, $28.6 million of transfers to foreclosed assets and $30.8 million of charge-offs to customer loan balances.  Gross loan balances (due from borrowers) related to InterBank were reduced approximately $308.2 million since the transaction date because of $265.8 million of principal repayments, $20.0 million of transfers to foreclosed assets and $22.4 million of charge-offs to customer loan balances.  Gross loan balances (due from borrowers) related to Valley Bank were reduced approximately $139.7 million since the transaction date because of $127.7 million of principal repayments, $4.0 million of transfers to foreclosed assets and $8.0 million of charge-offs to customer loan balances.  Based upon the collectability analyses performed at the time of the acquisitions, we expected certain levels of foreclosures and charge-offs, and actual results through December 31, 2018, related to the FDIC-assisted acquired portfolios, have been better than our expectations.  As a result, cash flows expected to be received from the acquired loan pools have increased, resulting in adjustments that were made to the related accretable yield which are discussed in Note 4 of the accompanying audited financial statements, included in Item 8 of this Report.

10





The following tables show the fixed- and adjustable-rate composition of the Bank's loan portfolio at the dates indicated. Amounts shown for TeamBank, Vantus Bank, Sun Security Bank, InterBank and Valley Bank represent unpaid principal balances, before fair value discounts.  The tables are based on information prepared in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles.

Legacy Great Southern Loan Portfolio Composition by Fixed- and Adjustable-Rates:

   
December 31,
 
   
2018
   
2017
   
2016
   
2015
   
2014
 
   
Amount
   
%
   
Amount
   
%
   
Amount
   
%
   
Amount
   
%
   
Amount
   
%
 
   
(Dollars In Thousands)
 
Fixed-Rate Loans:
                                                           
Real Estate Loans
                                                           
One- to four- family
 
$
152,778
     
3.2
%
 
$
148,790
     
3.4
%
 
$
168,813
     
4.1
%
 
$
110,738
     
3.2
%
 
$
102,780
     
3.5
%
Other residential
   
387,744
     
8.0
     
279,593
     
6.4
     
304,387
     
7.4
     
257,854
     
7.5
     
273,701
     
9.2
 
Commercial
   
686,832
     
14.2
     
603,183
     
13.8
     
589,354
     
14.3
     
522,924
     
15.2
     
453,153
     
15.3
 
Residential construction:
                                                                               
One- to four- family
   
6,908
     
0.1
     
7,998
     
0.2
     
10,950
     
0.3
     
16,483
     
0.5
     
17,753
     
0.6
 
Other residential
   
19,165
     
0.4
     
6,636
     
0.2
     
26,487
     
0.6
     
21,548
     
0.6
     
9,950
     
0.3
 
Commercial construction
   
922,418
     
19.2
     
717,350
     
16.4
     
530,375
     
12.9
     
376,661
     
10.9
     
285,623
     
9.7
 
                                                                                 
Total real estate loans
   
2,175,845
     
45.1
     
1,763,550
     
40.4
     
1,630,366
     
39.6
     
1,306,208
     
37.9
     
1,142,960
     
38.6
 
Consumer
   
301,627
     
6.2
     
411,068
     
9.4
     
553,800
     
13.4
     
506,574
     
14.7
     
396,412
     
13.4
 
Other commercial
   
186,030
     
3.9
     
203,388
     
4.7
     
194,431
     
4.7
     
195,602
     
5.6
     
197,635
     
6.7
 
Total fixed-rate loans
   
2,663,502
     
55.2
     
2,378,006
     
54.5
     
2,378,597
     
57.7
     
2,008,384
     
58.2
     
1,737,007
     
58.7
 
                                                                                 
Adjustable-Rate Loans:
                                                                               
Real Estate Loans
                                                                               
One- to four- family
   
248,176
     
5.1
     
169,396
     
3.9
     
184,896
     
4.5
     
161,673
     
4.7
     
142,400
     
4.8
 
Other residential
   
397,150
     
8.3
     
466,052
     
10.7
     
358,991
     
8.7
     
161,696
     
4.7
     
118,714
     
4.0
 
Commercial
   
698,543
     
14.5
     
653,803
     
15.0
     
622,290
     
15.1
     
557,912
     
16.2
     
533,783
     
18.0
 
Residential construction:
                                                                               
One- to four- family
   
19,775
     
0.4
     
15,268
     
0.4
     
15,814
     
0.4
     
19,947
     
0.5
     
31,878
     
1.1
 
Other residential
   
357,410
     
7.4
     
202,247
     
4.6
     
175,715
     
4.3
     
112,170
     
3.3
     
49,714
     
1.7
 
Commercial construction
   
176,002
     
3.6
     
201,679
     
4.6
     
110,820
     
2.7
     
174,454
     
5.0
     
119,060
     
4.0
 
                                                                                 
Total real estate loans
   
1,897,056
     
39.3
     
1,708,445
     
39.2
     
1,468,526
     
35.7
     
1,187,852
     
34.4
     
995,549
     
33.6
 
Consumer
   
130,603
     
2.7
     
124,881
     
2.9
     
119,187
     
2.9
     
92,116
     
2.7
     
71,242
     
2.4
 
Other commercial
   
136,089
     
2.8
     
150,165
     
3.4
     
154,524
     
3.7
     
161,979
     
4.7
     
156,377
     
5.3
 
Total adjustable-rate loans
   
2,163,748
     
44.8
     
1,983,491
     
45.5
     
1,742,237
     
42.3
     
1,441,947
     
41.8
     
1,223,168
     
41.3
 
                                                                                 
Total Loans
   
4,827,250
     
100.0
%
   
4,361,497
     
100.0
%
   
4,120,834
     
100.0
%
   
3,450,331
     
100.0
%
   
2,960,175
     
100.0
%
Less:
                                                                               
Loans in process
   
958,436
             
793,664
             
585,305
             
418,702
             
323,572
         
Deferred fees and discounts
   
7,400
             
6,500
             
4,869
             
3,528
             
3,276
         
Allowance for loan losses
   
37,988
             
36,033
             
36,775
             
36,646
             
36,300
         
                                                                                 
Total legacy loans receivable, net
 
$
3,823,426
           
$
3,525,300
           
$
3,493,885
           
$
2,991,455
           
$
2,597,027
         

11





Loans Acquired and Accounted for Under ASC 310-30 Composition by Fixed- and Adjustable-Rates:

   
December 31,
 
   
2018
   
2017
   
2016
   
2015
   
2014
 
   
Amount
   
%
   
Amount
   
%
   
Amount
   
%
   
Amount
   
%
   
Amount
   
%
 
   
(Dollars In Thousands)
 
Fixed-Rate Loans:
                                                           
Real Estate Loans
                                                           
One- to four- family
 
$
41,460
     
22.5
%
 
$
54,302
     
23.4
%
 
$
72,738
     
23.5
%
 
$
99,456
     
24.4
%
 
$
128,669
     
24.0
%
Other residential
   
12,572
     
6.8
     
13,129
     
5.7
     
25,593
     
8.2
     
25,551
     
6.3
     
24,250
     
4.5
 
Commercial
   
27,194
     
14.7
     
25,973
     
11.2
     
29,043
     
9.4
     
32,255
     
7.9
     
54,055
     
10.1
 
Construction
   
4,598
     
2.5
     
4,297
     
1.9
     
2,176
     
0.7
     
5,858
     
1.4
     
12,768
     
2.4
 
                                                                                 
Total real estate loans
   
85,824
     
46.5
     
97,701
     
42.2
     
129,550
     
41.8
     
163,120
     
40.0
     
219,742
     
41.0
 
Consumer
   
2,447
     
1.3
     
3,712
     
1.6
     
5,111
     
1.6
     
7,561
     
1.8
     
10,794
     
2.0
 
Other commercial
   
3,354
     
1.9
     
3,819
     
1.6
     
4,917
     
1.6
     
6,999
     
1.7
     
12,096
     
2.3
 
Total fixed-rate loans
   
91,625
     
49.7
     
105,232
     
45.4
     
139,578
     
45.0
     
177,680
     
43.5
     
242,632
     
45.3
 
                                                                                 
Adjustable-Rate Loans:
                                                                               
Real Estate Loans
                                                                               
One- to four- family
   
60,693
     
32.9
     
78,130
     
33.7
     
96,803
     
31.2
     
113,861
     
27.9
     
127,430
     
23.7
 
Other residential
   
824
     
0.4
     
2,372
     
1.0
     
5,012
     
1.6
     
12,936
     
3.2
     
29,664
     
5.5
 
Commercial
   
7,659
     
4.2
     
15,245
     
6.6
     
27,505
     
8.9
     
47,206
     
11.6
     
65,224
     
12.1
 
Construction
   
990
     
0.5
     
1,212
     
0.5
     
2,332
     
0.8
     
5,229
     
1.3
     
7,556
     
1.4
 
                                                                                 
Total real estate loans
   
70,166
     
38.0
     
96,959
     
41.8
     
131,652
     
42.5
     
179,232
     
44.0
     
229,874
     
42.7
 
Consumer
   
21,153
     
11.5
     
27,433
     
11.8
     
35,316
     
11.4
     
43,005
     
10.5
     
51,493
     
9.6
 
Other commercial
   
1,507
     
0.8
     
2,197
     
1.0
     
3,531
     
1.1
     
8,332
     
2.0
     
13,064
     
2.4
 
Total adjustable-rate loans
   
92,826
     
50.3
     
126,589
     
54.6
     
170,499
     
55.0
     
230,569
     
56.5
     
294,431
     
54.7
 
                                                                                 
Total Loans
   
184,451
     
100.0
%
   
231,821
     
100.0
%
   
310,077
     
100.0
%
   
408,249
     
100.0
%
   
537,063
     
100.0
%
Less:
                                                                               
Loans in process
   
5
             
5
             
8
             
17
             
631
         
Allowance for loan losses
   
421
             
459
             
625
             
1,503
             
2,135
         
Fair value discounts
   
16,800
             
22,152
             
26,918
             
45,387
             
77,897
         
                                                                                 
Total loans receivable, net
 
$
167,225
           
$
209,205
           
$
282,526
           
$
361,342
           
$
456,400
         
                                                                                 

12





The following tables present the contractual maturities of loans at December 31, 2018. Amounts shown for acquired loans represent unpaid principal balances, before fair value discounts.  The tables are based on information prepared in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles.

Legacy Great Southern Loan Portfolio Composition by Contractual Maturities:

 
Less Than
One Year
   
One to Five
Years
   
After Five
Years
   
Total
 
 
(In Thousands)
 
Real Estate Loans:
   
    Residential
   
      One- to four- family
 
$
29,228
   
$
72,287
   
$
299,439
   
$
400,954
 
      Other residential
   
182,147
     
542,451
     
60,296
     
784,894
 
    Commercial
   
296,796
     
939,802
     
148,777
     
1,385,375
 
    Residential construction:
   
      One- to four- family
   
16,709
     
6,742
     
3,232
     
26,683
 
      Other residential
   
57,438
     
315,603
     
3,534
     
376,575
 
    Commercial construction
   
895,660
     
175,262
     
27,498
     
1,098,420
 
 
        Total real estate loans
   
1,477,978
     
2,052,147
     
542,776
     
4,072,901
 
Other Loans:
   
    Consumer loans:
                               
      Automobile and other
   
29,133
     
225,344
     
56,401
     
310,878
 
      Home equity and improvement
   
8,475
     
29,750
     
83,127
     
121,352
 
 
        Total consumer loans
   
37,608
     
255,094
     
139,528
     
432,230
 
 
Other commercial loans
   
132,087
     
119,787
     
70,245
     
322,119
 
 
        Total other loans
   
169,695
     
374,881
     
209,773
     
754,349
 
 
             Total loans
 
$
1,647,673
   
$
2,427,028
   
$
752,549
   
$
4,827,250
 

As of December 31, 2018, loans due after December 31, 2019 with fixed interest rates totaled $1.5 billion and loans due after December 31, 2019 with adjustable rates totaled $1.7 billion.







13





Loans Acquired and Accounted for Under ASC 310-30 Portfolio Composition by Contractual Maturities:

 
 
Less Than
One Year
 
 
One to Five
Years
 
 
After Five
Years
 
 
Total
 
 
 
(In Thousands)
 
Real Estate Loans:
 
 
 
    Residential
 
 
 
      One- to four- family
 
$
7,260
 
 
$
26,323
 
 
$
68,570
 
 
$
102,153
 
      Other residential
 
 
4,814
 
 
 
7,274
 
 
 
1,308
 
 
 
13,396
 
    Commercial
 
 
13,784
 
 
 
16,685
 
 
 
4,384
 
 
 
34,853
 
    Construction
 
 
935
 
 
 
4,247
 
 
 
406
 
 
 
5,588
 
 
        Total real estate loans
 
 
26,793
 
 
 
54,529
 
 
 
74,668
 
 
 
155,990
 
Other Loans:
 
 
 
    Consumer loans:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
      Home equity and improvement
 
 
4,825
 
 
 
13,850
 
 
 
2,815
 
 
 
21,490
 
      Automobile and other
 
 
150
 
 
 
487
 
 
 
1,473
 
 
 
2,110
 
 
        Total consumer loans
 
 
4,975
 
 
 
14,337
 
 
 
4,288
 
 
 
23,600
 
 
Other commercial loans
 
 
1,507
 
 
 
3,258
 
 
 
96
 
 
 
4,861
 
 
        Total other loans
 
 
6,482
 
 
 
17,595
 
 
 
4,384
 
 
 
28,461
 
 
             Total loans
 
$
33,275
 
 
$
72,124
 
 
$
79,052
 
 
$
184,451
 

As of December 31, 2018, loans due after December 31, 2019 with fixed interest rates totaled $65.6 million and loans due after December 31, 2019 with adjustable rates totaled $85.6 million.

At December 31, 2018, $118.5 million, or 2.9%, of total loans were secured by junior lien mortgages and $7.4 million, or 2.0% of residential real estate loans, were interest only residential real estate loans.  At December 31, 2017, $126.7 million, or 3.3%, of total loans were secured by junior lien mortgages and $4.5 million, or 1.4% of residential real estate loans, were interest only residential real estate loans.  While high loan-to-value ratio mortgage loans are occasionally originated and held, they are typically either considered low risk based on analyses performed or are required to have private mortgage insurance.  The Company does not originate or hold option ARM loans or significant amounts of loans with initial teaser rates or subprime loans in its residential real estate portfolio.

To monitor and control risks related to concentrations of credit in the composition of the loan portfolio, management reviews the loan portfolio by loan types, industries and market areas on a monthly basis for credit quality and known and anticipated market conditions.  Changes in loan portfolio composition may be made by management based on the performance of each area of business, known and anticipated market conditions, credit demands, the deposit structure of the Bank and the expertise and/or depth of the lending staff.   Loan portfolio industry and market areas are monitored regularly for credit quality and trends.  Reports detailed by industry and geography are provided to the Board of Directors on a monthly and quarterly basis.

In response to the economic recession that began in 2008, the composition of the Bank’s loan portfolio has changed over the past several years; speculative construction and land development loan types have been limited, commercial real estate loan types have been stabilized and diversified and emphasis has been placed on increasing our multi-family, commercial business and, prior to 2017, consumer loan portfolios.

Environmental Issues

Loans secured by real property, whether commercial, residential or other, may have a material, negative effect on the financial position and results of operations of the lender if the collateral is environmentally contaminated. The result can be, but is not necessarily limited to, liability for the cost of cleaning up the contamination imposed on the lender by certain federal and state laws, a reduction in the borrower's ability to pay because of the liability imposed upon it for any clean-up costs, a reduction in the value of the collateral because of the presence of contamination or a subordination of security interests in the collateral to a super priority lien securing the cleanup costs by certain state laws.

14






Management is aware of the risk that the Bank may be negatively affected by environmentally contaminated collateral and attempts to control this risk through commercially reasonable methods, consistent with guidelines arising from applicable government or regulatory rules and regulations, and to a more limited extent, publications of the lending industry. Management currently is unaware (without, in many circumstances, specific inquiry or investigation of existing collateral, some of which was accepted as collateral before risk controlling measures were implemented) of any environmental contamination of real property securing loans in the Bank's portfolio that would subject the Bank to any material risk. No assurance can be given, however, that the Bank will not be adversely affected by environmental contamination.

Residential Real Estate Lending

At December 31, 2018 and 2017, loans secured by residential real estate, excluding that which is under construction and excluding all FDIC-assisted acquired loans, totaled $1.2 billion and $1.1 billion, respectively, and represented approximately 23.7% and 23.3%, respectively, of the Bank's total loan portfolio.  At December 31, 2018 and 2017, FDIC-assisted acquired loans (net of fair value discounts) secured by residential real estate totaled $106 million and $134 million, respectively, and represented approximately 2.1% and 2.9%, respectively, of the Bank’s total loan portfolio.  The Bank's legacy residential real estate loan portfolio increased during 2018, due to organic loan growth in both single-family and multi-family loans.  Since 2010, other residential real estate (multi-family) loan balances continued to increase as the Bank has emphasized this type of loan.  The Bank's legacy multi-family residential real estate loan portfolio grew by about 5% and 12% in 2018 and 2017, respectively.  In 2016, the Bank completed a non-FDIC-assisted acquisition of a portfolio of one- to four-family residential loans as part of the acquisition of branches and deposits in St. Louis, Mo. from Fifth Third Bank.

The Bank currently is originating one- to four-family adjustable-rate residential mortgage loans primarily with one-year adjustment periods or with rates that are fixed for the first few years of the loan and then adjust annually. Rate adjustments on loans originated prior to July 2001 are based upon changes in prevailing rates for one-year U.S. Treasury securities. Rate adjustments on loans originated since July 2001 are based upon changes in the average of interbank offered rates for twelve month U.S. Dollar-denominated deposits in the London Market (LIBOR) or changes in prevailing rates for one-year U.S. Treasury securities. Rate adjustments are generally limited to 2% maximum annually as well as a maximum aggregate adjustment over the life of the loan. Accordingly, the interest rates on these loans typically may not be as rate sensitive as is the Bank's cost of funds. Generally, the Bank's adjustable-rate mortgage loans are not convertible into fixed-rate loans, do not permit negative amortization of principal and carry no prepayment penalty. The Bank also currently is originating other residential (multi-family) mortgage loans with interest rates that are generally either adjustable with changes to the prime rate of interest or fixed for short periods of time (three to seven years).

The Bank's portfolio of adjustable-rate mortgage loans also includes a number of loans with different adjustment periods, without limitations on periodic rate increases and rate increases over the life of the loans, or which are tied to other short-term market indices. These loans were originated prior to the industry standardization of adjustable-rate loans. Since the adjustable-rate mortgage loans currently held in the Bank's portfolio have not been subject to an interest rate environment which causes them to adjust to the maximum, these loans entail unquantifiable risks resulting from potential increased payment obligations on the borrower as a result of upward repricing. The indices used by Great Southern for these types of loans have increased, but not significantly, in the past three years.  Compared to fixed-rate mortgage loans, these loans are subject to increased risk of delinquency or default if a higher, fully-indexed rate of interest subsequently comes into effect in replacement of a lower rate currently in effect.  From 2008 through 2012, as a result of the significant recession in the economy, including residential real estate, the Bank experienced a significant increase in delinquencies in adjustable-rate mortgage loans. In 2013 through 2018, these delinquencies trended lower.

In underwriting one- to four-family residential real estate loans, Great Southern evaluates the borrower's ability to make monthly payments and the value of the property securing the loan. It is the policy of Great Southern that generally all one- to four-family residential loans in excess of 80% of the appraised value of the property be insured by a private mortgage insurance company approved by Great Southern for the amount of the loan in excess of 80% of the appraised value. In addition, Great Southern requires borrowers to obtain title and fire and casualty insurance in an amount not less than the amount of the loan. Real estate loans originated by the Bank generally contain a "due on sale" clause allowing the Bank to declare the unpaid principal balance due and payable upon the sale of the property securing the loan. The Bank may enforce these due on sale clauses to the extent permitted by law.

Commercial Real Estate and Construction Lending

Commercial real estate lending has been a significant part of Great Southern's business activities since the mid-1980s.  Great Southern does commercial real estate lending in order to increase the potential yield on, and the proportion of interest rate sensitive loans in, its portfolio.  At December 31, 2008, commercial real estate loans and commercial construction loans each made up about one fourth of the total loan portfolio.  The economic recession that began in 2008 resulted in reduced activity in the market caused by the downturn in the economy and reduced real estate values. In response, Great Southern began limiting residential and commercial land development lending to reduce the risk in the portfolio and began originating an increased amount of commercial real estate loans.  Since December 31, 2008, the commercial land development construction loan portfolio has decreased from 32% of the loan portfolio

15





to 17% of the loan portfolio at December 31, 2018, while, overall, commercial real estate loans have trended upward.  The increase in commercial real estate loans in 2015-2018 reflects some economic improvement with increased investor activity in sales, purchases and refinancing of these types of properties.  Both commercial real estate occupancy and rental rates show improvement in the Bank’s market areas.  Excluding FDIC-assisted acquired loans, over the last three years, commercial real estate loans made up approximately 27-28% of the total loan portfolio while commercial construction loans were 15-22%.  Great Southern expects to continue to limit lending on land development loans in 2019 with increases in commercial construction and commercial real estate loans anticipated as long as the economy continues to be strong.  See "Government Supervision and Regulation" below.

At December 31, 2018 and 2017, loans secured by commercial real estate, excluding that which is under construction and excluding all FDIC-assisted acquired loans, totaled $1.4 billion and $1.3 billion, respectively, or approximately 27.7% and 27.5%, respectively, of the Bank's total loan portfolio.  At December 31, 2018 and 2017, FDIC-acquired loans (net of fair value discounts) secured by commercial real estate totaled $34 million and $39 million, respectively, and represented approximately 0.7% and 0.9%, respectively, of the Bank’s total loan portfolio.  In addition, at December 31, 2018 and 2017, construction loans, excluding all FDIC-acquired loans, secured by projects under construction and the land on which the projects are located aggregated $1.5 billion and $1.2 billion, respectively, or 30.1% and 25.2%, respectively, of the Bank's total loan portfolio.  At December 31, 2018 and 2017, FDIC-acquired construction loans (net of fair value discounts) totaled $5 million and $5 million, respectively, and represented approximately 0.1% and 0.1%, respectively, of the Bank’s total loan portfolio.  A majority of the Bank's commercial real estate loans have been originated with adjustable rates of interest, most of which are tied to the national prime rate, or fixed rates of interest with short-term maturities. A large majority of the Bank’s commercial real estate loans (both fixed and adjustable) mature in five years or less.  Substantially all of these loans were originated with loan commitments which did not exceed 80% of the appraised value of the properties securing the loans.

The Bank's construction loans generally have a term of eighteen months or less.  The construction loan agreements for one- to four-family projects generally require principal reductions as individual condominium units or single-family houses are built and sold to a third party.  This insures that the remaining loan balance, as a proportion of the value of the remaining security, does not increase, assuming that the value of the remaining security does not decrease.  Loan proceeds are disbursed in increments as construction progresses.  Generally, the amount of each disbursement is based on the construction cost estimate with inspections of the project performed in connection with each disbursement request.  Normally, Great Southern's commercial real estate and other residential construction loans are made either as the initial stage of a combination loan (i.e., with a commitment from the Bank to provide permanent financing upon completion of the project) or with a commitment from a third party to provide permanent financing.

The Bank's commercial real estate and construction loan portfolios consist of loans with diverse collateral types.  The following table sets forth loans that were secured by certain types of collateral at December 31, 2018, excluding FDIC-assisted acquired loans.  These collateral types represent the five highest percentage concentrations of commercial real estate and construction loan types in the loan portfolio.

Collateral Type
Loan Balance
Percentage of
Total Loan
Portfolio
Non-Performing
Loans at
December 31, 2018
 
(Dollars In Thousands)
 
 
Retail (Varied Projects)
$478,986
12.4%
$         148
Health Care Facilities
$313,604
  8.1%
$             0
Office Industry
$245,967
  6.4%
$             0
Motels/Hotels
$163,376
  4.2%
$             0
Warehouses
$138,743
  3.6%
$             0

Commercial real estate lending and construction lending generally affords the Bank an opportunity to receive interest at rates higher than those obtainable from residential mortgage lending and to receive higher origination and other loan fees. In addition, commercial real estate loans and construction loans are generally made with adjustable rates of interest or, if made on a fixed-rate basis, for relatively short terms. Nevertheless, commercial real estate lending entails significant additional risks as compared with residential mortgage lending. Commercial real estate loans typically involve large loan balances to single borrowers or groups of related borrowers. In addition, the payment experience on loans secured by commercial properties is typically dependent on the successful operation of the related real estate project and thus may be subject, to a greater extent, to adverse conditions in the real estate market or in the economy generally.

Construction loans involve additional risks attributable to the fact that loan funds are advanced upon the value of the project under construction, which is of uncertain value prior to the completion of construction. Moreover, because of the uncertainties inherent in estimating construction costs, delays arising from labor problems, material shortages, and other unpredictable contingencies, it is

16





relatively difficult to evaluate accurately the total loan funds required to complete a project, and the related loan-to-value ratios. See also the discussion under the headings "- Classified Assets" and "- Loan Delinquencies and Defaults" below.

The Company executes interest rate swaps with certain commercial banking customers to facilitate their respective risk management strategies.  The Company began offering this service during 2011.  Those interest rate swaps are simultaneously hedged by offsetting interest rate swaps that the Company executes with a third party, such that the Company minimizes its net risk exposure resulting from such transactions.  As the interest rate swaps associated with this program do not meet the strict hedge accounting requirements, changes in the fair value of both the customer swaps and the offsetting swaps are recognized directly in earnings.  As of December 31, 2018, the Company had 18 interest rate swaps totaling $78.5 million in notional amount with commercial customers, and 18 interest rate swaps with the same notional amount with third parties related to this program. As of December 31, 2017, the Company had 22 interest rate swaps totaling $92.7 million in notional amount with commercial customers, and 22 interest rate swaps with the same notional amount with third parties related to this program.  As part of the Valley Bank FDIC-assisted acquisition, the Company acquired seven loans with related interest rate swaps.  Valley’s swap program differed from the Company’s in that Valley did not have back to back swaps with the customer and a counterparty.  Five of the seven acquired loans with interest rate swaps have paid off.  The notional amount of the two remaining Valley swaps is $774,000 at December 31, 2018.  During the years ended December 31, 2018 and 2017, the Company recognized net gains of $25,000 and $28,000 respectively, in noninterest income related to changes in the fair value of these swaps.

Other Commercial Lending

At December 31, 2018 and 2017, Great Southern had $322 million and $354 million, respectively, in other commercial loans outstanding, excluding all FDIC-acquired loans, or 6.4% and 7.7%, respectively, of the Bank's total loan portfolio. At December 31, 2018 and 2017, FDIC-acquired other commercial loans (net of fair value discounts) totaled $4 million and $5 million, respectively, and represented approximately 0.1% and 0.1%, respectively, of the Bank’s total loan portfolio. Great Southern's other commercial lending activities encompass loans with a variety of purposes and security, including loans to finance accounts receivable, inventory and equipment. Great Southern expects to continue to originate loans in this category subject to market conditions and applicable regulatory restrictions. See "Government Supervision and Regulation" below.

Unlike residential mortgage loans, which generally are made on the basis of the borrower's ability to make repayment from his or her employment and other income and which are secured by real property, the value of which tends to be more easily ascertainable, other commercial loans are of higher risk and typically are made on the basis of the borrower's ability to make repayment from the cash flow of the borrower's business. Commercial loans are generally secured by business assets, such as accounts receivable, equipment and inventory. As a result, the availability of funds for the repayment of other commercial loans may be substantially dependent on the success of the business itself. Further, the collateral securing the loans may depreciate over time, may be difficult to appraise and may fluctuate in value based on the success of the business.

The Bank's management recognizes the generally increased risks associated with other commercial lending. Great Southern's commercial lending policy emphasizes complete credit file documentation and analysis of the borrower's character, capacity to repay the loan, the adequacy of the borrower's capital and collateral as well as an evaluation of the industry conditions affecting the borrower. Review of the borrower's past, present and future cash flows is also an important aspect of Great Southern's credit analysis. In addition, the Bank generally obtains personal guarantees from the borrowers on these types of loans. Historically, the majority of Great Southern's commercial loans have been to borrowers in southwestern and central Missouri and the St. Louis, Mo. area.  With the acquisitions in 2009, 2011, 2012 and 2014, geographic concentrations for commercial loans expanded to include the greater Kansas City, Mo. area, several areas in Iowa, and the Minneapolis-St. Paul, Minn. area.  Great Southern has continued its commercial lending in all of these geographic areas.

As part of its commercial lending activities, Great Southern issues letters of credit and receives fees averaging approximately 1% of the amount of the letter of credit per year. At December 31, 2018, Great Southern had 79 letters of credit outstanding in the aggregate amount of $28.9 million. Approximately 30% of the aggregate amount of these letters of credit was secured, including one $476,000 letter of credit secured by real estate which was issued to enhance the issuance of housing revenue refunding bonds and was current.

Consumer Lending

Consumer loans generally have short terms to maturity, thus reducing Great Southern's exposure to changes in interest rates, and carry higher rates of interest than do residential mortgage loans. In addition, Great Southern believes that the offering of consumer loan products helps to expand and create stronger ties to its existing customer base.

Great Southern offers a variety of secured consumer loans, including automobile loans, boat loans, home equity loans and loans secured by savings deposits. In addition, Great Southern also offers home improvement loans and unsecured consumer loans. Consumer loans, excluding all FDIC-acquired loans, totaled $432 million and $536 million at December 31, 2018 and 2017,

17





respectively, or 8.7% and 11.7%, respectively, of the Bank's total loan portfolio.  At December 31, 2018 and 2017, FDIC-assisted acquired consumer loans (net of fair value discounts) totaled $19 million and $26 million, respectively, and represented approximately 0.4% and 0.6%, respectively, of the Bank’s total loan portfolio.

The underwriting standards employed by the Bank for consumer loans include a determination of the applicant's payment history on other debts and an assessment of ability to meet existing obligations and payments on the proposed loan.  Although creditworthiness of the applicant is of primary consideration, the underwriting process also includes a comparison of the value of the underlying collateral, if any, in relation to the proposed loan amount.

Beginning in 1998, the Bank implemented indirect lending relationships, primarily with automobile dealerships.  Through these dealer relationships, the dealer completes the application with the consumer and then submits it to the Bank for credit approval.  While the Bank’s initial and ongoing concentrated effort was on automobiles, the program has evolved for use from time to time with other tangible products where financing of the product is provided through the seller, including, to a lesser extent, boats and manufactured homes.  At December 31, 2018 and 2017, the Bank had $311 million and $422 million, respectively, of auto, boat, modular home and recreational vehicle loans in its portfolio, including FDIC-acquired loans totaling $2 million and $3 million, respectively.

Indirect consumer loans decreased significantly in 2017 and 2018, primarily due to tightened underwriting guidelines on automobile lending implemented by the Company in the latter part of 2016, and were $235 million and $336 million at December 31, 2018 and 2017, respectively.  The total indirect consumer loan portfolio at December 31, 2018 was comprised of the following types of loans:  $200 million of used auto loans, $28 million of manufactured home loans, $6 million of new auto loans, $2 million of new boat loans, and various other loans including loans for RVs, used boats, ATVs and motorcycles.

In February 2019, the Company determined that it would cease providing indirect lending services to automobile dealerships, effective March 31, 2019. The environment for providing indirect automobile lending services has been difficult over the last several years. In the latter part of 2016, in response to more challenging consumer credit conditions, the Company tightened its underwriting guidelines on automobile lending. Management took this step in an effort to improve credit quality in the portfolio and lower delinquencies and charge-offs. The changes in underwriting guidelines resulted in lower origination volume, and as such, outstanding consumer auto loan balances have decreased significantly since the end of 2016. After a review of the indirect automobile lending model, the decision was made to exit this business line after March 31, 2019. Market and financial forces, including strong rate competition for well-qualified borrowers, have made indirect automobile lending less profitable over the long term. The Company will continue servicing indirect automobile loans made before March 31, 2019, until each loan agreement is satisfied. Direct consumer lending through the Company’s banking center network is expected to continue as normal.

Consumer loans may entail greater risk than do residential mortgage loans, particularly in the case of consumer loans that are unsecured or secured by rapidly depreciable assets such as automobiles. In such cases, any repossessed collateral for a defaulted consumer loan may not provide an adequate source of repayment of the outstanding loan balance as a result of the greater likelihood of damage, loss or depreciation. The remaining deficiency often does not warrant further substantial collection efforts against the borrower. In addition, consumer loan collections are dependent on the borrower's continuing financial strength, and thus are more likely to be adversely affected by job loss, divorce, illness or personal bankruptcy. Furthermore, the application of various federal and state laws, including federal and state consumer bankruptcy and insolvency laws, may limit the amount which can be recovered on these loans. These loans may also give rise to claims and defenses by a consumer loan borrower against an assignee of these loans such as the Bank, and a borrower may be able to assert against the assignee claims and defenses which it has against the seller of the underlying collateral.

Originations, Purchases, Sales and Servicing of Loans

The Bank originates loans through internal loan production personnel located in the Bank's main and branch offices, as well as loan production offices. Walk-in customers and referrals from existing customers of the Company are also important sources of loan originations.

Great Southern may also purchase whole loans and participation interests in loans (generally without recourse, except in cases of breach of representation, warranty or covenant) from other banks, thrift institutions and life insurance companies (originators). The purchase transaction is governed by a participation agreement entered into by the originator and participant (Great Southern) containing guidelines as to ownership, control and servicing rights, among others. The originator may retain all rights with respect to enforcement, collection and administration of the loan. This may limit Great Southern's ability to control its credit risk when it purchases participations in these loans. For instance, the terms of participation agreements vary; however, generally Great Southern may not have direct access to the borrower, and the institution administering the loan may have some discretion in the administration of performing loans and the collection of non-performing loans.

18






Over the years, a number of banks, both locally and regionally, have sought to diversify the risk in their portfolios. In order to take advantage of this situation, Great Southern purchases participations in commercial real estate, commercial construction and other commercial loans. Great Southern subjects these loans to its normal underwriting standards used for originated loans and rejects any credits that do not meet those guidelines. The originating bank retains the servicing of these loans. Excluding all FDIC-acquired loans, the Bank purchased $128.0 million and $133.0 million of these loans in the fiscal years ended December 31, 2018 and 2017, respectively. Of the total $198.8 million of purchased participation loans outstanding at December 31, 2018, the largest aggregate amount outstanding purchased from one institution was $17.8 million.  This total was comprised of two loans, one which was secured by a senior living facility and the other which was secured by office suites and parking garage.  These loans were performing at December 31, 2018. At December 31, 2018 and 2017, loans which were previously covered by loss sharing agreements with the FDIC but are no longer covered included purchased and participation loans of $136,000 and $249,000, respectively.  At December 31, 2018 and 2017, FDIC-acquired loans which were never covered by loss sharing agreements included purchased and participation loans of $14.1 million and $11.2 million, respectively.  These amounts represent the undiscounted balance of these loans.

From time to time, Great Southern also sells non-residential loan participations generally without recourse to private investors, such as other banks, thrift institutions and life insurance companies (participants). The sales transaction is governed by a participation agreement entered into by the originator (Great Southern) and participant containing guidelines as to ownership, control and servicing rights, among others. Great Southern generally retains servicing rights for these participations sold. These participations are sold with a provision for repurchase upon breach of representation, warranty or covenant.

Great Southern also sells whole residential real estate loans without recourse to Freddie Mac and Fannie Mae as well as to private investors, such as other banks, thrift institutions, mortgage companies and life insurance companies.  Whole real estate loans are sold with a provision for repurchase upon breach of representation, warranty or covenant.  These representations, warranties and covenants include those regarding the compliance of loan originations with all applicable legal requirements, mortgage title insurance policies when applicable, enforceable liens on collateral, collateral type, borrower credit worthiness, private mortgage insurance when required and compliance with all applicable federal regulations.  A minimal number of repurchase requests have been received to date based on a breach of representations, warranties or covenants as outlined in the investor contracts.  These loans are generally sold for cash in amounts equal to the unpaid principal amount of the loans adjusted for current market yields to the buyer. The sale amounts generally produce gains to the Bank and allow a margin for servicing income on loans when the servicing is retained by the Bank. However, residential real estate loans sold in recent years have primarily been with Great Southern releasing control of the servicing of the loans.

The Bank sold one- to four-family whole real estate loans and loan participations in aggregate amounts of $90.6 million, $135.5 million and $153.0 million during fiscal 2018, 2017, and 2016, respectively. The Bank typically sells long-term fixed rate mortgages.  Sales of whole real estate loans and participations in real estate loans can be beneficial to the Bank since these sales generally generate income at the time of sale, produce future servicing income on loans where servicing is retained, provide funds for additional lending and other investments, and increase liquidity.

Gains, losses and transfer fees on sales of loans and loan participations are recognized at the time of the sale. When real estate loans and loan participations sold have an average contractual interest rate that differs from the agreed upon yield to the purchaser (less the agreed upon servicing fee), resulting gains or losses are recognized in an amount equal to the present value of the differential over the estimated remaining life of the loans. Any resulting discount or premium is accreted or amortized over the same estimated life using a method approximating the level yield interest method. When real estate loans and loan participations are sold with servicing released, as the Bank primarily does, an additional fee is received for the servicing rights. Net gains and transfer fees on sales of loans for fiscal 2018, 2017 and 2016 were $1.8 million, $3.2 million and $3.9 million, respectively.  These gains were from the sale of fixed-rate residential loans.

The Bank serviced loans owned by others totaling approximately $260.2 million and $254.0 million at December 31, 2018 and 2017, respectively. Of the total loans serviced at December 31, 2018, $181.5 million related to commercial real estate, commercial business and construction loans, portions of which were sold to other parties.  The remaining $78.7 million of loans serviced for others related to one- to four-family real estate loans which the Bank had originated and sold, but retained the obligation to service, or had acquired the servicing through various FDIC-assisted transactions.  The servicing of these loans generated fees (net of amortization of the servicing rights) to the Bank for the years ended December 31, 2018, 2017 and 2016, of $185,000, $206,000 and $220,000, respectively.

In addition to interest earned on loans and loan origination fees, the Bank receives fees for loan commitments, letters of credit, prepayments, modifications, late payments, transfers of loans due to changes of property ownership and other miscellaneous services. The fees vary from time to time, generally depending on the supply of funds and other competitive conditions in the market. Fees from prepayments, commitments, letters of credit and late payments totaled $1.8 million, $2.4 million and $2.0 million for the years ended December 31, 2018, 2017 and 2016, respectively. Loan origination fees, net of related costs, are accounted for in accordance with FASB ASC 310-20, Receivables – Nonrefundable Fees and Other Costs. Loan fees and certain direct loan origination costs are

19





deferred, and the net fee or cost is recognized in interest income using the level-yield method over the contractual life of the loan. For further discussion of this matter, see Note 1 of the accompanying audited financial statements, included in Item 8 of this Report.

Loan Delinquencies and Defaults

When a borrower fails to make a required payment on a loan, the Bank attempts to cause the delinquency to be cured by contacting the borrower. In the case of loans secured by residential real estate, a late notice is sent 15 days after the due date. If the delinquency is not cured by the 30th day, a delinquent notice is sent to the borrower.

Additional written contacts are made with the borrower 45 and 60 days after the due date. If the delinquency continues for a period of 65 days, the Bank usually institutes appropriate action to foreclose on the collateral. The actual time it takes to foreclose on the collateral varies depending on the particular circumstances and the applicable governing law. If foreclosed upon, the property is sold at public auction and may be purchased by the Bank. Delinquent consumer loans are handled in a generally similar manner, except that initial contacts are made when the payment is five days past due and appropriate action may be taken to collect any loan payment that is delinquent for more than 15 days. The Bank's procedures for repossession and sale of consumer collateral are subject to various requirements under the applicable consumer protection laws as well as other applicable laws and the determination by the Bank that it would be beneficial from a cost basis.

Delinquent commercial business loans and loans secured by commercial real estate are initially handled by the loan officer in charge of the loan, who is responsible for contacting the borrower. Senior management also works with the commercial loan officers to see that necessary steps are taken to collect delinquent loans and may reassign the loan relationship to the special assets group. In addition, the Bank has a Problem Loan Committee which meets at least quarterly and reviews all classified assets, as well as other loans which management feels may present possible collection problems. If an acceptable workout of a delinquent commercial loan cannot be agreed upon, the Bank may initiate foreclosure proceedings on any collateral securing the loan. However, in all cases, whether a commercial or other loan, the prevailing circumstances may be such that management may determine it is in the best interest of the Bank not to foreclose on the collateral.















20





The following tables set forth our loans by aging category:

   
December 31, 2018
 
                                                         
Total
 
   
30-59 Days
   
60-89 Days
                                 
Loans
 
   
Past Due
   
Past Due
   
Over 90 Days
   
Total Past Due
   
Current
   
Receivable
 
     
#
   
Amount
     
#
   
Amount
     
#
   
Amount
     
#
   
Amount
   
Amount
   
Amount
 
   
(Dollars In Thousands)
 
One- to four-family residential construction
   
   
$
     
   
$
     
   
$
     
   
$
   
$
26,177
   
$
26,177
 
Subdivision construction
   
     
     
     
     
     
     
     
     
13,844
     
13,844
 
Land development
   
1
     
13
     
     
     
3
     
49
     
4
     
62
     
44,430
     
44,492
 
Commercial construction
   
     
     
     
     
     
     
     
     
1,417,166
     
1,417,166
 
Owner occupied one- to four-
    family residential
   
19
     
1,431
     
12
     
806
     
16
     
1,206
     
47
     
3,443
     
273,423
     
276,866
 
Non-owner occupied one- to four-family residential
   
6
     
1,142
     
1
     
144
     
12
     
1,458
     
19
     
2,744
     
119,694
     
122,438
 
Commercial real estate
   
6
     
3,940
     
1
     
53
     
7
     
334
     
14
     
4,327
     
1,367,108
     
1,371,435
 
Other residential
   
     
     
     
     
     
     
     
     
784,894
     
784,894
 
Commercial business
   
4
     
72
     
2
     
54
     
7
     
1,437
     
13
     
1,563
     
320,555
     
322,118
 
Industrial revenue bonds
   
1
     
3
     
     
     
     
     
1
     
3
     
13,937
     
13,940
 
Consumer auto
   
282
     
2,596
     
76
     
722
     
150
     
1,490
     
508
     
4,808
     
248,720
     
253,528
 
Consumer other
   
45
     
691
     
23
     
181
     
19
     
240
     
87
     
1,112
     
56,238
     
57,350
 
Home equity lines of credit
   
11
     
229
     
     
     
7
     
86
     
18
     
315
     
121,037
     
121,352
 
Loans acquired and accounted for under ASC 310-30,
                                                                               
   net of discounts
   
33
     
2,195
     
10
     
1,416
     
79
     
6,827
     
122
     
10,438
     
157,213
     
167,651
 
     
408
     
12,312
     
125
     
3,376
     
300
     
13,127
     
833
     
28,815
     
4,964,436
     
4,993,251
 
Less loans acquired and accounted for under ASC 310-30,
                                                                               
   net of discounts
   
33
     
2,195
     
10
     
1,416
     
79
     
6,827
     
122
     
10,438
     
157,213
     
167,651
 
                                                                                 
Total
   
375
   
$
10,117
     
115
   
$
1,960
     
221
   
$
6,300
     
711
   
$
18,377
   
$
4,807,223
   
$
4,825,600
 


21




   
December 31, 2017
 
                                                         
Total
 
   
30-59 Days
   
60-89 Days
                                 
Loans
 
   
Past Due
   
Past Due
   
Over 90 Days
   
Total Past Due
   
Current
   
Receivable
 
     
#
   
Amount
     
#
   
Amount
     
#
   
Amount
     
#
   
Amount
   
Amount
   
Amount
 
   
(Dollars In Thousands)
 
One- to four-family residential construction
   
1
   
$
250
     
   
$
     
   
$
     
1
   
$
250
   
$
20,543
   
$
20,793
 
Subdivision construction
   
     
     
     
     
1
     
98
     
1
     
98
     
17,964
     
18,062
 
Land development
   
3
     
54
     
1
     
37
     
     
     
4
     
91
     
43,880
     
43,971
 
Commercial construction
   
     
     
     
     
     
     
     
     
1,068,352
     
1,068,352
 
Owner occupied one- to four-family residential
   
22
     
1,927
     
1
     
71
     
14
     
904
     
37
     
2,902
     
187,613
     
190,515
 
Non-owner occupied one- to four-family residential
   
6
     
947
     
1
     
190
     
14
     
1,816
     
21
     
2,953
     
116,515
     
119,468
 
Commercial real estate
   
9
     
8,346
     
2
     
993
     
8
     
1,226
     
19
     
10,565
     
1,224,764
     
1,235,329
 
Other residential
   
2
     
540
     
1
     
353
     
1
     
1,877
     
4
     
2,770
     
742,875
     
745,645
 
Commercial business
   
12
     
2,623
     
4
     
1,282
     
7
     
2,063
     
23
     
5,968
     
347,383
     
353,351
 
Industrial revenue bonds
   
     
     
     
     
     
     
     
     
21,859
     
21,859
 
Consumer auto
   
437
     
5,196
     
107
     
1,230
     
215
     
2,284
     
759
     
8,710
     
348,432
     
357,142
 
Consumer other
   
41
     
464
     
16
     
64
     
26
     
557
     
83
     
1,085
     
62,283
     
63,368
 
Home equity lines of credit
   
6
     
58
     
     
     
14
     
430
     
20
     
488
     
114,951
     
115,439
 
Loans acquired and accounted for under ASC 310-30,
                                                                               
   net of discounts
   
59
     
4,449
     
18
     
1,951
     
96
     
10,675
     
173
     
17,075
     
192,594
     
209,669
 
     
598
     
24,854
     
151
     
6,171
     
396
     
21,930
     
1,145
     
52,955
     
4,510,008
     
4,562,963
 
Less loans acquired and  accounted for under ASC 310-30,
                                                                               
   net of discounts
   
59
     
4,449
     
18
     
1,951
     
96
     
10,675
     
173
     
17,075
     
192,594
     
209,669
 
                                                                                 
Total
   
539
   
$
20,405
     
133
   
$
4,220
     
300
   
$
11,255
     
972
   
$
35,880
   
$
4,317,414
   
$
4,353,294
 






22





Classified Assets

Federal regulations provide for the classification of loans and other assets such as debt and equity securities considered to be of lesser quality as "substandard," "doubtful" or "loss" assets. The regulations require insured institutions to classify their own assets and to establish prudent specific allocations for losses from assets classified "substandard" or "doubtful." “Substandard” assets include those characterized by the distinct possibility that the Bank will sustain some loss if the deficiencies are not corrected.  Assets classified as “doubtful,” have all the weaknesses inherent in those classified as “substandard” with the added characteristic that the weaknesses present make collection or liquidation in full, on the basis of currently existing facts, conditions and values, highly questionable and improbable.  For the portion of assets classified as "loss," an institution is required to either establish specific allowances of 100% of the amount classified or charge such amount off its books. Assets that do not currently expose the insured institution to sufficient risk to warrant classification in one of the aforementioned categories but possess a potential weakness (referred to as “special mention” assets), are required to be listed on the Bank's watch list and monitored for further deterioration. In addition, a bank's regulators may require the establishment of a general allowance for losses based on the general quality of the asset portfolio of the bank. Following are the total classified assets at December 31, 2018 and 2017, per the Bank's internal asset classification list, excluding assets acquired through FDIC-assisted transactions. The allowances for loan losses reflected below are the portions of the Bank’s total allowances for loan losses relating to these classified loans.  There were no significant off-balance sheet items classified at December 31, 2018 and 2017.

   
December 31, 2018
 
Asset Category
 
Special Mention
   
Substandard
   
Doubtful
   
Loss
   
Total
Classified
   
Allowance
for Losses
 
 
 
(In Thousands)
 
 
                                   
Investment securities
 
$
   
$
   
$
   
$
   
$
   
$
 
Loans
   
     
9,603
     
     
     
9,603
     
2,041
 
Foreclosed assets and repossessions
   
     
5,480
     
     
     
5,480
     
 
Total
 
$
   
$
15,083
   
$
   
$
   
$
15,083
   
$
2,041
 


   
December 31, 2017
 
Asset Category
 
Special Mention
   
Substandard
   
Doubtful
   
Loss
   
Total
Classified
   
Allowance
for Losses
 
 
 
(In Thousands)
 
 
                                   
Investment securities
 
$
   
$
   
$
   
$
   
$
   
$
 
Loans
   
     
18,633
     
500
     
     
19,133
     
3,951
 
Foreclosed assets and repossessions
   
     
16,575
     
     
     
16,575
     
 
Total
 
$
   
$
35,208
   
$
500
   
$
   
$
35,708
   
$
3,951
 


Non-Performing Assets

The table below sets forth the amounts and categories of gross non-performing assets (classified loans which are not performing under regulatory guidelines and all foreclosed assets, including assets acquired in settlement of loans) in the Bank's loan portfolio as of the dates indicated. Loans generally are placed on non-accrual status when the loan becomes 90 days delinquent or when the collection of principal, interest, or both, otherwise becomes doubtful.

Former TeamBank, Vantus Bank, Sun Security Bank and InterBank non-performing assets, including foreclosed assets, are not included in the totals of non-performing assets below as they were subject to loss sharing agreements with the FDIC, which substantially covered principal losses that may have been incurred in these portfolios for the applicable terms under the agreements.  In addition, these assets were initially recorded at their fair value estimated fair values as of their acquisition dates.  Former Valley Bank loans are also excluded from the totals of non-performing assets below, although they were not covered by a loss sharing agreement.  As in the previous FDIC-assisted acquisitions, former Valley Bank loans are accounted for in pools and were recorded at their fair value at the time of the acquisition as of June 20, 2014; therefore, these loan pools are analyzed rather than the individual loans.  The overall performance of the FDIC-covered acquired loan pools has been better than original expectations as of the acquisition dates.  At December 31, 2018, there were no material non-performing assets in these acquired loan portfolios.


23




 
December 31,
 
 
2018
   
2017
   
2016
   
2015
   
2014
 
 
(In Thousands)
 
 
                           
Non-accruing loans:
                           
One- to four-family residential
 
$
2,664
   
$
2,662
   
$
1,529
   
$
1,060
   
$
1,155
 
One- to four-family construction
   
49
     
98
     
109
     
     
 
Other residential
   
     
1,877
(1)
   
162
     
     
 
Commercial real estate
   
334
     
1,226
     
4,404
(2)
   
13,488
(3)
   
4,512
(4)
Other commercial
   
1,437
(5)
   
2,063
(6)
   
3,088
(7)
   
288
     
411
 
Commercial construction and land development
   
     
     
1,718
     
139
     
255
 
Consumer
   
1,816
     
3,233
     
3,071
     
1,594
     
1,038
 
 
                                       
Total gross non-accruing loans
   
6,300
     
11,159
     
14,081
     
16,569
     
7,371
 
 
                                       
 
   
Loans over 90 days delinquent
   still accruing interest:
   
  One- to four-family residential
   
     
58
     
     
     
170
 
  Commercial real estate
   
     
     
     
     
187
 
  Other commercial
   
     
     
     
     
 
  Commercial construction and land development
   
     
     
     
     
 
  Consumer
   
     
38
     
     
     
419
 
  Total loans over 90 days delinquent
   still accruing interest
   
     
96
     
     
     
776
 
 
                                       
 
                                       
Other impaired loans
   
     
     
     
     
 
 
                                       
  Total gross non-performing loans
   
6,300
     
11,255
     
14,081
     
16,569
     
8,147
 
 
                                       
Foreclosed assets:
                                       
  One- to four-family residential
   
269
     
112
     
1,217
     
1,375
     
3,353
 
  One- to four-family construction
   
     
     
     
     
223
 
  Other residential
   
     
140
     
954
     
2,150
     
2,625
 
  Commercial real estate
   
     
1,694
     
3,841
     
3,608
     
1,632
 
  Commercial construction and land development
   
4,283
     
12,642
     
17,246
     
19,149
     
27,025
 
  Other commercial
   
     
     
     
     
59
 
 
                                       
Total foreclosed assets
   
4,552
     
14,588
     
23,258
     
26,282
     
34,917
 
 
                                       
Repossessions
   
928
     
1,987
     
1,991
     
1,109
     
624
 
 
                                       
Total gross non-performing assets
 
$
11,780
   
$
27,830
   
$
39,330
   
$
43,960
   
$
43,688
 
Total gross non-performing assets as a
  percentage of average total assets
   
0.26
%
   
0.62
%
   
0.90
%
   
1.08
%
   
1.14
%
________________________
(1)
One relationship was $1.9 million, the entire total of this category, at December 31, 2017.
(2)
The largest two relationships in this category were $1.7 million and $1.7 million, respectively, at December 31, 2016.
(3)
The largest two relationships in this category were $6.5 million and $3.7 million, respectively, at December 31, 2015.
(4)
The largest two relationships in this category were $2.0 million and $1.9 million, respectively, at December 31, 2014.
(5)
One relationship was $1.1 million of this total at December 31, 2018.
(6)
One relationship was $1.5 million of this total at December 31, 2017.
(7)
One relationship was $3.0 million of this total at December 31, 2016.
   

See Item 7. "Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations – Non-performing Assets” for further information.

24





Gross impaired loans totaled $13.9 million at December 31, 2018 and $25.3 million at December 31, 2017. A loan is considered impaired when, based on current information and events, it is probable that the Company will be unable to collect the scheduled payments of principal or interest when due according to the contractual terms of the loan agreement. Factors considered by management in determining impairment include payment status, collateral value and the probability of collecting scheduled principal and interest payments when due.  See Note 3 “Loans” of the accompanying audited financial statements included in Item 8 for additional information including further detail of non-accruing loans and impaired loans and details of troubled debt restructurings.  See also Note 15 “Disclosures About Fair Value of Financial Instruments” of the accompanying audited financial statements included in Item 8 for additional information.

For the year ended December 31, 2018, gross interest income which would have been recorded had the non-accruing loans been current in accordance with their original terms amounted to $1.0 million. No interest income was included on these loans for the year ended December 31, 2018. For the year ended December 31, 2017, gross interest income which would have been recorded had the non-accruing loans been current in accordance with their original terms amounted to $1.2 million. No interest income was included on these loans for the year ended December 31, 2017. For the year ended December 31, 2016, gross interest income which would have been recorded had the non-accruing loans been current in accordance with their original terms amounted to $1.5 million. No interest income was included on these loans for the year ended December 31, 2016.

Restructured Troubled Debt

Included in impaired loans at December 31, 2018 and 2017, were loans modified in troubled debt restructurings as follows:

   
December 31, 2018
 
   
Restructured
   
Accruing
   
Restructured Troubled
 
   
Troubled Debt
   
Interest
   
Debt Nonaccruing
 
   
(In Thousands)
 
                   
Commercial real estate
 
$
1,344
   
$
1,238
   
$
106
 
One- to four-family residential
   
3,892
     
2,299
     
1,593
 
Other residential
   
     
     
 
Construction
   
283
     
283
     
 
Commercial
   
548
     
407
     
141
 
Consumer
   
803
     
428
     
375
 
   
$
6,870
   
$
4,655
   
$
2,215
 

   
December 31, 2017
 
   
Restructured
   
Accruing
   
Restructured Troubled
 
   
Troubled Debt
   
Interest
   
Debt Nonaccruing
 
   
(In Thousands)
 
                   
Commercial real estate
 
$
7,085
   
$
7,085
   
$
 
One- to four-family residential
   
3,265
     
2,602
     
663
 
Other residential
   
2,907
     
1,030
     
1,877
 
Construction
   
266
     
266
     
 
Commercial
   
867
     
867
     
 
Consumer
   
617
     
410
     
207
 
   
$
15,007
   
$
12,260
   
$
2,747
 

Allowances for Losses on Loans and Foreclosed Assets

Great Southern maintains an allowance for loan losses to absorb losses known and inherent in the loan portfolio based upon ongoing, monthly assessments of the loan portfolio. Our methodology for assessing the appropriateness of the allowance consists of several key elements, which include a formula allowance, specific allowances for identified problem loans and portfolio segments and economic conditions that may lead to a concern about the loan portfolio or segments of the loan portfolio.

The formula allowance is calculated by applying loss factors to outstanding loans based on the internal risk evaluation of such loans or pools of loans. Changes in risk evaluations of both performing and non-performing loans affect the amount of the formula allowance.

25





Loss factors are based both on our historical loss experience and on significant factors that, in management's judgment, affect the collectability of the portfolio as of the evaluation date. Loan loss factors for portfolio segments are representative of the credit risks associated with loans in those segments. The greater the credit risks associated with a particular segment, the greater the loss factor.

The appropriateness of the allowance is reviewed by management based upon its evaluation of then-existing economic and business conditions affecting our key lending areas. Other conditions that management considers in determining the appropriateness of the allowance include, but are not limited to, changes to our underwriting standards (if any), credit quality trends (including changes in non-performing loans expected to result from existing economic and other market conditions), trends in collateral values, loan volumes and concentrations, and recent loss experience in particular segments of the portfolio that existed as of the balance sheet date and the impact that such conditions were believed to have had on the collectability of those loans.

Senior management reviews these conditions regularly in discussions with our credit officers. To the extent that any of these conditions are evident in a specifically identifiable problem loan or portfolio segment as of the evaluation date, management's estimate of the effect of such condition may be reflected as a specific allowance applicable to such loan or portfolio segment. Where any of these conditions are not evident in a specifically identifiable problem loan or portfolio segment as of the evaluation date, management's evaluation of the loss related to these conditions is reflected in the general allowance associated with our loan portfolio. The evaluation of the inherent loss with respect to these conditions is subject to a higher degree of uncertainty because they are not identified with specific problem loans or portfolio segments.

The amounts actually observed in respect of these losses can vary significantly from the estimated amounts. Our methodology permits adjustments to any loss factor used in the computation of the formula allowances in the event that, in management's judgment, significant factors which affect the collectability of the portfolio, as of the evaluation date, are not reflected in the current loss factors. By assessing the estimated losses inherent in our loan portfolio on a monthly basis, we can adjust specific and inherent loss estimates based upon more current information.

On a quarterly basis, senior management presents a formal assessment of the adequacy of the allowance for loan losses to Great Southern's board of directors for the board's approval of the allowance. Assessing the adequacy of the allowance for loan losses is inherently subjective as it requires making material estimates including the amount and timing of future cash flows expected to be received on impaired loans or changes in the market value of collateral securing loans that may be susceptible to significant change. In the opinion of management, the allowance when taken as a whole is adequate to absorb reasonable estimated loan losses inherent in Great Southern's loan portfolio.

Allowances for estimated losses on foreclosed assets (real estate and other assets acquired through foreclosure) are charged to expense, when in the opinion of management, any significant and permanent decline in the market value of the underlying asset reduces the market value to less than the carrying value of the asset. Senior management assesses the market value of each foreclosed asset individually on a regular basis.

At December 31, 2018 and 2017, Great Southern had an allowance for losses on loans of $38.4 million and $36.5 million, respectively, of which $2.0 million and $4.0 million, respectively, had been allocated to specific loans.  All loans with specific allowances were considered to be impaired loans. The allowance and the activity within the allowance during 2018, 2017 and 2016 are discussed further in Note 3 “Loans and Allowance for Loan Losses” of the accompanying audited financial statements and "Management's Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations" contained in Item 8 and Item 7 of this Report, respectively.




26






The allocation of the allowance for losses on loans at the dates indicated is summarized as follows.

 
 
December 31,
 
 
 
2018
   
2017
   
2016
   
2015
   
2014
 
 
 
Amount
   
% of
Loans to
Total
Loans (2)
   
Amount
   
% of
Loans to
Total
Loans (2)
   
Amount
   
% of
Loans to
Total
Loans (2)
   
Amount
   
% of
Loans to
Total
Loans (2)
   
Amount
   
% of
Loans to
Total
Loans (2)
 
 
 
(Dollars In Thousands)
 
One- to four-family residential
      and construction
 
$
3,086
     
9.1
%
 
$
2,077
     
8.0
%
 
$
2,198
     
9.2
%
 
$
4,195
     
9.4
%
 
$
3,361
     
10.2
%
Other residential and construction
   
4,681
     
16.3
     
2,813
     
17.1
     
5,396
     
16.1
     
3,122
     
12.2
     
2,923
     
13.3
 
Commercial real estate
   
19,571
     
28.4
     
18,442
     
28.4
     
15,716
     
28.9
     
14,444
     
30.3
     
18,422
     
32.1
 
Commercial construction
   
3,029
     
30.3
     
1,690
     
25.6
     
2,244
     
20.3
     
2,961
     
19.2
     
3,412
     
15.1
 
Other commercial
   
1,556
     
7.0
     
3,509
     
8.6
     
2,976
     
9.1
     
3,977
     
11.5
     
3,628
     
13.4
 
Consumer and overdrafts
   
6,065
     
8.9
     
7,501
     
12.3
     
8,245
     
16.4
     
7,947
     
17.4
     
4,553
     
15.9
 
Loans covered by loss sharing
      agreements (1)
   
     
     
     
     
70
     
     
344
     
     
941
     
 
Acquired loans not covered by loss
      sharing agreements
   
421
     
     
460
     
     
555
     
     
1,159
     
     
1,195
     
 
Total
 
$
38,409
     
100.0
%
 
$
36,492
     
100.0
%
 
$
37,400
     
100.0
%
 
$
38,149
     
100.0
%
 
$
38,435
     
100.0
%
______________
(1) Associated with these allowances at December 31, 2018, 2017, 2016, 2015 and 2014, were receivables from the FDIC totaling $-0-, $-0-, $56,000, $275,000, and $753,000, respectively, under the loss sharing agreements which were in place at the time.
(2) Excludes loans acquired through FDIC-assisted transactions.
 

The following table sets forth an analysis of activity in the Bank's allowance for losses on loans showing the details of the activity by types of loans.

 
 
December 31,
 
 
 
2018
 
 
2017
 
 
2016
 
 
2015
 
 
2014
 
 
 
(Dollars In Thousands)
 
 
 
 
 
Balance at beginning of period
 
$
36,492
 
 
$
37,400
 
 
$
38,149
 
 
$
38,435
 
 
$
40,116
 
Charge-offs:
 
 
 
  One- to four-family residential
 
 
62
 
 
 
165
 
 
 
229
 
 
 
80
 
 
 
2,251
 
  Other residential
 
 
525
 
 
 
488
 
 
 
16
 
 
 
2
 
 
 
1
 
  Commercial real estate
 
 
102
 
 
 
1,656
 
 
 
5,653
 
 
 
2,584
 
 
 
2,160
 
  Construction
 
 
87
 
 
 
420
 
 
 
31
 
 
 
329
 
 
 
126
 
  Other commercial
 
 
1,155
 
 
 
1,489
 
 
 
589
 
 
 
1,202
 
 
 
3,286
 
  Consumer, overdrafts and other loans
 
 
9,425
 
 
 
11,859
 
 
 
8,751
 
 
 
5,315
 
 
 
4,005
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  Total charge-offs
 
 
11,356
 
 
 
16,077
 
 
 
15,269
 
 
 
9,512
 
 
 
11,829
 
 
 
 
 
Recoveries:
 
 
 
  One- to four-family residential
 
 
334
 
 
 
109
 
 
 
58
 
 
 
97
 
 
 
496
 
  Other residential
 
 
417
 
 
 
197
 
 
 
52
 
 
 
58
 
 
 
37
 
  Commercial real estate
 
 
172
 
 
 
123
 
 
 
1,221
 
 
 
302
 
 
 
3,139
 
  Construction
 
 
394
 
 
 
546
 
 
 
123
 
 
 
405
 
 
 
181
 
  Other commercial
 
 
755
 
 
 
580
 
 
 
327
 
 
 
276
 
 
 
105
 
  Consumer, overdrafts and other loans
 
 
4,051
 
 
 
4,514
 
 
 
3,458
 
 
 
2,569
 
 
 
2,039
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  Total recoveries
 
 
6,123
 
 
 
6,069
 
 
 
5,239
 
 
 
3,707
 
 
 
5,997
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Net charge-offs
 
 
5,233
 
 
 
10,008
 
 
 
10,030
 
 
 
5,805
 
 
 
5,832
 
Provision for losses on loans
 
 
7,150
 
 
 
9,100
 
 
 
9,281
 
 
 
5,519
 
 
 
4,151
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Balance at end of period
 
$
38,409
 
 
$
36,492
 
 
$
37,400
 
 
$
38,149
 
 
$
38,435
 
Ratio of net charge-offs to average loans outstanding
 
 
0.13
%
 
 
0.26
%
 
 
0.29
%
 
 
0.20
%
 
 
0.24
%

27




Investment Activities

Excluding securities issued by the United States Government, or its agencies, there were no investment securities in excess of 10% of the Company’s stockholders’ equity at December 31, 2018, 2017 and 2016, respectively.  Agencies, for this purpose, primarily include Freddie Mac, Fannie Mae, Ginnie Mae and FHLBank.

As of December 31, 2018 and 2017, the Bank held approximately $-0- and $130,000, respectively, in principal amount of investment securities which the Bank intends to hold until maturity.  As of such dates, these securities had fair values of approximately $-0- and $131,000, respectively. In addition, as of December 31, 2018 and 2017, the Company held approximately $244.0 million and $179.2 million, respectively, in principal amount of investment securities which the Company classified as available-for-sale. See Notes 1 and 2 of the accompanying audited financial statements included in Item 8 of this Report.

The amortized cost and fair values of, and gross unrealized gains and losses on, investment securities at the dates indicated are summarized as follows.

   
December 31, 2018
 
   
Amortized
   
Gross Unrealized
   
Gross Unrealized
   
Fair
 
   
Cost
   
Gains
   
Losses
   
Value
 
   
(In Thousands)
 
                         
AVAILABLE-FOR-SALE SECURITIES:
                       
Agency mortgage-backed securities
 
$
154,557
   
$
1,272
   
$
2,571
   
$
153,258
 
Agency collateralized mortgage obligations
   
39,024
     
250
     
14
     
39,260
 
States and political subdivisions
   
50,022
     
1,428
     
     
51,450
 
   
$
243,603
   
$
2,950
   
$
2,585
   
$
243,968
 

   
December 31, 2017
 
   
Amortized
   
Gross Unrealized
   
Gross Unrealized
   
Fair
 
   
Cost
   
Gains
   
Losses
   
Value
 
   
(In Thousands)
 
                         
AVAILABLE-FOR-SALE SECURITIES:
                       
Agency mortgage-backed securities
 
$
123,300
   
$
871
   
$
1,638
   
$
122,533
 
States and political subdivisions
   
53,930
     
2,716
     
     
56,646
 
   
$
177,230
   
$
3,587
   
$
1,638
   
$
179,179
 
                                 
HELD-TO-MATURITY SECURITIES
                               
States and political subdivisions
 
$
130
   
$
1
   
$
   
$
131
 
                                 

   
December 31, 2016
 
   
Amortized
   
Gross Unrealized
   
Gross Unrealized
   
Fair
 
   
Cost
   
Gains
   
Losses
   
Value
 
   
(In Thousands)
 
                         
AVAILABLE-FOR-SALE SECURITIES:
                       
Agency mortgage-backed securities
 
$
146,491
   
$
1,045
   
$
1,501
   
$
146,035
 
States and political subdivisions
   
64,682
     
3,163
     
8
     
67,837
 
   
$
211,173
   
$
4,208
   
$
1,509
   
$
213,872
 
                                 
HELD-TO-MATURITY SECURITIES
                               
States and political subdivisions
 
$
247
   
$
11
   
$
   
$
258
 

28





At December 31, 2018, the Company’s mortgage-backed securities portfolio consisted of FHLMC securities totaling $37.2 million, FNMA securities totaling $92.1 million and GNMA securities totaling $23.9 million.  At December 31, 2018, agency collateralized mortgage obligations consisted of GNMA securities totaling $39.3 million, all of which are commercial multi-family fixed rate securities. At December 31, 2018, $108.5 million of the Company’s agency mortgage-backed securities had fixed rates of interest and $84.0 million had variable rates of interest.  Of the total FNMA securities at December 31, 2018, $56.3 million are commercial multi-family fixed rate securities.

The following tables present the contractual maturities and weighted average tax-equivalent yields of available-for-sale securities at December 31, 2018.  Expected maturities may differ from contractual maturities because issuers may have the right to call or prepay obligations with or without call or prepayment penalties.
 
 
 
Cost
   
Tax-Equivalent
Amortized
Yield
   
Fair Value
 
 
 
(Dollars In Thousands)
 
After one through five years
 
$
849
     
5.68
%
 
$
919
 
After five through ten years
   
9,959
     
4.30
%
   
10,139
 
After ten years
   
39,214
     
4.92
%
   
40,392
 
Securities not due on a single maturity date
   
193,581
     
2.90
%
   
192,518
 
 
                       
Total
 
$
243,603
     
3.29
%
 
$
243,968
 

 
 
One Year
or Less
   
After One
Through
Five Years
   
After Five
Through
Ten Years
   
After
Ten
Years
   
Securities
Not Due
on a Single
Maturity Date
   
Total
 
 
  (In Thousands)
 
 
                                   
Agency mortgage-backed securities
 
$
   
$
   
$
   
$
   
$
153,258
   
$
153,258
 
Agency collateralized mortgage obligations
   
     
     
     
     
39,260
     
39,260
 
States and political subdivisions
   
     
919
     
10,139
     
40,392
     
     
51,450
 
 
                                               
     Total
 
$
   
$
919
   
$
10,139
   
$
40,392
   
$
192,518
   
$
243,968
 

The following table shows our investments' gross unrealized losses and fair values, aggregated by investment category and length of time that individual securities have been in a continuous unrealized loss position at December 31, 2018, 2017 and 2016, respectively:

   
2018
 
   
Less than 12 Months
   
12 Months or More
   
Total
 
   
Fair
   
Unrealized
   
Fair
   
Unrealized
   
Fair
   
Unrealized
 
Description of Securities
 
Value
   
Losses
   
Value
   
Losses
   
Value
   
Losses
 
   
(In Thousands)
 
                                     
Agency mortgage-backed securities
 
$
11,255
   
$
(82
)
 
$
74,186
   
$
(2,489
)
 
$
85,441
   
$
(2,571
)
Agency collateralized mortgage obligations
   
9,725
     
(14
)
   
     
     
9,725
     
(14
)
States and political
                                               
subdivisions
   
511
     
     
     
     
511
     
 
   
$
21,491
   
$
(96
)
 
$
74,186
   
$
(2,489
)
 
$
95,677
   
$
(2,585
)


29






   
2017
 
   
Less than 12 Months
   
12 Months or More
   
Total
 
   
Fair
   
Unrealized
   
Fair
   
Unrealized
   
Fair
   
Unrealized
 
Description of Securities
 
Value
   
Losses
   
Value
   
Losses
   
Value
   
Losses
 
   
(In Thousands)
 
                                     
Agency mortgage-backed securities
 
$
33,862
   
$
(384
)
 
$
55,845
   
$
(1,254
)
 
$
89,707
   
$
(1,638
)
States and political
                                               
subdivisions
   
     
     
     
     
     
 
   
$
33,862
   
$
(384
)
 
$
55,845
   
$
(1,254
)
 
$
89,707
   
$
(1,638
)

   
2016
 
   
Less than 12 Months
   
12 Months or More
   
Total
 
   
Fair
   
Unrealized
   
Fair
   
Unrealized
   
Fair
   
Unrealized
 
Description of Securities
 
Value
   
Losses
   
Value
   
Losses
   
Value
   
Losses
 
   
(In Thousands)
 
                                     
Agency mortgage-backed securities
 
$
102,296
   
$
(1,501
)
 
$
   
$
   
$
102,296
   
$
(1,501
)
States and political
                                               
subdivisions
   
2,164
     
(8
)
   
     
     
2,164
     
(8
)
   
$
104,460
   
$
(1,509
)
 
$
   
$
   
$
104,460
   
$
(1,509
)

On at least a quarterly basis, the Company evaluates the securities portfolio to determine if an other-than-temporary impairment (OTTI) needs to be recorded.  For debt securities with fair values below carrying value, when the Company does not intend to sell a debt security, and it is more likely than not the Company will not have to sell the security before recovery of its cost basis, it recognizes the credit component of an OTTI of a debt security in earnings and the remaining portion in other comprehensive income.  For held-to-maturity debt securities, the amount of an OTTI recorded in other comprehensive income for the noncredit portion of a previous OTTI is amortized prospectively over the remaining life of the security on the basis of the timing of future estimated cash flows of the security.  During 2018, 2017 and 2016, no securities were determined to have impairment that had become other than temporary.

The Company’s consolidated statements of income as of December 31, 2018, 2017 and 2016, reflect the full impairment (that is, the difference between the security’s amortized cost basis and fair value) on debt securities that the Company intends to sell or would more likely than not be required to sell before the expected recovery of the amortized cost basis.  For available-for-sale and held-to-maturity debt securities that management has no intent to sell and believes that it more likely than not will not be required to sell prior to recovery, only the credit loss component of the impairment is recognized in earnings, while the noncredit loss is recognized in accumulated other comprehensive income.  The credit loss component recognized in earnings is identified as the amount of principal cash flows not expected to be received over the remaining term of the security as projected based on cash flow projections.

For equity securities, if any, when the Company has decided to sell an impaired available-for-sale security and the Company does not expect the fair value of the security to fully recover before the expected time of sale, the security is deemed other-than-temporarily impaired in the period in which the decision to sell is made.  The Company recognizes an impairment loss when the impairment is deemed other than temporary even if a decision to sell has not been made.

Sources of Funds

General. Deposit accounts have traditionally been the principal source of the Bank's funds for use in lending and for other general business purposes. In addition to deposits, the Bank obtains funds through advances from the Federal Home Loan Bank of Des Moines ("FHLBank") and other borrowings, loan repayments, loan sales, and cash flows generated from operations. Scheduled loan payments are a relatively stable source of funds, while deposit inflows and outflows and the related costs of such funds have varied widely. Borrowings such as FHLBank advances may be used on a short-term basis to compensate for seasonal reductions in deposits or deposit inflows at less than projected levels and may be used on a longer-term basis to support expanded lending activities. The availability of funds from loan sales is influenced by general interest rates as well as the volume of originations.

30






Deposits. The Bank attracts both short-term and long-term deposits from the general public by offering a wide variety of accounts and rates and also purchases brokered deposits from time to time. The Bank offers regular savings accounts, checking accounts, various money market accounts, fixed-interest rate certificates with varying maturities, certificates of deposit in minimum amounts of $100,000 ("Jumbo" accounts), brokered certificates and individual retirement accounts.  In 2016, the Bank increased its deposits through internal growth and the assumption of deposits in a branch acquisition. Additionally in 2016, the Bank increased its brokered deposits by $40 million.  In 2017, the Bank increased its interest-bearing demand and savings deposits and non-interest-bearing demand deposits through internal growth.  Additionally in 2017, the Bank decreased its brokered deposits by $64 million and decreased its time deposits in denominations of $100,000 or more by $36 million. In 2018, the Bank increased its deposits primarily through internal growth in time deposits and growth in brokered deposits, partially offset by a decrease in interest-bearing demand and savings deposits.  In 2018, the Bank increased its brokered deposits by $101 million.  The deposit growth and funds from borrowings were used to fund the Bank’s loan growth.  Also in 2018, the Bank sold deposits totaling approximately $56 million.

The following table sets forth the dollar amount of deposits, by interest rate range, in the various types of deposit programs offered by the Bank at the dates indicated.

 
 
 
December 31,
 
 
 
 
2018
 
 
2017
 
 
2016
 
 
 
 
Amount
 
 
Percent of
Total
 
 
Amount
 
 
Percent of
Total
 
 
Amount
 
 
Percent of
Total
 
 
 
     
(Dollars In Thousands)
     
Time deposits:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
0.00% - 0.99%
 
$
150,656
 
 
 
4.05
%
 
$
254,502
 
 
 
7.07
%
 
$
695,738
 
 
 
18.92
%
 
 
 
1.00% - 1.99%
   
511,873
     
13.74
     
1,006,373
     
27.98
     
737,649
     
20.06
     
 
2.00% - 2.99%
 
 
857,973
 
 
 
23.03
 
 
 
106,888
 
 
 
2.97
 
 
 
48,777
 
 
 
1.33
 
 
 
 
3.00% - 3.99%
 
 
69,793
 
 
 
1.87
 
 
 
701
 
 
 
0.02
 
 
 
1,119
 
 
 
0.03
 
 
 
 
4.00% - 4.99%
 
 
1,116
 
 
 
0.03
 
 
 
1,108
 
 
 
0.03
 
 
 
1,171
 
 
 
0.03
 
 
 
 
5.00% and above 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
272
 
 
 
0.01
 
 
 
272
 
 
 
0.01
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Total time deposits
 
 
 
1,591,411
 
 
 
42.72
 
 
 
1,369,844
 
 
 
38.08
 
 
 
1,484,726
 
 
 
40.38
 
 
 
Non-interest-bearing demand deposits
 
 
 
661,061
 
 
 
17.75
 
 
 
661,589
 
 
 
18.39
 
 
 
653,288
 
 
 
17.76
 
 
 
Interest-bearing demand and savings deposits
(0.46%-0.32%-0.26%)
 
 
 
1,472,535
 
 
 
 
39.53
 
 
 
1,565,711
 
 
 
 
43.53
 
 
 
1,539,216
 
 
 
 
41.86
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Total Deposits
 
 
$
3,725,007
 
 
 
100.00
%
 
$
3,597,144
 
 
 
100.00
%
 
$
3,677,230
 
 
 
100.00
%
 
 

A table showing maturity information for the Bank's time deposits as of December 31, 2018, is presented in Note 8 of the accompanying audited financial statements, which are included in Item 8 of this Report.

The variety of deposit accounts offered by the Bank has allowed it to be competitive in obtaining funds and has allowed it to respond with flexibility to changes in consumer demand. The Bank has become more susceptible to short-term fluctuations in deposit flows, as customers have become more interest rate conscious and the Bank’s deposit mix has changed to a smaller percentage of time deposits. The Bank manages the pricing of its deposits in keeping with its asset/liability management and profitability objectives. Based on its experience, management believes that its certificate accounts are relatively stable sources of deposits, while its checking accounts have proven to be more volatile. In the past three years, the Bank has focused on growing its checking accounts both internally and through acquisitions.  The ability of the Bank to attract and maintain deposits, and the rates paid on these deposits, has been and will continue to be significantly affected by money market conditions.

31





The following table sets forth the time remaining until maturity of the Bank's time deposits as of December 31, 2018. The table is based on information prepared in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles.
 
 
 
Maturity
 
 
 
 
3 Months
Or Less
 
 
Over
3 to 6
Months
 
 
Over
6 to 12
Months
 
 
Over
12
Months
 
 
Total
 
 
 
(In Thousands)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Time deposits:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Less than $100,000
 
$
147,599
 
 
$
95,514
 
 
$
157,463
 
 
$
129,208
 
 
$
529,784
 
$100,000 or more
 
 
159,583
 
 
 
126,425
 
 
 
237,209
 
 
 
205,657
 
 
 
728,874
 
Brokered
 
 
95,075
 
 
 
106,237
 
 
 
85,610
 
 
 
40,000
 
 
 
326,922
 
Public funds(1)
 
 
279
 
 
 
1,986
 
 
 
2,841
 
 
 
725
 
 
 
5,831
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
      Total
 
$
402,536
 
 
$
330,162
 
 
$
483,123
 
 
$
375,590
 
 
$
1,591,411
 
______________
 (1) Deposits from governmental and other public entities.
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 

Brokered deposits. Brokered deposits are marketed through national brokerage firms to their customers in $1,000 increments. The Bank maintains only one account for the total deposit amount while the detailed records of owners are maintained by the Depository Trust Company under the name of CEDE & Co. The deposits are transferable just like a stock or bond investment and the customer can open the account with only a phone call or an online request. This provides a large deposit for the Bank at a lower operating cost since the Bank only has one account to maintain versus several accounts with multiple interest and maturity dates. At December 31, 2018 and 2017, the Bank had approximately $326.9 million and $225.5 million in brokered deposits, respectively.

Included in the brokered deposits total at December 31, 2018 and 2017, was $109.3 million and $153.0 million, respectively, in Certificate of Deposit Account Registry Service (CDARS) purchased funds accounts.  CDARS purchased funds transactions represent an easy, cost-effective source of funding without collateralization or credit limits for the Company.  Purchased funds transactions help the Company obtain large blocks of funding while providing control over pricing and diversity of wholesale funding options.  Purchased funds transactions are obtained through a bid process that occurs weekly, with varying maturity terms.

Previously included in the brokered deposits total at December 31, 2017 was $34.5 million in CDARS reciprocal customer deposit accounts.  CDARS reciprocal customer deposit accounts are accounts that are just like any other deposit account on the Company’s books, except that the account total exceeds the FDIC deposit insurance maximum. When a customer places a large deposit with a CDARS Network bank, that bank uses CDARS to place the funds into deposit accounts issued by other banks in the CDARS Network. This occurs in increments of less than the standard FDIC insurance maximum, so that both principal and interest are eligible for complete FDIC protection. Other Network members do the same thing with their customers' funds.  In 2018, the FDIC amended its regulations to exclude these deposits from its definition of brokered deposits.

Unlike non-brokered deposits where the deposit amount can be withdrawn prior to maturity with a penalty for any reason, including increasing interest rates, a brokered deposit (excluding CDARS purchased funds) can only be withdrawn in the event of the death, or court declared mental incompetence, of the depositor. This allows the Bank to better manage the maturity of its deposits. Currently, the rates offered by the Bank for brokered deposits are somewhat higher than that offered for retail certificates of deposit of similar size and maturity.  Because the Bank had kept higher levels of liquidity since the economic recession began in 2008, we had gradually reduced the amount of brokered deposits (excluding CDARS purchased funds) utilized since December 31, 2008.  As loan demand began to increase since 2013, we began to gradually increase our usage of brokered deposits again from time to time.

The Company may use interest rate swaps from time to time to manage its interest rate risks from recorded financial liabilities. In the past, the Company entered into interest rate swap agreements with the objective of economically hedging against the effects of changes in the fair value of its liabilities for fixed rate brokered certificates of deposit caused by changes in market interest rates. These interest rate swaps allowed the Company to create funding of varying maturities at a variable rate that in the past has approximated three-month LIBOR.  The Company did not utilize these types of interest rate swaps in 2018, 2017 or 2016.

Borrowings. Great Southern's other sources of funds include advances from the FHLBank, a Qualified Loan Review ("QLR") arrangement with the FRB, customer repurchase agreements and other borrowings.

As a member of the FHLBank, the Bank is required to own capital stock in the FHLBank and is authorized to apply for advances from the FHLBank. Each FHLBank credit program has its own interest rate, which may be fixed or variable, and range of maturities. The FHLBank may prescribe the acceptable uses for these advances, as well as other risks on availability, limitations on the size of the

32





advances and repayment provisions. At December 31, 2018 and 2017, the Bank's FHLBank advances outstanding were $-0- and $127.5 million, respectively.  Additionally, the Bank had outstanding overnight borrowings from the FHLBank of $178.0 million and $15.0 million at December 31, 2018 and 2017, respectively. Because they are overnight borrowings, the $178.0 million and $15.0 million are included in short-term borrowings in the Company’s financial statements. The Bank utilized FHLBank advances from time to time to fund loan growth during 2018 and 2017.

The Federal Reserve Bank of St. Louis (“FRBSL”) has a QLR program where the Bank can borrow on a temporary basis using commercial loans pledged to the FRBSL. Under the QLR program, the Bank can borrow any amount up to a calculated collateral value of the commercial loans pledged, for virtually any reason that creates a temporary cash need. Examples of this could be: (1) the need to fund for late outgoing wires or cash letter settlements, (2) the need to disburse one or several loans but the permanent source of funds will not be available for a few days; (3) a temporary spike in interest rates on other funding sources that are being used; or (4) the need to purchase a security for collateral pledging purposes a few days prior to the funds becoming available on an existing security that is maturing. The Bank had commercial, consumer and other loans pledged to the FRBSL at December 31, 2018 that would have allowed approximately $460.7 million to be borrowed under the above arrangement.  There were no outstanding borrowings from the FRBSL at December 31, 2018 or 2017 and the facility was not used during 2018 or 2017.

The Bank enters into sales of securities under agreements to repurchase (reverse repurchase agreements).  Reverse repurchase agreements are treated as financings, and the obligations to repurchase securities sold are reflected as a liability in the statements of financial condition.  The dollar amount of securities underlying the agreements remains in the asset accounts.  Securities underlying the agreements are being held by the Bank during the agreement period.  The agreements generally are written on a one-month or less term.

In November 2006, Great Southern Capital Trust II ("Trust II"), a statutory trust formed by the Company for the purpose of issuing the securities, issued $25.0 million aggregate liquidation amount of floating rate cumulative trust preferred securities. The Trust II securities bear a floating distribution rate equal to 90-day LIBOR plus 1.60%. The Trust II securities became redeemable at the Company's option in February 2012, and if not sooner redeemed, mature on February 1, 2037. The Trust II securities were sold in a private transaction exempt from registration under the Securities Act of 1933, as amended. The gross proceeds of the offering were used to purchase Junior Subordinated Debentures from the Company totaling $25.8 million and bearing an interest rate identical to the distribution rate on the Trust II securities. The initial interest rate on the Trust II debentures was 6.98%. The interest rate was 4.14% and 2.98% at December 31, 2018 and 2017, respectively.

In July 2007, Great Southern Capital Trust III ("Trust III"), a statutory trust formed by the Company for the purpose of issuing the securities, issued $5.0 million aggregate liquidation amount of floating rate cumulative trust preferred securities. The Trust III securities bore a floating distribution rate equal to 90-day LIBOR plus 1.40%. The Trust III securities were redeemable at the Company's option beginning in October 2012, and if not sooner redeemed, were to mature on October 1, 2037. The Trust III securities were sold in a private transaction exempt from registration under the Securities Act of 1933, as amended. The gross proceeds of the offering were used to purchase Junior Subordinated Debentures from the Company totaling $5.2 million and bearing an interest rate identical to the distribution rate on the Trust III securities. In July 2015, the Company was the successful bidder in an auction of the $5.0 million aggregate liquidation amount of floating rate cumulative trust preferred securities issued in 2007 by Great Southern Capital Trust III.  Such securities were then canceled and the principal amount of the Company’s related debentures was reduced to zero.

In 2013, the Company entered into two interest rate cap agreements for a portion of its Junior Subordinated Debentures associated with its trust preferred securities.  The term of these agreements was four years with a termination date in August 2017.  Under the agreements, with notional amounts of $25.0 million and $5.0 million, respectively, the Company paid interest on its Junior Subordinated Debentures in accordance with the original terms at a floating rate based on LIBOR.  Should the interest rate have risen above a certain threshold, the counterparty was to reimburse the Company for interest paid such that the Company would have an effective interest rate on the portion of its Junior Subordinated Debentures no higher than 2.37% for the first agreement and no higher than 2.17% on the second agreement.  The effective portion of the gain or loss on the derivative was reported as a component of other comprehensive income and reclassified into earnings in the same period or periods during which the hedged transaction affects earnings.  The fair value of the interest rate caps at December 31, 2017 was $-0-.  The $5.0 million notional interest rate cap agreement was terminated when the Company purchased the related trust preferred securities in July 2015.

On August 8, 2016, the Company completed the public offering and sale of $75.0 million of its subordinated notes.  The notes are due August 15, 2026, and have a fixed interest rate of 5.25% until August 15, 2021, at which time the rate becomes floating at a rate equal to three-month LIBOR plus 4.087%.  The Company may call the notes at par beginning on August 15, 2021, and on any scheduled interest payment date thereafter.  The notes were sold at par, resulting in net proceeds, after underwriting discounts and commissions, legal, accounting and other professional fees, of approximately $73.5 million.  Total debt issuance costs, totaling approximately $1.5 million, were deferred and are being amortized over the expected life of the notes, which is 10 years.  Amortization of the debt issuance costs during the years ended December 31, 2018 and 2017, totaled $154,000 and $151,000, respectively, and is included in interest expense on subordinated notes in the consolidated statements of income, resulting in an imputed interest rate of 5.47%.

33






The following table sets forth the maximum month-end balances, average daily balances and weighted average interest rates of FHLBank advances during the periods indicated.

 
 
Year Ended December 31,
 
 
 
2018
 
 
2017
 
 
2016
 
 
 
(Dollars In Thousands)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
FHLBank Advances:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  Maximum balance
 
$
259,000
 
 
$
174,000
 
 
$
292,538
 
  Average balance
 
 
190,245
 
 
 
93,524
 
 
 
68,325
 
  Weighted average interest rate
 
 
2.09
%
 
 
1.62
%
 
 
1.78
%

The following table sets forth certain information as to the Company's FHLBank advances at the dates indicated.

 
 
December 31,
 
 
 
2018
 
 
2017
 
 
2016
 
 
 
(Dollars In Thousands)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
FHLBank advances
 
$
 
 
$
127,500
 
 
$
31,452
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Weighted average interest
   rate of FHLBank advances
 
 
%
 
 
1.53
%
 
 
3.30
%

The following tables set forth the maximum month-end balances, average daily balances and weighted average interest rates of other borrowings during the periods indicated.

 
 
Year Ended December 31, 2018
 
 
 
Maximum
Balance
 
 
Average
Balance
 
 
Weighted
Average
Interest
Rate
 
 
 
(Dollars In Thousands)
 
Other Borrowings:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  Securities sold under reverse repurchase agreements
 
123,731
 
 
104,512
 
 
 
0.03
  Overnight borrowings -- FHLBank
 
 
178,000
 
 
 
30,346
 
 
 
2.34
 
  Collateral held for interest rate swap
   
13,100
     
993
     
2.24
 
  Other
 
 
1,625
 
 
 
1,406
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
     Total
 
 
 
 
 
$
137,257
 
 
 
0.56
%
     Total maximum month-end balance
 
 
297,978
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 

 
 
Year Ended December 31, 2017
 
 
 
Maximum
Balance
 
 
Average
Balance
 
 
Weighted
Average
Interest
Rate
 
 
 
(Dollars In Thousands)
 
Other Borrowings:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  Securities sold under reverse repurchase agreements
 
150,703
 
 
120,475
 
 
 
0.04
  Overnight borrowings -- FHLBank
 
 
184,000
 
 
 
64,448
 
 
 
1.09
 
  Other
 
 
1,665
 
 
 
1,441
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
     Total
 
 
 
 
 
$
186,364
 
 
 
0.40
%
     Total maximum month-end balance
 
 
297,357
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 


34





 
 
Year Ended December 31, 2016
 
 
 
Maximum
Balance
 
 
Average
Balance
 
 
Weighted
Average
Interest
Rate
 
 
 
(Dollars In Thousands)
 
Other Borrowings:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  Securities sold under reverse repurchase agreements
 
139,044
 
 
123,002
 
 
 
0.04
  Overnight borrowings -- FHLBank
 
 
400,200
 
 
 
203,575
 
 
 
0.54
 
  Other
 
 
1,323
 
 
 
1,081
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
     Total
 
 
 
 
 
$
327,658
 
 
 
0.35
%
     Total maximum month-end balance
 
 
523,078
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 

The following tables set forth year-end balances and weighted average interest rates of the Company's other borrowings at the dates indicated.

   
December 31,
 
   
2018
   
2017
   
2016
 
   
Balance
   
Weighted
Average
Interest Rate
   
Balance
   
Weighted
Average
Interest Rate
   
Balance
   
Weighted
Average
Interest Rate
 
   
(Dollars In Thousands)
 
Other borrowings:
                                   
Securities sold under reverse repurchase agreements
 
$
105,253
     
0.02
%
 
$
80,531
     
0.05
%
 
$
113,700
     
0.04
%
Overnight borrowings -- FHLBank
   
178,000
     
2.63
     
15,000
     
1.63
     
171,000
     
0.53
 
Collateral held for interest rate swap
   
13,100
     
2.30
     
     
     
     
 
Other
   
1,625
     
     
1,604
     
     
1,323
     
 
                                                 
Total
 
$
297,978
     
1.68
%
 
$
97,135
     
0.30
%
 
$
286,023
     
0.33
%

 
The following table sets forth the maximum month-end balances, average daily balances and weighted average interest rates (including cost of related interest rate caps) of subordinated debentures issued to capital trusts during the periods indicated.

 
Year Ended December 31,
 
 
2018
 
2017
 
2016
 
 
(Dollars In Thousands)
 
Subordinated debentures:
           
  Maximum balance
 
$
25,774
   
$
25,774
   
$
25,774
 
  Average balance
   
25,774
     
25,774
     
25,774
 
  Weighted average interest rate
   
3.70
%
   
3.68
%
   
3.12
%

The following table sets forth certain information as to the Company's subordinated debentures issued to capital trusts at the dates indicated.
 
 
December 31,
 
 
2018
 
2017
 
2016
 
 
(Dollars In Thousands)
 
 
           
Subordinated debentures
 
$
25,774
   
$
25,774
   
$
25,774
 
Weighted average interest
   rate of subordinated debentures
   
4.14
%
   
2.98
%
   
2.49
%


35




The following table sets forth the maximum month-end balances, average daily balances and weighted average interest rates of subordinated notes during the periods indicated.

 
Year Ended December 31,
 
 
2018
 
2017
 
2016
 
 
(Dollars In Thousands)
 
Subordinated notes:
           
  Maximum balance
 
$
73,842
   
$
73,688
   
$
73,537
 
  Average balance
   
73,772
     
73,613
     
28,526
 
  Weighted average interest rate
   
5.55
%
   
5.57
%
   
5.53
%

The following table sets forth certain information as to the Company's subordinated notes at the dates indicated.
 
 
December 31,
 
 
2018
 
2017
 
2016
 
 
(Dollars In Thousands)
 
 
           
Subordinated notes
 
$
73,842
   
$
73,688
   
$
73,537
 
Weighted average interest
   rate of subordinated debentures
   
5.55
%
   
5.57
%
   
5.45
%


Subsidiaries

Great Southern. As a Missouri-chartered trust company, Great Southern may invest up to 3%, which was equal to $140.2 million at December 31, 2018, of its assets in service corporations.  At December 31, 2018, the Bank's total investment in Great Southern Real Estate Development Corporation ("Real Estate Development") was $2.7 million. Real Estate Development was incorporated and organized in 2003 under the laws of the State of Missouri.  At December 31, 2018, the Bank's total investment in Great Southern Financial Corporation ("GSFC") was $6.2 million. GSFC is incorporated under the laws of the State of Missouri, and has not had any business activity since November 30, 2012, when it sold Great Southern Insurance and Great Southern Travel, two divisions of Great Southern that were operated through GSFC.  At December 31, 2018, the Bank's total investment in Great Southern Community Development Company, L.L.C. (“CDC”) and its subsidiary Great Southern CDE, L.L.C. ("CDE") was $715,000. CDC and CDE were formed in 2010 under the laws of the State of Missouri. At December 31, 2018, the Bank's total investment in GS, L.L.C. ("GSLLC") was $34.1 million. GSLLC was formed in 2005 under the laws of the State of Missouri.  At December 31, 2018, the Bank's total investment in GSSC, L.L.C. ("GSSCLLC") was $21.0 million. GSSCLLC was formed in 2009 under the laws of the State of Missouri.  At December 31, 2018, the Bank's total investment in GSRE Holding, L.L.C. ("GSRE Holding") was $2.6 million.  GSRE Holding was formed in 2009 under the laws of the State of Missouri.  At December 31, 2018, the Bank's total investment in GSRE Holding II, L.L.C. ("GSRE Holding II") was $-0-.  GSRE Holding II was formed in 2009 under the laws of the State of Missouri.  At December 31, 2018, the Bank's total investment in GSRE Holding III, L.L.C. ("GSRE Holding III") was $-0-.  GSRE Holding III was formed in 2012 under the laws of the State of Missouri.  At December 31, 2018, the Bank's total investment in GSTC Investments, L.L.C. ("GSTCLLC") was $6.5 million.  GSTCLLC was formed in 2016 under the laws of the State of Missouri.  These subsidiaries are primarily engaged in the activities described below.  In addition, Great Southern has four other subsidiary companies that are not considered service corporations, GSB One, L.L.C., GSB Two, L.L.C., VFP Conclusion Holding, L.L.C. and VFP Conclusion Holding II, L.L.C.  These companies are also described below.

Great Southern Real Estate Development Corporation. Generally, the purpose of Real Estate Development is to hold real estate assets which have been obtained through foreclosure by the Bank and which require ongoing operation of a business or completion of construction. During 2018 and 2017, Real Estate Development did not hold any real estate assets related to foreclosed property.  Real Estate Development had net losses of $-0- and $(2,000) in the years ended December 31, 2018 and 2017, respectively.

Great Southern Community Development Company, L.L.C. and Great Southern CDE, L.L.C. Generally, the purpose of CDC is to invest in community development projects that have a public benefit, and are permissible under Missouri and Kansas law.  These include such activities as investing in real estate and investing in other community development entities.  It also serves as parent to subsidiary CDE which invests in limited liability entities for the purpose of acquiring federal tax credits to be utilized by Great Southern.  CDC had consolidated net income of $10,000 and $-0- in the years ended December 31, 2018 and 2017, respectively.

GS, L.L.C. GSLLC was organized in 2005.  GSLLC is a limited liability company that invests in multiple limited liability entities for the purpose of acquiring state and federal tax credits which are utilized by Great Southern.  GSLLC had net losses of $(194,000) and $(2.1 million) in the years ended December 31, 2018 and 2017, respectively, which primarily resulted from the cost to acquire tax credits.  These losses were offset by the tax credits utilized by Great Southern.

36





GSSC, L.L.C. GSSCLLC was organized in 2009.  GSSCLLC is a limited liability company that invests in multiple limited liability entities for the purpose of acquiring state tax credits which are utilized by Great Southern or sold to third parties.  GSSCLLC had net income of $88,000 and $112,000 in the years ended December 31, 2018 and 2017, respectively.

GSRE Holding, L.L.C. Generally, the purpose of GSRE Holding is to hold real estate assets which have been obtained through foreclosure by the Bank and which require ongoing operation of a business or completion of construction.  At December 31, 2018, GSRE Holding held only cash of $2.6 million.  GSRE Holding had net income (loss) of $82,000 and $(2,000) in the years ended December 31, 2018 and 2017, respectively.

GSRE Holding II, L.L.C. Generally, the purpose of GSRE Holding II is to hold real estate assets which have been obtained through foreclosure by the Bank and which require ongoing operation of a business or completion of construction. In 2018 and 2017, GSRE Holding II did not hold any significant real estate assets. GSRE Holding II had net income of $-0- in each of the years ended December 31, 2018 and 2017.

GSRE Holding III, L.L.C. Generally, the purpose of GSRE Holding III is to hold real estate assets which have been obtained through foreclosure by the Bank and which require ongoing operation of a business or completion of construction. In 2018 and 2017, GSRE Holding III did not hold any significant real estate assets. GSRE Holding III had net income of $-0- in each of the years ended December 31, 2018 and 2017.

GSTC Investments, L.L.C. GSTCLLC was organized in 2016.  GSTCLLC is a limited liability company that invests in multiple limited liability entities for the purpose of acquiring state and federal tax credits which are utilized by Great Southern.  GSTCLLC had net income of $-0- in each of the years ended December 31, 2018 and 2017.

GSB One, L.L.C. At December 31, 2018, the Bank's total investment in GSB One, L.L.C. ("GSB One") and GSB Two, L.L.C. ("GSB Two") was $1.19 billion.  The capital contribution was made by transferring participations in loans to GSB Two.  GSB One is a Missouri limited liability company that was formed in March of 1998.  Currently the only activity of this company is the ownership of GSB Two.

GSB Two, L.L.C. This is a Missouri limited liability company that was formed in March of 1998.  GSB Two is a real estate investment trust ("REIT"). It holds participations in real estate mortgages from the Bank.  The Bank continues to service the loans in return for a management and servicing fee from GSB Two.  GSB Two had net income of $52.0 million and $54.5 million in the years ended December 31, 2018 and 2017, respectively.

VFP Conclusion Holding, L.L.C. VFP Conclusion Holding, L.L.C. (“VFP”) is a Missouri limited liability company that was formed in August of 2011.  Generally, the purpose of VFP is to hold real estate assets which have been obtained through foreclosure by the Bank.  The real estate assets obtained through foreclosure were formerly collateral for a participation loan sold by the Bank.  The Bank has a 50 percent interest in VFP and at December 31, 2018 its investment totaled $4.2 million.  Two other entities also have interests in VFP as a result of their participation in the loan sold by the Bank.  At December 31, 2018, the only asset of VFP was cash.  VFP had net income of $-0- in each of the years ended December 31, 2018 and 2017.

VFP Conclusion Holding II, L.L.C. VFP Conclusion Holding II, L.L.C. (“VFP II”) is a Missouri limited liability company that was formed in September of 2012.  Generally, the purpose of VFP II is to hold real estate assets which have been obtained through foreclosure by the Bank.  The real estate assets obtained through foreclosure were formerly collateral for a participation loan sold by the Bank.  The Bank has a 50 percent interest in VFP II and at December 31, 2018 its investment totaled $2.2 million.  One other entity also has an interest in VFP II as a result of its participation in the loan sold by the Bank.  At December 31, 2018, the only asset of VFP II was cash.  VFP II had net income of $-0- for each of the years ended December 31, 2018 and 2017.

Competition

The banking industry in the Company's market areas is highly competitive.  In addition to competing with other commercial and savings banks, the Company competes with credit unions, finance companies, leasing companies, mortgage companies, insurance companies, brokerage and investment banking firms and many other financial service firms.  Competition is based on a number of factors including, among others, customer service, quality and range of products and services offered, price, reputation, interest rates on loans and deposits, lending limits and customer convenience.  Our ability to continue to compete effectively also depends in large part on our ability to attract new employees and retain and motivate our existing employees, while managing compensation and other costs.
 
A substantial number of the commercial banks operating in most of the Company's market areas are branches or subsidiaries of large organizations affiliated with statewide, regional or national banking companies and as a result they may have greater resources with

37




which to compete. Additionally, the Company faces competition from a large number of community banks, many of which have senior management who were previously with other local banks or investor groups with strong local business and community ties.

The Company encounters strong competition in attracting deposits throughout its six-state retail footprint.  The Company attracts a significant amount of deposits through its branch offices primarily from the communities in which those branch offices are located.  Of our total 99 branch offices at the end of 2018, 71.2% of our deposit franchise dollars were located in Missouri, where our total market share at June 30, 2018, was 1.5%, or seventh in the state (based on FDIC market share deposits). The financial institutions with the top three market share positions in Missouri at June 30, 2018, were U.S. Bank, Bank of America and Commerce Bank, which had a combined market share of 29.9%.  We also have branch offices in the states of Iowa, Kansas, Minnesota, Nebraska and Arkansas which make up 14.2%, 6.8%, 6.5%, 0.9%, and 0.4% of our total deposit franchise dollars, respectively (based on our total deposits as of December 31, 2018).  The Company's market share in its primary metropolitan statistical areas was as follows at June 30, 2018:

Metropolitan Statistical Area
Number of Branch Offices
Percentage of Total Market Share
Rank
Institution with Leading Market Share Position
Springfield, MO
19
13.5%
1
Great Southern Bank
Sioux City, IA-NE-SD
6
5.5%
4
Security National Bank of Sioux City
Davenport/Moline/Rock Island, IA-IL
5
1.1%
22
Quad City Bank and Trust Co.
Des Moines/West Des Moines, IA
4
0.4%
33
Wells Fargo Bank
St. Louis, MO-IL
19
0.6%
25
Stifel Bank and Trust
Kansas City, MO-KS
8
0.4%
33
UMB Bank
Fayetteville/Springdale/Rogers, AR-MO
2
0.2%
33
Arvest Bank
Minneapolis/St. Paul/Bloomington, MN-WI
4
0.1%
34
US Bank NA

Our most direct competition for deposits has historically come from other commercial banks, savings institutions and credit unions located in our market areas.  The Bank competes for these deposits by offering a variety of deposit accounts at competitive rates, convenient business hours, and convenient branch, online, mobile and ATM services. In addition, some competitors located outside of our market areas conduct business primarily over the Internet, which may enable them to realize certain savings and offer certain deposit products and services at lower rates and with greater convenience to certain customers.  Our ability to attract and retain customer deposits depends on our ability to generally provide a rate of return, liquidity and risk comparable to that offered by competing investment opportunities.

Competition in originating real estate loans comes primarily from other commercial banks, savings institutions and mortgage bankers making loans secured by real estate located in the Bank's market area.  The specific institutions are similar to those discussed above in regards to deposit market share.  Commercial banks and finance companies provide vigorous competition in commercial and consumer lending.  The Bank competes for real estate and other loans principally on the basis of the interest rates and loan fees it charges, the types of loans it originates, the quality of services it provides to borrowers and the locations of our branch office network and loan production offices. 

Many of our competitors have substantially greater resources, name recognition and market presence, which benefit them in attracting business.  In addition, larger competitors (including nationwide banks that have a significant presence in our market areas) may be able to price loans and deposits more aggressively than we do because of their greater economies of scale.  Smaller and newer competitors may also be more aggressive than we are in terms of pricing loan and deposit products in order to obtain a larger share of the market.  In addition, some competitors located outside of our market areas conduct business primarily over the Internet, which may enable them to realize certain savings and offer products and services at more favorable rates and with greater convenience to certain customers. 

We also depend, from time to time, on outside funding sources, including brokered deposits, where we experience nationwide competition, and Federal Home Loan Bank advances.  Some of the financial institutions and financial services organizations with which we compete are not subject to the same degree of regulation as is imposed on insured depositary institutions and their holding companies.  As a result, these non-bank competitors have certain advantages over us in accessing funding and in providing various services.

Despite the highly competitive environment and the challenges it presents to us, management believes the Company will continue to be competitive because of its strong commitment to quality customer service, competitive products and pricing, convenient local branches, online and mobile capabilities, and active community involvement.

38





Employees

At December 31, 2018, the Company and its affiliates had a total of 1,182 employees, including 269 part-time employees.  None of the Company’s employees are represented by any collective bargaining agreement.  Management considers its employee relations to be good.

Government Supervision and Regulation

General

The Company and its subsidiaries are subject to supervision and examination by applicable federal and state banking agencies.  The earnings of the Company’s subsidiaries, and therefore the earnings of the Company, are affected by general economic conditions, management policies, federal and state legislation, and actions of various regulatory authorities, including the Board of Governors of the Federal Reserve System, often referred to as the Federal Reserve Board (the “FRB”), the Federal Deposit Insurance Corporation (the "FDIC") and  the Missouri Division of Finance (the “MDF”).  The following is a brief summary of certain aspects of the regulation of the Company and the Bank and does not purport to fully discuss such regulation.  Such regulation is intended primarily for the protection of depositors and the Deposit Insurance Fund (the “DIF”), and not for the protection of stockholders.

Significant Legislation Impacting the Financial Services Industry

On July 21, 2010, sweeping financial regulatory reform legislation entitled the “Dodd-Frank Wall Street Reform and Consumer Protection Act” (the “Dodd-Frank Act”) was signed into law. The Dodd-Frank Act implements far-reaching changes across the financial regulatory landscape, including provisions that, among other things:

•  
Centralize responsibility for consumer financial protection by creating a new agency, the Consumer Financial Protection Bureau, with broad rulemaking authority for a wide range of consumer protection laws that apply to all banks.  These laws are enforced by the Bureau for banks with more than $10 billion in assets and by the federal banking regulators for other banks.
•  
Require capital rules for bank holding companies and banks
•  
Change the assessment base for federal deposit insurance from the amount of insured deposits to consolidated average assets less Tier 1 capital.
•  
Increase the minimum ratio of net worth to insured deposits of the Deposit Insurance Fund from 1.15% to 1.35% and require the FDIC, in setting assessments, to offset the effect of the increase on institutions with assets of less than $10 billion.  
•  
Set out new disclosure and other requirements relating to executive compensation and corporate governance and a prohibition on compensation arrangements that encourage inappropriate risks or that could provide excessive compensation.
•  
Make permanent the $250 thousand limit for federal deposit insurance.
•  
Repeal the federal prohibitions on the payment of interest on demand deposits, thereby permitting depository institutions to pay interest on business transaction and other accounts.
•  
Increase the authority of the FRB to examine the Company and its non-bank subsidiaries.
•  
Require all bank holding companies to serve as a source of financial strength to their depository institution subsidiaries in the event such subsidiaries suffer from financial distress.

Certain aspects of the Dodd-Frank Act remain subject to rulemaking and take effect over a number of years. Provisions in the legislation that affect deposit insurance assessments, and payment of interest on demand deposits could increase the costs associated with deposits. The capital requirements for the Company and the Bank could require the Company and the Bank to seek additional sources of capital in the future. See “Capital” below.

In May 2018, the Economic Growth, Regulatory Relief, and Consumer Protection Act (the “Economic Growth Act”), was enacted to modify or eliminate certain financial reform rules and regulations, including some implemented under the Dodd-Frank Act. While the Economic Growth Act maintains most of the regulatory structure established by the Dodd-Frank Act, it amends certain aspects of the regulatory framework for small depository institutions with assets of less than $10 billion and for large banks with assets of more than $50 billion. Many of these amendments could result in meaningful regulatory changes.

The Economic Growth Act, among other matters, expands the definition of qualified mortgages which may be held by a financial institution and simplifies the regulatory capital rules for financial institutions and their holding companies with total consolidated assets of less than $10 billion by instructing the federal banking regulators to establish a single “Community Bank Leverage Ratio” of between 8 and 10 percent. Any qualifying depository institution or its holding company that exceeds the “community bank leverage ratio” will be considered to have met generally applicable leverage and risk-based regulatory capital requirements and any qualifying depository institution that exceeds the new ratio will be considered “well-capitalized” under the prompt corrective action rules.

39




In addition, the Economic Growth Act includes regulatory relief in the areas of examination cycles, call reports, mortgage disclosures and risk weights for certain high-risk commercial real estate loans.

It is difficult at this time to predict when or how any new standards under the Economic Growth Act will ultimately be applied to us or what specific impact the Economic Growth Act and the forthcoming implementing rules and regulations will have on us.

Bank Holding Company Regulation

The Company is a bank holding company that has elected to be treated as a financial holding company by the FRB. Financial holding companies are subject to comprehensive regulation by the FRB under the Bank Holding Company Act and the regulations of the FRB.  The Company is required to file reports with the FRB and such additional information as the FRB may require, and is subject to regular examinations by the FRB.  The FRB also has extensive enforcement authority over financial holding companies, including, among other things, the ability to assess civil money penalties, to issue cease and desist or removal orders and to require that a holding company divest subsidiaries (including its bank subsidiaries).  In general, enforcement actions may be initiated for violations of law and regulations and unsafe or unsound practices.

Under FRB policy and the Dodd-Frank Act, a bank holding company must serve as a source of strength for its subsidiary banks.  Accordingly, the FRB may require, and has required in the past, that a bank holding company contribute additional capital to an undercapitalized subsidiary bank.

Under the Bank Holding Company Act, a financial holding company must obtain FRB approval before: (i) acquiring, directly or indirectly, ownership or control of any voting shares of another bank or bank holding company that is not a subsidiary if, after such acquisition, it would own or control more than 5% of such shares; (ii) acquiring all or substantially all of the assets of another bank or bank or financial holding company; or (iii) merging or consolidating with another bank or financial holding company.

The Bank Holding Company Act also prohibits a financial holding company generally from engaging directly or indirectly in activities other than those involving banking, activities closely related to banking that are permitted for a bank holding company, and certain securities, insurance and merchant banking activities.  Certain investments greater than 5% in companies engaged in activities not permitted for a bank holding company are prohibited.   

Volcker Rule 

The federal banking agencies have adopted regulations to implement the provisions of the Dodd-Frank Act known as the Volcker Rule.  Under the regulations, FDIC-insured depository institutions, their holding companies, subsidiaries and affiliates are generally prohibited, subject to certain exemptions, from proprietary trading of securities and other financial instruments and from acquiring or retaining an ownership interest in a “covered fund.” 

Trading in certain government obligations is not prohibited.  These include, among others, obligations of or guaranteed by the United States or an agency or government-sponsored entity of the United States, obligations of a state of the United States or a political subdivision thereof, and municipal securities.  Proprietary trading generally does not include transactions under repurchase and reverse repurchase agreements, securities lending transactions and purchases and sales for the purpose of liquidity management if the liquidity management plan meets specified criteria; nor does it generally include transactions undertaken in a fiduciary capacity. 

The term “covered fund” can include, in addition to many private equity and hedge funds and other entities, certain collateralized mortgage obligations, collateralized debt obligations and collateralized loan obligations, and other items, but it does not include wholly owned subsidiaries, certain joint ventures, or loan securitizations generally if the underlying assets are solely loans.  The term “ownership interest” includes not only an equity interest or a partnership interest, but also an interest that has the right to participate in selection or removal of a general partner, managing member, director, trustee or investment manager or advisor; to receive a share of income, gains or profits of the fund; to receive underlying fund assets after all other interests have been redeemed; to receive all or a portion of excess spread; or to receive income on a pass-through basis or income determined by reference to the performance of fund assets. In addition, “ownership interest” includes an interest under which amounts payable can be reduced based on losses arising from underlying fund assets.

Activities eligible for exemptions include, among others, certain brokerage, underwriting and marketing activities, and risk-mitigating hedging activities with respect to specific risks and subject to specified conditions.

Interstate Banking and Branching

Federal law allows the FRB to approve an application of a bank holding company to acquire control of, or acquire all or substantially all of the assets of, a bank located in a state other than such holding company's home state, without regard to whether the transaction is


40




prohibited by the laws of any state.  The FRB may not approve the acquisition of a bank that has not been in existence for the minimum time period (not exceeding five years) specified by the statutory law of the host state.  Federal law also prohibits the FRB from approving such an application if the applicant (and its depository institution affiliates) controls or would control more than 10% of the insured deposits in the United States or if the applicant would control 30% or more of the deposits in any state in which the target bank maintains a branch and in which the applicant or any of its depository institution affiliates controls a depository institution or branch immediately prior to the acquisition of the target bank.  Federal law does not affect the authority of states to limit the percentage of total insured deposits in the state which may be held or controlled by a bank or bank holding company to the extent such limitation does not discriminate against out-of-state banks or bank holding companies.  Individual states may also waive the 30% state-wide concentration limit. Missouri law prohibits a bank holding company from acquiring a depository institution if total deposits would exceed 13% of statewide deposits excluding bank certificates of deposit of $100,000 or more.

The federal banking agencies are generally authorized to approve interstate bank merger transactions and de novo branching without regard to whether such transactions are prohibited by the law of any state.  Interstate acquisitions of branches are generally permitted only if the law of the state in which the branch is located permits such acquisitions. 

As required by federal law, federal regulations prohibit any out-of-state bank from using the interstate branching authority primarily for the purpose of deposit production, including guidelines to ensure that interstate branches operated by an out-of-state bank in a host state reasonably help to meet the credit needs of the communities which they serve.

Certain Transactions with Affiliates and Other Persons

Transactions involving the Bank and its affiliates are subject to sections 23A and 23B of the Federal Reserve Act, and regulations thereunder, which impose certain quantitative limits and collateral requirements on such transactions, and require all such transactions to be on terms at least as favorable to the Bank as are available in transactions with non-affiliates.

All loans by the Bank to the principal stockholders, directors and executive officers of the Bank or any affiliate are subject to regulations restricting loans and other transactions with insiders of the Bank and its affiliates.  Transactions involving such persons must be on terms and conditions as favorable to the bank as those that apply in similar transactions with non-insiders.  A bank may allow favorable rate loans to insiders pursuant to an employee benefit program available to bank employees generally.  The Bank has such a program.

Dividends

The FRB has issued a policy statement on the payment of cash dividends by bank holding companies, which expresses the FRB's view that a bank holding company should pay cash dividends only to the extent that its net income for the past year is sufficient to cover both the cash dividends and a rate of earnings retention that is consistent with the holding company's capital needs, asset quality and overall financial condition.  The FRB also indicated that it would be inappropriate for a company experiencing serious financial problems to borrow funds to pay dividends.  Furthermore, a bank holding company may be prohibited from paying any dividends if the holding company's bank subsidiary is not adequately capitalized, and dividends payable by a bank holding company and its depository institutions subsidiaries can be restricted if the capital conservation buffer requirement is not met.  See “Capital” below.

A bank holding company is required to give the FRB prior written notice of any purchase or redemption of its outstanding equity securities if the gross consideration for the purchase or redemption, when combined with the net consideration paid for all such purchases or redemptions during the preceding 12 months, is equal to 10% or more of the company's consolidated net worth. The FRB may disapprove such a purchase or redemption if it determines that the proposal would constitute an unsafe or unsound practice or would violate any law, regulation, FRB order, or any condition imposed by, or written agreement with, the FRB.  This notification requirement does not apply to any company that meets the well-capitalized standard for bank holding companies, is well-managed, and is not subject to any unresolved supervisory issues.  Under Missouri law, the Bank may pay dividends from certain undivided profits and may not pay dividends if its capital is impaired.  Dividends of the Company and the Bank may also be restricted under the capital conservation buffer rules, as discussed below under “—Capital.”
 
Capital

Effective January 1, 2015 (with some changes phased in over several years), the Company and the Bank became subject to new capital regulations adopted by the FRB and the FDIC, which established minimum required ratios for common equity Tier 1 (“CET1”) capital, Tier 1 capital and total capital and the  minimum leverage ratio; set forth the risk-weightings of  assets and certain off-balance sheet items for purposes of the risk-based capital ratios; require an additional capital conservation buffer over the required risk-based capital ratios, and define what qualifies as capital for purposes of meeting the capital requirements.

41





Under the capital regulations, the minimum capital ratios are: (1) a CET1 capital ratio of 4.5% of risk-weighted assets; (2) a Tier 1 capital ratio of 6.0% of risk-weighted assets; (3) a total risk-based capital ratio of 8.0% of risk-weighted assets; and (4) a leverage ratio (the ratio of Tier 1 capital to average total adjusted assets) of 4.0%.  CET1 generally consists of common stock; retained earnings; accumulated other comprehensive income (“AOCI”) unless an institution has elected to exclude AOCI from regulatory capital; and certain minority interests; all subject to applicable regulatory adjustments and deductions. Tier 1 capital generally consists of CET1 and noncumulative perpetual preferred stock.  Tier 2 capital generally consists of other preferred stock and subordinated debt meeting certain conditions plus an amount of the allowance for loan and lease losses up to 1.25% of assets.  Total capital is the sum of Tier 1 and Tier 2 capital.

A number of changes in what constitutes regulatory capital compared to the rules in effect prior to January 1, 2015 are subject to transition periods.  These changes include the phasing-out of certain instruments as qualifying capital.  Mortgage servicing and deferred tax assets over designated percentages of CET1 are deducted from capital.  In addition, Tier 1 capital includes AOCI, which includes all unrealized gains and losses on available for sale debt and equity securitiesHowever, because of our asset size, we were eligible to elect to permanently opt out of the inclusion of unrealized gains and losses on available for sale debt and equity securities in our capital calculations.  We elected this option.

For purposes of determining risk-based capital, assets and certain off-balance sheet items are risk-weighted from 0% to 1,250%, depending on the risk characteristics of the asset or item. The new regulations make certain changes in the risk-weighting of assets to better reflect credit risk and other risk exposure compared to the earlier capital rules. These include a 150% risk weight for certain high volatility commercial real estate acquisition, development and construction loans and for non-residential mortgage loans that are 90 days past due or otherwise in nonaccrual status; a 20% credit conversion factor for the unused portion of a commitment with an original maturity of one year or less that is not unconditionally cancellable; and a 250% risk weight for mortgage servicing and deferred tax assets that are not deducted from capital.

In addition to the minimum CET1, Tier 1 and total capital ratios, the Company and the Bank must maintain a capital conservation buffer consisting of additional CET1 capital greater than 2.5% of risk-weighted assets above the required minimum levels in order to avoid limitations on paying dividends, repurchasing shares, and paying discretionary bonuses.  The capital conservation buffer requirement began to be phased in on January 1, 2016, when a buffer greater than 0.625% of risk-weighted assets was required, which amount increased each year until the buffer requirement was fully implemented on January 1, 2019.

The Financial Accounting Standards Board has adopted a new accounting standard for US Generally Accepted Accounting Principles that will be effective for us for our first fiscal year beginning after December 31, 2019. This standard, referred to as Current Expected Credit Loss, or CECL, requires FDIC-insured institutions and their holding companies (banking organizations) to recognize credit losses expected over the life of certain financial assets. CECL covers a broader range of assets than the current method of recognizing credit losses and generally results in earlier recognition of credit losses. Upon adoption of CECL, a banking organization must record a one-time adjustment to its credit loss allowances as of the beginning of the fiscal year of adoption equal to the difference, if any, between the amount of credit loss allowances under the current methodology and the amount required under CECL.  For a banking organization, implementation of CECL is generally likely to reduce retained earnings, and to affect other items, in a manner that reduces its regulatory capital. The federal banking regulators (the Federal Reserve, the OCC and the FDIC) have adopted a rule that gives a banking organization the option to phase in over a three-year period the day-one adverse effects of CECL on its regulatory capital.

Under the FDIC’s prompt corrective action standards, in order to be considered well-capitalized, the Bank must have a ratio of CET1 capital to risk-weighted assets of 6.5%, a ratio of Tier 1 capital to risk-weighted assets of 8%, a ratio of total capital to risk-weighted assets of 10%, and a leverage ratio of 5%; and must not be subject to any written agreement, order, capital directive, or prompt corrective action directive to meet and maintain a specific capital level for any capital measure.  In order to be considered adequately capitalized, an institution must have the minimum capital ratios described above.  As of December 31, 2018, the Bank was “well-capitalized.” An institution that is not well-capitalized is subject to certain restrictions on brokered deposits and interest rates on deposits. 

The federal banking regulators are required to take prompt corrective action if an institution fails to satisfy the requirements to qualify as adequately capitalized.  All institutions, regardless of their capital levels, are restricted from making any capital distribution or paying any management fees that would cause the institution to fail to satisfy the requirements to qualify as adequately capitalized.  An institution that is not at least adequately capitalized is: (i) subject to increased monitoring by the appropriate federal banking regulator; (ii) required to submit an acceptable capital restoration plan (including certain guarantees by any company controlling the institution) within 45 days; (iii) subject to asset growth limits; and (iv) required to obtain prior regulatory approval for acquisitions, branching and new lines of business. Additional restrictions and appointment of a receiver or conservator, can apply, depending on the institution's capital level.  The FDIC has jurisdiction over the Bank for purposes of prompt corrective action.  When the FDIC as receiver liquidates an institution, the claims of depositors and the FDIC as their successor (for deposits covered by FDIC insurance) have priority over other unsecured claims against the institution, including claims of stockholders.

42






To be considered "well-capitalized," a bank holding company must have, on a consolidated basis, a total risk-based capital ratio of 10.0% or greater and a Tier 1 risk-based capital ratio of 6.0% or greater and must not be subject to an individual order, directive or agreement under which the FRB requires it to maintain a specific capital level.  As of December 31, 2018, the Company was "well-capitalized." 

The federal banking agencies consider concentrations of credit risk and risks from non-traditional activities, as well as an institution's ability to manage those risks, when determining the adequacy of an institution's capital. This evaluation is generally made as part of the institution's regular safety and soundness examination. Under their regulations, the federal banking agencies also consider interest rate risk (when the interest rate sensitivity of an institution's assets does not match the sensitivity of its liabilities or its off-balance-sheet position) in the evaluation of a bank's capital adequacy. The banking agencies have issued guidance on evaluating interest rate risk.

Although we continue to evaluate the impact that the capital rules have on the Company and the Bank, we anticipate that the Company and the Bank will remain well-capitalized, and will continue to meet the capital conservation buffer requirement.

Insurance of Accounts and Regulation by the FDIC

Great Southern is a member of the DIF, which is administered by the FDIC.  Deposits are insured up to the applicable limits by the FDIC, backed by the full faith and credit of the United States Government.  The general deposit insurance limit is $250,000.  

The FDIC assesses deposit insurance premiums on all FDIC-insured institutions quarterly based on annualized rates.  These premiums are assessed on an institution’s total assets minus its tangible equity.  Under these rules, assessment rates for an institution with total assets of less than $10 billion are determined by weighted average CAMELS composite ratings and certain financial ratios, and range from 3.0 to 30.0 basis, subject to certain adjustments. In an emergency, the FDIC may also impose a special assessment.

The FDIC also collects assessments from insured institutions to service the debt on bonds issued during the 1980s to resolve the thrift bailout.  For the quarter ended December 31, 2018, the assessment rate was 0.32 basis points applied to the same assessment base as is used for deposit insurance assessments. 

The Dodd-Frank Act establishes 1.35% as the minimum reserve ratio.  The FDIC adopted a plan to meet this ratio, which was achieved on September 30, 2018, ahead of the September 30, 2020 statutory deadline.  In addition to the statutory minimum ratio, the FDIC has the authority to establish a reserve ratio known as the designated reserve ratio or DRR, which may exceed the statutory minimum.  The FDIC has established 2.0% as the DRR. The Dodd-Frank Act requires the FDIC to offset the effect on institutions with assets less than $10 billion of the increase in the statutory minimum reserve ratio to 1.35% from the former statutory minimum of 1.15%.    To implement the offset requirement, the FDIC imposed a surcharge on institutions with assets of $10 billion or more during a temporary period that ended on September 30, 2018.  Smaller institutions will receive credits against their deposit insurance assessments which will reduce regular assessments by 2.0 basis points for quarters when the reserve ratio is at least 1.38%.

The FDIC is authorized to conduct examinations of and to require reporting by FDIC-insured institutions, and is the primary federal banking regulator of state banks that are not members of the Federal Reserve, such as the Bank.  The FDIC examines the Bank regularly.  The FDIC may prohibit any insured institution from engaging in any activity the FDIC determines by regulation or order to pose a serious threat to the DIF.  The FDIC also has the authority to take enforcement actions against banks and savings associations.

Federal Reserve System

The FRB requires all depository institutions to maintain reserves against their transaction accounts (primarily NOW and Super NOW checking accounts) and non-personal time deposits.  At December 31, 2018, the Bank was in compliance with these reserve requirements.

Banks are authorized to borrow from the FRB "discount window," but FRB regulations only allow this borrowing for short periods of time and generally require banks to exhaust other reasonable alternative sources of funds where practical, including FHLBank advances, before borrowing from the FRB. See "Sources of Funds Borrowings" above.

Federal Home Loan Bank System

The Bank is a member of the FHLBank of Des Moines, which is one of 11 regional FHLBanks.
 
As a member, Great Southern is required to purchase and maintain stock in the FHLBank of Des Moines in an amount equal to the greater of 1% of its outstanding home loans or 5% of its outstanding FHLBank advances.  At December 31, 2018, Great Southern had

43





$12.4 million in FHLBank of Des Moines stock, which was in compliance with this requirement.  In past years, the Bank has received dividends on its FHLBank stock. Over the past five years, such dividends have averaged 3.86% and were 5.19% for the year ended December 31, 2018.

Legislative and Regulatory Proposals

Any changes in the extensive regulatory scheme to which the Company or the Bank is and will be subject, whether by any of the federal banking agencies or Congress, or the Missouri legislature or MDF, could have a material effect on the Company or the Bank, and the Company and the Bank cannot predict what, if any, future actions may be taken by legislative or regulatory authorities or what impact such actions may have.

Federal and State Taxation

General

The following discussion contains a summary of certain federal and state income tax provisions applicable to the Company and the Bank. It is not a comprehensive description of the federal or state income tax laws that may affect the Company and the Bank. The following discussion is based upon current provisions of the Internal Revenue Code of 1986 (the "Code") and Treasury and judicial interpretations thereof.

The Company and its subsidiaries file a consolidated federal income tax return using the accrual method of accounting, with the exception of GSB Two which files a separate return as a REIT.  All corporations joining in the consolidated federal income tax return are jointly and severally liable for taxes due and payable by the consolidated group.  The following discussion primarily focuses upon the taxation of the Bank, since the federal income tax law contains certain special provisions with respect to banks.

Financial institutions, such as the Bank, are subject, with certain exceptions, to the provisions of the Code generally applicable to corporations.

Bad Debt Deduction

As of December 31, 2018 and 2017, retained earnings included approximately $17.5 million for which no deferred income tax liability has been recognized.  This amount represents an allocation of income to bad debt deductions for tax purposes only for tax years prior to 1988. If the Bank were to liquidate, the entire amount would have to be recaptured and would create income for tax purposes only, which would be subject to the then-current corporate income tax rate.  The unrecorded deferred income tax liability on the above amount was approximately $3.9 million at both December 31, 2018 and 2017.

The Bank is required to follow the specific charge-off method which only allows a bad debt deduction equal to actual charge-offs, net of recoveries, experienced during the fiscal year of the deduction. In a year where recoveries exceed charge-offs, the Bank would be required to include the net recoveries in taxable income.

Interest Deduction

In the case of a financial institution, such as the Bank, no deduction is allowed for the pro rata portion of its interest expense which is allocable to tax-exempt interest on obligations acquired after August 7, 1986. A limited class of tax-exempt obligations acquired after August 7, 1986 will not be subject to this complete disallowance rule.  For certain tax exempt obligations issued in 2009 and 2010, an amount of tax-exempt obligations that are not generally considered part of the “limited class of tax-exempt obligations” noted above may be treated as part of the “limited class of tax-exempt obligations” to the extent of two percent of a financial institutions total assets. For tax-exempt obligations acquired after December 31, 1982 and before August 8, 1986 and for obligations acquired after August 7, 1986 that are not subject to the complete disallowance rule, 80% of interest incurred to purchase or carry such obligations will be deductible. No portion of the interest expense allocable to tax-exempt obligations acquired by a financial institution before January 1, 1983, which is otherwise deductible, will be disallowed. There are two significant changes for bonds issued in 2009 and 2010 which include (1) the annual limit for bonds that may be designated as bank qualified is increased from $10 million to $30 million and (2) the annual limitation is considered at the organization level rather than the issuer level. The interest expense disallowance rules cited above have not significantly impacted the Bank.

FDIC-Assisted Bank Transactions

During 2009, 2011 and 2012, the Bank acquired assets and liabilities of four unrelated failed institutions in transactions with the FDIC. As part of these transactions, the Bank and the FDIC entered into loss sharing agreements whereby the FDIC agreed to share losses

44





incurred associated with the assets purchased by the Bank.  In 2014, the Bank acquired assets and liabilities of an unrelated failed institution in a transaction with the FDIC.  The Bank and the FDIC did not enter into a loss sharing agreement on this transaction.

The Bank recognized financial statement gains associated with these transactions.   The ultimate tax treatment of these transactions is similar to the financial statement treatment; however, the approaches to valuing the acquired assets and liabilities is different, and results in carrying value differences in the underlying assets and liabilities, for tax purposes.  In addition, any gain recognized on the transactions for tax purposes is recognized over a six year period.

During 2016, the Bank and the FDIC reached an agreement to terminate the loss sharing agreements associated with the 2009 and 2011 acquisition transactions.  During 2017, the Bank and the FDIC reached an agreement to terminate the loss sharing agreements associated with the 2012 acquisition transaction.

Alternative Minimum Tax

Through 2017, corporations generally were subject to a 20% corporate alternative minimum tax ("AMT"). A corporation must pay the AMT to the extent it exceeds that corporation's regular federal income tax liability The AMT is imposed on "alternative minimum taxable income," defined as taxable income with certain adjustments and tax preference items, less any available exemption. Such adjustments and items include, but are not limited to, (i) net interest received on certain tax-exempt bonds issued after August 7, 1986; and (ii) 75% of the difference between adjusted current earnings and alternative minimum taxable income, as otherwise determined with certain adjustments. Net operating loss carryovers may be utilized, subject to adjustment, to offset up to 90% of the alternative minimum taxable income, as otherwise determined.  Any AMT paid may be credited against future regular federal income tax liabilities to the extent the regular federal income tax liability exceeds the AMT liability.  In addition, certain credits may be used to reduce AMT obligations.  The Company has invested in certain partnerships that generate tax credits (low-income housing and rehabilitation tax credits) that may be used to reduce their AMT.

State Taxation

Missouri-based banks, such as the Bank, are subject to a franchise tax which is imposed on the bank's taxable income at the rate of 7% of the taxable income (determined without regard for any net operating losses) - income-based calculation. Missouri-based banks are entitled to a credit against the income-based franchise tax for all other state or local taxes on banks, except taxes on real estate, unemployment taxes, bank tax, and taxes on tangible personal property owned by the Bank and held for lease or rental to others.

The Company and all subsidiaries are subject to a Missouri income tax that is imposed on the corporation's taxable income at the rate of 6.25%. The return is filed on a consolidated basis by all members of the consolidated group including the Bank, but excluding GSB Two. As a REIT, GSB Two files a separate Missouri income tax return.

The Bank also has full service offices in Kansas, Iowa, Minnesota, Nebraska and Arkansas, and has commercial loan production offices in Texas, Oklahoma, Nebraska, Illinois, Colorado and Georgia.  As a result, the Bank is subject to franchise and income taxes that are imposed on the corporation's taxable income attributable to those states. 

As a Maryland corporation, the Company is required to file an annual report with and pay an annual fee to the State of Maryland.

Examinations

The Company and its consolidated subsidiaries have not been audited recently by the Internal Revenue Service (IRS) and, as such, tax years through December 31, 2005, have been closed without audit.  The Company, through one of its subsidiaries, is a partner in two partnerships which have been under Internal Revenue Service examination for 2006 and 2007.  As a result, the Company’s 2006 and subsequent tax years remain open for examination.  The examinations of these partnerships advanced during 2017 and 2018.  One of the partnerships has advanced to Tax Court and has entered a Motion for Entry of Decision with an agreed upon settlement.  The other partnership examination was recently completed by the IRS with no change impacting the Company’s tax position.  The Company does not currently expect significant adjustments to its financial statements from the partnership matter settled at the Tax Court.

The Company is currently under State of Missouri income and franchise tax examinations for its 2014 through 2015 tax years. The Company does not currently expect significant adjustments to its financial statements from this state examination.  During 2017, the Company settled its appeal with the Kansas Department of Revenue.  The settlement did not result in any significant adjustments to the Company’s financial statements.


45





Tax Reform

In the fourth quarter of 2017 the Company re-measured its deferred tax assets and liabilities as a result of the enactment of the new tax law “H.R.1,” originally known as the “Tax Cuts and Jobs Act” (the “Tax Reform Legislation”).  Enactment occurred on December 22, 2017.  The Tax Reform Legislation became effective January 1, 2018 and modifies the tax law in many ways.  The centerpiece of the Tax Reform Legislation is the reduction of the federal corporate income tax rate from 35% to 21%.  All deferred tax items as of December 22, 2017 needed to be re-valued using the new federal corporate income tax rate of 21%.  As a result, income tax expense recorded in 2017 included a $2.1 million increase to the deferred tax asset.

The SEC staff issued Staff Accounting Bulletin No. 118 (“SAB 118”) to address the application of U.S. GAAP in situations when a registrant does not have the necessary information available, prepared, or analyzed (including computations) in reasonable detail to complete the accounting for certain income tax effects of the Tax Reform Legislation.  The Company recognized the provisional tax impact related to the revaluation of deferred tax assets and liabilities and included these amounts in its consolidated financial statements for the year ended December 31, 2017.  The ultimate impact may differ from these provisional amounts, possibly materially, due to, among other things, additional analysis, changes in interpretations and assumptions the Company has made, additional regulatory guidance that may be issued, and actions the Company may take as a result of the Tax Reform Legislation.  The Company completed its accounting during 2018 without any significant adjustments from the provisional amounts.

ITEM 1A.  RISK FACTORS

An investment in the common stock of the Company is speculative in nature and is subject to certain risks inherent in the business of the Company and the Bank. The material risks and uncertainties that management believes affect the Company and the Bank are described below. You should carefully consider the risks described below, as well as the other information included in this Annual Report on Form 10-K, before making an investment in the Company’s common stock. The risks described below are not the only ones we face in our business. Additional risks and uncertainties not presently known to us or that we currently believe to be immaterial may also impair our business operations. If any of the following risks occur, our business, financial condition or operating results could be materially harmed. In such an event, our common stock could decline in value.

References to “we,” “us,” and “our” in this “Risk Factors” section refer to the Company and its subsidiaries, including the Bank, unless otherwise specified or unless the context otherwise requires.
Risks Relating to the Company and the Bank
Difficult market conditions and economic trends have adversely affected our industry and our business.

The United States experienced a severe economic recession in 2008 and 2009.  While economic growth has resumed, the rate of this growth generally has been slower than previous periods of economic recovery.  Many lending institutions, including us, experienced declines in the performance of their loans, including construction loans and commercial real estate loans, during the economic recession and for a few years after.  In addition, the values of real estate collateral supporting many loans declined.  The values of real estate collateral may increase or decrease over time and are subject to many factors.  At times in the past, bank and bank holding company stock prices have been negatively affected, as has the ability of banks and bank holding companies to raise capital and borrow in the debt markets. Conditions such as these may have a material adverse effect on our financial condition and results of operations. In addition, as a result of the foregoing factors, there is a potential for new laws and regulations regarding lending and funding practices and capital and liquidity standards (some of which have already been proposed or implemented), and bank regulatory agencies have been and are expected to continue to be very aggressive in responding to concerns and trends identified in examinations.

Adverse developments in the financial services industry and the impact of new legislation and regulations in response to those developments could restrict our business operations, including our ability to originate loans, and adversely impact our results of operations and financial condition. Overall, during some of the past several years, the general business environment had an adverse effect on our business.  The past few years have seen some areas of improvement in the general business environment; however, our business, financial condition and results of operations could be adversely affected by negative circumstances in the general business environment.

Since our business is primarily concentrated in Missouri, Iowa, Kansas and Minnesota, a significant downturn in these state or local economies, particularly in St. Louis and the Springfield, Mo. areas, may adversely affect our business.  We also have originated a significant dollar amount of loans in Texas and Oklahoma from our commercial loan offices in Dallas and Tulsa.  A significant downturn in these state economies may adversely affect our business.

Our lending and deposit gathering activities historically were concentrated primarily in the Springfield and southwest Missouri areas. Our success continues to depend heavily on general economic conditions in Springfield and the surrounding areas.  Although we

46





believe the economy in these areas has recently been favorable relative to other areas, we do not know whether these conditions will continue.  Until the past few years, our greatest concentration of loans and deposits has traditionally been in the Greater Springfield area. With a population of approximately 462,000, the Greater Springfield area is the third largest metropolitan area in Missouri.  At December 31, 2018, approximately $364.4 million of our loan portfolio (excluding those loans acquired in FDIC-assisted transactions) consisted of loans to borrowers in or secured by properties in the Springfield, Missouri metropolitan area.

Contiguous to Springfield is the Branson, Mo. area, which is a vacation and entertainment center, attracting tourists to its lakes, theme parks, resorts, country music and novelty shows and other recreational facilities.  The Branson area experienced rapid growth in the early 1990s, with stable to slightly negative growth trends occurring in the late 1990s and into the early 2000s.  Branson experienced growth again in the late 2000s as a result of a large retail, hotel, and convention center project which was constructed in Branson’s historic downtown.  In addition, several large national retailers opened new stores in Branson.  In 2010 through 2017, Branson experienced some negative growth trends with fewer visitors and the closing of some motels and shows.  Residential construction has been very limited in the past few years and little net growth has occurred in Branson’s commercial real estate market segments.  At December 31, 2018, approximately $72.6 million of our loan portfolio (excluding those loans acquired in FDIC-assisted transactions) consisted of loans to borrowers in or secured by properties in the two-county region that includes the Branson area.

In addition to the concentrations in the southwest Missouri area, we also now have our largest concentration of loans to borrowers in or secured by properties in the St. Louis, Mo. metropolitan area.  At December 31, 2018, approximately $750.3 million of our loan portfolio consisted of loans for apartments, condominiums, residential and commercial land developments, industrial revenue bonds and other types of commercial properties in the St. Louis, Mo. metropolitan area.

In addition to the concentrations previously discussed, we also have a concentration of loans to borrowers in or secured by properties in the States of Texas and Oklahoma.  At December 31, 2018, approximately $422.1 million and $301.2 million of our loan portfolio consisted of loans primarily for various types of commercial real estate in the States of Texas and Oklahoma, respectively.

With the FDIC-assisted transactions that were completed in 2009, we now have additional concentrations of loans in Western and Central Iowa and in Eastern Kansas.  The FDIC-assisted transaction completed in 2011 added to our concentrations in Missouri, particularly in St. Louis.  As a result of the FDIC-assisted transaction completed in 2012, we have additional concentrations of loans in the Minneapolis, Minnesota metropolitan area.  With the FDIC-assisted transaction that was completed in 2014, we now have additional loans in Eastern and Central Iowa.

Adverse changes in regional and general economic conditions could reduce our growth rate, impair our ability to collect loans, increase loan delinquencies, increase problem assets and foreclosures, increase claims and lawsuits, decrease demand for our products and services, and decrease the value of collateral for loans, especially real estate, thereby having a material adverse effect on our financial condition and results of operations.  Real estate values can also be affected by governmental rules or policies and natural disasters.

Our loan portfolio possesses increased risk due to our relatively high concentration of commercial and residential construction, commercial real estate, multi-family and other commercial loans.

Our commercial and residential construction, commercial real estate, multi-family and other commercial loans accounted for approximately 81.1% of our total loan portfolio as of December 31, 2018.  Generally, we consider these types of loans to involve a higher degree of risk compared to first mortgage loans on one- to four-family, owner-occupied residential properties. At December 31, 2018, we had $1.15 billion of loans secured by apartments, $479.0 million of loans secured by retail-related projects, $384.7 million of loans secured by office/warehouse facilities, $313.6 million of loans secured by healthcare facilities, and $163.4 million of loans secured by motels/hotels, which are particularly sensitive to certain risks, including the following:


large loan balances owed by a single borrower;

payments that are dependent on the successful operation of the project; and

loans that are more directly impacted by adverse conditions in the real estate market or the economy generally.

The risks associated with construction lending include the borrower’s inability to complete the construction process on time and within budget, the sale of the project within projected absorption periods, the economic risks associated with real estate collateral, and the potential of a rising interest rate environment.  These loans may include financing the development and/or construction of residential subdivisions.  This activity may involve financing land purchases, infrastructure development (e.g., roads, utilities, etc.), as well as construction of residences or multi-family dwellings for subsequent sale by the developer/builder. Because the sale of developed properties is critical to the success of the developer’s business, loan repayment may be especially subject to the volatility of real estate market values.  Management has established underwriting and monitoring criteria to help minimize the inherent risks of commercial real estate construction lending. However, there is no guarantee that these controls and procedures will reduce losses on this type of lending.

Commercial and multi-family real estate lending typically involves higher loan principal amounts and the repayment of these loans generally is dependent, in large part, on the successful operation of the property securing the loan or the business conducted on the

47





property securing the loan.  Other commercial loans are typically made on the basis of the borrower’s ability to make repayment from the cash flow of the borrower’s business or investment.  These loans may therefore be more adversely affected by conditions in the real estate markets or in the economy generally. For example, if the cash flow from the borrower’s project is reduced due to leases not being obtained or renewed, the borrower’s ability to repay the loan may be impaired.  In addition, many commercial and multi-family real estate loans are not fully amortized over the loan period, but have balloon payments due at maturity. A borrower’s ability to make a balloon payment typically will depend on being able to either refinance the loan or complete a timely sale of the underlying property.

We plan to continue to originate commercial real estate and construction loans based on economic and market conditions.  In the years prior to 2013, there was not significant demand for these types of loans.  In the current economic situation, demand for these types of loans has increased and we expect to continue to originate these types of loans.  Because of the increased risks related to these types of loans, we may determine it necessary to increase the level of our provision for loan losses. Increased provisions for loan losses would adversely impact our operating results.  See “Item 1. Business-The Company-Lending Activities-Commercial Real Estate and Construction Lending,” “-Other Commercial Lending,” “-Residential Real Estate Lending” and “-Allowance for Losses on Loans and Foreclosed Assets” and “Item 7. Management’s Discussion of Financial Condition and Results of Operations – Non-performing Assets” in this Report.

A slowdown in the residential or commercial real estate markets may adversely affect our earnings and liquidity position.

The overall credit quality of our construction loan portfolio is impacted by trends in real estate values.  We continually monitor changes in key regional and national economic factors because changes in these factors can impact our residential and commercial construction loan portfolio and the ability of our borrowers to repay their loans.  Across the United States for several years, the residential real estate market experienced significant adverse trends, including accelerated price depreciation and rising delinquency and default rates, and weaknesses arose in the commercial real estate market as well.  The conditions in the residential real estate market led to significant increases in loan delinquencies and credit losses as well as higher provisioning for loan losses, which in turn had a negative effect on earnings for many banks across the country.  Likewise, we also experienced delinquencies in our construction loan portfolio, almost entirely related to loans originated prior to 2009.  Many of these older construction projects were “build to sell” types of projects where repayment of the loans was reliant on the borrower completing the project and then selling it. Conditions of both the residential and the commercial real estate markets could negatively impact real estate values and the ability of our borrowers to liquidate properties.  A lack of liquidity in the real estate market or tightening of credit standards within the banking industry could diminish sales, further reducing our borrowers’ cash flows and weakening their ability to repay their debt obligations to us, which could lead to material adverse impacts on our financial condition and results of operations.

Our loan portfolio also possesses increased risk due to our concentration in consumer loans.

Our consumer loan portfolio grew significantly between 2010 and 2016.  More recently, consumer loans have grown from approximately $467.7 million, or 13.7% of our total loan portfolio as of December 31, 2014, to a peak of $673.0 million, or 15.3% of our total loan portfolio at December 31, 2016.  Since 2016, consumer loans have decreased to $432.2 million (this total includes $121.4 million of home equity loans), or 8.7% of our total loan portfolio as of December 31, 2018.  Consumer loans may entail greater risk than do residential mortgage loans, particularly in the case of consumer loans that are unsecured or secured by rapidly depreciable assets such as automobiles. In such cases, any repossessed collateral for a defaulted consumer loan may not provide an adequate source of repayment of the outstanding loan balance as a result of the greater likelihood of damage, loss or depreciation. The remaining deficiency often does not warrant further substantial collection efforts against the borrower. In addition, consumer loan collections are dependent on the borrower's continuing financial strength, and thus are more likely to be adversely affected by job loss, divorce, illness or personal bankruptcy. Furthermore, the application of various federal and state laws, including federal and state consumer bankruptcy and insolvency laws, may limit the amount which can be recovered on these loans. These loans may also give rise to claims and defenses by a consumer loan borrower against an assignee of these loans such as the Bank, and a borrower may be able to assert against the assignee claims and defenses which it has against the seller of the underlying collateral.

The majority of our consumer loans are secured by automobiles and, to a lesser extent, boats, recreational vehicles and manufactured homes, most of which are made by us indirectly through dealers in these products.  Through these dealer relationships, the dealer completes the application with the consumer and then submits it to us for credit approval.  As a result, we have limited personal contact with the borrower, which creates an additional risk element for us.

Our allowance for loan losses may prove to be insufficient to absorb potential losses in our loan portfolio.

Lending money is a substantial part of our business.  However, every loan we make carries a certain risk of non-payment.  This risk is affected by, among other things:


cash flows of the borrower and/or the project being financed;

in the case of a collateralized loan, the changes and uncertainties as to the future value of the collateral;

the credit history of a particular borrower;

changes in economic and industry conditions; and

the duration of the loan.
48




We maintain an allowance for loan losses that we believe reflects a reasonable estimate of known and inherent losses within the loan portfolio.  We make various assumptions and judgments about the collectability of our loan portfolio. Through a periodic review and consideration of the loan portfolio, management determines the amount of the allowance for loan losses by considering general market conditions, credit quality of the loan portfolio, the collateral supporting the loans and performance of customers relative to their financial obligations with us.  The amount of future losses is susceptible to changes in economic, operating and other conditions, including changes in interest rates, which may be beyond our control, and these losses may exceed current estimates.  Growing loan portfolios are, by their nature, unseasoned. As a result, estimating loan loss allowances for growing portfolios is more difficult, and may be more susceptible to changes in estimates, and to losses exceeding estimates, than more seasoned portfolios. We cannot fully predict the amount or timing of losses or whether the loss allowance will be adequate in the future.  Excessive loan losses and significant additions to our allowance for loan losses could have a material adverse impact on our financial condition and results of operations.

In addition, bank regulators periodically review our allowance for loan losses and may require us to increase our provision for loan losses or recognize further loan charge-offs. Any increase in our allowance for loan losses or loan charge-offs as required by these regulatory authorities might have a material adverse effect on our financial condition and results of operations.

We may be adversely affected by interest rate changes.

Our earnings are largely dependent upon our net interest income.  Net interest income is the difference between interest income earned on interest-earning assets such as loans and securities and interest expense paid on interest-bearing liabilities such as deposits and borrowed funds. Interest rates are highly sensitive to many factors that are beyond our control, including general economic conditions and policies of various governmental and regulatory agencies, in particular, the FRB. Changes in monetary policy, including changes in interest rates, could influence not only the interest we receive on loans and securities and the amount of interest we pay on deposits and borrowings, but these changes could also affect our ability to originate loans and obtain deposits, the fair values of our financial assets and liabilities and the average duration of our loan and mortgage-backed securities portfolios.  If the interest rates paid on deposits and other borrowings increase at a faster rate than the interest rates received on loans and other investments, our net interest income, and therefore earnings, could be adversely affected. In addition, a substantial portion of our loans (approximately 45.0% of our total loan portfolio as of December 31, 2018) have adjustable rates of interest.  While the higher payment amounts we would receive on these loans in a rising interest rate environment may increase our interest income, some borrowers may be unable to afford the higher payment amounts, which may result in a higher rate of default.  Earnings could also be adversely affected if the interest rates received on loans and other investments fall more quickly than the interest rates paid on deposits and other borrowings.

We generally seek to maintain a neutral position in terms of the volume of assets and liabilities that mature or re-price during any period.  As such, we have adopted asset and liability management strategies to attempt to minimize the potential adverse effects of changes in interest rates on net interest income, primarily by altering the mix and maturity of fixed-rate and variable-rate loans, investments and funding sources, including interest rate derivatives, so that we may reasonably maintain the Company’s net interest income and net interest margin.  However, interest rate fluctuations, the level and shape of the interest rate yield curve, maintaining excess liquidity levels, loan prepayments, loan production and deposit flows are constantly changing and influence the ability to maintain a neutral position.  Accordingly, we may not be successful in maintaining a neutral position and, as a result, our net interest margin may be adversely impacted.

The fair value of our investment securities can fluctuate due to market conditions outside of our control.

Factors beyond our control can significantly influence the fair value of securities in our investment securities portfolio and can cause potential adverse changes to the fair value of these securities. These factors include, but are not limited to, rating agency downgrades of the securities, defaults by the issuer or with respect to the underlying securities, changes in market rates of interest and instability in the credit markets. Any of these mentioned factors could cause an other-than-temporary impairment or permanent impairment of these assets, which would lead to accounting charges which could have a material negative effect on our financial condition and/or results of operations.

Conditions in the financial markets may limit our access to additional funding to meet our liquidity needs.

Liquidity is essential to our business, as we must maintain sufficient funds to respond to the needs of depositors and borrowers. An inability to raise funds through deposits, borrowings, the sale or pledging as collateral of loans and other assets could have a substantial adverse effect on our liquidity. Our access to funding sources in amounts adequate to finance our activities could be impaired by factors that affect us specifically or the financial services industry in general. Factors that could negatively affect our access to liquidity sources include a decrease in the level of our business activity due to a market downturn or regulatory action against us. Our ability to borrow could also be impaired by factors that are not specific to us, such as severe disruption of the financial markets or negative news and expectations about the prospects for the financial services industry as a whole.

49





Our operations may depend upon our continued ability to access brokered deposits and Federal Home Loan Bank advances.

Due to the high level of competition for deposits in our markets, we have from time to time utilized a sizable amount of certificates of deposit obtained through deposit brokers and advances from the Federal Home Loan Bank of Des Moines to help fund our asset base. Brokered deposits are marketed through national brokerage firms that solicit funds from their customers for deposit in banks, including our bank.  Brokered deposits and Federal Home Loan Bank advances may generally be more sensitive to changes in interest rates and volatility in the capital markets than retail deposits attracted through our branch network, and our reliance on these sources of funds increases the sensitivity of our portfolio to these external factors.  Our brokered deposits and Federal Home Loan Bank advances totaled $326.9 million and $-0- at December 31, 2018, compared with $225.5 million and $127.5 million at December 31, 2017.  In addition to the Federal Home Loan Bank advances, we had overnight borrowings from the Federal Home Loan Bank totaling $178.0 million and $15.0 million at December 31, 2018 and 2017, respectively.  These overnight borrowings are included in short-term borrowings in the Company’s consolidated financial statements.  We expect to continue to utilize brokered deposits from time to time as a supplemental funding source.

Bank regulators can restrict our access to these sources of funds in certain circumstances.  For example, if the Bank’s regulatory capital ratios declined below the “well-capitalized” status, banking regulators would require the Bank to obtain their approval prior to obtaining or renewing brokered deposits.  The regulators might not approve our acceptance of brokered deposits in amounts that we desire or at all. In addition, the availability of brokered deposits and the rates paid on these brokered deposits may be volatile as the balance of the supply of and the demand for brokered deposits changes.  Market credit and liquidity concerns may also impact the availability and cost of brokered deposits.  Similarly, Federal Home Loan Bank advances are only available to borrowers that meet certain conditions. If Great Southern were to cease meeting these conditions, our access to Federal Home Loan Bank advances could be significantly reduced or eliminated.

Certain Federal Home Loan Banks, including the Federal Home Loan Bank of Des Moines, have experienced lower earnings from time to time and paid out lower dividends to their members.  Future problems at the Federal Home Loan Banks may impact the collateral necessary to secure borrowings and limit the borrowings extended to its member banks, as well as require additional capital contributions by its member banks.  Should this occur, our short term liquidity needs could be negatively impacted.  Should Great Southern be restricted from using FHLBank advances due to weakness in the system or with the FHLBank of Des Moines, Great Southern may be forced to find alternative funding sources. These alternative funding sources may include the utilization of existing lines of credit with third party banks or the Federal Reserve Bank along with seeking other lines of credit, borrowing under repurchase agreement lines, increasing deposit rates to attract additional funds, accessing additional brokered deposits, or selling loans or investment securities in order to maintain adequate levels of liquidity.  At December 31, 2018, the Bank owned $12.4 million of stock in the FHLBank of Des Moines, which declared and paid an annualized dividend approximating 5.75% during the fourth quarter of 2018.  The FHLBank of Des Moines may eliminate or reduce dividend payments at any time in the future in order for it to maintain or restore its retained earnings.

Our strategy of pursuing acquisitions exposes us to financial, execution and operational risks that could adversely affect us.

We pursue a strategy of supplementing internal growth by acquiring other financial institutions or branches that we believe will help us fulfill our strategic objectives and enhance our earnings. There are risks associated with this strategy, however, including the following:


We may be exposed to potential asset quality issues or unknown or contingent liabilities of the banks or businesses we acquire.  If these issues or liabilities exceed our estimates, our earnings and financial condition may be adversely affected;

Prices at which acquisitions can be made fluctuate with market conditions.  We have experienced times during which acquisitions could not be made in specific markets at prices our management considered acceptable and expect that we will experience this condition in the future in one or more markets;

The acquisition of other entities generally requires integration of systems, procedures and personnel of the acquired entity in order to make the transaction economically feasible. This integration process is complicated and time consuming and can also be disruptive to the customers of the acquired business. If the integration process is not conducted successfully and with minimal effect on the acquired business and its customers, we may not realize the anticipated economic benefits of particular acquisitions within the expected time frame, and we may lose customers or employees of the acquired business.  We may also experience greater than anticipated customer losses even if the integration process is successful;

To finance an acquisition, we may borrow funds, thereby increasing our leverage and diminishing our liquidity, or raise additional capital, which could dilute the interests of our existing stockholders; and

50






We may not be able to continue to sustain our past rate of growth or to grow at all in the future.  We completed two acquisitions in 2009, one acquisition in 2011, one acquisition in 2012, one acquisition in 2014 and opened additional banking offices and commercial loan production offices in recent years that enhanced our rate of growth.  Also in 2014, we acquired certain loans, deposits and branches from Boulevard Bank.  In 2016, we completed an acquisition of certain loans, deposits and branches in St. Louis from Fifth Third Bank.

Our growth or future losses may require us to raise additional capital in the future, but that capital may not be available when it is needed.  If available, the cost of that capital may also be very high.

We are required by federal and state regulatory authorities to maintain adequate levels of capital to support our operations.  In addition, we may elect to raise additional capital to support the growth of our business or to finance acquisitions, if any, or we may elect to raise additional capital for other reasons.   Should we be required by regulatory authorities or otherwise elect to raise additional capital, we may seek to do so through the issuance of, among other things, our common stock or securities convertible into our common stock, which could dilute your ownership interest in the Company.

Our ability to raise additional capital, if needed or desired, will depend on conditions in the capital markets at that time, which are outside our control, and on our financial condition and performance.  Accordingly, we cannot make assurances of our ability to raise additional capital if needed or desired, or if the terms will be acceptable to us.  If we cannot raise additional capital when needed or desired, our ability to further expand our operations through internal growth and acquisitions could be materially impaired and our financial condition and liquidity could be materially adversely affected.

Our future success is dependent on our ability to compete effectively in the highly competitive banking industry.

We face substantial competition in all phases of our operations from a variety of different competitors.  Our future growth and success will depend on our ability to compete effectively in this highly competitive environment.  To date, we have grown our business successfully by focusing on our geographic market, expanding into complementary markets and emphasizing the high level of service and responsiveness desired by our customers.  We compete for loans, deposits and other financial services with other commercial banks, thrifts, credit unions, consumer finance companies, insurance companies and brokerage firms.  Many of our competitors offer products and services that we do not offer, and many have substantially greater resources, name recognition and market presence that benefit them in attracting business.  In addition, larger competitors (including certain nationwide banks that have a significant presence in our market areas) may be able to price loans and deposits more aggressively than we do, and smaller and newer competitors may also be more aggressive in terms of pricing loan and deposit products than us in order to obtain a larger share of the market.  As we have grown, we have become dependent from time to time on outside funding sources, including funds borrowed from the FHLBank of Des Moines and brokered deposits, where we face nationwide competition.  Some of the financial institutions and financial services organizations with which we compete are not subject to the same degree of regulation as is imposed on insured depositary institutions and their holding companies.  As a result, these non-bank competitors have certain advantages over us in accessing funding and in providing various services.

We also experience competition from a variety of institutions outside of our market areas.  Some of these institutions conduct business primarily over the Internet and may thus be able to realize certain cost savings and offer products and services at more favorable rates and with greater convenience to the customer.

Our business may be adversely affected by the highly regulated environment in which we operate, including the various capital adequacy guidelines we are required to meet.

We are subject to extensive federal and state legislation, regulation, examination and supervision. Recently enacted, proposed and future legislation and regulations have had, will continue to have, or may have an adverse effect on our business and operations.  For example, a federal rule which took effect on July 1, 2010 prohibits a financial institution from automatically enrolling customers in overdraft protection programs, on ATM and one-time debit card transactions, unless a consumer consents, or opts in, to the overdraft service.  This rule has adversely affected, and is likely to continue to adversely affect, the results of our operations by reducing the amount of our non-interest income.

Our success depends on our continued ability to maintain compliance with the various regulations to which we are subject.  Some of these regulations may increase our costs and thus place other financial institutions in stronger, more favorable competitive positions. We cannot predict what restrictions may be imposed upon us with future legislation. See “Item 1.-The Company -Government Supervision and Regulation” in this Report.

The Company and the Bank are required to meet certain regulatory capital adequacy guidelines and other regulatory requirements imposed by the FRB, the FDIC and the Missouri Division of Finance. If the Company or the Bank fails to meet these minimum capital guidelines and other regulatory requirements, our financial condition and results of operations could be materially and adversely affected and could compromise the status of the Company as a financial holding company.  See “Item 1.-The Company -Government Supervision and Regulation” in this Report.

51





Financial reform legislation has, among other things, tightened capital standards, created a Consumer Financial Protection Bureau and resulted in regulations that have increased, and are expected to continue to increase, our costs of operations.

On July 21, 2010, the Dodd-Frank Wall Street Reform and Consumer Protection Act (the “Dodd-Frank Act”) was signed into law. This law has significantly changed the bank regulatory structure and affected the lending, deposit, investment, trading and operating activities of financial institutions and their holding companies. The Dodd-Frank Act requires various federal agencies to adopt a broad range of new implementing rules and regulations, and to prepare numerous studies and reports for Congress. The federal agencies are given significant discretion in drafting the implementing rules and regulations, and consequently, many of the details and much of the impact of the Dodd-Frank Act may not be known for many months or years.

Among the many requirements in the Dodd-Frank Act is a requirement for new capital regulations.  Generally, trust preferred securities are no longer eligible as Tier 1 capital, but the Company’s currently outstanding trust preferred securities were grandfathered and will continue to qualify as Tier 1 capital.  See “Item 1. Business—Government Supervision and Regulation-Capital” and “Item 7. Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations-Effect of Laws and Regulations-New Capital Rules.”

The Dodd-Frank Act created the Consumer Financial Protection Bureau (the “Bureau”), with broad powers to supervise and enforce consumer protection laws. The Bureau has broad rule-making authority for a wide range of consumer protection laws that apply to all banks, including the authority to prohibit “unfair, deceptive or abusive acts and practices.” The Bureau has examination and primary enforcement authority with respect to depository institutions with $10 billion or more in assets, their service providers and certain non-depository entities such as debt collectors and consumer reporting agencies. In the case of banks, such as the Bank, with total assets of less than $10 billion, this examination and enforcement authority is held by the institution’s primary federal banking regulator (the FDIC, in the case of the Bank).

The Bureau has finalized a number of significant rules that could have a significant impact on our business and the financial services industry more generally. In particular, the Bureau has adopted rules impacting nearly every aspect of the lifecycle of a residential mortgage loan. The Bureau has also issued guidance which could significantly affect the automotive financing industry by subjecting indirect auto lenders, such as the Bank, to regulation as creditors under the Equal Credit Opportunity Act, which would make indirect auto lenders monitor and control certain credit policies and procedures undertaken by auto dealers.

Additional provisions of the Dodd-Frank Act are described in this report under “Item 1. Business—Government Supervision and Regulation-Significant Legislation Impacting the Financial Services Industry” and “Item 7. - Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations—Effect of Federal Laws and Regulations-Significant Legislation Impacting the Financial Services Industry.”

Certain aspects of the Dodd-Frank Act remain subject to rulemaking and have taken and will continue to take effect over several years.  Compliance with this law and its implementing regulations have resulted in and will continue to result in additional operating costs that could have a material adverse effect on our financial condition and results of operations.

The recently enacted tax reform legislation is expected to have a significant impact on us, and our financial condition and results of operations could be adversely affected by the broader implications of the legislation.

H.R. 1, which was originally known as the "Tax Cuts and Jobs Act" and was signed into law in December 2017, is expected to have a significant impact on our financial statements and customers. It will take some time for us to analyze all of the implications of this legislation. Although we generally benefit from the legislation’s reduction in the Federal corporate income tax rate, a tax rate reduction potentially has broader implications for our operations, as the new rate could cause positive or negative effects on loan demand and on our pricing models, municipal bonds, tax credits and other investments. The interest deduction limitation implemented by the legislation could make some businesses and industries less inclined to borrow, potentially reducing demand for our commercial loan products. Further, the legislation’s limitation on the mortgage interest deduction and state and local tax deduction for individual taxpayers could increase the after-tax cost of owning a home for some of our potential and existing customers and potentially reduce demand for, or the individual size of, the residential mortgage loans we originate.

Our exposure to operational risks may adversely affect us.

Similar to other financial institutions, we are exposed to many types of operational risk, including reputational risk, legal and compliance risk, the risk of fraud or theft by employees or outsiders, the risk that sensitive customer or Company data is compromised, unauthorized transactions by employees or operational errors, including clerical or record-keeping errors. If any of these risks occur, it could result in material adverse consequences for us.

We continually encounter technological change, and we may have fewer resources than many of our competitors to continue to invest in technological improvements.

The financial services industry is undergoing rapid technological changes, with frequent introductions of new technology-driven products and services.  Our future success will depend, in part, upon our ability to address the needs of our clients by using technology to provide products and services that will satisfy client demands for convenience, as well as to create additional efficiencies in our

52





operations. Many of our competitors have substantially greater resources to invest in technological improvements. We may not be able to effectively implement new technology-driven products and services or be successful in marketing these products and services to our clients.

We are also subject to security-related risks in connection with our use of technology, and our security measures may not be sufficient to mitigate the risk of a cyber attack or to protect us from systems failures or interruptions.

Communications and information systems are essential to the conduct of our business, as we use such systems to manage our client relationships, our general ledger and virtually all other aspects of our business. Our operations rely on the secure processing, storage, and transmission of confidential and other information in our computer systems and networks. Although we take protective measures and endeavor to modify them as circumstances warrant, the security of our computer systems, software, and networks may be vulnerable to breaches, unauthorized access, misuse, computer viruses, or other malicious code and cyber attacks that could have a security impact.  If one or more of these events occur, this could jeopardize our or our clients’ confidential and other information processed and stored in, and transmitted through, our computer systems and networks, or otherwise cause interruptions or malfunctions in our operations or the operations of our clients or counterparties. We may be required to expend significant additional resources to modify our protective measures or to investigate and remediate vulnerabilities or other exposures, and we may be subject to litigation and financial losses that are either not insured against or not fully covered through any insurance maintained by us. We could also suffer significant reputational damage.

As a service to our clients, we currently offer an Internet PC banking product and a smartphone application for iPhone and Android users.  Use of these services involves the transmission of confidential information over public networks. We cannot be sure that advances in computer capabilities, new discoveries in the field of cryptography or other developments will not result in a compromise or breach in the commercially available encryption and authentication technology that we use to protect our clients' transaction data. If we were to experience such a breach or compromise, we could suffer losses and reputational damage and our results of operations could be materially adversely affected.

While we have established policies and procedures to prevent or limit the impact of systems failures and interruptions, there can be no assurance that such events will not occur or that they will be adequately addressed if they do. In addition, we outsource certain aspects of our data processing and other operational functions to certain third-party providers. If our third-party providers encounter difficulties, or if we have difficulty in communicating with them, our ability to adequately process and account for transactions could be affected, and our business operations could be adversely impacted. Threats to information security also exist in the processing of client information through various other vendors and their personnel.

The occurrence of any systems failure or interruption could damage our reputation and result in a loss of clients and business, or could expose us to legal liability. Any of these occurrences could have a material adverse effect on our results of operations.

Our accounting policies and methods impact how we report our financial condition and results of operations. Application of these policies and methods may require management to make estimates about matters that are uncertain.

Our accounting policies and methods are fundamental to how we record and report our financial condition and results of operations.  Our management must exercise judgment in selecting and applying many of these accounting policies and methods so they comply with generally accepted accounting principles and reflect management’s judgment of the most appropriate manner to report our financial condition and results of operations.  In some cases, management must select the accounting policy or method to apply from two or more alternatives, any of which might be reasonable under the circumstances yet might result in our reporting materially different amounts than would have been reported under a different alternative.  Our significant accounting policies are described in Note 1 of the accompanying audited financial statements included in Item 8 of this Report.  These accounting policies are critical to presenting our financial condition and results of operations. They may require management to make difficult, subjective or complex judgments about matters that are uncertain.  Materially different amounts could be reported under different conditions or using different assumptions.

Changes in accounting standards could materially impact our consolidated financial statements.

The accounting standard setters, including the Financial Accounting Standards Board, Securities and Exchange Commission and other regulatory bodies, from time to time may change the financial accounting and reporting standards that govern the preparation of our consolidated financial statements. These changes can be hard to predict and can materially impact how we record and report our financial condition and results of operations.  In some cases, we could be required to apply a new or revised standard retroactively, resulting in changes to previously reported financial results, or a cumulative charge to retained earnings.

New accounting standards may result in a significant change to our recognition of credit losses and may materially impact our financial condition or results of operations.

In June 2016, the Financial Accounting Standards Board issued new authoritative accounting guidance under ASC Topic 326 "Financial Instruments - Credit Losses" amending the incurred loss impairment methodology in current accounting principles generally accepted in the United States of America ("GAAP") with a methodology that reflects expected credit losses (referred to as the "CECL model") and requires consideration of a broader range of reasonable and supportable information for credit loss estimates,

53





which goes into effect for us on January 1, 2020. Under the incurred loss model, we delay recognition of losses until it is probable that a loss has been incurred. The CECL model represents a dramatic departure from the incurred loss model. The CECL model requires a financial asset (or a group of financial assets) measured at amortized cost basis, such as loans held for investment and held-to-maturity debt securities, to be presented at the net amount expected to be collected (net of the allowance for credit losses). Similarly, the credit losses relating to available-for-sale debt securities will be recorded through an allowance for credit losses rather than a write-down. In addition, the measurement of expected credit losses will take place at the time the financial asset is first added to the balance sheet (with periodic updates thereafter) and will be based on relevant information about past events, including historical experience, current conditions, and reasonable and supportable forecasts that affect the collectability of the reported amount.

As such, the CECL model will materially impact how we determine our allowance for loan losses and may require us to significantly increase our allowance for loan losses. Furthermore, we may experience more fluctuations in our allowance for loan losses, which may be significant. If we were required to materially increase our allowance for loan losses, it may negatively impact our financial condition and results of operations. We are currently evaluating the new guidance and expect it to have an impact on our statements of income and financial condition, the significance of which is not yet known. We expect the CECL model will require us to recognize a one-time cumulative adjustment to our allowance for loan losses in order to fully transition from the incurred loss model to the CECL model, which could negatively impact our financial condition and results of operations.

Uncertainty relating to the LIBOR calculation process and potential phasing out of LIBOR may adversely affect us.

On July 27, 2017, the Chief Executive of the United Kingdom Financial Conduct Authority, which regulates LIBOR, announced that it intends to stop persuading or compelling banks to submit rates for the calibration of LIBOR to the administrator of LIBOR after 2021. The announcement indicates that the continuation of LIBOR on the current basis cannot and will not be guaranteed after 2021. It is impossible to predict whether and to what extent banks will continue to provide LIBOR submissions to the administrator of LIBOR or whether any additional reforms to LIBOR may be enacted in the United Kingdom or elsewhere. At this time, no consensus exists as to what rate or rates may become acceptable alternatives to LIBOR and it is impossible to predict the effect of any such alternatives on the value of LIBOR-based securities and variable rate loans, debentures, or other securities or financial arrangements, given LIBOR's role in determining market interest rates globally. Uncertainty as to the nature of alternative reference rates and as to potential changes or other reforms to LIBOR may adversely affect LIBOR rates and the value of LIBOR-based loans and securities in our portfolio and may impact the availability and cost of hedging instruments and borrowings. If LIBOR rates are no longer available, and we are required to implement substitute indices for the calculation of interest rates under our loan agreements with our borrowers, we may incur significant expenses in effecting the transition, and may be subject to disputes or litigation with customers over the appropriateness or comparability to LIBOR of the substitute indices, which could have a material adverse effect on our results of operations and financial condition.

Our controls and procedures may be ineffective.

We regularly review and update our internal controls, disclosure controls and procedures and corporate governance policies and procedures. As a result, we may incur increased costs to maintain and improve our controls and procedures. Any system of controls, however well designed and operated, is based in part on certain assumptions and can provide only reasonable, not absolute, assurances that the objectives of the system are met. Any failure or circumvention of our controls or procedures or failure to comply with regulations related to controls and procedures could have a material adverse effect on our business, results of operations or financial condition.

Risks Relating to our Common Stock

The price of our common stock may fluctuate significantly, and this may make it difficult for you to resell our common stock when you want or at prices you find attractive.

We cannot predict how our common stock will trade in the future. The market value of our common stock will likely continue to fluctuate in response to a number of factors including the following, most of which are beyond our control, as well as the other factors described in this “Risk Factors” section:


actual or anticipated quarterly fluctuations in our operating and financial results;

developments related to investigations, proceedings or litigation that involve us;

changes in financial estimates and recommendations by financial analysts;

dispositions, acquisitions and financings;

actions of our current stockholders, including sales of common stock by existing stockholders and our directors and executive officers;

fluctuations in the stock price and operating results of our competitors;

regulatory developments; and

other developments related to the financial services industry. 



54





The market value of our common stock may also be affected by conditions affecting the financial markets in general, including price and trading fluctuations. These conditions may result in (i) volatility in the level of, and fluctuations in, the market prices of stocks generally and, in turn, our common stock and (ii) sales of substantial amounts of our common stock in the market, in each case that could be unrelated or disproportionate to changes in our operating performance.  These broad market fluctuations may adversely affect the market value of our common stock.  Our common stock also has a low average daily trading volume relative to many other stocks, which may limit an investor’s ability to quickly accumulate or divest themselves of large blocks of our stock. This can lead to significant price swings even when a relatively small number of shares are being traded.

There may be future sales of additional common stock or other dilution of our equity, which may adversely affect the market price of our common stock.

We are not restricted from issuing additional common stock or preferred stock, including any securities that are convertible into or exchangeable for, or that represent the right to receive, common stock or preferred stock or any substantially similar securities.  The market value of our common stock could decline as a result of sales by us of a large number of shares of common stock or preferred stock or similar securities in the market or the perception that such sales could occur.

Our board of directors is authorized to cause us to issue additional common stock, as well as classes or series of preferred stock, generally without any action on the part of the stockholders.  In addition, the board has the power, generally without stockholder approval, to set the terms of any such classes or series of preferred stock that may be issued, including voting rights, dividend rights and preferences over the common stock with respect to dividends or upon the liquidation, dissolution or winding-up of our business and other terms.  If we issue preferred stock in the future that has a preference over the common stock with respect to the payment of dividends or upon liquidation, dissolution or winding-up, or if we issue preferred stock with voting rights that dilute the voting power of the common stock, the rights of holders of the common stock or the market value of the common stock could be adversely affected.

Regulatory and contractual restrictions may limit or prevent us from paying dividends on and repurchasing our common stock.

Great Southern Bancorp, Inc. is an entity separate and distinct from its principal subsidiary, Great Southern Bank, and derives substantially all of its revenue in the form of dividends from that subsidiary.  Accordingly, Great Southern Bancorp, Inc. is and will be dependent upon dividends from the Bank to pay the principal of and interest on its indebtedness, to satisfy its other cash needs and to pay dividends on its common and preferred stock.  The Bank’s ability to pay dividends is subject to its ability to earn net income and to meet certain regulatory requirements.  In the event the Bank is unable to pay dividends to Great Southern Bancorp, Inc., Great Southern Bancorp, Inc. may not be able to pay dividends on its common or preferred stock.  Also, Great Southern Bancorp, Inc.’s right to participate in a distribution of assets upon a subsidiary’s liquidation or reorganization is subject to the prior claims of the subsidiary’s creditors.  This includes claims under the liquidation account maintained for the benefit of certain eligible deposit account holders of the Bank established in connection with the Bank’s conversion from the mutual to the stock form of ownership.

As described below in the next risk factor, the terms of our outstanding junior subordinated debt securities prohibit us from paying dividends on or repurchasing our common stock at any time when we have elected to defer the payment of interest on such debt securities or certain events of default under the terms of those debt securities have occurred and are continuing.  These restrictions could have a negative effect on the value of our common stock.  Moreover, holders of our common stock are entitled to receive dividends only when, as and if declared by our board of directors.  Although we have historically paid cash dividends on our common stock, we are not required to do so and our board of directors could reduce, suspend or eliminate our common stock cash dividend in the future.

If we defer payments of interest on our outstanding junior subordinated debt securities or if certain defaults relating to those debt securities occur, we will be prohibited from declaring or paying dividends or distributions on, and from making liquidation payments with respect to, our common stock.

As of December 31, 2018, we had outstanding $25.8 million aggregate principal amount of junior subordinated debt securities issued in connection with the sale of trust preferred securities by one of our subsidiaries that is a statutory business trust.  We have also guaranteed those trust preferred securities.  The indenture governing the junior subordinated debt securities, together with the related guarantee, prohibits us, subject to limited exceptions, from declaring or paying any dividends or distributions on, or redeeming, repurchasing, acquiring or making any liquidation payments with respect to, any of our capital stock (including any preferred stock and our common stock) at any time when (i) there shall have occurred and be continuing an event of default under the indenture or any event, act or condition that with notice or lapse of time or both would constitute an event of default under the indenture; or (ii) we are in default with respect to payment of any obligations under the related guarantee; or (iii) we have deferred payment of interest on the junior subordinated debt securities. In that regard, we are entitled, at our option but subject to certain conditions, to defer payments of interest on the junior subordinated debt securities from time to time for up to five years.



55





Events of default under the indenture generally consist of our failure to pay interest on the junior subordinated debt securities under certain circumstances, our failure to pay any principal of or premium on the junior subordinated debt securities when due, our failure to comply with certain covenants under the indenture, and certain events of bankruptcy, insolvency or liquidation relating to us or Great Southern Bank.

As a result of these provisions, if we were to elect to defer payments of interest on the junior subordinated debt securities, or if any of the other events described in clause (i) or (ii) of the first paragraph of this risk factor were to occur, we would be prohibited from declaring or paying any dividends on our stock, from redeeming, repurchasing or otherwise acquiring any of our stock, and from making any payments to holders of our stock in the event of our liquidation, which would likely have a material adverse effect on the market value of our common stock.  Moreover, without notice to or consent from our stockholders, we may issue additional series of junior subordinated debt securities in the future with terms similar to those of our existing junior subordinated debt securities or enter into other financing agreements that limit our ability to purchase or to pay dividends or distributions on our capital stock, including our common stock.

The voting limitation provision in our charter could limit your voting rights as a holder of our common stock.

Our charter provides that any person or group who acquires beneficial ownership of our common stock in excess of 10.0% of the outstanding shares may not vote the excess shares.  Accordingly, if you acquire beneficial ownership of more than 10.0% of the outstanding shares of our common stock, your voting rights with respect to the common stock will not be commensurate with your economic interest in our company.

Anti-takeover provisions could adversely impact our stockholders.

Provisions in our charter and bylaws, the corporate law of the state of Maryland and federal regulations could delay or prevent a third party from acquiring us, despite the possible benefit to our stockholders, or otherwise adversely affect the market price of any class of our equity securities, including our common stock.  These provisions include: a prohibition on voting shares of common stock beneficially owned in excess of 10% of total shares outstanding, supermajority voting requirements for certain business combinations with any person who beneficially owns 10% or more of our outstanding common stock; the election of directors to staggered terms of three years; advance notice requirements for nominations for election to our board of directors and for proposing matters that stockholders may act on at stockholder meetings, a requirement that only directors may fill a vacancy in our board of directors, and supermajority voting requirements to remove any of our directors.  Our charter also authorizes our board of directors to issue preferred stock, and preferred stock could be issued as a defensive measure in response to a takeover proposal.  In addition, because we are a bank holding company, purchasers of 10% or more of our common stock may be required to obtain approvals under the Change in Bank Control Act of 1978, as amended, or the Bank Holding Company Act of 1956, as amended (and in certain cases such approvals may be required at a lesser percentage of ownership).  Specifically, under regulations adopted by the Federal Reserve Board, (a) any other bank holding company may be required to obtain the approval of the Federal Reserve Board to acquire or retain 5% or more of our common stock and (b) any person other than a bank holding company may be required to obtain the approval of the Federal Reserve Board to acquire or retain 10% or more of our common stock.

These provisions may discourage potential takeover attempts, discourage bids for our common stock at a premium over market price or adversely affect the market price of, and the voting and other rights of the holders of, our common stock.  These provisions also could discourage proxy contests and make it more difficult for holders of our common stock to elect directors other than the candidates nominated by our board of directors.

Three members of the Turner family may exert substantial influence over the Company through their board and management positions and their ownership of the Company’s stock.

The Company’s Chairman of the Board, William V. Turner, and the Company’s Director, President and Chief Executive Officer, Joseph W. Turner, are father and son, respectively.  Julie Turner Brown, a director of the Company, is the sister of Joseph Turner and the daughter of William Turner.  These three Turner family members hold three of the Company’s nine Board positions.  As of December 31, 2018, they collectively beneficially owned approximately 2,120,574 shares of the Company’s common stock (excluding 57,000 shares underlying stock options exercisable as of or within 60 days after that date), representing approximately 15.0% of total shares outstanding, though they are subject to the voting limitation provision in our charter which precludes any person or group with beneficial ownership in excess of 10% of total shares outstanding from voting shares in excess of that threshold.   Through their board and management positions and their ownership of the Company’s stock, these three members of the Turner family may exert substantial influence over the direction of the Company and the outcome of Board and stockholder votes.

In addition to the Turner family members, we are aware of other beneficial owners of more than five percent of the outstanding shares of our common stock.  One of these beneficial owners is also a director of the Company.

As of December 31, 2018, one of the Company’s directors, Earl A. Steinert, beneficially owned 936,096 shares of our common stock, representing approximately 6.6% of total shares outstanding.  The shares that can be voted by the Turner family members (1,415,120 shares, per the ten percent voting limitation in our charter) and the shares beneficially owned by Mr. Steinert (936,096) total 2,351,216, representing approximately 16.6% of total shares outstanding.  While they have no agreement to do so, to the extent they vote in the same manner, these stockholders may be able to exercise influence over the management and business affairs of our Company. For example, using their collective voting power, these stockholders may be able to affect the outcome of director elections or block significant transactions, such as a merger or acquisition, or any other matter that might otherwise be favored by other stockholders.



56





ITEM 1B.  UNRESOLVED STAFF COMMENTS

None.

ITEM 2.  PROPERTIES.

The Company’s corporate offices and operations center are located in Springfield, Missouri.  At December 31, 2018, the Company operated 99 retail banking centers and over 200 automated teller machines ("ATMs") in Missouri, Iowa, Minnesota, Kansas, Nebraska and Arkansas.  Of the 99 banking centers, the Company owns 89 of its locations and 10 were leased for various terms.  The majority of our banking center locations are in southwest and central Missouri, including the Springfield, Mo. metropolitan area, with additional concentrations in the Sioux City, Iowa, Des Moines, Iowa, Quad Cities, Iowa, Minneapolis, Minn., St. Louis Mo. and Kansas City, Mo. metropolitan areas.  The ATMs are located at various banking centers and primarily convenience stores and retail centers located throughout southwest and central Missouri. At December 31, 2018, the Company also operated six commercial and one mortgage loan production offices.  The Company owns one of its loan production office locations and five locations are leased.  All buildings which are owned are owned free of encumbrances or mortgages.  In the opinion of management, the facilities are adequate and suitable for the needs of the Company.  The aggregate net book value of the Company's premises and equipment was $132.4 million and $138.0 million at December 31, 2018 and 2017, respectively.  See also Note 6 and Note 16 of the accompanying audited financial statements, which are included in Item 8 of this Report.

ITEM 3.  LEGAL PROCEEDINGS.

In the normal course of business, the Company and its subsidiaries are subject to pending and threatened legal actions, some of which seek substantial relief or damages.  While the ultimate outcome of such legal proceedings cannot be predicted with certainty, after reviewing pending and threatened litigation with counsel, management believes at this time that, except as noted below, the outcome of such litigation will not have a material adverse effect on the Company’s business, financial condition or results of operations.

ITEM 4.  MINE SAFETY DISCLOSURES

Not applicable.

ITEM 4A.  EXECUTIVE OFFICERS OF THE REGISTRANT.

Pursuant to General Instruction G(3) of Form 10-K and Instruction 3 to Item 401(b) of Regulation S-K, the following list is included as an unnumbered item in Part I of this Form 10-K in lieu of being included in the Registrant's Definitive Proxy Statement.

The following information as to the business experience during the past five years is supplied with respect to executive officers of the Company and its subsidiaries who are not directors of the Company and its subsidiaries. There are no arrangements or understandings between the persons named and any other person pursuant to which such officers were selected. The executive officers are elected annually and serve at the discretion of the respective Boards of Directors of the Company and its subsidiaries.

Kevin L Baker.  Mr. Baker, age 51, is Vice President and Chief Credit Officer of the Bank.  He joined the bank in 2005 and is responsible for the overall credit approval process, commercial and consumer loan collection process and the loan documentation and servicing processes.  Prior to joining the Bank, Mr. Baker was a lending officer at a commercial bank. 

John M. Bugh. Mr. Bugh, age 51, is Vice President and Chief Lending Officer of the Bank. He joined the Bank in 2011 and is in charge of all loan production for the Bank, including commercial, residential and consumer loans. Prior to joining the Bank, Mr. Bugh was a lending officer at other commercial banks and was an examiner for the FDIC.

57





Rex A. Copeland. Mr. Copeland, age 54, is Treasurer of the Company and Senior Vice President and Chief Financial Officer of the Bank. He joined the Bank in 2000 and is responsible for the financial functions of the Company, including the internal and external financial reporting of the Company and its subsidiaries. Mr. Copeland is a Certified Public Accountant. Prior to joining the Bank, Mr. Copeland served other financial services companies in the areas of corporate accounting, internal audit and independent public accounting.

Douglas W. Marrs. Mr. Marrs, age 61, is Secretary of the Company and Secretary, Vice President - Operations of the Bank. He joined the Bank in 1996 and is responsible for all operations functions of the Bank. Prior to joining the Bank, Mr. Marrs was a bank officer in the areas of operations and data processing at a commercial bank.

Linton J. Thomason. Mr. Thomason, age 63, is Vice President - Information Services of the Bank. He joined the Bank in 1997 and is responsible for information services for the Company and all of its subsidiaries and all treasury management sales/operations of the Bank. Prior to joining the Bank, Mr. Thomason was a bank officer in the areas of technology and data processing, operations and treasury management at a commercial bank.


PART II

ITEM 5.     MARKET FOR REGISTRANT'S COMMON EQUITY, RELATED STOCKHOLDER MATTERS AND
ISSUER PURCHASES OF EQUITY SECURITIES.

Market Information

The Company's Common Stock is listed on The NASDAQ Global Select Market under the symbol "GSBC."

As of December 31, 2018 there were 14,151,198 total shares of common stock outstanding and approximately 2,000 stockholders of record.

The Company's ability to pay dividends is substantially dependent on the dividend payments it receives from the Bank. For a description of the regulatory restrictions on the ability of the Bank to pay dividends to the Company, and the ability of the Company to pay dividends to its stockholders, see "Item 1. Business - Government Supervision and Regulation - Dividends."

Stock Repurchases

On April 18, 2018, the Company's Board of Directors authorized management to repurchase up to 500,000 shares of the Company's outstanding common stock, under a program of open market purchases or privately negotiated transactions. The plan does not have an expiration date.  The authorization of this new plan terminated the previous repurchase plan which was approved in November 2006, with an authorization to repurchase up to 700,000 shares of the Company's outstanding common stock.

As indicated below, the Company repurchased the following shares of its common stock during the three months ended December 31, 2018.

 
 
Total Number
of Shares
Purchased
   
Average
Price
Per Share
   
Total Number
of Shares
Purchased as
Part of Publicly
Announced Plan
   
Maximum
Number of
Shares that May
Yet Be Purchased
Under the Plan (1)
 
 
                       
October 1, 2018 - October 31, 2018
   
2,500
   
$
52.05
     
2,500
     
497,500
 
November 1, 2018- November 30, 2018
   
     
     
     
497,500
 
December 1, 2018- December 31, 2018
   
15,042
     
51.43
     
15,042
     
482,458
 
 
                               
 
   
17,542
   
$
51.52
     
17,542
         

__________________
(1)
Amount represents the number of shares available to be repurchased under the April 2018 plan as of the last calendar day of the month shown.
 




















58





ITEM 6.  SELECTED FINANCIAL DATA

The following table sets forth selected consolidated financial information and other financial data of the Company. The summary statement of financial condition information and statement of income information are derived from our consolidated financial statements, which have been audited by BKD, LLP.  See Item 7. “Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations,” and Item 8. “Financial Statements and Supplementary Information.”  Results for past periods are not necessarily indicative of results that may be expected for any future period.
 
 
 
December 31,
 
 
 
2018
   
2017
   
2016
   
2015
   
2014
 
 
 
(Dollars In Thousands)
 
 
                             
Summary Statement of Financial Condition Information:
                             
  Assets
 
$
4,676,200
   
$
4,414,521
   
$
4,550,663
   
$
4,104,189
   
$
3,951,334
 
  Loans receivable, net
   
3,990,651
     
3,734,505
     
3,776,411
     
3,352,797
     
3,053,427
 
  Allowance for loan losses
   
38,409
     
36,492
     
37,400
     
38,149
     
38,435
 
  Available-for-sale securities
   
243,968
     
179,179
     
213,872
     
262,856
     
365,506
 
  Other real estate and repossessions, net
   
8,440
     
22,002
     
32,658
     
31,893
     
45,838
 
  Deposits
   
3,725,007
     
3,597,144
     
3,677,230
     
3,268,626
     
2,990,840
 
  Total borrowings and other interest-bearing liabilities
   
397,594
     
324,097
     
416,786
     
406,797
     
514,014
 
  Stockholders' equity (retained
                                       
    earnings substantially restricted)
   
531,977
     
471,662
     
429,806
     
398,227
     
419,745
 
  Common stockholders' equity
   
531,977
     
471,662
     
429,806
     
398,227
     
361,802
 
  Average loans receivable
   
3,910,819
     
3,814,560
     
3,659,360
     
3,235,787
     
2,784,106
 
  Average total assets
   
4,503,326
     
4,460,196
     
4,370,793
     
4,067,399
     
3,824,493
 
  Average deposits
   
3,556,240
     
3,598,579
     
3,475,887
     
3,203,262
     
3,007,588
 
  Average stockholders' equity
   
498,508
     
455,704
     
414,799
     
438,683
     
402,670
 
  Number of deposit accounts
   
227,240
     
230,456
     
231,272
     
217,139
     
217,877
 
  Number of full-service offices
   
99
     
104
     
104
     
110
     
108
 

 
59


 

 
 
For the Year Ended December 31,
 
 
 
2018
   
2017
   
2016
   
2015
   
2014
 
 
 
(In Thousands)
 
Summary Statement of Income Information:
     
Interest income:
                             
  Loans
 
$
198,226
   
$
176,654
   
$
178,883
   
$
177,240
   
$
172,569
 
  Investment securities and other
   
7,723
     
6,407
     
6,292
     
7,111
     
10,793
 
 
   
205,949
     
183,061
     
185,175
     
184,351
     
183,362
 
Interest expense:
     
  Deposits
   
27,957
     
20,595
     
17,387
     
13,511
     
11,225
 
  Federal Home Loan Bank advances
   
3,985
     
1,516
     
1,214
     
1,707
     
2,910
 
  Short-term borrowings and repurchase agreements
   
765
     
747
     
1,137
     
65
     
1,099
 
  Subordinated debentures issued to capital trust
   
953
     
949
     
803
     
714
     
567
 
  Subordinated notes
   
4,097
     
4,098
     
1,578
     
     
 
 
   
37,757
     
27,905
     
22,119
     
15,997
     
15,801
 
Net interest income
   
168,192
     
155,156
     
163,056
     
168,354
     
167,561
 
Provision for loan losses
   
7,150
     
9,100
     
9,281
     
5,519
     
4,151
 
Net interest income after  provision for loan losses
   
161,042
     
146,056
     
153,775
     
162,835
     
163,410
 
Noninterest income:
                                       
  Commissions
   
1,137
     
1,041
     
1,097
     
1,136
     
1,163
 
  Service charges and ATM fees
   
21,695
     
21,628
     
21,666
     
19,841
     
19,075
 
  Net realized gains on sales of loans
   
1,788
     
3,150
     
3,941
     
3,888
     
4,133
 
  Net realized gains on sales of
                                       
     available-for-sale securities
   
2
     
     
2,873
     
2
     
2,139
 
  Late charges and fees on loans
   
1,622
     
2,231
     
1,747
     
2,129
     
1,400
 
Gain (loss) on derivative interest rate products
   
25
     
28
     
66
     
(43
)
   
(345
)
Gain recognized on sale of business units
   
7,414
     
     
     
     
 
  Gain recognized on business acquisitions
   
     
     
     
     
10,805
 
  Gain (loss) on termination of loss sharing agreements
   
     
7,705
     
(584
)
   
     
 
  Amortization of income/expense related to business acquisition
   
     
(486
)
   
(6,351
)
   
(18,345
)
   
(27,868
)
  Other income
   
2,535
     
3,230
     
4,055
     
4,973
     
4,229
 
 
   
36,218
     
38,527
     
28,510
     
13,581
     
14,731
 
Noninterest expense:
                                       
  Salaries and employee benefits
   
60,215
     
60,034
     
60,377
     
58,682
     
56,032
 
  Net occupancy expense
   
25,628
     
24,613
     
26,077
     
25,985
     
23,541
 
  Postage
   
3,348
     
3,461
     
3,791
     
3,787
     
3,578
 
  Insurance
   
2,674
     
2,959
     
3,482
     
3,566
     
3,837
 
  Advertising
   
2,460
     
2,311
     
2,228
     
2,317
     
2,404
 
  Office supplies and printing
   
1,047
     
1,446
     
1,708
     
1,333
     
1,464
 
  Telephone
   
3,272
     
3,188
     
3,483
     
3,235
     
2,866
 
  Legal, audit and other professional fees
   
3,423
     
2,862
     
3,191
     
2,713
     
3,957
 
  Expense on other real estate and repossessions
   
4,919
     
3,929
     
4,111
     
2,526
     
5,636
 
  Partnership tax credit investment amortization
   
575
     
930
     
1,681
     
1,680
     
1,720
 
  Acquired deposit intangible asset amortization
   
1,562
     
1,650
     
1,910
     
1,750
     
1,519
 
  Other operating expenses
   
6,187
     
6,878
     
8,388
     
6,776
     
14,305
 
 
   
115,310
     
114,261
     
120,427
     
114,350
     
120,859
 
                                         
Income before income taxes
   
81,950
     
70,322
     
61,858
     
62,066
     
57,282
 
Provision for income taxes
   
14,841
     
18,758
     
16,516
     
15,564
     
13,753
 
Net income
   
67,109
     
51,564
     
45,342
     
46,502
     
43,529
 
Preferred stock dividends and discount accretion
   
     
     
     
554
     
579
 
Net income available to common shareholders
 
$
67,109
   
$
51,564
   
$
45,342
   
$
45,948
   
$
42,950
 


60





 
 
At or For the Year Ended December 31,
 
 
 
2018
   
2017
   
2016
   
2015
   
2014
 
 
 
(Number of shares in thousands)
 
Per Common Share Data:
                             
  Basic earnings per common share
 
$
4.75
   
$
3.67
   
$
3.26
   
$
3.33
   
$
3.14
 
  Diluted earnings per common share
   
4.71
     
3.64
     
3.21
     
3.28
     
3.10
 
  Cash dividends declared
   
1.20
     
0.94
     
0.88
     
0.86
     
0.80
 
  Book value per common share
   
37.59
     
33.48
     
30.77
     
28.67
     
26.30
 
                                         
  Average shares outstanding
   
14,132
     
14,032
     
13,912
     
13,818
     
13,700
 
  Year-end actual shares outstanding
   
14,151
     
14,088
     
13,968
     
13,888
     
13,755
 
  Average fully diluted shares outstanding
   
14,260
     
14,180
     
14,141
     
14,000
     
13,876
 
 
     
Earnings Performance Ratios:
     
  Return on average assets(1)
   
1.49
%
   
1.16
%
   
1.04
%
   
1.14
%
   
1.14
%
  Return on average stockholders' equity(2)
   
13.46
     
11.32
     
10.93
     
12.13
     
12.63
 
  Non-interest income to average total assets
   
0.80
     
0.86
     
0.65
     
0.33
     
0.39
 
  Non-interest expense to average total assets
   
2.56
     
2.56
     
2.76
     
2.81
     
3.16
 
  Average interest rate spread(3)
   
3.75
     
3.59
     
3.93
     
4.44
     
4.74
 
  Year-end interest rate spread
   
3.60
     
3.67
     
3.60
     
3.80
     
3.86
 
  Net interest margin(4)
   
3.99
     
3.74
     
4.05
     
4.53
     
4.84
 
  Efficiency ratio(5)
   
56.41
     
58.99
     
62.86
     
62.85
     
66.30
 
  Net overhead ratio(6)
   
1.76
     
1.70
     
2.10
     
2.48
     
2.77
 
  Common dividend pay-out ratio(7)
   
25.48
     
25.82
     
27.41
     
26.22
     
25.81
 
 
                                       
Asset Quality Ratios (8):
                                       
  Allowance for loan losses/year-end loans
   
0.98
%
   
1.01
%
   
1.04
%
   
1.20
%
   
1.34
%
  Non-performing assets/year-end loans and foreclosed assets
   
0.29
     
0.73
     
1.02
     
1.28
     
1.39
 
  Allowance for loan losses/non-performing loans
   
609.67
     
324.23
     
265.60
     
230.24
     
471.77
 
  Net charge-offs/average loans
   
0.13
     
0.26
     
0.29
     
0.20
     
0.24
 
  Gross non-performing assets/year end assets
   
0.25
     
0.63
     
0.86
     
1.07
     
1.11
 
  Non-performing loans/year-end loans
   
0.16
     
0.30
     
0.37
     
0.49
     
0.26
 
 
                                       
Balance Sheet Ratios:
                                       
  Loans to deposits
   
106.76
%
   
103.82
%
   
102.70
%
   
102.58
%
   
102.09
%
  Average interest-earning assets as a percentage
     of average interest-bearing liabilities
   
126.47
     
123.74
     
121.33
     
121.60
     
120.95
 
 
                                       
Capital Ratios:
                                       
  Average common stockholders' equity to average assets
   
11.1
%
   
10.2
%
   
9.5
%
   
9.4
%
   
9.0
%
  Year-end tangible common stockholders' equity to tangible assets(9)
   
11.2
     
10.5
     
9.2
     
9.6
     
9.0
 
  Great Southern Bancorp, Inc.:
                                       
     Tier 1 capital ratio
   
11.9
     
11.4
     
10.8
     
11.5
     
13.3
 
     Total capital ratio
   
14.4
     
14.1
     
13.6
     
12.6
     
14.5
 
     Tier 1 leverage ratio
   
11.7
     
10.9
     
9.9
     
10.2
     
11.1
 
     Common equity Tier 1 ratio
   
11.4
     
10.9
     
10.2
     
10.8
     
 
  Great Southern Bank:
                                       
     Tier 1 capital ratio
   
12.4
     
12.3
     
11.8
     
11.0
     
11.4
 
     Total capital ratio
   
13.3
     
13.2
     
12.7
     
12.1
     
12.6
 
     Tier 1 leverage ratio
   
12.2
     
11.7
     
10.8
     
9.8
     
9.5
 
     Common equity Tier 1 ratio
   
12.4
     
12.3
     
11.8
     
11.0
     
 


61




____________________
 
(1)
Net income divided by average total assets.
 
(2)
Net income divided by average stockholders' equity.
 
(3)
Yield on average interest-earning assets less rate on average interest-bearing liabilities.
 
(4)
Net interest income divided by average interest-earning assets.
 
(5)
Non-interest expense divided by the sum of net interest income plus non-interest income.
 
(6)
Non-interest expense less non-interest income divided by average total assets.
 
(7)
Cash dividends per common share divided by earnings per common share.
 
(8)
Excludes FDIC-acquired assets.
 
(9)
Non-GAAP Financial Measure.  For additional information, including a reconciliation to GAAP, see “Item 7. Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations – Non-GAAP Financial Measures.”
 
 
 
ITEM 7.  MANAGEMENT'S DISCUSSION AND ANALYSIS OF FINANCIAL CONDITION AND RESULTS OF OPERATIONS

Forward-looking Statements

When used in this Annual Report and in other documents filed or furnished by Great Southern Bancorp, Inc. (the “Company”) with the Securities and Exchange Commission (the "SEC"), in the Company's press releases or other public or stockholder communications, and in oral statements made with the approval of an authorized executive officer, the words or phrases "will likely result," "are expected to," "will continue," "is anticipated," "estimate," "project," "intends" or similar expressions are intended to identify "forward-looking statements" within the meaning of the Private Securities Litigation Reform Act of 1995. Such statements are subject to certain risks and uncertainties, including, among other things, (i) the possibility that the changes in non-interest income, non-interest expense and interest expense actually resulting from Great Southern Bank's recently completed transaction with West Gate Bank might be materially different from estimated amounts; (ii) the possibility that the actual reduction in the Company’s effective tax rate expected to result from H. R. 1, formerly known as the “Tax Cuts and Jobs Act” (the “Tax Reform Legislation”) might be different from the reduction estimated by the Company; (iii) expected revenues, cost savings, earnings accretion, synergies and other benefits from the Company's  merger and acquisition activities might not be realized within the anticipated time frames or at all, and costs or difficulties relating to integration matters, including but not limited to customer and employee retention, might be greater than expected; (iv) changes in economic conditions, either nationally or in the Company's market areas; (v) fluctuations in interest rates; (vi) the risks of lending and investing activities, including changes in the level and direction of loan delinquencies and write-offs and changes in estimates of the adequacy of the allowance for loan losses; (vii) the possibility of other-than-temporary impairments of securities held in the Company's securities portfolio; (viii) the Company's ability to access cost-effective funding; (ix) fluctuations in real estate values and both residential and commercial real estate market conditions; (x) demand for loans and deposits in the Company's market areas; (xi) the ability to adapt successfully to technological changes to meet customers' needs and developments in the marketplace; (xii) the possibility that security measures implemented might not be sufficient to mitigate the risk of a cyber attack or cyber theft, and that such security measures might not protect against systems failures or interruptions; (xiii) legislative or regulatory changes that adversely affect the Company's business, including, without limitation, the Dodd-Frank Wall Street Reform and Consumer Protection Act of 2010 and its implementing regulations, the overdraft protection regulations and customers' responses thereto and the Tax Reform Legislation; (xiv) changes in accounting principles, policies or guidelines; (xv) monetary and fiscal policies of the Federal Reserve Board and the U.S. Government and other governmental initiatives affecting the financial services industry; (xvi) results of examinations of the Company and Great Southern Bank by their regulators, including the possibility that the regulators may, among other things, require the Company to limit its business activities, changes its business mix, increase its allowance for loan losses, write-down assets or increase its capital levels, or affect its ability to borrow funds or maintain or increase deposits, which could adversely affect its liquidity and earnings; (xvii) costs and effects of litigation, including settlements and judgments; and (xviii) competition. The Company wishes to advise readers that the factors listed above and other risks described from time to time in documents filed or furnished by the Company with the SEC could affect the Company's financial performance and could cause the Company's actual results for future periods to differ materially from any opinions or statements expressed with respect to future periods in any current statements.

The Company does not undertake -and specifically declines any obligation- to publicly release the result of any revisions which may be made to any forward-looking statements to reflect events or circumstances after the date of such statements or to reflect the occurrence of anticipated or unanticipated events.


62




Critical Accounting Policies, Judgments and Estimates

The accounting and reporting policies of the Company conform with accounting principles generally accepted in the United States and general practices within the financial services industry. The preparation of financial statements in conformity with accounting principles generally accepted in the United States of America requires management to make estimates and assumptions that affect the amounts reported in the financial statements and the accompanying notes. Actual results could differ from those estimates.

Allowance for Loan Losses and Valuation of Foreclosed Assets

The Company believes that the determination of the allowance for loan losses involves a higher degree of judgment and complexity than its other significant accounting policies. The allowance for loan losses is calculated with the objective of maintaining an allowance level believed by management to be sufficient to absorb estimated loan losses. Management's determination of the adequacy of the allowance is based on periodic evaluations of the loan portfolio and other relevant factors. However, this evaluation is inherently subjective as it requires material estimates of, among other things, expected default probabilities, loss once loans default, expected commitment usage, the amounts and timing of expected future cash flows on impaired loans, value of collateral, estimated losses, and general amounts for historical loss experience.

The process also considers economic conditions, uncertainties in estimating losses and inherent risks in the loan portfolio. All of these factors may be susceptible to significant change. To the extent actual outcomes differ from management estimates, additional provisions for loan losses may be required which would adversely impact earnings in future periods. In addition, the Bank’s regulators could require additional provisions for loan losses as part of their examination process.

Additional discussion of the allowance for loan losses is included in "Item 1. Business - Allowances for Losses on Loans and Foreclosed Assets." Inherent in this process is the evaluation of individual significant credit relationships. From time to time certain credit relationships may deteriorate due to payment performance, cash flow of the borrower, value of collateral, or other factors. In these instances, management may revise its loss estimates and assumptions for these specific credits due to changing circumstances. In some cases, additional losses may be realized; in other instances, the factors that led to the deterioration may improve or the credit may be refinanced elsewhere and allocated allowances may be released from the particular credit.  In the fourth quarter of 2014, the Company began using a three-year average of historical losses for the general component of the allowance for loan loss calculation.  The Company had previously used a five-year average.  The Company believes that the three-year average provides a better representation of the current risks in the loan portfolio.  This change was made after consultation with our regulators and third-party consultants, as well as a review of the practices used by the Company’s peers.  No significant changes were made to management's overall methodology for evaluating the allowance for loan losses during the periods presented in the financial statements of this report.

In addition, the Company considers that the determination of the valuations of foreclosed assets held for sale involves a high degree of judgment and complexity. The carrying value of foreclosed assets reflects management’s best estimate of the amount to be realized from the sales of the assets.  While the estimate is generally based on a valuation by an independent appraiser or recent sales of similar properties, the amount that the Company realizes from the sales of the assets could differ materially from the carrying value reflected in the financial statements, resulting in losses that could adversely impact earnings in future periods.

Carrying Value of Loans Acquired in FDIC-assisted Transactions and Indemnification Asset

The Company considers that the determination of the carrying value of loans acquired in the FDIC-assisted transactions and the carrying value of the related FDIC indemnification asset involves a high degree of judgment and complexity. The carrying value of the acquired loans and, prior to June 30, 2017, the FDIC indemnification asset reflect management’s best ongoing estimates of the amounts to be realized on each of these assets. The Company has now terminated all loss sharing agreements with the FDIC and, accordingly, no longer has an indemnification asset.  The Company determined initial fair value accounting estimates of the acquired assets and assumed liabilities in accordance with FASB ASC 805, Business Combinations. However, the amount that the Company realizes on its acquired loan assets could differ materially from the carrying value reflected in its financial statements, based upon the timing of collections on the acquired loans in future periods. Because of the loss sharing agreements with the FDIC on certain of these assets, the Company did not expect to incur any significant losses related to these assets. To the extent the actual values realized for the acquired loans are different from the estimates, the indemnification asset was generally impacted in an offsetting manner due to the loss sharing support from the FDIC.  Subsequent to the initial valuation, the Company continues to monitor identified loan pools for changes in estimated cash flows projected for the loan pools, anticipated credit losses and changes in the accretable yield.  Analysis of these variables requires significant estimates and a high degree of judgment.  See Note 4 of the accompanying audited financial statements for additional information regarding the TeamBank, Vantus Bank, Sun Security Bank, InterBank and Valley Bank FDIC-assisted transactions.

63





Goodwill and Intangible Assets

Goodwill and intangible assets that have indefinite useful lives are subject to an impairment test at least annually and more frequently if circumstances indicate their value may not be recoverable. Goodwill is tested for impairment using a process that estimates the fair value of each of the Company’s reporting units compared with its carrying value. The Company defines reporting units as a level below each of its operating segments for which there is discrete financial information that is regularly reviewed. As of December 31, 2018, the Company has one reporting unit to which goodwill has been allocated – the Bank. If the fair value of a reporting unit exceeds its carrying value, then no impairment is recorded. If the carrying value amount exceeds the fair value of a reporting unit, further testing is completed comparing the implied fair value of the reporting unit’s goodwill to its carrying value to measure the amount of impairment. Intangible assets that are not amortized will be tested for impairment at least annually by comparing the fair values of those assets to their carrying values. At December 31, 2018, goodwill consisted of $5.4 million at the Bank reporting unit, which included goodwill of $4.2 million that was recorded during 2016 related to the acquisition of 12 branches from Fifth Third Bank.  Other identifiable intangible assets that are subject to amortization are amortized on a straight-line basis over a period of seven years. At December 31, 2018, the amortizable intangible assets consisted of core deposit intangibles of $3.9 million, including $2.6 million related to the Fifth Third Bank transaction in January 2016, $1.0 million related to the Valley Bank transaction in June 2014 and $275,000 related to the Boulevard Bank transaction in March 2014.  These amortizable intangible assets are reviewed for impairment if circumstances indicate their value may not be recoverable based on a comparison of fair value. See Note 1 of the accompanying audited financial statements for additional information.

For purposes of testing goodwill for impairment, the Company used a market approach to value its reporting unit. The market approach applies a market multiple, based on observed purchase transactions for each reporting unit, to the metrics appropriate for the valuation of the operating unit. Significant judgment is applied when goodwill is assessed for impairment. This judgment may include developing cash flow projections, selecting appropriate discount rates, identifying relevant market comparables and incorporating general economic and market conditions.

Based on the Company’s goodwill impairment testing, management does not believe any of its goodwill or other intangible assets are impaired as of December 31, 2018. While the Company believes no impairment existed at December 31, 2018, different conditions or assumptions used to measure fair value of the reporting unit, or changes in cash flows or profitability, if significantly negative or unfavorable, could have a material adverse effect on the outcome of the Company’s impairment evaluation in the future.

Current Economic Conditions

Changes in economic conditions could cause the values of assets and liabilities recorded in the financial statements to change rapidly, resulting in material future adjustments in asset values, the allowance for loan losses, or capital that could negatively impact the Company’s ability to meet regulatory capital requirements and maintain sufficient liquidity.

Following the housing and mortgage crisis and correction beginning in mid-2007, the United States entered a prolonged economic downturn.  Unemployment rose from 4.7% in November 2007 to peak at 10.0% in October 2009.  The elevated unemployment levels negatively impacted consumer confidence, which had a detrimental impact on industry-wide performance nationally as well as in the Company's Midwest market area.  Economic conditions have significantly improved since then, as indicated by consumer confidence levels, increased economic activity and low unemployment levels.

The national unemployment rate rose to 3.9% in December 2018 from a 49-year low of 3.7% the previous month.  The rate compares to an employment rate of 4.1% at December 2017. Total nonfarm payroll employment increased by 312,000 in December 2018 with employment increases in health care, food services and drinking places, construction, manufacturing and retail trade.  In December 2018, the U.S. labor force participation rate (the share of working-age Americans who are either employed or are actively looking for a job) was 63.1% and the employment population ratio was 60.6%, with both ratios changing little since November 2018.  The unemployment rate for the Midwest, where most of the Company’s business is conducted, was at 3.7% in December 2018, which is slightly better than the national unemployment rate of 3.9%.  Unemployment rates for December 2018 were:  Missouri at 3.1%, Arkansas at 3.6%, Kansas at 3.3%, Iowa at 2.4%, Minnesota at 2.8%, Illinois at 4.3%, Oklahoma at 3.2%, Texas at 3.7%, Georgia at 3.6% and Colorado at 3.5%.  Of the metropolitan areas in which the Company does business, the Chicago area had the highest unemployment level at 4.0% as of December 2018.  This rate had improved significantly since the 4.7% rate reported as of December 2017.  The unemployment rates for the Springfield and St. Louis market areas at 2.6% and 3.4%, respectively, were well below the national average.  Metropolitan areas in Iowa, Missouri, Arkansas and Minnesota continued to boast unemployment levels amongst the lowest in the nation.

Sales of newly built single-family homes for November 2018 were at a seasonally adjusted annual rate of 657,000 according to U.S. Census Bureau and the Department of Housing and Urban Development estimates.  This is 16.9% above the revised October 2018 seasonally adjusted annual rate of 562,000, but is 7.7% below the November 2017 seasonally adjusted annual rate of 712,000.  The median sales price of new houses sold in November 2018 was $302,400, down from $343,300 a year earlier.  The average sales price


64




was $362,400, down from $402,900 as of December 2017.  The inventory of new homes for sale at the end of November would support 6 months’ supply at the current sales pace, down from 7.1 months in September, and similar to 5.7 months a year ago.

After two consecutive months of increases, existing home sales declined in the month of December, according to the National Association of Realtors (NAR). Total existing home sales decreased 6.4% from November 2018 to a seasonally adjusted rate of 4.99 million in December 2018. Sales are now down 10.3% from a year ago.  Total housing inventory at the end of December decreased to 1.55 million, down from 1.74 million existing homes available for sale in November.  Unsold inventory is at a 3.7 month supply at the current sales pace, up from 3.2 months a year ago.

The national median existing home price for all housing types in December was $253,600, up 2.9% from December 2017. December’s price increase marks the 82nd straight month of year-over-year gains.  The Midwest region existing home median sale price, after some fluctuations, landed at $191,300 for December 2018, the same as a year ago. First-time buyers accounted for 32% of sales in December, down slightly from 33% last month but the same as a year ago.

The multi-family sector rebounded in 2017 and 2018, with demand approaching the highest level on record. National vacancy rates were 6% at the end of December 2018 while our market areas reflected the following vacancy levels: Springfield, Mo. at 5.4%, St. Louis at 9.0%, Kansas City at 7.1%, Minneapolis at 4.7%, Tulsa, Okla. at 9.5%, Dallas-Fort Worth at 8.1% and Chicago at 6.4%. Rent growth picked up in recent months and demand has increased at a steady rate supported by the strong economy.  Vacancy rates have increased in Tulsa, St. Louis and Dallas due to an increased number of units coming on-line. Developers continue to favor more-expensive submarkets.  Transaction volume has slowed, but pricing has remained on an upward trajectory.  Cap rates are still at very low levels. Continued increase in the homeownership rate is the single largest risk to the apartment sector.  Despite the decline in affordability and rigid mortgage origination standards, about two-thirds of consumers still believe now is a good time to buy a home, according to a recent University of Michigan consumer survey. The homeownership rate has risen by more than a percentage point since 2016, to 64.4% in the third quarter of 2018. All of the Company’s market areas within the multi-family sector are in expansion phase with the exception of Denver and Atlanta which are both currently in a hyper-supply phase.

Nationally, approximately 45% of the suburban office markets are in an expansion market cycle -- characterized by decreasing vacancy rates, moderate/high new construction, high absorption, moderate/high employment growth and medium/high rental rate growth.  Signs of late-cycle conditions are spreading as we begin 2019. Both CBD and suburban markets are being categorized as either in recession or in hyper-supply by about one in 10 market respondents. So while most markets are in recovery or expansion, they tilt toward risk in the coming years. The Company’s larger market areas in the suburban office expansion market cycle include Minneapolis, Dallas-Ft. Worth, and St. Louis.  Tulsa, Okla. and Kansas City are currently in the recovery/expansion market cycle -- typified by decreasing vacancy rates, low new construction, moderate absorption, low/moderate employment growth and negative/low rental rate growth. Chicago is currently in a recession market cycle typified by increasing vacancies, low absorption and low new construction while Denver is in hyper-supply.

Approximately 70% of the retail sector is in the expansion phase of the market cycle, with another 20% in recovery mode and the remaining 10% in hyper-supply and recession.  The Company’s larger market areas included in the retail expansion market segment are Chicago, Denver, Minneapolis, Kansas City, Dallas-Ft. Worth, and St. Louis, with Chicago and Minneapolis nearing hyper-supply. The Atlanta and Tulsa markets are each in recovery phase.

The industrial segment, once concentrated in manufacturing, is now epitomized by a dense network of warehousing, distribution, logistics, and R&D/Flex properties which is the conduit of the current global e-commerce revolution.  All of the Company’s larger industrial market areas are categorized as being in the expansion cycle with prospects of continuing good economic growth.  Two market areas; Chicago and Kansas City are in the latter stages of the expansion cycle.

Occupancy, absorption and rental income levels of commercial real estate properties located throughout the Company’s market areas remain stable according to information provided by real estate services firm CoStar Group.  Moderate real estate sales and financing activity is continuing to support loan growth.

While current economic indicators show stability nationally in employment, housing starts and prices, commercial real estate occupancy, absorption and rental rates, our management will continue to closely monitor regional, national and global economic conditions, as these could significantly impact our market areas.

Loss Sharing Agreements

On April 26, 2016, Great Southern Bank executed an agreement with the FDIC to terminate the loss sharing agreements for Team Bank, Vantus Bank and Sun Security Bank, effective immediately.  The agreement required the FDIC to pay $4.4 million to settle all outstanding items related to the terminated loss sharing agreements.

65





On June 9, 2017, Great Southern Bank executed an agreement with the FDIC to terminate the loss sharing agreements for InterBank, effective immediately.  Pursuant to the termination agreement, the FDIC paid $15.0 million to the Bank to settle all outstanding items related to the terminated loss sharing agreements.  The Company recorded a pre-tax gain on the termination of $7.7 million.

The termination of the loss sharing agreements for the TeamBank, Vantus Bank, Sun Security Bank and InterBank transactions have no impact on the yields for the loans that were previously covered under these agreements, as the remaining accretable yield adjustments that affect interest income have not been changed and will continue to be recognized for all FDIC-assisted transactions in the same manner as they have been previously. All post-termination recoveries, gains, losses and expenses related to these previously covered assets are recognized entirely by Great Southern Bank since the FDIC no longer shares in such gains or losses. Accordingly, the Company’s earnings are positively impacted to the extent the Company recognizes gains on any sales or recoveries in excess of the carrying value of such assets. Similarly, the Company’s earnings are negatively impacted to the extent the Company recognizes expenses, losses or charge-offs related to such assets.  There will be no future effects on non-interest income (expense) related to adjustments or amortization of the indemnification assets for Team Bank, Vantus Bank, Sun Security Bank or InterBank.  All rights and obligations of the Bank and the FDIC under the terminated loss sharing agreements, including the settlement of all existing loss sharing and expense reimbursement claims, have been resolved and terminated.

General

The profitability of the Company and, more specifically, the profitability of its primary subsidiary, the Bank, depend primarily on its net interest income, as well as provisions for loan losses and the level of non-interest income and non-interest expense. Net interest income is the difference between the interest income the Bank earns on its loans and investment portfolios, and the interest it pays on interest-bearing liabilities, which consists mainly of interest paid on deposits and borrowings. Net interest income is affected by the relative amounts of interest-earning assets and interest-bearing liabilities and the interest rates earned or paid on these balances. When interest-earning assets approximate or exceed interest-bearing liabilities, any positive interest rate spread will generate net interest income.

In the year ended December 31, 2018, Great Southern's total assets increased $261.7 million, or 5.9%, from $4.41 billion at December 31, 2017, to $4.68 billion at December 31, 2018. Full details of the current year changes in total assets are provided in the “Comparison of Financial Condition at December 31, 2018 and December 31, 2017” section.

Loans.  In the year ended December 31, 2018, Great Southern's net loans increased $262.7 million, or 7.0%, from $3.73 billion at December 31, 2017, to $3.99 billion at December 31, 2018.  Excluding FDIC-assisted acquired loans and mortgage loans held for sale, total gross loans increased $472.3 million, or 10.8%, from December 31, 2017 to December 31, 2018.  This increase was primarily in construction loans, commercial real estate loans, one- to four-family residential mortgage loans and other residential (multi-family) real estate loans.  These increases were offset by a decrease in consumer auto loans of $103.6 million and decrease in the FDIC-acquired loan portfolios of $42.0 million.  In addition, there were higher than usual unscheduled significant paydowns on loans during 2018 due to borrowers selling projects or refinancing debt.  Total loan paydowns in excess of $1.0 million exceeded $668 million during 2018.   As loan demand is affected by a variety of factors, including general economic conditions, and because of the competition we face and our focus on pricing discipline and credit quality, we cannot be assured that our loan growth will match or exceed the level of increases achieved in 2018 or prior years.  The Company's strategy continues to be focused on maintaining credit risk and interest rate risk at appropriate levels. 

Recent loan growth has occurred in several loan types, primarily construction loans, other residential (multi-family) real estate loans and commercial real estate loans and in most of Great Southern's primary lending locations, including Springfield, St. Louis, Kansas City, Des Moines and Minneapolis, as well as the loan production offices in Chicago, Dallas, Omaha and Tulsa.  Certain minimum underwriting standards and monitoring help assure the Company's portfolio quality. Great Southern's loan committee reviews and approves all new loan originations in excess of lender approval authorities.  Generally, the Company considers commercial construction, consumer, and commercial real estate loans to involve a higher degree of risk compared to some other types of loans, such as first mortgage loans on one- to four-family, owner-occupied residential properties.  For commercial real estate, commercial business and construction loans, the credits are subject to an analysis of the borrower's and guarantor's financial condition, credit history, verification of liquid assets, collateral, market analysis and repayment ability.  It has been, and continues to be, Great Southern's practice to verify information from potential borrowers regarding assets, income or payment ability and credit ratings as applicable and as required by the authority approving the loan.  To minimize construction risk, projects are monitored as construction draws are requested by comparison to budget and with progress verified through property inspections.  The geographic and product diversity of collateral, equity requirements and limitations on speculative construction projects help to mitigate overall risk in these loans. Underwriting standards for all loans also include loan-to-value ratio limitations which vary depending on collateral type, debt service coverage ratios or debt payment to income ratio guidelines, where applicable, credit histories, use of guaranties and other recommended terms relating to equity requirements, amortization, and maturity.  Consumer loans are primarily secured by new and used motor vehicles and these loans are also subject to certain minimum underwriting standards to assure portfolio quality.  Great Southern's consumer underwriting and pricing standards were fairly consistent over the past several years through the first half of 2016.  In response to a more challenging consumer credit environment, the Company tightened its underwriting guidelines on

66




automobile lending in the latter part of 2016.  Management took this step in an effort to improve credit quality in the portfolio and lower delinquencies and charge-offs.  The underwriting standards employed by Great Southern for consumer loans include a determination of the applicant's payment history on other debts, credit scores, employment history and an assessment of ability to meet existing obligations and payments on the proposed loan.  In 2019, the Company made the decision to discontinue indirect auto loan originations. 
 
Of the total loan portfolio at December 31, 2018 and 2017, 84.4% and 79.9%, respectively, was secured by real estate, as this is the Bank’s primary focus in its lending efforts.  At December 31, 2018 and 2017, commercial real estate and commercial construction loans were 49.7% and 48.0% of the Bank’s total loan portfolio (excluding loans acquired through FDIC-assisted transactions), respectively.  Commercial real estate and commercial construction loans generally afford the Bank an opportunity to increase the yield on, and the proportion of interest rate sensitive loans in, its portfolio.  They do, however, present somewhat greater risk to the Bank because they may be more adversely affected by conditions in the real estate markets or in the economy generally.  At December 31, 2018 and 2017, loans made in the Springfield, Mo. metropolitan statistical area (Springfield MSA) were 9% and 11% of the Bank’s total loan portfolio (excluding loans acquired through FDIC-assisted transactions), respectively.  The Company’s headquarters are located in Springfield and we have operated in this market since 1923.  Because of our large presence and experience in the Springfield MSA, many lending opportunities exist.  However, if the economic conditions of the Springfield MSA were worse than those of other market areas in which we operate or the national economy overall, the performance of these loans could decline comparatively.  At December 31, 2018 and 2017, loans made in the St. Louis, Mo. metropolitan statistical area (St. Louis MSA) were 19% and 19% of the Bank’s total loan portfolio (excluding loans acquired through FDIC-assisted transactions), respectively.  The Company’s expansion into the St. Louis MSA beginning in May 2009 has provided an opportunity to not only expand its markets and provide diversification from the Springfield MSA, but also has provided access to a larger economy with increased lending opportunities despite higher levels of competition.  Loans made in the St. Louis MSA are primarily commercial real estate, commercial business and multi-family residential loans which are less likely to be impacted by the higher levels of unemployment rates, as mentioned above under “Current Economic Conditions,” than if the focus were on one- to four-family residential and consumer loans.  For further discussions of the Bank’s loan portfolio, and specifically, commercial real estate and commercial construction loans, see “Item 1. Business – Lending Activities.”

The percentage of fixed-rate loans in our loan portfolio has increased from 46% as of December 31, 2010 to 55% as of December 31, 2018 due to customer preference for fixed rate loans during this period of low and, more recently, increasing interest rates.  The majority of the increase in fixed rate loans was in commercial construction and commercial real estate, both of which typically have short durations within our portfolio.  Of the total amount of fixed rate loans in our portfolio as of December 31, 2018, approximately 81% mature within one to five years and therefore are not considered to create significant long-term interest rate risk for the Company.  Fixed rate loans make up only a portion of our balance sheet and our overall interest rate risk strategy.  As of December 31, 2018, our interest rate risk models indicated a one-year interest rate earnings sensitivity position that is modestly positive in an increasing rate environment.  For further discussion of our interest rate sensitivity gap and the processes used to manage our exposure to interest rate risk, see “Quantitative and Qualitative Disclosures About Market Risk – How We Measure the Risks to Us Associated with Interest Rate Changes.” For discussion of the risk factors associated with interest rate changes, see “Risk Factors – We may be adversely affected by interest rate changes.”

While our policy allows us to lend up to 95% of the appraised value on one-to four-family residential properties, originations of loans with loan-to-value ratios at that level are minimal.  Private mortgage insurance is typically required for loan amounts above the 80% level.  Few exceptions occur and would be based on analyses which determined minimal transactional risk to be involved.  We consider these lending practices to be consistent with or more conservative than what we believe to be the norm for banks our size.  At December 31, 2018 and 2017, an estimated 0.1% and 0.1%, respectively, of total owner occupied one- to four-family residential loans had loan-to-value ratios above 100% at origination.  At December 31, 2018 and 2017, an estimated 0.9% and 1.5%, respectively, of total non-owner occupied one- to four-family residential loans had loan-to-value ratios above 100% at origination.

At December 31, 2018, troubled debt restructurings totaled $6.9 million, or 0.2% of total loans, down $8.1 million from $15.0 million, or 0.4% of total loans, at December 31, 2017.  Concessions granted to borrowers experiencing financial difficulties may include a reduction in the interest rate on the loan, payment extensions, forgiveness of principal, forbearance or other actions intended to maximize collection.  For troubled debt restructurings occurring during the year ended December 31, 2018, five loans totaling $31,000 were restructured into multiple new loans.  For troubled debt restructurings occurring during the year ended December 31, 2017, no loans were restructured into multiple new loans.  For further information on troubled debt restructurings, see Note 3 of the accompanying audited financial statements, which are included in Item 8 of this report.

Loans that were acquired through FDIC-assisted transactions, which are accounted for in pools, are currently included in the analysis and estimation of the allowance for loan losses.  If expected cash flows to be received on any given pool of loans decreases from previous estimates, then a determination is made as to whether the loan pool should be charged down or the allowance for loan losses should be increased (through a provision for loan losses).  As noted above, the loss sharing agreements for Team Bank, Vantus Bank and Sun Security Bank were terminated on April 26, 2016 and the loss sharing agreements for InterBank were terminated on June 9, 2017.  Acquired loans are described in detail in Note 4 of the accompanying audited financial statements, included in Item 8 of this

67




Report.  For acquired loan pools, the Company may allocate, and at December 31, 2018, has allocated, a portion of its allowance for loan losses related to these loan pools in a manner similar to how it allocates its allowance for loan losses to those loans which are collectively evaluated for impairment.

The level of non-performing loans and foreclosed assets affects our net interest income and net income. We generally do not accrue interest income on these loans and do not recognize interest income until the loans are repaid or interest payments have been made for a period of time sufficient to provide evidence of performance on the loans.  Generally, the higher the level of non-performing assets, the greater the negative impact on interest income and net income.  

Available-for-sale Securities.  In the year ended December 31, 2018, available-for-sale securities increased $64.8 million, or 36.2%, from $179.2 million at December 31, 2017, to $244.0 million at December 31, 2018.  The increase was primarily due to the purchase of FNMA and GNMA fixed-rate multi-family mortgage-backed securities, partially offset by calls of municipal securities and normal monthly payments received related to the portfolio of mortgage-backed securities.

Deposits.  The Company attracts deposit accounts through its retail branch network, correspondent banking and corporate services areas, and brokered deposits. The Company then utilizes these deposit funds, along with FHLBank advances and other borrowings, to meet loan demand or otherwise fund its activities. In the year ended December 31, 2018, total deposit balances increased $127.9 million, or 3.6%.  Transaction account balances decreased $93.7 million and retail certificates of deposit increased $120.1 million compared to December 31, 2017.  A large portion of the decrease in transaction accounts was due to the sale of the Company’s branches and deposits in Omaha, Neb. during 2018, which resulted in a decrease in transaction account balances of $39.7 million and a decrease in retail certificates of deposit of $16.1 million.  Excluding the Omaha branch deposits sold, transaction account balances decreased $54.0 million to $2.13 billion at December 31, 2018, while retail certificates of deposit increased $136.2 million compared to December 31, 2017, to $1.26 billion at December 31, 2018.  The decreases in transaction accounts were primarily a result of decreases in money market deposit accounts, with a smaller portion of the decreases coming from NOW account deposit accounts.  Retail certificates of deposit increased due to an increase of approximately $56 million in retail certificates generated through our banking centers and an increase of approximately $70 million in certificates of deposit opened through the Company’s internet deposit acquisition channels during 2018.  Some of these deposits were generated as a result of our rates intentionally being in the top tier compared to our competitors in the internet channels during the last few months of 2018.  Brokered deposits, including CDARS program purchased funds, were $326.9 million at December 31, 2018, an increase of $101.4 million from $225.5 million at December 31, 2017.

Our deposit balances may fluctuate depending on customer preferences and our relative need for funding.  We do not consider our retail certificates of deposit to be guaranteed long-term funding because customers can withdraw their funds at any time with minimal interest penalty.  When loan demand trends upward, we can increase rates paid on deposits to increase deposit balances and utilize brokered deposits to provide additional funding.  The level of competition for deposits in our markets is high. It is our goal to gain deposit market share, particularly checking accounts, in our branch footprint.  To accomplish this goal, increasing rates to attract deposits may be necessary, which could negatively impact the Company’s net interest margin.

Our ability to fund growth in future periods may also depend on our ability to continue to access brokered deposits and FHLBank advances. In times when our loan demand has outpaced our generation of new deposits, we have utilized brokered deposits and FHLBank advances to fund these loans. These funding sources have been attractive to us because we can create either fixed or variable rate funding, as desired, which more closely matches the interest rate nature of much of our loan portfolio. It also gives us greater flexibility in increasing or decreasing the duration of our funding.  While we do not currently anticipate that our ability to access these sources will be reduced or eliminated in future periods, if this should happen, the limitation on our ability to fund additional loans could have a material adverse effect on our business, financial condition and results of operations.

Federal Home Loan Bank Advances and Short Term Borrowings.  The Company’s Federal Home Loan Bank advances totaled $-0- at December 31, 2018, compared to $127.5 million at December 31, 2017.  The balance of $127.5 million at December 31, 2017, consisted of short-term advances.  At December 31, 2018, there were no borrowings from the FHLBank, other than overnight advances, which are included in the short term borrowings category.

Short term borrowings and other interest-bearing liabilities increased $176.1 million from $16.6 million at December 31, 2017 to $192.7 million at December 31, 2018.  The short term borrowings included overnight FHLBank borrowings of $178.0 million at December 31, 2018 and $15.0 million at December 31, 2017. The Company utilizes both overnight borrowings and short-term FHLBank advances depending on relative interest rates.

Net Interest Income and Interest Rate Risk Management.  Our net interest income may be affected positively or negatively by changes in market interest rates. A large portion of our loan portfolio is tied to one-month LIBOR, three-month LIBOR or the "prime rate" and adjusts immediately or shortly after the index rate adjusts (subject to the effect of contractual interest rate floors on some of

68





the loans, which are discussed below).  We monitor our sensitivity to interest rate changes on an ongoing basis (see "Quantitative and Qualitative Disclosures About Market Risk").  In addition, our net interest income may be impacted by changes in the cash flows expected to be received from acquired loan pools.  As described in Note 4 of the accompanying audited financial statements,  included in Item 8 of this report, the Company’s evaluation of cash flows expected to be received from acquired loan pools is on-going and increases in cash flow expectations are recognized as increases in accretable yield through interest income.  Decreases in cash flow expectations are recognized as impairments through the allowance for loan losses.

The current level and shape of the interest rate yield curve poses challenges for interest rate risk management. Prior to its increase of 0.25% on December 16, 2015, the Federal Reserve Board had last changed interest rates on December 16, 2008. This was the first rate increase since June 29, 2006.  The FRB has now also implemented rate increases of 0.25% on eight different occasions beginning December 14, 2016, with the Federal Funds rate now at 2.50%.  Great Southern has a substantial portion of its loan portfolio ($1.46 billion at December 31, 2018) which is tied to the one-month or three-month LIBOR index and will be subject to adjust at least once within 90 days after December 31, 2018.  Of these loans, $1.34 billion as of December 31, 2018 had interest rate floors.  Great Southern also has a portfolio of loans ($257 million at December 31, 2018) which are tied to a "prime rate" of interest and will adjust immediately with changes to the "prime rate" of interest. But for the interest rate floors, a rate cut by the FRB generally would have an anticipated immediate negative impact on the Company's net interest income due to the large total balance of loans which generally adjust immediately as the Federal Funds rate adjusts. Loans at their floor rates are, however, subject to the risk that borrowers will seek to refinance elsewhere at the lower market rate.  Because the Federal Funds rate is still generally low, there may also be a negative impact on the Company's net interest income due to the Company's inability to significantly lower its funding costs in the current competitive rate environment, although interest rates on assets may decline further. Conversely, interest rate increases would normally result in increased interest rates on our LIBOR-based and prime-based loans. As of December 31, 2018, Great Southern's interest rate risk models indicate that, generally, rising interest rates are expected to have a positive impact on the Company's net interest income, while declining interest rates would have a negative impact on net interest income. We model various interest rate scenarios for rising and falling rates, including both parallel and non-parallel shifts in rates. The results of our modeling indicate that net interest income is not likely to be materially affected either positively or negatively in the first twelve months following a rate change, regardless of any changes in interest rates, because our portfolios are relatively well matched in a twelve-month horizon. The effects of interest rate changes, if any, are expected to be more impacting to net interest income in the 12 to 36 months following a rate change. For further discussion of the processes used to manage our exposure to interest rate risk, see “Quantitative and Qualitative Disclosures About Market Risk – How We Measure the Risks to Us Associated with Interest Rate Changes.”

Non-Interest Income and Operating Expenses.  The Company's profitability is also affected by the level of its non-interest income and operating expenses. Non-interest income consists primarily of service charges and ATM fees, late charges and prepayment fees on loans, gains on sales of loans and available-for-sale investments and other general operating income.  In 2016, increases in the cash flows expected to be collected from the FDIC-covered loan portfolios resulted in amortization (expense) recorded relating to reductions of expected reimbursements under the loss sharing agreements with the FDIC, which were recorded as indemnification assets.  This is no longer the case for the TeamBank, Vantus Bank and Sun Security Bank transactions, subsequent to April 26, 2016 (due to the termination of the related loss sharing agreements effective as of that date) and for the InterBank transaction subsequent to June 2017 (due to the termination of the related loss sharing agreements effective as of that date).  Therefore, no further amortization (expense) will be recorded relating to the reductions of expected reimbursements under the loss sharing agreements with the FDIC as all indemnification assets and other balances due to/from the FDIC have been settled.  The Company recorded a gain in non-interest income during 2017 related to the termination of the InterBank loss sharing agreements.  Non-interest income may also be affected by the Company's interest rate derivative activities, if the Company chooses to implement derivatives.

Operating expenses consist primarily of salaries and employee benefits, occupancy-related expenses, expenses related to foreclosed assets, postage, FDIC deposit insurance, advertising and public relations, telephone, professional fees, office expenses and other general operating expenses.  Details of the current period changes in non-interest income and non-interest expense are provided under “Results of Operations and Comparison for the Years Ended December 31, 2018 and 2017.”

Business Initiatives

The Company implemented several business and operational initiatives in 2018.

The Company continually evaluates the performance of its banking center network and other customer access channels.  As a result, several activities were initiated in 2018. In the second quarter of 2018, the Company consolidated operations of a banking center into a nearby office in Paola, Kan. The banking center, located at 1 S. Pearl Street, was closed and all accounts were automatically transferred to the banking center at 1515 Baptiste Drive, less than a mile away. A deposit-taking ATM and interactive teller machine remain available for customers at the S. Pearl Street building.

In the third quarter of 2018, the Company completed its sale of four banking centers in the Omaha, Neb., metropolitan market to a Nebraska-based bank. Pursuant to the purchase and assumption agreement, Great Southern sold branch deposits of approximately $56

69





million and sold substantially all branch-related real estate, fixed assets and ATMs. The Company recorded pre-tax income, net of expenses, of $7.25 million, or $0.39 (after tax) per diluted common share. A commercial loan production office is all that remains in the Omaha market.

In the fourth quarter of 2018, the Company announced that in April 2019 it expects to consolidate its Fayetteville, Ark., banking center into its Rogers, Ark., office, approximately 20 miles away. The Fayetteville office opened in 2014 and has not met performance expectations. After this consolidation, the Company will operate one Arkansas banking center, in Rogers.

The online account opening platform on the Company’s website was upgraded and available to customers in January 2019. The new platform provides a faster and more streamlined experience for opening deposit accounts. It is expected that online account opening will continue to increase in the future as customer preferences evolve. The Company’s online banking and bill payment platform is also being significantly upgraded and is expected to be ready for customers beginning in mid-2019.

Commercial loan production offices opened in Atlanta, Ga., and Denver, Colo. in the fourth quarter of 2018. Each office is managed by a local and highly-experienced commercial lender. The Company also operates commercial loan production offices in Chicago, Dallas, Omaha, Neb., and Tulsa, Okla.

In 2018, an experienced lender was hired to serve as Small Business Administration (SBA) Manager, a new role in the Company.  Based in the Dallas commercial loan production office, the Manager and his staff will exclusively focus on sourcing and servicing SBA 7a, SBA 504 and other commercial real estate loan opportunities throughout Great Southern’s market areas.

In February 2019, the Company determined that it would cease providing indirect lending services to automobile dealerships, effective March 31, 2019. Market and financial forces, including strong rate competition for well-qualified borrowers, have made indirect automobile lending less profitable over the long term. The Company will continue servicing indirect automobile loans made before March 31, 2019, until each loan agreement is satisfied.  Direct consumer lending through the Company’s banking center network is expected to continue as normal.

Effect of Federal Laws and Regulations

General. Federal legislation and regulation significantly affect the operations of the Company and the Bank, and have increased competition among commercial banks, savings institutions, mortgage banking enterprises and other financial institutions. In particular, the capital requirements and operations of regulated banking organizations such as the Company and the Bank have been and will be subject to changes in applicable statutes and regulations from time to time, which changes could, under certain circumstances, adversely affect the Company or the Bank.

Dodd-Frank Act. On July 21, 2010, sweeping financial regulatory reform legislation entitled the “Dodd-Frank Wall Street Reform and Consumer Protection Act” (the “Dodd-Frank Act”) was signed into law. The Dodd-Frank Act implements far-reaching changes across the financial regulatory landscape, including provisions that, among other things, centralize responsibility for consumer financial protection by creating a new agency, the Consumer Financial Protection Bureau, with broad rulemaking authority for a wide range of consumer protection laws that apply to all banks, require new capital rules (discussed below), change the assessment base for federal deposit insurance, repeal the federal prohibitions on the payment of interest on demand deposits, amend the account balance limit for federal deposit insurance protection, and increase the authority of the FRB to examine the Company and its non-bank subsidiaries.

Certain aspects of the Dodd-Frank Act remain subject to rulemaking and take effect over a number of years. Provisions in the legislation that affect deposit insurance assessments and payment of interest on demand deposits could increase the costs associated with deposits. Provisions in the legislation that require revisions to the capital requirements of the Company and the Bank could require the Company and the Bank to seek additional sources of capital in the future.

A provision of the Dodd-Frank Act, commonly referred to as the “Durbin Amendment,” directed the FRB to analyze the debit card payments system and fix the interchange rates based upon their estimate of actual costs. The FRB has established the interchange rate for all debit transactions for issuers with over $10 billion in assets at $0.21 per transaction. An additional five basis points of the transaction amount and an additional $0.01 may be collected by the issuer for fraud prevention and recovery, provided the issuer performs certain actions. The Bank is currently exempt from the rule on the basis of asset size.

Certain aspects of the Dodd-Frank Act have been affected by the recently EGRRCP Act, as defined and discussed below under “-EGRRCP Act.”

Capital Rules. The federal banking agencies have adopted regulatory capital rules that substantially amend the risk-based capital rules applicable to the Bank and the Company. The rules implement the “Basel III” regulatory capital reforms and changes required by the Dodd-Frank Act. “Basel III” refers to various documents released by the Basel Committee on Banking Supervision. For the Company

70





and the Bank, the general effective date of the new rules was January 1, 2015, and, for certain provisions, various phase-in periods and later effective dates apply. The chief features of the new rules are summarized below.

The rules refine the definitions of what constitutes regulatory capital and add a new regulatory capital element, common equity Tier 1 capital. The minimum capital ratios are (i) a common equity Tier 1 (“CET1”) risk-based capital ratio of 4.5%; (ii) a Tier 1 risk-based capital ratio of 6%; (iii) a total risk-based capital ratio of 8%; and (iv) a Tier 1 leverage ratio of 4%. In addition to the minimum capital ratios, the new rules include a capital conservation buffer, under which a banking organization must have CET1 more than 2.5% above each of its minimum risk-based capital ratios in order to avoid restrictions on paying dividends, repurchasing shares, and paying certain discretionary bonuses.  The capital conservation buffer requirement began phasing in on January 1, 2016 when a buffer greater than 0.625% of risk-weighted assets was required, which amount increased an equal amount each year until the buffer requirement of greater than 2.5% of risk-weighted assets became fully implemented on January 1, 2019.

Effective January 1, 2015, these rules also revised the prompt corrective action framework, which is designed to place restrictions on insured depository institutions if their capital levels show signs of weakness. Under the new prompt corrective action requirements, insured depository institutions are required to meet the following in order to qualify as “well capitalized:” (i) a common equity Tier 1 risk-based capital ratio of at least 6.5%, (ii) a Tier 1 risk-based capital ratio of at least 8%, (iii) a total risk-based capital ratio of at least 10% and (iv) a Tier 1 leverage ratio of 5%, and must not be subject to an order, agreement or directive mandating a specific capital level.

EGRRCP Act. In May 2018 the Economic Growth, Regulatory Relief and Consumer Protection Act (the “EGRRCCP Act”), was enacted to modify or remove certain financial reform rules and regulations, including some of those implemented under the Dodd-Frank Act. While the EGRRCP Act maintains most of the regulatory structure established by the Dodd-Frank Act, it amends certain aspects of the regulatory framework for depository institutions with assets of less than $10 billion and for banks with assets of more than $50 billion. Many of these changes could result in meaningful regulatory relief for community banks such as Great Southern.

The EGRRCP Act, among other matters, expands the definition of qualified mortgages that may be held by a financial institution and simplifies the regulatory capital rules for financial institutions and their holding companies with total consolidated assets of less than $10 billion by instructing the federal banking regulators to establish a single “Community Bank Leverage Ratio” of between 8 and 10 percent. Any qualifying depository institution or its holding company that exceeds the “community bank leverage ratio” will be considered to have met generally applicable leverage and risk-based regulatory capital requirements and any qualifying depository institution that exceeds the new ratio will be considered to be “well capitalized” under the prompt corrective action rules.  In addition, the EGRRCP Act includes regulatory relief for community banks regarding regulatory examination cycles, call reports, the Volcker Rule (proprietary trading prohibitions), mortgage disclosures and risk weights for certain high-risk commercial real estate loans.

It is difficult at this time to predict when or how any new standards under the EGRRCP Act will ultimately be applied to the Company and the Bank or what specific impact the EGRRCP Act and the yet-to-be-written implementing rules and regulations will have on community banks.

Recent Accounting Pronouncements

See Note 1 to the accompanying audited financial statements, which are included in Item 8 of this Report, for a description of recent accounting pronouncements including the respective dates of adoption and expected effects on the Company’s financial position and results of operations.

Comparison of Financial Condition at December 31, 2018 and December 31, 2017

During the year ended December 31, 2018, total assets increased by $261.7 million to $4.68 billion. The increase was primarily attributable to increases in loans receivable and available-for-sale investment securities, partially offset by decreases in cash and cash equivalents, other real estate owned and repossessions and current and deferred income taxes.

Cash and cash equivalents were $202.7 million at December 31, 2018, a decrease of $39.6 million, or 16.3%, from $242.3 million at December 31, 2017.  During 2018, cash and cash equivalents decreased primarily in order to fund the origination of loans and purchase of available for sale securities.  This decrease in cash and cash equivalents was partially offset by an increase in deposits.

The Company’s available for sale securities increased $64.8 million, or 36.2%, compared to December 31, 2017.  The increase was primarily due to the purchase of FNMA and GNMA fixed-rate multi-family mortgage-backed securities, partially offset by calls of municipal securities and normal monthly payments received related to the portfolio of mortgage-backed securities.  The available-for-sale securities portfolio was 5.2% and 4.1% of total assets at December 31, 2018 and 2017, respectively.


71





Net loans increased $262.7 million from December 31, 2017, to $3.99 billion at December 31, 2018.  Excluding FDIC-assisted acquired loans and mortgage loans held for sale, total gross loans (including the undisbursed portion of loans) increased $472.3 million, or 10.8%, from December 31, 2017 to December 31, 2018. Increases primarily occurred in commercial construction loans, commercial real estate loans, other residential (multi-family) loans and one- to four-family residential mortgage loans.  Outstanding and undisbursed balances of commercial construction loans increased $350.5 million, or 30.4%, commercial real estate loans increased $136.1 million, or 11.0%, one- to four-family residential loans increased $89.3 million, or 28.8%, and other residential (multi-family) loans increased $39.2 million, or 5.3%.  Partially offsetting the increases in these loans were reductions of $103.6 million, or 29.0%, in consumer auto loans and $42.0 million, or 20.0%, in the FDIC-acquired loan portfolios.

Other real estate owned and repossessions were $8.4 million at December 31, 2018, a decrease of $13.6 million, or 61.6%, from $22.0 million at December 31, 2017.  The decrease was primarily due to sales of other real estate properties during the period, and is discussed in more detail in the Non-performing Assets section below.

Total liabilities increased $201.4 million from $3.94 billion at December 31, 2017 to $4.14 billion at December 31, 2018. The increase was primarily attributable to an increase in deposits and short-term borrowings, partially offset by a decrease in FHLB advances.

Total deposits increased $127.9 million, or 3.6%, from $3.60 billion at December 31, 2017 to $3.73 billion at December 31, 2018Partially offsetting the increase in deposits was a decrease due to the sale of the Company’s branches and deposits in Omaha, Neb. during 2018, which resulted in a decrease in transaction account balances of $39.7 million and a decrease in retail certificates of deposit of $16.1 million.  Excluding the Omaha branch deposits sold, transaction account balances decreased $54.0 million to $2.13 billion at December 31, 2018, while retail certificates of deposit increased $136.2 million compared to December 31, 2017, to $1.26 billion at December 31, 2018.  Customer retail certificates increased by $72.3 million during the year ended December 31, 2018 and certificates of deposit opened through the Company's internet deposit acquisition channels increased by $70.5 million.  Brokered deposits, including CDARS program purchased funds, were $326.9 million at December 31, 2018, an increase of $101.4 million from $225.5 million at December 31, 2017.

The Company’s Federal Home Loan Bank advances totaled $-0- at December 31, 2018, compared to $127.5 million at December 31, 2017.  The balance of $127.5 million at December 31, 2017, consisted of short-term advances.  At December 31, 2018, there were no borrowings from the FHLBank, other than overnight borrowings, which are included in the short term borrowings category.  The Company utilizes both overnight borrowings and short-term FHLBank advances depending on relative interest rates.

Short term borrowings and other interest-bearing liabilities increased $176.1 million from $16.6 million at December 31, 2017 to $192.7 million at December 31, 2018.  The short term borrowings included overnight FHLBank borrowings of $178.0 million at December 31, 2018 and $15.0 million at December 31, 2017.

Securities sold under reverse repurchase agreements with customers increased $24.7 million, or 30.7%, from December 31, 2017 to December 31, 2018 as these balances fluctuate over time based on customer demand for this product.

Total stockholders' equity increased $60.3 million from $471.7 million at December 31, 2017 to $532.0 million at December 31, 2018.  The Company recorded net income of $67.1 million for the year ended December 31, 2018, and dividends declared on common stock were $17.0 million. Accumulated other comprehensive income increased $8.4 million due to increases in the fair value of available-for-sale investment securities and the fair value of cash flow hedges.  In addition, total stockholders’ equity increased $3.0 million due to stock option exercises.  Total stockholders’ equity decreased $903,000 due to the repurchase of the Company’s common stock.

Results of Operations and Comparison for the Years Ended December 31, 2018 and 2017

General

Net income increased $15.5 million, or 30.1%, during the year ended December 31, 2018, compared to the year ended December 31, 2017.  Net income was $67.1 million for the year ended December 31, 2018 compared to $51.6 million for the year ended December 31, 2017.  This increase was due to an increase in net interest income of $13.0 million, or 8.4%, a decrease in provision for income taxes of $3.9 million, or 20.9%, and a decrease in the provision for loan losses of $2.0 million, or 21.4%, partially offset by a decrease in non-interest income of $2.3 million, or 6.0%, and an increase in non-interest expense of $1.0 million, or 0.9%.  Net income available to common shareholders was $67.1 million for the year ended December 31, 2018 compared to $51.6 million for the year ended December 31, 2017.

Total Interest Income

Total interest income increased $22.9 million, or 12.5%, during the year ended December 31, 2018 compared to the year ended December 31, 2017. The increase was due to a $21.6 million, or 12.2%, increase in interest income on loans and a $1.3 million, or

72





20.5%, increase in interest income on investment securities and other interest-earning assets.  Interest income on loans increased in 2018 due to higher average rates of interest and higher average balances of loans.  Interest income from investment securities and other interest-earning assets increased during 2018 compared to 2017 primarily due to higher average rates of interest, partially offset by lower average balances.

Interest Income – Loans

During the year ended December 31, 2018 compared to the year ended December 31, 2017, interest income on loans increased due to higher average interest rates and higher average balances.  Interest income increased $17.0 million as the result of higher average interest rates on loans.  The average yield on loans increased from 4.63% during the year ended December 31, 2017 to 5.07% during the year ended December 31, 2018.  This increase was primarily due to increased yields in most loan categories as a result of increased LIBOR and Federal Funds interest rates.  Interest income increased $4.5 million as the result of higher average loan balances, which increased from $3.81 billion during the year ended December 31, 2017, to $3.91 billion during the year ended December 31, 2018.  The higher average balances were primarily due to organic loan growth in commercial construction loans, commercial real estate loans and other residential (multi-family) loans, partially offset by decreases in consumer loans.

On an on-going basis, the Company estimates the cash flows expected to be collected from the acquired loan pools. For each of the loan portfolios acquired, the cash flow estimates have increased, based on the payment histories and the collection of certain loans, thereby reducing loss expectations of certain loan pools, resulting in adjustments to be spread on a level-yield basis over the remaining expected lives of the loan pools. The loss sharing agreements for the Team Bank, Vantus Bank and Sun Security Bank transactions were terminated in April 2016, and the related indemnification assets were reduced to $-0- at that time.  The loss sharing agreements for InterBank were terminated in June 2017, and the related indemnification asset was reduced to $-0- at that time.  The Valley Bank transaction does not include a loss sharing agreement with the FDIC.  The entire amount of the discount adjustment has been and will be accreted to interest income over time with no further offsetting impact to non-interest income.  For the years ended December 31, 2018 and 2017, the adjustments increased interest income by $5.1 million and $5.0 million, respectively, and decreased non-interest income by $-0- and $634,000, respectively.  The net impact to pre-tax income was $5.1 million and $4.4 million, respectively, for the years ended December 31, 2018 and 2017.

As of December 31, 2018, the remaining accretable yield adjustment that will affect interest income was $2.7 million.  As there is no longer, nor will there be in the future, indemnification asset amortization related to Team Bank, Vantus Bank, Sun Security Bank or InterBank due to the termination or expiration of the related loss sharing agreements for those transactions, there is no remaining indemnification asset or related adjustments that will affect non-interest income (expense).  Of the remaining adjustments affecting interest income, we expect to recognize $2.0 million of interest income during 2019.  Additional adjustments may be recorded in future periods from the FDIC-assisted transactions, as the Company continues to estimate expected cash flows from the acquired loan pools. Apart from the yield accretion, the average yield on loans was 4.94% during the year ended December 31, 2018, compared to 4.50% during the year ended December 31, 2017, as a result of higher current market rates on adjustable rate loans and new loans originated during the year.

In October 2018, the Company entered into an interest rate swap transaction as part of its ongoing interest rate management strategies to hedge the risk of its floating rate loans.  The notional amount of the swap is $400 million with a termination date of October 6, 2025.  Under the terms of the swap, the Company will receive a fixed rate of interest of 3.018% and will pay a floating rate of interest equal to one-month USD-LIBOR.  The floating rate will be reset monthly and net settlements of interest due to/from the counterparty will also occur monthly.  The floating rate of interest was 2.383% as of December 31, 2018.  Therefore, in the near term, the Company will receive net interest settlements which will be recorded as loan interest income, to the extent that the fixed rate of interest continues to exceed one-month USD-LIBOR.  If USD-LIBOR exceeds the fixed rate of interest in future periods, the Company will be required to pay net settlements to the counterparty and will record those net payments as a reduction of interest income on loans.  The Company recorded loan interest income of $673,000 in 2018 related to this interest rate swap.

Interest Income - Investments and Other Interest-earning Assets

Interest income on investments increased $640,000 in the year ended December 31, 2018 compared to the year ended December 31, 2017.  Interest income increased $796,000 due to an increase in average interest rates from 2.50% during the year ended December 31, 2017 to 2.90% during the year ended December 31, 2018, due to higher market rates of interest on investment securities and a decrease in the volume of prepayments on mortgage-backed securities.  Partially offsetting that increase in average interest rates, interest income decreased $156,000 as a result of a decrease in average balances from $207.8 million during the year ended December 31, 2017, to $201.3 million during the year ended December 31, 2018.  Average balances of securities decreased primarily due to certain municipal securities being called and the normal monthly payments received on the portfolio of mortgage-backed securities.

73





Interest income on other interest-earning assets increased $676,000 in the year ended December 31, 2018 compared to the year ended December 31, 2017.  Interest income increased $819,000 due to an increase in average interest rates from 1.00% during the year ended December 31, 2017, to 1.81% during the year ended December 31, 2018, primarily due to higher market rates of interest on other interest-bearing deposits in financial institutions.  Partially offsetting that increase, interest income decreased $143,000 as a result of a decrease in average balances from $121.6 million during the year ended December 31, 2017, to $104.2 million during the year ended December 31, 2018.

Total Interest Expense

Total interest expense increased $9.9 million, or 35.3%, during the year ended December 31, 2018, when compared with the year ended December 31, 2017, due to an increase in interest expense on deposits of $7.4 million, or 35.7%, an increase in interest expense on FHLBank advances of $2.5 million, or 162.9%, an increase in interest expense on short-term and repurchase agreement borrowings of $18,000, or 2.4%, and an increase in interest expense on subordinated debentures issued to capital trust of $4,000, or 0.4%.

Interest Expense - Deposits

Interest on demand deposits increased $1.4 million due to an increase in average rates from 0.30% during the year ended December 31, 2017, to 0.39% during the year ended December 31, 2018.  Partially offsetting that increase, interest on demand deposits decreased $71,000 due to a decrease in average balances from $1.56 billion in the year ended December 31, 2017, to $1.53 billion in the year ended December 31, 2018.  The increase in average interest rates of interest-bearing demand deposits was primarily a result of increased market interest rates on these types of accounts since December 2016.

Interest expense on time deposits increased $6.5 million as a result of an increase in average rates of interest from 1.12% during the year ended December 31, 2017, to 1.60% during the year ended December 31, 2018.  Partially offsetting that increase, interest expense on time deposits decreased $422,000 due to a decrease in average balances of time deposits from $1.41 billion during the year ended December 31, 2017, to $1.38 billion during the year ended December 31, 2018.  A large portion of the Company’s certificate of deposit portfolio matures within six to eighteen months and therefore reprices fairly quickly; this is consistent with the portfolio over the past several years.  Older certificates of deposit that renewed or were replaced with new deposits generally resulted in the Company paying a higher rate of interest due to market interest rate increases in 2017 and 2018.  The decrease in average balances of time deposits was primarily a result of decreases in CDARS program purchased funds brokered deposits.

Interest Expense - FHLBank Advances, Short-term Borrowings and Repurchase Agreements, Subordinated Debentures Issued to Capital Trust and Subordinated Notes

Interest expense on FHLBank advances increased due to higher average balances and higher average rates of interest.  Interest expense on FHLBank advances increased $1.9 million due to an increase in average balances from $93.5 million during the year ended December 31, 2017, to $190.2 million during the year ended December 31, 2018.  This increase was primarily due to an increase in borrowings to fund loan growth and the replacement of overnight borrowings with short-term three week FHLBank advances due to the short-term advances having a more favorable interest rate from time to time.  The $31.5 million of the Company’s long-term higher fixed-rate FHLBank advances were repaid in June 2017. In addition, interest expense on FHLBank advances increased $544,000 due to an increase in average interest rates from 1.62% in the year ended December 31, 2017, to 2.09% in the year ended December 31, 2018.  The increase in the average rate was due to market interest rate increases during 2018.

Interest expense on short-term borrowings and repurchase agreements increased $55,000 due to average rates that increased from 0.40% in the year ended December 31, 2017, to 0.56% in the year ended December 31, 2018.  The increase was due to increases in market interest rates and a change in the mix of funding during the period, with a lower percentage of the total made up of customer repurchase agreements, which have a lower interest rate.  Partially offsetting the increase, interest expense on short-term borrowings and repurchase agreements decreased $37,000 due to a decrease in average balances from $186.4 million during the year ended December 31, 2017, to $137.3 million during the year ended December 31, 2018, which is primarily due to changes in the Company’s funding needs and the mix of funding, which can fluctuate.  The Company had a higher amount of overnight borrowings from the FHLBank in 2017.

During the year ended December 31, 2018, compared to the year ended December 31, 2017, interest expense on subordinated debentures issued to capital trusts increased $4,000 due to slightly higher average interest rates.  The average interest rate was 3.68% in 2017, compared to 3.70% in 2018.  There was no change in the average balance of the subordinated debentures between the 2018 and the 2017 years.

In August 2016, the Company issued $75 million of 5.25% fixed-to-floating rate subordinated notes due August 15, 2026.  The notes were sold at par, resulting in net proceeds, after underwriting discounts and commissions and other issuance costs, of approximately $73.5 million.  Interest expense on the subordinated notes for both of the years ended December 31, 2018 and 2017, was $4.1 million.

74





Net Interest Income

Net interest income for the year ended December 31, 2018 increased $13.0 million, or 8.4%, to $168.2 million, compared to $155.2 million for the year ended December 31, 2017. Net interest margin was 3.99% for the year ended December 31, 2018, compared to 3.74% in 2017, an increase of 25 basis points.  In both years, the Company’s net interest income and margin were positively impacted by the increases in expected cash flows from the FDIC-acquired loan pools and the resulting increase to accretable yield, which was discussed previously in “Interest Income – Loans” and is discussed in Note 4 of the accompanying audited financial statements, which are included in Item 8 of this Report.  The positive impact of these changes on the years ended December 31, 2018 and 2017 were increases in interest income of $5.1 million and $5.0 million, respectively, and increases in net interest margin of 12 basis points and 12 basis points, respectively.  Excluding the positive impact of the additional yield accretion, net interest margin increased 25 basis points during the year ended December 31, 2018.  The increase in net interest margin is primarily due to increased yields in most loan categories and higher overall yields on investments and interest-earning deposits at the Federal Reserve Bank, partially offset by an increase in the average interest rate on deposits and FHLBank advances and other borrowings.

The Company's overall interest rate spread increased 16 basis points, or 4.4%, from 3.59% during the year ended December 31, 2017, to 3.75% during the year ended December 31, 2018. The increase was due to a 46 basis point increase in the weighted average yield on interest-earning assets, partially offset by a 30 basis point increase in the weighted average rate paid on interest-bearing liabilities. In comparing the two years, the yield on loans increased 44 basis points, the yield on investment securities increased 40 basis points and the yield on other interest-earning assets increased 81 basis points. The rate paid on deposits increased 27 basis points, the rate paid on FHLBank advances increased 47 basis points, the rate paid on subordinated debentures issued to capital trust increased two basis points, the rate paid on short-term borrowings increased 16 basis points, and the rate paid on subordinated notes decreased two basis points.

For additional information on net interest income components, refer to the "Average Balances, Interest Rates and Yields" table in this Report.

Provision for Loan Losses and Allowance for Loan Losses

Management records a provision for loan losses in an amount it believes sufficient to result in an allowance for loan losses that will cover current net charge-offs as well as risks believed to be inherent in the loan portfolio of the Bank. The amount of provision charged against current income is based on several factors, including, but not limited to, past loss experience, current portfolio mix, actual and potential losses identified in the loan portfolio, economic conditions, and internal as well as external reviews.  The levels of non-performing assets, potential problem loans, loan loss provisions and net charge-offs fluctuate from period to period and are difficult to predict.

Weak economic conditions, higher inflation or interest rates, or other factors may lead to increased losses in the portfolio and/or requirements for an increase in loan loss provision expense. Management maintains various controls in an attempt to limit future losses, such as a watch list of possible problem loans, documented loan administration policies and a loan review staff to review the quality and anticipated collectability of the portfolio. Additional procedures provide for frequent management review of the loan portfolio based on loan size, loan type, delinquencies, financial analysis, on-going correspondence with borrowers and problem loan work-outs. Management determines which loans are potentially uncollectible, or represent a greater risk of loss, and makes additional provisions to expense, if necessary, to maintain the allowance at a satisfactory level.

The provision for loan losses for the year ended December 31, 2018 decreased $1.9 million, to $7.2 million, compared with $9.1 million for the year ended December 31, 2017.  At December 31, 2018 and December 31, 2017, the allowance for loan losses was $38.4 million and $36.5 million, respectively.  Total net charge-offs were $5.2 million and $10.0 million for the years ended December 31, 2018 and 2017, respectively. During the year ended December 31, 2018, $3.9 million of the $5.2 million of net charge-offs were in the consumer auto category.  In response to a more challenging consumer credit environment, the Company tightened its underwriting guidelines on automobile lending beginning in the latter part of 2016.  Management took this step in an effort to improve credit quality in the portfolio and lower delinquencies and charge-offs.  This action also reduced origination volume and, as such, the outstanding balance of the Company's automobile loans declined approximately $104 million in the year ended December 31, 2018.  We expect further declines in the automobile loan outstanding balance in 2019 as the Company determined in February 2019 that it will cease providing indirect lending services to automobile dealerships.  In addition, six commercial loan relationships amounted to $1.3 million of the total net charge-offs during the year ended December 31, 2018.  Charge-offs were partially offset by recoveries on multiple loans during the year.  General market conditions and unique circumstances related to individual borrowers and projects contributed to the level of provisions and charge-offs.  As assets were categorized as potential problem loans, non-performing loans or foreclosed assets, evaluations were made of the values of these assets with corresponding charge-offs as appropriate.

All acquired loans were grouped into pools based on common characteristics and were recorded at their estimated fair values, which incorporated estimated credit losses at the acquisition date.  These loan pools are systematically reviewed by management to

75





determine the risk of losses that may exceed those identified at the time of the acquisition.  Techniques used in determining risk of loss are similar to those used to determine the risk of loss for the legacy Great Southern Bank portfolio, with most focus being placed on those loan pools which include the larger loan relationships and those loan pools which exhibit higher risk characteristics.  Review of the acquired loan portfolio also includes monitoring of payment performance, review of financial information and credit scores, collateral valuations and customer interaction to determine if additional reserves are warranted.

The Bank’s allowance for loan losses as a percentage of total loans, excluding FDIC-acquired loans, was 0.98% and 1.01% at December 31, 2018 and December 31, 2017, respectively.  Management considers the allowance for loan losses adequate to cover losses inherent in the Bank’s loan portfolio at December 31, 2018, based on recent reviews of the Bank’s loan portfolio and current economic conditions. If economic conditions were to deteriorate or management’s assessment of the loan portfolio were to change, it is possible that additional loan loss provisions would be required, thereby adversely affecting future results of operations and financial condition.

Non-performing Assets

Non-performing assets acquired through FDIC-assisted transactions, including foreclosed assets and potential problem loans, are not included in the totals or in the discussion of non-performing loans, potential problem loans and foreclosed assets below.  These assets were initially recorded at their estimated fair values as of their acquisition dates and are accounted for in pools; therefore, these loan pools are analyzed rather than the individual loans. The overall performance of the loan pools acquired in each of the five FDIC-assisted transactions has been better than original expectations as of the acquisition dates.

As a result of changes in balances and composition of the loan portfolio, changes in economic and market conditions that occur from time to time, and other factors specific to a borrower's circumstances, the level of non-performing assets will fluctuate.

Non-performing assets, excluding all FDIC-assisted acquired assets, at December 31, 2018, were $11.8 million, a decrease of $16.0 million from $27.8 million at December 31, 2017.  Non-performing assets, excluding all FDIC-assisted acquired assets, as a percentage of total assets were 0.25% at December 31, 2018, compared to 0.63% at December 31, 2017.

Compared to December 31, 2017, non-performing loans decreased $5.0 million to $6.3 million at December 31, 2018, and foreclosed assets decreased $11.1 million to $5.5 million at December 31, 2018.  Non-performing one-to four-family residential loans comprised $2.7 million, or 42.3%, of the total $6.3 million of non-performing loans at December 31, 2018.  Non-performing consumer loans comprised $1.8 million, or 28.8%, of the total non-performing loans at December 31, 2018.  Non-performing commercial business loans comprised $1.4 million, or 22.8%, of total non-performing loans at December 31, 2018.  Non-performing commercial real estate loans comprised $334,000, or 5.3%, of total non-performing loans at December 31, 2018.  The majority of the decrease in the non-performing commercial real estate category was due to one relationship totaling approximately $650,000 being transferred to foreclosed assets during 2018.  Non-performing other residential loans were $-0- at December 31, 2018.  The decrease in non-performing other residential loans was due to the one loan previously in this category being transferred to foreclosed assets during 2018.

Non-performing Loans. Activity in the non-performing loans category during the year ended December 31, 2018, was as follows:

   
Beginning
Balance,
January 1
   
Additions to
Non-
Performing
   
Removed
from Non-
Performing
   
Transfers to
Potential
Problem Loans
   
Transfers to
Foreclosed
Assets and
Repossessions
   
Charge-Offs
   
Payments
   
Ending
Balance,
December 31
 
   
(In Thousands)
 
                                                 
One- to four-family construction
 
$
   
$
   
$
   
$
   
$
   
$
   
$
   
$
 
Subdivision construction
   
98
     
     
     
     
     
(3
)
   
(95
)
   
 
Land development
   
     
49
     
     
     
     
     
     
49
 
Commercial construction
   
     
     
     
     
     
     
     
 
One- to four-family residential
   
2,728
     
975
     
(81
)
   
(67
)
   
(467
)
   
(30
)
   
(394
)
   
2,664
 
Other residential
   
1,877
     
3
     
     
     
(1,601
)
   
(279
)
   
     
 
Commercial real estate
   
1,226
     
157
     
     
     
(894
)
   
(101
)
   
(54
)
   
334
 
Other commercial
   
2,063
     
2,321
     
     
     
     
(1,024
)
   
(1,923
)
   
1,437
 
Consumer
   
3,263
     
2,725
     
(7
)
   
(461
)
   
(790
)
   
(1,884
)
   
(1,030
)
   
1,816
 
                                                                 
Total
 
$
11,255
   
$
6,230
   
$
(88
)
 
$
(528
)
 
$
(3,752
)
 
$
(3,321
)
 
$
(3,496
)
 
$
6,300
 

At December 31, 2018, the non-performing one- to four-family residential category included 28 loans, eight of which were added during 2018.  The largest relationship in this category was added in 2017 and included nine loans totaling $1.3 million, or 48.4% of the total category, which are collateralized by residential rental homes in the Springfield, Mo. area. The non-performing consumer category included 176 loans, 104 of which were added during 2018, and the majority of which are indirect used automobile loans. The

76





non-performing commercial business category included five loans, all of which were added during 2018.  The largest relationship in this category totaled $1.1 million, or 78.6% of the total category.  This relationship is collateralized by an assignment of an interest in a real estate project.  A relationship in the commercial business category, which previously totaled $1.5 million, received payments during the year ended December 31, 2018, to satisfy the remaining recorded balance.  The non-performing commercial real estate category included five loans, two of which were added during 2018 and were part of the same customer relationship.  Three loans in the category were transferred to foreclosed assets during 2018, the largest of which totaled $652,000 and was collateralized by commercial property in the St. Louis, Mo., area.  The non-performing other residential category had a balance of $-0- at December 31, 2018.  The one loan previously in this category, which was collateralized by an apartment project in the central Missouri area, had charge-offs of $279,000 during the year ended December 31, 2018 and the remaining balance of $1.6 million was transferred to foreclosed assets.

Other Real Estate Owned and Repossessions. Of the total $8.4 million of other real estate owned and repossessions at December 31, 2018, $1.4 million represents the fair value of foreclosed and repossessed assets related to loans acquired in FDIC-assisted transactions and $1.6 million represents properties which were not acquired through foreclosure. The foreclosed and other assets acquired in the FDIC-assisted transactions and the properties not acquired through foreclosure are not included in the following table and discussion of other real estate owned and repossessions.  Because sales and write-downs of foreclosed and repossessed properties exceeded additions, total foreclosed assets and repossessions decreased.  Activity in foreclosed assets and repossessions during the year ended December 31, 2018, was as follows:

   
Beginning
Balance,
January 1
   
Additions
   
ORE and
Repossession
Sales
   
Capitalized
Costs
   
ORE and
Repossession
Write-Downs
   
Ending
Balance,
December 31
 
   
(In Thousands)
 
                                     
One- to four-family construction
 
$
   
$
   
$
   
$
   
$
   
$
 
Subdivision construction
   
5,413
     
     
(2,402
)
   
     
(1,919
)
   
1,092
 
Land development
   
7,729
     
20
     
(2,837
)
   
     
(1,721
)
   
3,191
 
Commercial construction
   
     
     
     
     
     
 
One- to four-family residential
   
112
     
820
     
(663
)
   
     
     
269
 
Other residential
   
140
     
1,601
     
(1,884
)
   
143
     
     
 
Commercial real estate
   
1,194
     
894
     
(1,932
)
   
10
     
(166
)
   
 
Commercial business
   
     
     
     
     
     
 
Consumer
   
1,987
     
7,711
     
(8,770
)
   
     
     
928
 
                                                 
Total
 
$
16,575
   
$
11,046
   
$
(18,488
)
 
$
153
   
$
(3,806
)
 
$
5,480
 

Excluding the consumer category, during the year ended December 31, 2018, the Company reduced its foreclosed assets by $9.7 million through asset sales.  At December 31, 2018, the land development category of foreclosed assets included seven properties, the largest of which was located in the Branson, Mo. area and had a balance of $913,000, or 28.6% of the total category.  Of the total dollar amount in the land development category of foreclosed assets, 66.8% was located in the Branson, Mo. area, including the largest property previously mentioned.  The subdivision construction category of foreclosed assets included seven properties, the largest of which was located in the Branson, Mo. area and had a balance of $350,000, or 32.1% of the total category.  Of the total dollar amount in the subdivision construction category of foreclosed assets, 65.0% is located in the Branson, Mo. area, including the largest property previously mentioned.  The write-downs in the land development and subdivision construction categories resulted from management’s decision during the three months ended June 30, 2018, after marketing these assets for an extended period, to reduce the asking price for several parcels of land.  The Company experienced increased levels of delinquencies and repossessions in indirect and used automobile loans throughout 2016 and 2017.  The amount of additions and sales under consumer loans are due to a higher volume of repossessions of automobiles, which generally are subject to a shorter repossession process.  The level of delinquencies and repossessions in indirect and used automobile loans decreased in 2018. The commercial real estate category of foreclosed assets had a zero balance at December 31, 2018.  All of the previously remaining properties in the commercial real estate category, totaling $1.9 million, were sold during 2018.  The other residential category of foreclosed assets had a zero balance at December 31, 2018.  The previously remaining property in the category, an apartment building in central Missouri totaling $1.7 million, was sold during 2018.

Potential Problem Loans. Potential problem loans decreased $4.6 million during the year ended December 31, 2018, from $7.9 million at December 31, 2017 to $3.3 million at December 31, 2018. This decrease was primarily due to $5.3 million in loans removed from potential problem loans due to improvements in the credits, $1.6 million in payments on potential problem loans and $489,000 in loans transferred to the non-performing category, partially offset by the addition of $2.8 million of loans to potential problem loans.  Potential problem loans are loans which management has identified through routine internal review procedures as having possible credit problems that may cause the borrowers difficulty in complying with current repayment terms. These loans are not reflected in

77





non-performing assets, but are considered in determining the adequacy of the allowance for loan losses.  Activity in the potential problem loans category during the year ended December 31, 2018, was as follows:

   
Beginning
Balance,
January 1
   
Additions to
Potential
Problem
   
Removed
from Potential
Problem
   
Transfers to
Non-
Performing
   
Transfers to
Foreclosed
Assets and
Repossessions
   
Charge-Offs
   
Payments
   
Ending
Balance,
December 31
 
   
(In Thousands)
 
                                                 
One- to four-family construction
 
$
   
$
   
$
   
$
   
$
   
$
   
$
   
$
 
Subdivision construction
   
     
     
     
     
     
     
     
 
Land development
   
4
     
     
(3
)
   
     
     
     
(1
)
   
 
Commercial construction
   
     
     
     
     
     
     
     
 
One- to four-family residential
   
1,122
     
122
     
     
     
     
     
(200
)
   
1,044
 
Other residential
   
     
     
     
     
     
     
     
 
Commercial real estate
   
5,759
     
2,180
     
(4,709
)
   
     
     
     
(1,177
)
   
2,053
 
Other commercial
   
503
     
     
(59
)
   
(407
)
   
     
     
(37
)
   
 
Consumer
   
549
     
455
     
(497
)
   
(82
)
   
     
(30
)
   
(189
)
   
206
 
                                                                 
Total
 
$
7,937
   
$
2,757
   
$
(5,268
)
 
$
(489
)
 
$
   
$
(30
)
 
$
(1,604
)
 
$
3,303
 

At December 31, 2018, the commercial real estate category of potential problem loans included two loans, both of which were added during 2018.  The largest relationship in this category, totaling $1.9 million, or 93.9% of the total category, is collateralized by a mixed use commercial retail building.  One relationship previously in this category consists of three loans totaling $4.7 million collateralized by theatre and retail property in Branson, Mo.  The decision to remove this relationship from potential problem loans during the year was due to an improvement in debt service coverage, and timely principal and interest payments on these loans, including over $1.0 million in payments during 2018.  The one- to four-family residential category of potential problem loans included 18 loans, four of which were added during 2018. The consumer category of potential problem loans included 18 loans, 15 of which were added during 2018.

Non-Interest Income

Non-interest income for the year ended December 31, 2018 was $36.2 million compared with $38.5 million for the year ended December 31, 2017. The decrease of $2.3 million, or 6.0%, was primarily as a result of the following items:

2017 gain on early termination of FDIC loss sharing agreements for Inter Savings Bank:  In 2017, the Company recognized a one-time gross gain of $7.7 million from the termination of the loss sharing agreements for Inter Savings Bank, which was recorded in the gain on termination of loss sharing agreements line item of the consolidated statements of income for the year ended December 31, 2017.

Net gains on loan sales:  Net gains on loan sales decreased $1.4 million compared to the prior year.  The decrease was due to a decrease in originations of fixed-rate loans during 2018 compared to 2017.  Fixed rate single-family mortgage loans originated are generally subsequently sold in the secondary market. In 2018, the Company originated more variable-rate single-family mortgage loans, partially due to higher market rates of interest, which have been retained in the Company’s portfolio.

Late charges and fees on loans:  Late charges and fees on loans decreased $609,000 compared to the prior year.  The decrease was primarily due to fees totaling $632,000 on loan payoffs received on four loan relationships in 2017 which were not repeated in 2018.

Other income:  Other income decreased $695,000 compared to the prior year period.  The decrease was primarily due to income from interest rate swaps entered into in 2017, the receipt of approximately $260,000 more income related to the exit of certain tax credit partnerships in 2017 compared to 2018 and $250,000 less in merchant card services fees compared to 2017.

Sale of Omaha-area banking centers:  On July 20, 2018, the Company closed on the sale of four banking centers in the Omaha, Neb., metropolitan market.  The Bank sold branch deposits of approximately $56 million and sold substantially all branch-related real estate, fixed assets and ATMs.   The Company recorded a pre-tax gain of $7.4 million on the sale during the year ended December 31, 2018.

Amortization of income related to business acquisitions:  Because of the termination of the remaining loss sharing agreements in June 2017, the net amortization expense related to business acquisitions was $-0- for the year ended December 31, 2018, compared to $486,000 for the year ended December 31, 2017, which reduced non-interest income by that amount in the previous year.

Non-Interest Expense

Total non-interest expense increased $1.0 million, or 0.9%, from $114.3 million in the year ended December 31, 2017, to $115.3 million in the year ended December 31, 2018.  The Company’s efficiency ratio for the year ended December 31, 2018 was 56.41%, a

78





decrease from 58.99% for 2017.  The improvement in the ratio for 2018 was primarily due to an increase in net interest income, partially offset by a decrease in non-interest income and an increase in non-interest expense. In the year ended December 31, 2018, the Company’s efficiency ratio was positively impacted by the significant gain recorded related to the sale of the Bank’s branches and deposits in Omaha, Neb.  In the year ended December 31, 2017, the Company’s efficiency ratio was positively impacted by the significant gain recorded related to the termination of the Inter Savings Bank loss sharing agreements.  The Company’s ratio of non-interest expense to average assets was 2.56% for each of the years ended December 31, 2018 and 2017.  Average assets for the year ended December 31, 2018, increased $43.1 million, or 1.0%, from the year ended December 31, 2017, primarily due to organic loan growth, partially offset by decreases in investment securities and other interest-earning assets.

The following were key items related to the increase in non-interest expense for the year ended December 31, 2018 as compared to the year ended December 31, 2017:

Net occupancy and equipment expense:  Net occupancy expense increased $1.0 million in the year ended December 31, 2018 compared to the year ended December 31, 2017.  This increase was primarily due to increased expenses related to hardware and software costs for loan loss accounting and commercial loan systems and data servers at the Company’s disaster recovery site, increased depreciation expense for upgraded ATM/ITM machines, deconversion expenses related to the sale of the Omaha-area banking centers and repairs and maintenance costs for various banking centers.

Expense on other real estate and repossessions:  Expense on other real estate and repossessions increased $990,000 compared to the prior year primarily due to the valuation write-down of certain foreclosed assets during the second quarter 2018, totaling approximately $2.1 million, partially offset by gains on sales of foreclosed and repossessed assets in 2018 and lower repossession and collection expenses in 2018.

Legal, audit and other professional fees:  Legal, audit and other professional fees increased $561,000 in the year ended December 31, 2018 compared to 2017. The increase was primarily due to fees for professional services related to process improvement initiatives, fees paid to advisors for the negotiation and implementation of derivative transactions, consulting fees related to the ongoing implementation of an accounting system which will be utilized for the new loan loss accounting standard and legal costs related to the sale of the Omaha-area banking centers.

Other operating expenses:  Other operating expenses decreased $691,000 in the year ended December 31, 2018 compared to 2017.  During 2017, the Company incurred a $340,000 prepayment penalty when FHLB advances totaling $31.4 million were repaid prior to maturity, which was not repeated in the 2018 period.  In addition, the Company experienced significantly lower debit card and check fraud losses in 2018 compared to 2017.

Office supplies and printing expense:  Office supplies and printing expense decreased $399,000 in the year ended December 31, 2018 compared to 2017.  During 2017 the Bank incurred printing and other costs totaling $373,000 related to the replacement of a portion of customer debit cards with chip-enabled cards, which was not repeated in the current year.

Partnership tax credit:  Partnership tax credit expense decreased $355,000 in the year ended December 31, 2018 compared to the 2017 year.  The Company periodically invests in certain tax credits and amortizes those investments over the period that the tax credits are used.  The tax credit period for certain of these credits ended in 2017 and so the final amortization of the investment in those credits also ended in 2017.

79





Provision for Income Taxes

For the years ended December 31, 2018 and 2017, the Company's effective tax rate was 18.1% and 26.7%, respectively.  These effective rates were lower than the statutory federal tax rates of 21% (2018) and 35% (2017), due primarily to the utilization of certain investment tax credits and to tax-exempt investments and tax-exempt loans which reduced the Company’s effective tax rate.  The Company’s effective tax rate may fluctuate in future periods as it is impacted by the level and timing of the Company’s utilization of tax credits and the level of tax-exempt investments and loans and the overall level of pre-tax income.  The Company’s effective income tax rate was slightly higher than its typical effective tax rate in the 2018 and 2017 years due to gains on the sale of the Omaha branches and related deposits (2018) and increased net income resulting from the gain on termination of the loss sharing agreements for the Inter Savings Bank FDIC-assisted transaction (2017).  The Company currently expects its effective tax rate (combined federal and state) to be approximately 17.0% to 18.5% in future periods, mainly as a result of the Act. The Company's effective income tax rate is expected to continue to be less than the statutory rate due primarily to investments in low-income housing tax credit projects and tax-exempt obligations. The Company’s effective tax rate could change in future periods based on changes in the level of investments in tax credit projects and tax-exempt obligations, as well as changes in the level of overall pre-tax earnings.

On December 22, 2017, H.R.1, originally known as the Tax Cuts and Jobs Act (the “TCJ Act”) was signed into law. Among other things, the TCJ Act permanently lowers the corporate federal income tax rate to 21% from the prior maximum rate of 35%, effective for tax years including or commencing January 1, 2018. As a result of the reduction of the corporate federal income tax rate to 21%, U.S. generally accepted accounting principles require companies to perform a revaluation of their deferred tax assets and liabilities as of the date of enactment, with the resulting tax effects accounted for in the reporting period of enactment (the year ended December 31, 2017). Deferred income taxes result from temporary differences between the tax basis of assets and liabilities and their reported amounts in the financial statements, which will result in taxable or deductible amounts in future years. Deferred tax assets and liabilities are measured using enacted tax rates expected to apply to taxable income in years in which those temporary differences are expected to be recovered or settled. As changes in tax laws or rates are enacted, deferred tax assets and liabilities are adjusted through income tax expense.

In 2017, based upon current accounting guidance and the utilization and recognition of the timing differences referred to above, the Company recorded a net decrease in income tax expense of approximately $250,000. This net decrease in income tax expense was comprised of a $2.1 million decrease from the adjustment of net deferred tax liabilities resulting from enactment of the TCJ Act, partially offset by the impacts of other tax planning strategies implemented. This impact on the Company’s net deferred tax liabilities, which included, among other things, the timing of recognition of various revenues and expenses, was based upon a review and analysis of the Company’s net deferred tax liabilities at December 31, 2017, as well as expected adjustments to various deferred tax assets and deferred tax liabilities in the year ended December 31, 2017, including those accounted for in accumulated other comprehensive income.

Average Balances, Interest Rates and Yields

The following table presents, for the periods indicated, the total dollar amount of interest income from average interest-earning assets and the resulting yields, as well as the interest expense on average interest-bearing liabilities, expressed both in dollars and rates, and the net interest margin. Average balances of loans receivable include the average balances of non-accrual loans for each period. Interest income on loans includes interest received on non-accrual loans on a cash basis. Interest income on loans includes the amortization of net loan fees, which were deferred in accordance with accounting standards. Net fees included in interest income were $3.5 million, $2.9 million and $5.0 million for 2018, 2017 and 2016, respectively. Tax-exempt income was not calculated on a tax equivalent basis. The table does not reflect any effect of income taxes.







80





   
Dec. 31, 2018(2)
   
Year Ended
December 31, 2018
   
Year Ended
December 31, 2017
   
Year Ended
December 31, 2016
 
   
Yield/ Rate
   
Average Balance
   
Interest
   
Yield/ Rate
   
Average Balance
   
Interest
   
Yield/ Rate
   
Average Balance
   
Interest
   
Yield/ Rate
 
         
(Dollars In Thousands)
 
Interest-earning assets:
                                                           
Loans receivable:
                                                           
  One- to four-family residential
   
4.23
%
 
$
449,917
   
$
22,924
     
5.10
%
 
$
459,227
   
$
22,102
     
4.81
%
 
$
538,776
   
$
28,674
     
5.32
%
  Other residential
   
5.13
     
761,115
     
38,863
     
5.11
     
706,217
     
31,970
     
4.53
     
535,793
     
25,052
     
4.68
 
  Commercial real estate
   
4.91
     
1,325,398
     
64,605
     
4.87
     
1,240,017
     
54,911
     
4.43
     
1,146,983
     
53,516
     
4.67
 
  Construction
   
5.35
     
569,570
     
31,198
     
5.48
     
454,907
     
21,099
     
4.64
     
394,051
     
18,059
     
4.58
 
  Commercial business
   
5.22
     
285,125
     
14,104
     
4.95
     
295,379
     
14,666
     
4.97
     
316,526
     
17,389
     
5.49
 
  Other loans
   
6.01
     
499,131
     
25,250
     
5.06
     
632,968
     
30,356
     
4.80
     
693,550
     
34,176
     
4.93
 
  Industrial revenue bonds (1)
   
4.82
     
20,563
     
1,282
     
6.23
     
25,845
     
1,550
     
6.00
     
33,681
     
2,017
     
5.99
 
                                                                                 
     Total loans receivable
   
5.16
     
3,910,819
     
198,226
     
5.07
     
3,814,560
     
176,654
     
4.63
     
3,659,360
     
178,883
     
4.89
 
                                                                                 
Investment securities (1)
   
3.36
     
201,330
     
5,835
     
2.90
     
207,803
     
5,195
     
2.50
     
249,484
     
5,741
     
2.30
 
Other interest-earning assets
   
2.50
     
104,220
     
1,888
     
1.81
     
121,604
     
1,212
     
1.00
     
116,812
     
551
     
0.47
 
                                                                                 
     Total interest-earning assets
   
5.00
     
4,216,369
     
205,949
     
4.88
     
4,143,967
     
183,061
     
4.42
     
4,025,656
     
185,175
     
4.60
 
Non-interest-earning assets:
                                                                               
  Cash and cash equivalents
           
97,796
                     
103,505
                     
108,593
                 
  Other non-earning assets
           
189,161
                     
212,724
                     
236,544
                 
     Total assets
         
$
4,503,326
                   
$
4,460,196
                   
$
4,370,793
                 
                                                                                 
Interest-bearing liabilities:
                                                                               
  Interest-bearing demand and savings
   
0.46
   
$
1,531,375
     
5,982
     
0.39
   
$
1,555,375
     
4,698
     
0.30
   
$
1,496,837
     
3,888
     
0.26
 
  Time deposits
   
1.98
     
1,375,508
     
21,975
     
1.60
     
1,414,189
     
15,897
     
1.12
     
1,370,935
     
13,499
     
0.98
 
  Total deposits
   
1.25
     
2,906,883
     
27,957
     
0.96
     
2,969,564
     
20,595
     
0.69
     
2,867,772
     
17,387
     
0.61
 
  Short-term borrowings,  repurchase agreements and other interest-bearing liabilities
   
1.68
     
137,257
     
765
     
0.56
     
186,364
     
747
     
0.40
     
327,658
     
1,137
     
0.35
 
  Subordinated debentures issued to capital trust
   
4.14
     
25,774
     
953
     
3.70
     
25,774
     
949
     
3.68
     
25,774
     
803
     
3.12
 
  Subordinated notes
   
5.55
     
73,772
     
4,097
     
5.55
     
73,613
     
4,098
     
5.57
     
28,526
     
1,578
     
5.53
 
  FHLB advances
   
0.00
     
190,245
     
3,985
     
2.09
     
93,524
     
1,516
     
1.62
     
68,325
     
1,214
     
1.78
 
                                                                                 
     Total interest-bearing liabilities
   
1.40
     
3,333,931
     
37,757
     
1.13
     
3,348,839
     
27,905
     
0.83
     
3,318,055
     
22,119
     
0.67
 
Non-interest-bearing liabilities:
                                                                               
  Demand deposits
           
649,357
                     
629,015
                     
608,115
                 
  Other liabilities
           
21,530
                     
26,638
                     
29,824
                 
     Total liabilities
           
4,004,818
                     
4,004,492
                     
3,955,994
                 
Stockholders’ equity
           
498,508
                     
455,704
                     
414,799
                 
     Total liabilities and stockholders’ equity
         
$
4,503,326
                   
$
4,460,196
                   
$
4,370,793
                 
                                                                                 
Net interest income:
                                                                               
Interest rate spread
   
3.60
%
         
$
168,192
     
3.75
%
         
$
155,156
     
3.59
%
         
$
163,056
     
3.93
%
Net interest margin*
                           
3.99
%
                   
3.74
%
                   
4.05
%
Average interest-earning assets to average interest-bearing liabilities
           
126.5
%
                   
123.7
%
                   
121.3
%
               

*
Defined as the Company's net interest income divided by total interest-earning assets.
 
(1)
Of the total average balances of investment securities, average tax-exempt investment securities were $53.6 million, $61.5 million and $72.0 million for 2018, 2017 and 2016, respectively. In addition, average tax-exempt industrial revenue bonds were $24.76 million, $28.6 million and $32.0 million in 2018, 2017 and 2016, respectively. Interest income on tax-exempt assets included in this table was $3.1 million, $3.3 million and $3.8 million for 2018, 2017 and 2016, respectively. Interest income net of disallowed interest expense related to tax-exempt assets was $2.9 million, $3.1 million and $3.7 million for 2018, 2017 and 2016, respectively.
 
(2)
The yield/rate on loans at December 31, 2018 does not include the impact of the accretable yield (income) on loans acquired in the FDIC-assisted transactions.  See “Net Interest Income” for a discussion of the effect on 2018 results of operations.
 


81





Rate/Volume Analysis

The following table presents the dollar amount of changes in interest income and interest expense for major components of interest-earning assets and interest-bearing liabilities for the periods shown. For each category of interest-earning assets and interest-bearing liabilities, information is provided on changes attributable to (i) changes in rate (i.e., changes in rate multiplied by old volume) and (ii) changes in volume (i.e., changes in volume multiplied by old rate). For purposes of this table, changes attributable to both rate and volume, which cannot be segregated, have been allocated proportionately to volume and rate. Tax-exempt income was not calculated on a tax equivalent basis.

   
Year Ended
December 31, 2018 vs.
December 31, 2017
   
Year Ended
December 31, 2017 vs.
December 31, 2016
 
   
Increase (Decrease)
Due to
   
Total Increase (Decrease)
   
Increase (Decrease)
Due to
   
Total Increase (Decrease)
 
   
Rate
   
Volume
   
Rate
   
Volume
 
   
(In Thousands)
 
Interest-earning assets:
                                   
Loans receivable
 
$
17,025
   
$
4,547
   
$
21,572
   
$
(9,638
)
 
$
7,409
   
$
(2,229
)
Investment securities
   
796
     
(156
)
   
640
     
468
     
(1,014
)
   
(546
)
Other interest-earning assets
   
819
     
(143
)
   
676
     
638
     
23
     
661
 
Total interest-earning assets
   
18,640
     
4,248
     
22,888
     
(8,532
)
   
6,418
     
(2,114
)
Interest-bearing liabilities:
                                               
Demand deposits
   
1,355
     
(71
)
   
1,284
     
653
     
157
     
810
 
Time deposits
   
6,500
     
(422
)
   
6,078
     
1,961
     
437
     
2,398
 
Total deposits
   
7,855
     
(493
)
   
7,362
     
2,614
     
594
     
3,208
 
Short-term borrowings and repurchase agreements
   
55
     
(37
)
   
18
     
156
     
(546
)
   
(390
)
Subordinated debentures issued to capital trust
   
4
     
     
4
     
146
     
     
146
 
Subordinated notes
   
(1
)
   
     
(1
)
   
216
     
2,304
     
2,520
 
FHLBank advances
   
544
     
1,925
     
2,469
     
(114
)
   
416
     
302
 
Total interest-bearing liabilities
   
8,457
     
1,395
     
9,852
     
3,018
     
2,768
     
5,786
 
Net interest income
 
$
10,183
   
$
2,853
   
$
13,036
   
$
(11,550
)
 
$
3,650
   
$
(7,900
)


Results of Operations and Comparison for the Years Ended December 31, 2017 and 2016

General

Net income increased $6.3 million, or 13.7%, during the year ended December 31, 2017, compared to the year ended December 31, 2016.  Net income was $51.6 million for the year ended December 31, 2017 compared to $45.3 million for the year ended December 31, 2016.  This increase was due to an increase in non-interest income of $10.0 million, or 35.1%, a decrease in non-interest expense of $6.2 million, or 5.1%, and a decrease in the provision for loan losses of $181,000, or 2.0%, partially offset by a decrease in net interest income of $7.9 million, or 4.8%, and an increase in provision for income taxes of $2.2 million, or 13.6%.  Net income available to common shareholders was $51.6 million for the year ended December 31, 2017 compared to $45.3 million for the year ended December 31, 2016.

Total Interest Income

Total interest income decreased $2.1 million, or 1.1%, during the year ended December 31, 2017 compared to the year ended December 31, 2016. The decrease was due to a $2.2 million, or 1.2%, decrease in interest income on loans, partially offset by a $115,000, or 1.8%, increase in interest income on investment securities and other interest-earning assets.  Interest income on loans decreased in 2017 due to lower average rates of interest, partially offset by higher average balances of loans.  The decrease in average interest rates on loans was primarily the result of a reduction in the additional yield accretion recognized in conjunction with updated estimates of the fair value of the acquired loan pools compared to the prior year.  Interest income from investment securities and other interest-earning assets increased during 2017 compared to 2016 primarily due to higher average rates of interest, partially offset by lower average balances.

82





Interest Income – Loans

During the year ended December 31, 2017 compared to the year ended December 31, 2016, interest income on loans decreased due to lower average interest rates, partially offset by higher average balances.  Interest income decreased $9.6 million as the result of lower average interest rates on loans.  The average yield on loans decreased from 4.89% during the year ended December 31, 2016 to 4.63% during the year ended December 31, 2017.  This decrease was due to a lower amount of accretion income in the current year resulting from the increases in expected cash flows to be received from the FDIC-acquired loan pools, which is discussed in Note 4 of the accompanying audited financial statements included in Item 8 of this report.  The decrease was partially offset by higher overall average loan balances.  Interest income increased $7.4 million as the result of higher average loan balances, which increased from $3.66 billion during the year ended December 31, 2016, to $3.81 billion during the year ended December 31, 2017.  The higher average balances were primarily due to organic loan growth.

On an on-going basis, the Company estimates the cash flows expected to be collected from the acquired loan pools. For each of the loan portfolios acquired, the cash flow estimates have increased, based on the payment histories and the collection of certain loans, thereby reducing loss expectations of certain loan pools, resulting in adjustments to be spread on a level-yield basis over the remaining expected lives of the loan pools. The loss sharing agreements for the Team Bank, Vantus Bank and Sun Security Bank transactions were terminated in April 2016, and the related indemnification assets were reduced to $-0- at that time.  The loss sharing agreements for InterBank were terminated in June 2017, and the related indemnification asset was reduced to $-0- at that time.  The Valley Bank transaction does not include a loss sharing agreement with the FDIC.  Therefore, there was no remaining indemnification asset for FDIC-assisted transactions as of December 31, 2017. The entire amount of the discount adjustment has been and will be accreted to interest income over time with no further offsetting impact to non-interest income.  For the years ended December 31, 2017 and 2016, the adjustments increased interest income by $5.0 million and $16.4 million, respectively, and decreased non-interest income by $634,000 and $7.0 million, respectively.  The net impact to pre-tax income was $4.4 million and $9.4 million, respectively, for the years ended December 31, 2017 and 2016.

Interest Income - Investments and Other Interest-earning Assets

Interest income on investments and other interest-earning assets increased $115,000 in the year ended December 31, 2017 compared to the year ended December 31, 2016.  Interest income increased $1.1 million due to an increase in average interest rates from 1.72% during the year ended December 31, 2016 to 2.05% during the year ended December 31, 2017, due to higher market rates of interest on investment securities and other interest-bearing deposits in financial institutions.  Interest income decreased $1.0 million as a result of a decrease in average balances from $366.3 million during the year ended December 31, 2016, to $329.4 million during the year ended December 31, 2017.  Average balances of securities decreased due to certain U. S. government agency securities and municipal securities being called and the normal monthly payments received related to the portfolio of mortgage-backed securities.

The Company’s interest-earning deposits and non-interest-earning cash equivalents currently earn very low or no yield and therefore negatively impact the Company’s net interest margin. At December 31, 2017, the Company had cash and cash equivalents of $242.3 million compared to $279.8 million at December 31, 2016.  See "Net Interest Income" for additional information on the impact of this interest activity.

Total Interest Expense

Total interest expense increased $5.8 million, or 26.2%, during the year ended December 31, 2017, when compared with the year ended December 31, 2016, due to an increase in interest expense on deposits of $3.2 million, or 18.5%, an increase in interest expense on the subordinated notes issued during 2016 of $2.5 million, or 159.7%, an increase in interest expense on FHLBank advances of $302,000, or 24.9%, and an increase in interest expense on subordinated debentures issued to capital trust of $146,000, or 18.2%, partially offset by a decrease in interest expense on short-term and repurchase agreement borrowings of $390,000, or 34.3%.

Interest Expense - Deposits

Interest on demand deposits increased $653,000 due to an increase in average rates from 0.26% during the year ended December 31, 2016, to 0.30% during the year ended December 31, 2017.  Interest on demand deposits increased $157,000 due to an increase in average balances from $1.50 billion in the year ended December 31, 2016, to $1.56 billion in the year ended December 31, 2017.  The increase in average balances of interest-bearing demand deposits was primarily a result of increased balances in money market accounts.  Market interest rates on these types of accounts have increased since December 2016.




83






Interest expense on time deposits increased $2.0 million as a result of an increase in average rates of interest from 0.98% during the year ended December 31, 2016, to 1.12% during the year ended December 31, 2017.  Interest expense on time deposits increased $437,000 due to an increase in average balances of time deposits from $1.37 billion during the year ended December 31, 2016, to $1.41 billion during the year ended December 31, 2017.  The increase in average balances of time deposits was primarily a result of organic growth of retail deposits.  A large portion of the Company’s certificate of deposit portfolio matures within six to eighteen months and therefore reprices fairly quickly; this is consistent with the portfolio over the past several years.  Older certificates of deposit that renewed or were replaced with new deposits generally had a higher rate of interest due to market interest rate increases since December 2016.

Interest Expense - FHLBank Advances, Short-term Borrowings and Structured Repurchase Agreements, Subordinated Debentures Issued to Capital Trust and Subordinated Notes

Interest expense on FHLBank advances increased due to higher average balances, partially offset by lower average rates of interest.  Interest expense on FHLBank advances increased $416,000 due to an increase in average balances from $68.3 million during the year ended December 31, 2016, to $93.5 million during the year ended December 31, 2017.  This increase was primarily due to the replacement of overnight borrowings with short-term three week FHLBank advances due to the short-term advances having a more favorable interest rate from time to time.  The $31.5 million of the Company’s long-term higher fixed-rate FHLBank advances were repaid during June 2017. Partially offsetting the increase due to higher average balances was a decrease in interest expense of $114,000 due to a decrease in average interest rates from 1.78% in the year ended December 31, 2016, to 1.62% in the year ended December 31, 2017.  The decrease in the average rate was due to the repayment of the fixed-rate term FHLBank advances during June 2017 and the borrowing of shorter term FHLBank advances at a lower rate.

Interest expense on short-term borrowings and repurchase agreements decreased $546,000 due to a decrease in average balances from $327.7 million during the year ended December 31, 2016, to $186.4 million during the year ended December 31, 2017, which is primarily due to changes in the Company’s funding needs and the mix of funding, which can fluctuate.  The Company had a much higher amount of overnight borrowings from the FHLBank in 2016.  Partially offsetting that decrease was an increase in interest expense on short-term borrowings and repurchase agreements of $156,000 due to average rates that increased from 0.35% in the year ended December 31, 2016, to 0.40% in the year ended December 31, 2017.  The increase was due to increases in market interest rates and a change in the mix of funding during the period, with a lower percentage of the total made up of customer repurchase agreements, which have a lower interest rate.

During the year ended December 31, 2017, compared to the year ended December 31, 2016, interest expense on subordinated debentures issued to capital trusts increased $146,000 due to higher average interest rates.  The average interest rate was 3.12% in 2016, compared to 3.68% in 2017.  The amortization of the cost of interest rate caps the Company purchased in 2013 to limit the interest rate risk from rising LIBOR rates related to the Company’s subordinated debentures issued to capital trusts effectively increased the rates for each year.  The 2017 average interest rate was higher than 3.68% until the three months ended September 30, 2017, when the interest rate cap terminated based on its contractual terms, as a result of the amortization of the cost of the interest rate cap.  There was no change in the average balance of the subordinated debentures between the 2017 and the 2016 years.

In August 2016, the Company issued $75 million of 5.25% fixed-to-floating rate subordinated notes due August 15, 2026.  The notes were sold at par, resulting in net proceeds, after underwriting discounts and commissions and other issuance costs, of approximately $73.5 million.  Interest expense on the subordinated notes for the year ended December 31, 2017, was $4.1 million, an increase of $2.5 million over the $1.6 million of interest expense for the year ended December 31, 2016.  The increase was due to the fact that the notes were issued during the second half of 2016 and the Company did not incur interest expense for the entire year in 2016.

Net Interest Income

Net interest income for the year ended December 31, 2017 decreased $7.9 million, to $155.2 million, compared to $163.1 million for the year ended December 31, 2016. Net interest margin was 3.74% for the year ended December 31, 2017, compared to 4.05% in 2016, a decrease of 31 basis points.  In both years, the Company’s net interest income and margin were significantly impacted by increases in expected cash flows to be received from the FDIC-acquired loan pools and the resulting increase to accretable yield, which was discussed previously in “Interest Income – Loans” and is discussed in Note 4 of the accompanying audited financial statements, which

84





are included in Item 8 of this Report.  The positive impact of these changes on the years ended December 31, 2017 and 2016 were increases in interest income of $5.0 million and $16.4 million, respectively, and increases in net interest margin of 12 basis points and 41 basis points, respectively.  Excluding the positive impact of the additional yield accretion, net interest margin decreased 2 basis points during the year ended December 31, 2017.  The decrease in net interest margin was primarily due to the interest expense associated with the issuance of $75.0 million of subordinated notes in August 2016 and an increase in the average interest rate on deposits and other borrowings.

The Company's overall interest rate spread decreased 34 basis points, or 8.6%, from 3.93% during the year ended December 31, 2016, to 3.59% during the year ended December 31, 2017. The decrease was due to an 18 basis point decrease in the weighted average yield on interest-earning assets and a 16 basis point increase in the weighted average rate paid on interest-bearing liabilities. In comparing the two years, the yield on loans decreased 26 basis points while the yield on investment securities and other interest-earning assets increased 23 basis points. The rate paid on deposits increased 8 basis points, the rate paid on subordinated debentures issued to capital trust increased 56 basis points, the rate paid on short-term borrowings increased 5 basis points, the rate paid on subordinated notes increased 4 basis points and the rate paid on FHLBank advances decreased 16 basis points.

For additional information on net interest income components, refer to the "Average Balances, Interest Rates and Yields" table in this Report.

Provision for Loan Losses and Allowance for Loan Losses

The provision for loan losses for the year ended December 31, 2017 decreased $181,000, to $9.1 million, compared with $9.3 million for the year ended December 31, 2016.  At December 31, 2017 and December 31, 2016, the allowance for loan losses was $36.5 million and $37.4 million, respectively.  Total net charge-offs were $10.0 million and $10.0 million for the years ended December 31, 2017 and 2016, respectively.  During the year ended December 31, 2017, $6.1 million of the $10.0 million of net charge-offs were in the consumer auto category.  Five commercial loan relationships amounted to $2.9 million of the net charge-off total for the year ended December 31, 2017.  In response to a more challenging consumer credit environment, the Company tightened its underwriting guidelines on automobile lending beginning in the latter part of 2016.  Management took this step in an effort to improve credit quality in the portfolio and lower delinquencies and charge-offs.  This action also resulted in a lower level of origination volume and, as such, the outstanding balance of the Company's automobile loans declined approximately $137 million in the year ended December 31, 2017.  General market conditions and unique circumstances related to individual borrowers and projects contributed to the level of provisions and charge-offs.  As assets were categorized as potential problem loans, non-performing loans or foreclosed assets, evaluations were made of the values of these assets with corresponding charge-offs as appropriate.

In June 2017, the loss sharing agreements for Inter Savings Bank were terminated.  In April 2016, the loss sharing agreements for Team Bank, Vantus Bank and Sun Security Bank were terminated.  Loans acquired from the FDIC related to Valley Bank did not have a loss sharing agreement.  All acquired loans were grouped into pools based on common characteristics and were recorded at their estimated fair values, which incorporated estimated credit losses at the acquisition date.  These loan pools are systematically reviewed by the Company to determine the risk of losses that may exceed those identified at the time of the acquisition.  Techniques used in determining risk of loss are similar to those used to determine the risk of loss for the legacy Great Southern Bank portfolio, with most focus being placed on those loan pools which include the larger loan relationships and those loan pools which exhibit higher risk characteristics.  Review of the acquired loan portfolio also includes review of financial information, collateral valuations and customer interaction to determine if additional reserves are warranted.

The Bank’s allowance for loan losses as a percentage of total loans, excluding acquired loans that were previously covered by the FDIC loss sharing agreements, was 1.01% and 1.04% at December 31, 2017 and December 31, 2016, respectively.

Non-performing Assets

Former TeamBank, Vantus Bank, Sun Security Bank, InterBank and Valley Bank non-performing assets, including foreclosed assets and potential problem loans, are not included in the totals or in the discussion of non-performing loans, potential problem loans and foreclosed assets below.  These assets were initially recorded at their estimated fair values as of their acquisition dates and are accounted for in pools; therefore, these loan pools are analyzed rather than the individual loans.  The performance of the loan pools acquired in the five transactions has been better than original expectations as of the acquisition dates.


85





As a result of changes in balances and composition of the loan portfolio, changes in economic and market conditions that occur from time to time, and other factors specific to a borrower's circumstances, the level of non-performing assets will fluctuate.

Non-performing assets, excluding all FDIC-assisted acquired assets, at December 31, 2017, were $27.8 million, a decrease of $11.5 million from $39.3 million at December 31, 2016.  Non-performing assets, excluding all FDIC-assisted acquired assets, as a percentage of total assets were 0.63% at December 31, 2017, compared to 0.86% at December 31, 2016.

Compared to December 31, 2016, non-performing loans decreased $2.8 million to $11.3 million at December 31, 2017, and foreclosed assets decreased $8.7 million to $16.6 million at December 31, 2017.  Non-performing consumer loans comprised $3.3 million, or 29.1%, of the total $11.3 million of non-performing loans at December 31, 2017.  Non-performing one-to four-family residential loans comprised $2.7 million, or 24.2%, of the total non-performing loans at December 31, 2017.  Non-performing commercial business loans were $2.1 million, or 18.3%, of total non-performing loans at December 31, 2017.  The decrease in non-performing commercial business loans was primarily due to one relationship totaling $2.9 million which was transferred to foreclosed assets during 2017.  Non-performing other residential loans were $1.9 million, or 16.7%, of total non-performing loans at December 31, 2017.  The increase in non-performing other residential loans was primarily due to the additional of one loan initially totaling $2.4 million, which was charged down upon being added to Non-performing Loans.  Non-performing commercial real estate loans comprised $1.2 million, or 10.9%, of total non-performing loans at December 31, 2017.  The majority of the decrease in the commercial real estate category was due to one relationship incurring charge-offs of $1.2 million during 2017, and two separate relationship with transfers to foreclosed assets totaling approximately $500,000 each.  Non-performing land development loans were $-0- at December 31, 2017.  The decrease in non-performing land development loans was primarily due to the payoff of two significant relationships.

Non-performing Loans. Activity in the non-performing loans category during the year ended December 31, 2017, was as follows:

   
Beginning
Balance,
January 1
   
Additions
   
Removed
from Non-
Performing
   
Transfers to
Potential
Problem Loans
   
Transfers to
Foreclosed
Assets
   
Charge-Offs
   
Payments
   
Ending
Balance,
December 31
 
   
(In Thousands)
 
                                                 
One- to four-family construction
 
$
   
$
381
   
$
   
$
   
$
   
$
   
$
(381
)
 
$
 
Subdivision construction
   
109
     
     
     
     
     
     
(11
)
   
98
 
Land development
   
1,718
     
4,060
     
     
     
(185
)
   
(125
)
   
(5,468
)
   
 
Commercial construction
   
     
     
     
     
     
     
     
 
One- to four-family residential
   
1,825
     
2,487
     
(36
)
   
(840
)
   
(242
)
   
(37
)
   
(437
)
   
2,720
 
Other residential
   
162
     
2,442
     
(77
)
   
     
(161
)
   
(488
)
   
(1
)
   
1,877
 
Commercial real estate
   
2,727
     
2,550
     
(394
)
   
(347
)
   
(1,060
)
   
(1,649
)
   
(601
)
   
1,226
 
Other commercial
   
4,765
     
1,256
     
     
     
(2,883
)
   
(829
)
   
(246
)
   
2,063
 
Consumer
   
2,775
     
5,923
     
(217
)
   
(329
)
   
(1,081
)
   
(2,075
)
   
(1,725
)
   
3,271
 
                                                                 
Total
 
$
14,081
   
$
19,099
   
$
(724
)
 
$
(1,516
)
 
$
(5,612
)
 
$
(5,203
)
 
$
(8,870
)
 
$
11,255
 

Commercial real estate collateral that secured one relationship, totaling $1.7 million, was partially sold, with the remaining assets transferred to foreclosed assets; therefore, the balance was reclassified from commercial real estate to commercial business in the Beginning Balance, January 1 presentation in the table above.

At December 31, 2017, the non-performing one- to four-family residential category included 28 loans, 18 of which were added during 2017.  The largest relationship in this category, which was added during 2017, included nine loans totaling $1.4 million, or 50.6% of the total category, which are collateralized by residential rental homes in the Springfield, Mo. area. The non-performing commercial business category included five loans.  The largest relationship in this category totaled $1.5 million, or 73.2% of the total category. This relationship, discussed in the paragraph above, was previously collateralized by commercial real estate which was foreclosed upon and subsequently sold.  One loan in this category, totaling $2.9 million and secured by the borrower’s interest in a condo project in Branson, Mo, was transferred to foreclosed assets during 2017.  One loan totaling $970,000 was transferred from potential problem loans during 2017.  This loan was added to potential problem loans earlier in 2017 and was subsequently transferred to non-performing loans.  The loan was charged down $470,000 and the remaining balance at December 31, 2017 was $500,000.  The loan is collateralized by the business assets of an entity in the St. Louis, Mo. area.  The non-performing other residential category included one loan, which was added during 2017.  This loan is collateralized by an apartment project in the central Missouri area and was originated in 2004.  The non-performing commercial real estate category included six loans, three of which were added during the year.  The largest relationship in this category, which was added during 2017, totaled $667,000, or 54.4% of the total category.  This loan is collateralized by commercial property in the St. Louis, Mo., area.  One relationship in this category, which included two loans, had $358,000 of charge-offs during 2017 and the remaining balance of $465,000 was transferred to foreclosed assets.  The relationship was collateralized by commercial entertainment property and other property in Branson, Mo.  One loan in this category with a balance of $498,000 was transferred to foreclosed assets during the period.  One relationship in this category, which was collateralized by a theatre property in Branson, Mo., incurred charge-offs of $1.2 million and received payments of $480,000 during the year, which paid off the remaining balance of that

86




loan.  The non-performing consumer category included 255 loans, 204 of which were added during 2017, and the majority of which are indirect used automobile loans. Compared to previous years, in 2016 and 2017 the Company experienced increased levels of delinquencies and repossessions in consumer loans, primarily indirect used automobile loans.  The non-performing land development category was zero at December 31, 2017.  During the year, one loan, which is the same relationship as one of the loans discussed in the commercial real estate category, and was collateralized by land in the Branson, Mo. area had charge-offs of $92,000 and received payments of $3.8 million, which paid off the remaining balance of that loan.  Also during 2017, one loan in this category received payments of $1.6 million, which paid off the remaining balance of that loan.

Foreclosed Assets. Of the total $22.0 million of other real estate owned at December 31, 2017, $2.1 million represents the fair value of foreclosed assets previously covered by FDIC loss sharing agreements, $1.7 million represents foreclosed assets related to Valley Bank and not previously covered by loss sharing agreements, and $1.6 million represents properties which were not acquired through foreclosure, including former branch locations that were closed and held for sale and land which was acquired for a potential branch location. The acquired foreclosed and other assets acquired in the FDIC-assisted transactions and the properties not acquired through foreclosure are not included in the following table and discussion of other real estate owned.  Because sales of foreclosed properties exceeded additions, total foreclosed assets decreased.  Activity in foreclosed assets during the year ended December 31, 2017, was as follows:

   
Beginning
Balance,
January 1
   
Additions
   
Proceeds
from Sales
   
Capitalized
Costs
   
ORE Expense
Write-Downs
   
Ending
Balance,
December 31
 
   
(In Thousands)
 
                                     
One- to four-family construction
 
$
   
$
   
$
   
$
   
$
   
$
 
Subdivision construction
   
6,360
     
350
     
(1,297
)
   
     
     
5,413
 
Land development
   
10,886
     
     
(2,431
)
   
     
(1,226
)
   
7,229
 
Commercial construction
   
     
     
     
     
     
 
One- to four-family residential
   
1,217
     
374
     
(1,470
)
   
     
(9
)
   
112
 
Other residential
   
954
     
161
     
(1,071
)
   
117
     
(21
)
   
140
 
Commercial real estate
   
3,841
     
896
     
(2,843
)
   
     
(200
)
   
1,694
 
Commercial business
   
     
2,876
     
(2,876
)
   
     
     
 
Consumer
   
1,991
     
15,728
     
(15,732
)
   
     
     
1,987
 
                                                 
Total
 
$
25,249
   
$
20,385
   
$
(27,720
)
 
$
117
   
$
(1,456
)
 
$
16,575
 

At December 31, 2017, the land development category of foreclosed assets included 17 properties, the largest of which was located in the Branson, Mo., area and had a balance of $1.2 million, or 17.2% of the total category.  One property located in the northwest Arkansas area and totaling $1.4 million was sold during 2017.  Of the total dollar amount in the land development category of foreclosed assets, 38.6% and 23.0% was located in the Branson, Mo. and the northwest Arkansas areas, respectively, including the largest property previously mentioned.  The subdivision construction category of foreclosed assets included 15 properties, the largest of which was located in the Springfield, Mo. metropolitan area and had a balance of $1.2 million, or 22.8% of the total category.  Of the total dollar amount in the subdivision construction category of foreclosed assets, 38.2% and 22.8% was located in Branson, Mo. and Springfield, Mo., respectively, including the largest property previously mentioned.  The subdivision construction category of foreclosed assets had 16 properties with total or partial sales during 2017, totaling $1.3 million.  The largest sale was a property in northwest Arkansas totaling $775,000.  The commercial real estate category of foreclosed assets included four properties.  The largest relationship in the commercial real estate category includes commercial properties in Springfield, Mo. and the surrounding area totaling $500,000, or 29.5% of the total category.  The assets of one relationship in the commercial real estate category, which included one retail property located in Georgia and one retail property located in Texas totaling $1.5 million, were sold during 2017.  One property in the commercial real estate category, which is a hotel located in the western United States totaling $1.1 million, was sold during the year.  The commercial business category of other real estate had a balance of zero as of December 31, 2017, due to the sale of the one foreclosed property which was added to the category during the year totaling $2.9 million, which was collateralized by the borrower’s interest in a condominium project in Branson, Mo.  The other residential category of foreclosed assets included one property which was added during 2017.  All five properties which were held at the beginning of the year were sold, and included in those sales were four properties which were part of the same condominium community located in Branson, Mo. totaling $843,000.  The larger amount of additions and sales under consumer loans are due to a higher volume of repossessions of automobiles, which generally are subject to a shorter repossession process.  The Company experienced increased levels of delinquencies and repossessions in indirect used automobile loans throughout 2016 and 2017.

Potential Problem Loans. Potential problem loans increased $975,000 during the year ended December 31, 2017, from $7.0 million at December 31, 2016 to $7.9 million at December 31, 2017. This increase was due to the addition of $9.7 million of loans to potential problem loans, partially offset by $5.9 million in loans transferred to the non-performing category, $1.0 million in loans removed from potential problem loans due to improvements in the credits, $72,000 in charge-offs, $89,000 in loans transferred to foreclosed assets,

87





and $1.7 million in payments on potential problem loans.  Potential problem loans are loans which management has identified through routine internal review procedures as having possible credit problems that may cause the borrowers difficulty in complying with current repayment terms. These loans are not reflected in non-performing assets, but are considered in determining the adequacy of the allowance for loan losses.  Activity in the potential problem loans category during the year ended December 31, 2017, was as follows:

   
Beginning
Balance,
January 1
   
Additions
   
Removed
from Potential
Problem
   
Transfers to
Non-
Performing
   
Transfers to
Foreclosed
Assets
   
Charge-Offs
   
Payments
   
Ending
Balance,
December 31
 
   
(In Thousands)
 
                                                 
One- to four-family construction
 
$
   
$
   
$
   
$
   
$
   
$
   
$
   
$
 
Subdivision construction
   
     
     
     
     
     
     
     
 
Land development
   
4,135
     
139
     
     
(3,980
)
   
     
     
(290
)
   
4
 
Commercial construction
   
     
     
     
     
     
     
     
 
One- to four-family residential
   
439
     
1,102
     
     
(131
)
   
(89
)
   
(72
)
   
(127
)
   
1,122
 
Other residential
   
     
     
     
     
     
     
     
 
Commercial real estate
   
2,062
     
6,569
     
(1,029
)
   
(803
)
   
     
     
(1,040
)
   
5,759
 
Other commercial
   
204
     
1,387
     
     
(970
)
   
     
     
(118
)
   
503
 
Consumer
   
122
     
561
     
(10
)
   
(28
)
   
     
     
(96
)
   
549
 
                                                                 
Total
 
$
6,962
   
$
9,758
   
$
(1,039
)
 
$
(5,912
)
 
$
(89
)
 
$
(72
)
 
$
(1,671
)
 
$
7,937
 

At December 31, 2017, the commercial real estate category of potential problem loans included three loans, all of which were part of the same customer relationship.  This relationship, totaling $5.8 million, or 100.0% of the total category, is collateralized by theatre and retail property in Branson, Mo.  This is a long-term customer of the Bank and these loans were all originated prior to 2008.  The borrower had been experiencing cash flow issues due to vacancies in some of the properties and the loans were added to potential problem loans during 2017.  $963,000 of the payments in the category related to one relationship, the remainder of which was moved to non-performing loans during 2017.  The one- to four-family residential category of potential problem loans included 16 loans, 10 of which were added during 2017.  The commercial business category of potential problem loans included five loans, one of which was added during 2017.  One loan in this category totaling $970,000 was added to potential problem loans during 2017 and then subsequently transferred to non-performing loans during the year, and is discussed above in non-performing loans.  The consumer category of potential problem loans included 43 loans, 36 of which were added during 2017.   The land development category of potential problem loans decreased from December 31, 2016 primarily due to the transfer of one loan totaling $3.8 million to the non-performing loans category, which is discussed above in non-performing loans.

Non-Interest Income

Non-interest income for the year ended December 31, 2017 was $38.5 million compared with $28.5 million for the year ended December 31, 2016. The increase of $10.0 million, or 35.1%, was primarily the result of the following items:

Gain on early termination of FDIC loss sharing agreement for Inter Savings Bank:  During 2017, the Company’s loss sharing agreement with the FDIC related to Inter Savings Bank was terminated early and the Company received a payment of $15.0 million to settle all outstanding items related to the terminated agreement.  The Company recognized a one-time gross gain in 2017 of $7.7 million related to the termination.

Amortization of income related to business acquisitions:  Because of the termination of FDIC loss sharing agreements in previous periods, the net amortization expense related to business acquisitions was $486,000 for the year ended December 31, 2017, compared to $6.4 million for the year ended December 31, 2016.  The amortization expense for the year ended December 31, 2017, consisted of the following items:  $504,000 of amortization expense related to the changes in cash flows expected to be collected from the FDIC-covered loan portfolios acquired from InterBank and $140,000 of amortization of the clawback liability. Partially offsetting the expense was income from the accretion of the discount related to the indemnification asset for the InterBank acquisition of $158,000.

Late charges and fees on loans:  Late charges and fees on loans increased $484,000 in 2017 compared to 2016.  The increase was primarily due to fees totaling $632,000 on loan payoffs received on four loan relationships during 2017.

Net gains on loan sales:  Net gains on loan sales decreased $791,000 in 2017 compared to 2016.  The decrease was due to a decrease in originations of fixed-rate loans in 2017 compared to 2016, which resulted in fewer loan sales during 2017.  Fixed rate single-family loans originated are generally subsequently sold in the secondary market.

Other income:  Other income decreased $825,000 in 2017 compared to 2016.  During 2016, the Company recognized gains of $367,000 on the sale of the two branches in Southwest Missouri.  In addition, a gain of $238,000 was recognized on sales of fixed assets unrelated to the branch sales during 2016.  There were no similar transactions during 2017.  There were net losses on the

88





disposal of certain fixed assets, including ATMs, during the year ended December 31, 2017 of approximately $114,000, with no significant losses on the disposal of fixed assets in 2016.

Net realized gains on sales of available-for-sale securities:  During 2016, the Company sold an investment held by Bancorp for a gain of $2.7 million and sold other investment securities for a net gain of $144,000.  There were no gains on sales of investments in 2017.

Non-Interest Expense

Total non-interest expense decreased $6.1 million, or 5.1%, from $120.4 million in the year ended December 31, 2016, to $114.3 million in the year ended December 31, 2017.  The Company’s efficiency ratio for the year ended December 31, 2017 was 58.99%, a decrease from 62.86% in 2016.  The improvement in the ratio for 2017 was primarily due to the decrease in non-interest expense and the increase in non-interest income (significantly impacted by the gain on the termination of the loss sharing agreements for the Inter Savings Bank FDIC-assisted transaction), partially offset by the decrease in net interest income. The Company’s ratio of non-interest expense to average assets decreased from 2.76% for the year ended December 31, 2016, to 2.56% for the year ended December 31, 2017.  The decrease in the ratio for 2017 was due to the decrease in non-interest expense and the increase in average assets in 2017 compared to 2016.  Average assets for the year ended December 31, 2017, increased $89.4 million, or 2.0%, from the year ended December 31, 2016, primarily due to organic loan growth, partially offset by decreases in investment securities.

The following were key items related to the decrease in non-interest expense for the year ended December 31, 2017 as compared to the year ended December 31, 2016:

Fifth Third Bank branch acquisition expenses:  During 2016, the Company incurred approximately $1.4 million of one-time expenses related to the acquisition of certain branches from Fifth Third Bank.  Those expenses included approximately $124,000 of compensation expense, approximately $385,000 of legal, audit and other professional fees expense, approximately $294,000 of computer license and support expense, approximately $436,000 in charges to replace former Fifth Third Bank customer checks with Great Southern Bank checks, and approximately $79,000 of travel, meals and other expenses related to the transaction.

Salaries and employee benefits:  Salaries and employee benefits decreased $343,000 from the prior year.  In 2016, the Company incurred one-time acquisition related net salary and retention bonus and other compensation expenses paid as part of the Fifth Third branch transaction totaling $124,000.  Subsequent to the transaction, some employees related to those operations left the Company and many were not replaced.  Compensation expense also decreased due to a reduction in incentive compensation for loan originators and staff due to fewer residential loan originations in 2017 than in 2016.  The Company also recently reorganized some staff functions in certain areas to operate more efficiently.  In addition, there were budgeted but unfilled positions in various areas of the Company that resulted in lower compensation costs in these areas. These decreases were partially offset by the increase of $1.1 million related to the special employee bonuses paid to all employees who were employed by the Company on December 31, 2017.  These bonuses were in response to the new federal tax reform legislation.

Net occupancy expense:  Net occupancy expense decreased $1.5 million in the year ended December 31, 2017 compared to 2016.  The decrease was primarily due to furniture, fixtures and equipment, and computer equipment which became fully depreciated, resulting in less depreciation expense during 2017.  During 2016, the Company had one-time expenses as part of the acquisition of the Fifth Third banking centers of $279,000 and increased computer license and support costs of $247,000 with no similar expenses in 2017.

Partnership tax credit:  Partnership tax credit expense decreased $751,000 in the year ended December 31, 2017 compared to 2016.  The decrease was primarily due to the end of the amortization period for some of the Company’s new market tax credits and the investment in those tax credits has been written off.

Insurance expense:  Insurance expense decreased $523,000 in the year ended December 31, 2017 compared to 2016 primarily due to a reduction in FDIC insurance premiums resulting from a change in the FDIC insurance assessment rates, which went into effect during the fourth quarter of 2016.

Postage:  Postage decreased $330,000 in 2017 from 2016.  During 2016, the Company incurred significant postage costs due to branch acquisitions and sales and the mailing of chip-enabled debit cards.

Legal, audit and other professional fees:  Legal, audit and other professional fees decreased $329,000 in 2017 from 2016 due to additional expenses in 2016 related to the Fifth Third transaction, as noted in the Fifth Third Bank branch acquisition expenses above.

Other operating expenses:  Other operating expenses decreased $1.5 million in the year ended December 31, 2017 compared to 2016.  The decrease in other operating expenses was primarily due to higher levels of debit card and check fraud losses in 2016.  In 2016, the Company experienced debit card and check fraud losses totaling $1.9 million, a significant portion of which

89




resulted from a data security breach at a national retail merchant which operates stores in many of our markets, affecting some of our debit card customers who transacted business with the merchant.  In 2017, the Company experienced debit card and check fraud losses totaling $1.0 million.  Additionally, $436,000 of the decrease in operating expenses was the charge in 2016 to replace Fifth Third customer checks as discussed above.

Provision for Income Taxes

For the years ended December 31, 2017 and 2016, the Company's effective tax rate was 26.7% and 26.7%, respectively.  These effective rates were lower than the statutory federal tax rate of 35%, due primarily to the utilization of certain investment tax credits and to tax-exempt investments and tax-exempt loans which reduced the Company’s effective tax rate.  The Company’s effective tax rate may fluctuate as it is impacted by the level and timing of the Company’s utilization of tax credits and the level of tax-exempt investments and loans and the overall level of pre-tax income.  The Company’s effective tax rate was higher in 2016 and 2017 than it had typically been in prior years due to increased net income resulting from the gain on termination of the loss sharing agreements for the Inter Savings Bank FDIC-assisted transaction (2017) and gains on the sales of investments (2016).

Based upon current accounting guidance and the utilization and recognition of timing differences, the Company recorded a net decrease in income tax expense of approximately $250,000. This net decrease in income tax expense was comprised of a $2.1 million decrease from the adjustment of net deferred tax liabilities resulting from enactment of the TCJ Act, partially offset by the impacts of other tax planning strategies implemented. This impact on the Company’s net deferred tax liabilities, which includes, among other things, the timing of recognition of various revenues and expenses, was based upon a review and analysis of the Company’s net deferred tax liabilities at December 31, 2017, as well as expected adjustments to various deferred tax assets and deferred tax liabilities in the three months and year ended December 31, 2017, including those accounted for in accumulated other comprehensive income.

Liquidity

Liquidity is a measure of the Company's ability to generate sufficient cash to meet present and future financial obligations in a timely manner through either the sale or maturity of existing assets or the acquisition of additional funds through liability management. These obligations include the credit needs of customers, funding deposit withdrawals and the day-to-day operations of the Company. Liquid assets include cash, interest-bearing deposits with financial institutions and certain investment securities and loans. As a result of the Company's management of the ability to generate liquidity primarily through liability funding, management believes that the Company maintains overall liquidity sufficient to satisfy its depositors' requirements and meet its customers' credit needs. At December 31, 2018, the Company had commitments of approximately $129.6 million to fund loan originations, $1.24 billion of unused lines of credit and unadvanced loans, and $28.9 million of outstanding letters of credit.

The following table summarizes the Company's fixed and determinable contractual obligations by payment date as of December 31, 2018. Additional information regarding these contractual obligations is discussed further in Notes 8, 9, 10, 11, 12, 13, 16 and 19 of the accompanying audited financial statements, which are included in Item 8 of this Report.

 
 
Payments Due In:
 
 
 
One Year or
Less
   
Over One to
Five
Years
   
Over Five
Years
   
Total
 
 
 
(In Thousands)
 
 
                       
Deposits without a stated maturity
 
$
2,133,596
   
$
   
$
   
$
2,133,596
 
Time and brokered certificates of deposit
   
1,215,822
     
374,145
     
1,444
     
1,591,411
 
Federal Home Loan Bank advances
   
     
     
     
 
Short-term borrowings
   
297,978
     
     
     
297,978
 
Subordinated debentures
   
     
     
25,774
     
25,774
 
Subordinated notes
   
     
     
73,842
     
73,842
 
Operating leases
   
958
     
2,483
     
837
     
4,278
 
Dividends declared but not paid
   
4,528
     
     
     
4,528
 
 
                               
 
 
$
3,652,882
   
$
376,628
   
$
101,897
   
$
4,131,407
 

90






The Company's primary sources of funds are customer deposits, FHLBank advances, other borrowings, loan repayments, unpledged securities, proceeds from sales of loans and available-for-sale securities and funds provided from operations. The Company utilizes particular sources of funds based on the comparative costs and availability at the time. The Company has from time to time chosen not to pay rates on deposits as high as the rates paid by certain of its competitors and, when believed to be appropriate, supplements deposits with less expensive alternative sources of funds.

At December 31, 2018 and 2017, the Company had these available secured lines and on-balance sheet liquidity:

 
December 31, 2018
 
December 31, 2017
Federal Home Loan Bank line
$666.8 million
 
$570.5 million
Federal Reserve Bank line
460.7 million
 
528.9 million
Interest-Bearing and Non-Interest-Bearing
             Deposits
202.7 million
 
242.3 million
Unpledged Securities
87.1 million
 
46.4 million


Statements of Cash Flows. During the years ended December 31, 2018, 2017 and 2016, the Company had positive cash flows from operating activities.  The Company experienced negative cash flows from investing activities during the years ended December 31, 2018 and 2016 and positive cash flows from investing activities during the year ended December 31, 2017.  The Company experienced positive cash flows from financing activities during the years ended December 31, 2018 and 2016 and negative cash flows from financing activities during the year ended December 31, 2017.

Cash flows from operating activities for the periods covered by the Statements of Cash Flows have been primarily related to changes in accrued and deferred assets, credits and other liabilities, the provision for loan losses, realized gains on the sale of investment securities and loans, depreciation and amortization, gains or losses on the termination of loss sharing agreements and the amortization of deferred loan origination fees and discounts (premiums) on loans and investments, all of which are non-cash or non-operating adjustments to operating cash flows. Net income adjusted for non-cash and non-operating items and the origination and sale of loans held-for-sale were the primary sources of cash flows from operating activities. Operating activities provided cash flows of $94.2 million, $62.8 million and $80.6 million during the years ended December 31, 2018, 2017 and 2016, respectively.

During the years ended December 31, 2018 and 2016, investing activities used cash of $381.3 million and $198.7 million, respectively, primarily due to the net increases and purchases of loans and investment securities and the cash paid for the sale of business units (deposits and branches in 2018), partially offset by the sales of investment securities (2016) and cash received from the purchase of business units (deposits and branches in 2016).  During the year ended December 31, 2017, investing activities provided cash of $81.4 million, primarily due to the cash received from the FDIC loss sharing termination reimbursement, proceeds from the sale of other real estate owned and the net repayment of investment securities.

Changes in cash flows from financing activities during the periods covered by the Statements of Cash Flows are primarily due to changes in deposits after interest credited, changes in FHLBank advances, changes in short-term borrowings, dividend payments to stockholders and issuance of subordinated notes (2016).  Financing activities provided cash flows of $247.6 million and $198.7 million during the years ended December 31, 2018 and 2016, respectively, primarily due to increases in customer deposit balances, net increases or decreases in various borrowings and issuance of subordinated notes (2016), partially offset by dividend payments to stockholders.  Financing activities used cash flows of $181.7 million during the year ended December 31, 2017, primarily due to reduction of customer certificate of deposit balances, net increases or decreases in various borrowings and dividend payments to stockholders.

Capital Resources

Management continuously reviews the capital position of the Company and the Bank to ensure compliance with minimum regulatory requirements, as well as to explore ways to increase capital either by retained earnings or other means.

As of December 31, 2018, total stockholders’ equity and common stockholders’ equity were each $532.0 million, or 11.4% of total assets, equivalent to a book value of $37.59 per common share.  As of December 31, 2017, total stockholders’ equity and common stockholders’ equity were each $471.7 million, or 10.7% of total assets, equivalent to a book value of $33.48 per common share.    At December 31, 2018, the Company’s tangible common equity to tangible assets ratio was 11.2% as compared to 10.5% at December 31, 2017.


91






Banks are required to maintain minimum risk-based capital ratios. These ratios compare capital, as defined by the risk-based regulations, to assets adjusted for their relative risk as defined by the regulations. Under current guidelines, which became effective January 1, 2015, banks must have a minimum common equity Tier 1 capital ratio of 4.50%, a minimum Tier 1 risk-based capital ratio of 6.00%, a minimum total risk-based capital ratio of 8.00%, and a minimum Tier 1 leverage ratio of 4.00%. To be considered "well capitalized," banks must have a minimum common equity Tier 1 capital ratio of 6.50%, a minimum Tier 1 risk-based capital ratio of 8.00%, a minimum total risk-based capital ratio of 10.00%, and a minimum Tier 1 leverage ratio of 5.00%.  On December 31, 2018, the Bank's common equity Tier 1 capital ratio was 12.4%, its Tier 1 capital ratio was 12.4%, its total capital ratio was 13.3% and its Tier 1 leverage ratio was 12.2%. As a result, as of December 31, 2018, the Bank was well capitalized, with capital ratios in excess of those required to qualify as such.  On December 31, 2017, the Bank's common equity Tier 1 capital ratio was 12.3%, its Tier 1 capital ratio was 12.3%, its total capital ratio was 13.2% and its Tier 1 leverage ratio was 11.7%. As a result, as of December 31, 2017, the Bank was well capitalized, with capital ratios in excess of those required to qualify as such.

The FRB has established capital regulations for bank holding companies that generally parallel the capital regulations for banks. On December 31, 2018, the Company's common equity Tier 1 capital ratio was 11.4%, its Tier 1 capital ratio was 11.9%, its total capital ratio was 14.4% and its Tier 1 leverage ratio was 11.7%.  To be considered well capitalized, a bank holding company must have a Tier 1 risk-based capital ratio of at least 6.00% and a total risk-based capital ratio of at least 10.00%.  As of December 31, 2018, the Company was considered well capitalized, with capital ratios in excess of those required to qualify as such. On December 31, 2017, the Company's common equity Tier 1 capital ratio was 10.9%, its Tier 1 capital ratio was 11.4%, its total capital ratio was 14.1% and its Tier 1 leverage ratio was 10.9%. As of December 31, 2017, the Company was considered well capitalized, with capital ratios in excess of those required to qualify as such.

In addition to the minimum common equity Tier 1 capital ratio, Tier 1 risk-based capital ratio and total risk-based capital ratio, the Company and the Bank have to maintain a capital conservation buffer consisting of additional common equity Tier 1 capital greater than 2.5% of risk-weighted assets above the required minimum levels in order to avoid limitations on paying dividends, repurchasing shares, and paying discretionary bonuses.  This capital conservation buffer requirement began phasing in beginning on January 1, 2016 when a buffer greater than 0.625% of risk-weighted assets was required, which amount increased by an additional 0.625% as of January 1, 2017, and increased an equal amount each year until the buffer requirement of greater than 2.5% of risk-weighted assets was fully implemented on January 1, 2019.

On August 18, 2011, the Company entered into a Small Business Lending Fund-Securities Purchase Agreement (“Purchase Agreement”) with the Secretary of the Treasury, pursuant to which the Company sold 57,943 shares of the Company’s Senior Non-Cumulative Perpetual Preferred Stock, Series A (the “SBLF Preferred Stock”) to the Secretary of the Treasury for a purchase price of $57.9 million.  The SBLF Preferred Stock was issued pursuant to Treasury’s SBLF program, a $30 billion fund established under the Small Business Jobs Act of 2010 that was created to encourage lending to small businesses by providing Tier 1 capital to qualified community banks and holding companies with assets of less than $10 billion.  As required by the SBLF Purchase Agreement, the proceeds from the sale of the SBLF Preferred Stock were used in connection with the redemption of all 58,000 shares of the Company’s preferred stock, issued to Treasury in December 2008 pursuant to Treasury’s TARP Capital Purchase Program (the “CPP”).  The shares of CPP Preferred Stock were redeemed at their liquidation amount of $1,000 per share plus the accrued but unpaid dividends to the redemption date.

The SBLF Preferred Stock qualified as Tier 1 capital.  The holders of SBLF Preferred Stock were entitled to receive noncumulative dividends, payable quarterly, on each January 1, April 1, July 1 and October 1.  The dividend rate, as a percentage of the liquidation amount, could fluctuate between one percent (1%) and five percent (5%) per annum on a quarterly basis during the first 10 quarters during which the SBLF Preferred Stock was outstanding, based upon changes in the level of “Qualified Small Business Lending” or “QSBL” (as defined in the SBLF Purchase Agreement) by the Bank over the adjusted baseline level calculated under the terms of the SBLF Preferred Stock $(249.7 million).  Based upon the increase in the Bank’s level of QSBL over the adjusted baseline level, the dividend rate had been 1.0%.  For the tenth calendar quarter through four and one-half years after issuance, the dividend rate was fixed at one percent (1%) based upon the level of qualifying loans. After four and one half years from issuance, the dividend rate would have increased to 9% (including a quarterly lending incentive fee of 0.5%).

On December 15, 2015, the Company (with the approval of its federal banking regulator) redeemed all 57,943 shares of the SBLF Preferred Stock at their liquidation amount of $1,000 per share plus accrued but unpaid dividends to the redemption date.  The redemption of the SBLF Preferred Stock was completed using internally available funds.

92





Dividends. During the year ended December 31, 2018, the Company declared common stock cash dividends of $1.20 per share (25.5% of net income per common share) and paid common stock cash dividends of $1.12 per share.  During the year ended December 31, 2017, the Company declared common stock cash dividends of $0.94 per share (25.8% of net income per common share) and paid common stock cash dividends of $0.92 per share.  The Board of Directors meets regularly to consider the level and the timing of dividend payments.  The $0.32 per share dividend declared but unpaid as of December 31, 2018, was paid to stockholders in January 2019. In addition, the Company paid preferred dividends as described below in years prior to 2016. 

While the SBLF Preferred Stock was outstanding, the terms of the SBLF Preferred Stock limited the ability of the Company to pay dividends and repurchase shares of common stock. Under the terms of the SBLF Preferred Stock, no repurchases could be effected, and no dividends could be declared or paid on preferred shares ranking pari passu with the SBLF Preferred Stock, junior preferred shares, or other junior securities (including the common stock) during the current quarter and for the next three quarters following the failure to declare and pay dividends on the SBLF Preferred Stock, except that, in any such quarter in which the dividend is paid, dividend payments on shares ranking pari passu may be paid to the extent necessary to avoid any resulting material covenant breach.

Under the terms of the SBLF Preferred Stock, the Company could only declare and pay a dividend on the common stock or other stock junior to the SBLF Preferred Stock, or repurchase shares of any such class or series of stock, if, after payment of such dividend, or after giving effect to such repurchase, (i) the dollar amount of the Company’s Tier 1 Capital would be at least equal to the “Tier 1 Dividend Threshold” and (ii) full dividends on all outstanding shares of SBLF Preferred Stock for the most recently completed dividend period have been or are contemporaneously declared and paid.  We satisfied this condition through the redemption date of the SBLF Preferred Stock.

Common Stock Repurchases and Issuances. The Company has been in various buy-back programs since May 1990. Our ability to repurchase common stock  was limited, but allowed, under the terms of the SBLF Preferred Stock as noted above, under “-Dividends” and was previously generally precluded due to our participation in the CPP from December 2008 through August 2011.  During the year ended December 31, 2018, the Company repurchased 17,542 shares of its common stock at an average price of $51.52 per share.  During the year ended December 31, 2017, the Company did not repurchase any shares of its common stock.  During the years ended December 31, 2018 and 2017, the Company issued 81,207 shares of stock at an average price of $27.60 per share and 119,147 shares of stock at an average price of $27.35 per share, respectively, to cover stock option exercises.

Management has historically utilized stock buy-back programs from time to time as long as management believed that repurchasing the stock would contribute to the overall growth of shareholder value. The number of shares of stock that will be repurchased at any particular time and the prices that will be paid are subject to many factors, several of which are outside of the control of the Company. The primary factors, however, are the number of shares available in the market from sellers at any given time, the price of the stock within the market as determined by the market and the projected impact on the Company’s earnings per share and capital.









93





Non-GAAP Financial Measures

This document contains certain financial information determined by methods other than in accordance with accounting principles generally accepted in the United States ("GAAP"). These non-GAAP financial measures include tangible common equity to tangible assets ratio.

In calculating the ratio of tangible common equity to tangible assets, we subtract period-end intangible assets from common equity and from total assets.  Management believes that the presentation of these measures excluding the impact of intangible assets provides useful supplemental information that is helpful in understanding our financial condition and results of operations, as they provide a method to assess management's success in utilizing our tangible capital as well as our capital strength.  Management also believes that providing measures that exclude balances of intangible assets, which are subjective components of valuation, facilitates the comparison of our performance with the performance of our peers.  In addition, management believes that these are standard financial measures used in the banking industry to evaluate performance.

These non-GAAP financial measures are supplemental and are not a substitute for any analysis based on GAAP financial measures. Because not all companies use the same calculation of non-GAAP measures, this presentation may not be comparable to other similarly titled measures as calculated by other companies.


Non-GAAP Reconciliation:  Ratio of Tangible Common Equity to Tangible Assets

   
December 31,
   
December 31,
   
December 31,
   
December 31,
   
December 31,
 
   
2018
   
2017
   
2016
   
2015
   
2014
 
   
(Dollars in thousands)
 
                               
Common equity at period end
 
$
531,977
   
$
471,662
   
$
429,806
   
$
398,227
   
$
361,802
 
Less:  Intangible assets at period end
   
9,288
     
10,850
     
12,500
     
5,758
     
7,508
 
Tangible common equity at period end  (a)
 
$
522,689
   
$
460,812
   
$
417,306
   
$
392,469
   
$
354,294
 
                                         
Total assets at period end
 
$
4,676,200
   
$
4,414,521
   
$
4,550,663
   
$
4,104,189
   
$
3,951,334
 
Less:  Intangible assets at period end
   
9,288
     
10,850
     
12,500
     
5,758
     
7,508
 
Tangible assets at period end (b)
 
$
4,666,912
   
$
4,403,671
   
$
4,538,163
   
$
4,098,431
   
$
3,943,826
 
                                         
Tangible common equity to tangible assets (a) / (b)
   
11.20
%
   
10.46
%
   
9.20
%
   
9.58
%
   
8.98
%







94






ITEM 7A.   QUANTITATIVE AND QUALITATIVE DISCLOSURES ABOUT MARKET RISK

Asset and Liability Management and Market Risk

A principal operating objective of the Company is to produce stable earnings by achieving a favorable interest rate spread that can be sustained during fluctuations in prevailing interest rates. The Company has sought to reduce its exposure to adverse changes in interest rates by attempting to achieve a closer match between the periods in which its interest-bearing liabilities and interest-earning assets can be expected to reprice through the origination of adjustable-rate mortgages and loans with shorter terms to maturity and the purchase of other shorter term interest-earning assets.

Our Risk When Interest Rates Change

The rates of interest we earn on assets and pay on liabilities generally are established contractually for a period of time. Market interest rates change over time. Accordingly, our results of operations, like those of other financial institutions, are impacted by changes in interest rates and the interest rate sensitivity of our assets and liabilities. The risk associated with changes in interest rates and our ability to adapt to these changes is known as interest rate risk and is our most significant market risk.

How We Measure the Risk to Us Associated with Interest Rate Changes

In an attempt to manage our exposure to changes in interest rates and comply with applicable regulations, we monitor Great Southern's interest rate risk. In monitoring interest rate risk we regularly analyze and manage assets and liabilities based on their payment streams and interest rates, the timing of their maturities and their sensitivity to actual or potential changes in market interest rates.

The ability to maximize net interest income is largely dependent upon the achievement of a positive interest rate spread that can be sustained despite fluctuations in prevailing interest rates. Interest rate sensitivity is a measure of the difference between amounts of interest-earning assets and interest-bearing liabilities which either reprice or mature within a given period of time. The difference, or the interest rate repricing "gap," provides an indication of the extent to which an institution's interest rate spread will be affected by changes in interest rates. A gap is considered positive when the amount of interest-rate sensitive assets exceeds the amount of interest-rate sensitive liabilities repricing during the same period, and is considered negative when the amount of interest-rate sensitive liabilities exceeds the amount of interest-rate sensitive assets during the same period. Generally, during a period of rising interest rates, a negative gap within shorter repricing periods would adversely affect net interest income, while a positive gap within shorter repricing periods would result in an increase in net interest income. During a period of falling interest rates, the opposite would be true. As of December 31, 2018, Great Southern's interest rate risk models indicate that, generally, rising interest rates are expected to have a positive impact on the Company's net interest income, while declining interest rates would have a negative impact on net interest income. We model various interest rate scenarios for rising and falling rates, including both parallel and non-parallel shifts in rates. The results of our modeling indicate that net interest income is not likely to be materially affected either positively or negatively in the first twelve months following a rate change, regardless of any changes in interest rates, because our portfolios are relatively well matched in a twelve-month horizon. The effects of interest rate changes, if any, are expected to be more impacting to net interest income in the 12 to 36 months following a rate change.

The current level and shape of the interest rate yield curve poses challenges for interest rate risk management. Prior to its increase of 0.25% on December 16, 2015, the FRB had last changed interest rates on December 16, 2008. This was the first rate increase since June 29, 2006.  The FRB has now also implemented rate increases of 0.25% on eight different occasions beginning December 14, 2016, with the Federal Funds rate now at 2.50%.  A substantial portion of Great Southern's loan portfolio ($1.46 billion at December 31, 2018) is tied to the one-month or three-month LIBOR index and will be subject to adjustment at least once within 90 days after December 31, 2018.  Of these loans, $1.34 billion as of December 31, 2018 had interest rate floors.  Great Southern also has a portfolio of loans ($257 million at December 31, 2018) which are tied to a "prime rate" of interest and will adjust immediately with changes to the "prime rate" of interest.

Interest rate risk exposure estimates (the sensitivity gap) are not exact measures of an institution's actual interest rate risk. They are only indicators of interest rate risk exposure produced in a simplified modeling environment designed to allow management to gauge the Bank's sensitivity to changes in interest rates. They do not necessarily indicate the impact of general interest rate movements on the Bank's net interest income because the repricing of certain categories of assets and liabilities is subject to competitive and other factors beyond the Bank's control. As a result, certain assets and liabilities indicated as maturing or otherwise repricing within a stated period may in fact mature or reprice at different times and in different amounts and cause a change, which potentially could be material, in the Bank's interest rate risk.

In order to minimize the potential for adverse effects of material and prolonged increases and decreases in interest rates on Great Southern's results of operations, Great Southern has adopted asset and liability management policies to better match the maturities and repricing terms of Great Southern's interest-earning assets and interest-bearing liabilities. Management recommends and the Board of

95





Directors sets the asset and liability policies of Great Southern which are implemented by the Asset and Liability Committee. The Asset and Liability Committee is chaired by the Chief Financial Officer and is comprised of members of Great Southern's senior management. The purpose of the Asset and Liability Committee is to communicate, coordinate and control asset/liability management consistent with Great Southern's business plan and board-approved policies. The Asset and Liability Committee establishes and monitors the volume and mix of assets and funding sources taking into account relative costs and spreads, interest rate sensitivity and liquidity needs. The objectives are to manage assets and funding sources to produce results that are consistent with liquidity, capital adequacy, growth, risk and profitability goals. The Asset and Liability Committee meets on a monthly basis to review, among other things, economic conditions and interest rate outlook, current and projected liquidity needs and capital positions and anticipated changes in the volume and mix of assets and liabilities. At each meeting, the Asset and Liability Committee recommends appropriate strategy changes based on this review. The Chief Financial Officer or his designee is responsible for reviewing and reporting on the effects of the policy implementations and strategies to the Board of Directors at their monthly meetings.

In order to manage its assets and liabilities and achieve the desired liquidity, credit quality, interest rate risk, profitability and capital targets, Great Southern has focused its strategies on originating adjustable rate loans or loans with fixed rates that mature in less than five years, and managing its deposits and borrowings to establish stable relationships with both retail customers and wholesale funding sources.

At times, depending on the level of general interest rates, the relationship between long- and short-term interest rates, market conditions and competitive factors, we may determine to increase our interest rate risk position somewhat in order to maintain or increase our net interest margin.

The Asset and Liability Committee regularly reviews interest rate risk by forecasting the impact of alternative interest rate environments on net interest income and market value of portfolio equity, which is defined as the net present value of an institution's existing assets, liabilities and off-balance sheet instruments, and evaluating such impacts against the maximum potential changes in net interest income and market value of portfolio equity that are authorized by the Board of Directors of Great Southern.

In the normal course of business, the Company may use derivative financial instruments (primarily interest rate swaps) from time to time to assist in its interest rate risk management.  In 2011, the Company began executing interest rate swaps with commercial banking customers to facilitate their respective risk management strategies.  Those interest rate swaps are simultaneously hedged by offsetting interest rate swaps that the Company executes with a third party, such that the Company minimizes its net risk exposure resulting from such transactions.  Because the interest rate swaps associated with this program do not meet the strict hedge accounting requirements, changes in the fair value of both the customer swaps and the offsetting swaps are recognized directly in earnings. These interest rate derivatives result from a service provided to certain qualifying customers and, therefore, are not used to manage interest rate risk in the Company’s assets or liabilities. The Company manages a matched book with respect to its derivative instruments in order to minimize its net risk exposure resulting from such transactions.

In 2013, the Company entered into an interest rate cap agreement related to its floating rate debt associated with its trust preferred securities. The agreement provided that the counterparty would reimburse the Company if interest rates rise above a certain threshold, thus creating a cap on the effective interest rate paid by the Company. This agreement was classified as a hedging instrument, and the effective portion of the gain or loss on the derivative was reported as a component of other comprehensive income and reclassified into earnings in the same period or periods during which the hedged transaction affects earnings.  The interest rate cap related to the $25.0 million trust preferred security terminated per its contractual terms in the third quarter of 2017.

In October 2018, the Company entered into an interest rate swap transaction as part of its ongoing interest rate management strategies to hedge the risk of its floating rate loans.  The notional amount of the swap is $400 million with a termination date of October 6, 2025.  Under the terms of the swap, the Company will receive a fixed rate of interest of 3.018% and will pay a floating rate of interest equal to one-month USD-LIBOR.  The floating rate will be reset monthly and net settlements of interest due to/from the counterparty will also occur monthly.  The floating rate of interest was 2.383% as of December 31, 2018.  Therefore, in the near term, the Company will receive net interest settlements which will be recorded as loan interest income, to the extent that the fixed rate of interest continues to exceed one-month USD-LIBOR.  If USD-LIBOR exceeds the fixed rate of interest in future periods, the Company will be required to pay net settlements to the counterparty and will record those net payments as a reduction of interest income on loans.  The effective portion of the gain or loss on the derivative is reported as a component of other comprehensive income and reclassified into earnings in the same period or periods during which the hedged transaction affected earnings.  Gains and losses on the derivative representing either hedge ineffectiveness or hedge components excluded from the assessment of effectiveness are recognized in current earnings.

The Company’s interest rate derivatives and hedging activities are discussed further in Note 17 of the accompanying audited financial statements, which are included in Item 8 of this Report.


96





The following tables illustrate the expected maturities and repricing, respectively, of the Bank's financial instruments at December 31, 2018. These schedules do not reflect the effects of possible prepayments or enforcement of due-on-sale clauses. The tables are based on information prepared in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles.

Maturities
 
 
 
December 31,
               
December 31,
 
 
 
2019
   
2020
   
2021
   
2022
   
2023
   
Thereafter
   
Total
   
2018
Fair Value
 
 
 
(Dollars In Thousands)
 
 
                                               
Financial Assets:
                                               
Interest bearing deposits
 
$
92,634
     
     
     
     
     
   
$
92,634
   
$
92,634
 
Weighted average rate
   
2.50
%
   
     
     
     
     
     
2.50
%
       
Available-for-sale debt securities(1)
 
$
15,847
   
$
17,571
   
$
6,012
   
$
1,710
   
$
13,227
   
$
189,601
   
$
243,968
   
$
243,968
 
Weighted average rate
   
4.96
%
   
5.12
%
   
4.86
%
   
5.50
%
   
3.09
%
   
2.94
%
   
3.29
%
       
Adjustable rate loans
 
$
443,238
   
$
330,228
   
$
467,422
   
$
299,033
   
$
218,671
   
$
497,982
   
$
2,256,574
   
$
2,189,440
 
Weighted average rate
   
5.44
%
   
5.52
%
   
5.29
%
   
5.37
%
   
5.31
%
   
4.15
%
   
5.12
%
       
Fixed rate loans
 
$
279,268
   
$
307,867
   
$
375,550
   
$
251,209
   
$
249,104
   
$
333,688
   
$
1,796,686
   
$
1,766,346
 
Weighted average rate
   
4.45
%
   
4.72
%
   
5.06
%
   
5.73
%
   
5.48
%
   
5.31
%
   
5.11
%
       
Federal Home Loan Bank stock
   
     
     
     
     
   
$
12,438
   
$
12,438
   
$
12,438
 
Weighted average rate
   
     
     
     
     
     
4.68
%
   
4.68
%
       
 
                                                               
    Total financial assets
 
$
830,987
   
$
655,666
   
$
848,984
   
$
551,952
   
$
481,002
   
$
1,033,709
   
$
4,402,300
         
 
                                                               
Financial Liabilities:
                                                               
Time deposits
 
$
1, 215,822
   
$
259,704
   
$
73,724
   
$
26,012
   
$
14,705
   
$
1,444
   
$
1,591,411
   
$
1,584,303
 
Weighted average rate
   
1.92
%
   
2.22
%
   
2.20
%
   
1.95
%
   
2.18
%
   
1.77
%
   
1.98
%
       
Interest-bearing demand
 
$
1,472,535
     
     
     
     
     
   
$
1,472,535
   
$
1,472,535
 
Weighted average rate
   
0.46
%
   
     
     
     
     
     
0.46
%
       
Non-interest-bearing demand
 
$
661,061
     
     
     
     
     
   
$
661,061
   
$
661,061
 
Weighted average rate
   
     
     
     
     
     
     
         
Short-term borrowings
 
$
297,978
     
     
     
     
     
   
$
297,978
   
$
297,978
 
Weighted average rate
   
1.68
%
   
     
     
     
     
     
1.68
%
       
Subordinated notes
   
     
     
     
     
   
$
75,000
   
$
75,000
   
$
75,188
 
Weighted average rate
   
     
     
     
     
     
5.55
%
   
5.55
%
       
Subordinated debentures
   
     
     
     
     
   
$
25,774
   
$
25,774
   
$
25,774
 
Weighted average rate
   
     
     
     
     
     
4.14
%
   
4.14
%
       
 
                                                               
    Total financial liabilities
 
$
3,647,396
   
$
259,704
   
$
73,724
   
$
26,012
   
$
14,705
   
$
102,218
   
$
4,123,759
         
 
_______________
(1)
Available-for-sale debt securities include approximately $192.5 million of mortgage-backed securities which pay interest and principal monthly to the Company. Of this total, $84.0 million represents securities that have variable rates of interest after a fixed interest period. These securities will experience rate changes at varying times over the next ten years. This table does not show the effect of these monthly repayments of principal or rate changes.




97




Repricing
 
 
 
December 31,
               
December 31,
 
 
 
2019
   
2020
   
2021
   
2022
   
2023
   
Thereafter
   
Total
   
2018
Fair Value
 
 
 
(Dollars In Thousands)
 
 
                                               
Financial Assets:
                                               
Interest bearing deposits
 
$
92,634
     
     
     
     
     
   
$
92,634
   
$
92,634
 
Weighted average rate
   
2.50
%
   
     
     
     
     
     
2.50
%
       
Available-for-sale debt securities(1)
 
$
43,202
   
$
17,571
   
$
12,757
   
$
24,406
   
$
36,022
   
$
110,010
   
$
243,968
   
$
243,968
 
Weighted average rate
   
3.68
%
   
5.12
%
   
3.35
%
   
2.47
%
   
2.43
%
   
3.33
%
   
3.29
%
       
Adjustable rate loans
 
$
1,983,704
   
$
87,167
   
$
43,032
   
$
11,740
   
$
32,874
   
$
98,057
   
$
2,256,574
   
$
2,189,440
 
Weighted average rate
   
5.28
%
   
3.80
%
   
4.03
%
   
3.70
%
   
4.41
%
   
3.95
%
   
5.12
%
       
Fixed rate loans
 
$
279,268
   
$
307,867
   
$
375,550
   
$
251,209
   
$
249,104
   
$
333,688
   
$
1,796,686
   
$
1,766,346
 
Weighted average rate
   
4.45
%
   
4.72
%
   
5.06
%
   
5.73
%
   
5.48
%
   
5.31
%
   
5.11
%
       
Federal Home Loan Bank stock
 
$
12,438
     
     
     
     
     
   
$
12,438
   
$
12,438
 
Weighted average rate
   
4.68
%
   
     
     
     
     
     
4.68
%
       
 
                                                               
Total financial assets
 
$
2,411,246
   
$
412,605
   
$
431,339
   
$
287,355
   
$
318,000
   
$
541,755
   
$
4,402,300
         
 
                                                               
 
                                                               
Financial Liabilities:
                                                               
Time deposits
 
$
1,215,822
   
$
259,704
   
$
73,724
   
$
26,012
   
$
14,705
   
$
1,444
   
$
1,591,411
   
$
1,584,303
 
Weighted average rate
   
1.92
%
   
2.22
%
   
2.20
%
   
1.93
%
   
2.18
%
   
1.77
%
   
1.98
%
       
Interest-bearing demand
 
$
1,472,535
     
     
     
     
     
   
$
1,472,535
   
$
1,472,535
 
Weighted average rate
   
0.46
%
   
     
     
     
     
     
0.46
%
       
Non-interest-bearing demand(2)
   
     
     
     
     
   
$
661,061
   
$
661,061
   
$
661,061
 
Weighted average rate
   
     
     
     
     
     
     
         
Short-term borrowings
 
$
297,978
     
     
     
     
     
   
$
297,978
   
$
297,978
 
Weighted average rate
   
1.68
%
   
     
     
     
     
     
1.68
%
       
Subordinated notes
   
     
     
     
     
   
$
75,000
   
$
75,000
   
$
75,188
 
Weighted average rate
   
     
     
     
     
     
5.55
%
   
5.55
%
       
Subordinated debentures
 
$
25,774
     
     
     
     
     
   
$
25,774
   
$
25,774
 
Weighted average rate
   
4.14
%
   
     
     
     
     
     
4.14
%
       
 
                                                               
Total financial liabilities
 
$
3,012,109
   
$
259,704
   
$
73,724
   
$
26,012
   
$
14,705
   
$
737,505
   
$
4,123,759
         
 
                                                               
Periodic repricing GAP
 
$
(600,863
)
 
$
152,901
   
$
357,615
   
$
261,343
   
$
303,295
   
$
(195,750
)
 
$
278,541
         
 
                                                               
Cumulative repricing GAP
 
$
(600,863
)
 
$
(447,962
)
 
$
(90,347
)
 
$
170,996
   
$
474,291
   
$
278,541
                 
 
_______________
(1)
Available-for-sale debt securities include approximately $192.5 million of mortgage-backed securities which pay interest and principal monthly to the Company. Of this total, $84.0 million represents securities that have variable rates of interest after a fixed interest period. These securities will experience rate changes at varying times over the next ten years. This table does not show the effect of these monthly repayments of principal or rate changes.
(2)
Non-interest-bearing demand is included in this table in the column labeled "Thereafter" since there is no interest rate related to these liabilities and therefore there is nothing to reprice.
 




98




ITEM 8.  FINANCIAL STATEMENTS AND SUPPLEMENTARY INFORMATION


Report of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm

Audit Committee, Board of Directors and Stockholders
Great Southern Bancorp, Inc.
Springfield, Missouri

Opinion on the Financial Statements

We have audited the accompanying consolidated statements of financial condition of Great Southern Bancorp, Inc. (the “Company”) as of December 31, 2018 and 2017, the related consolidated statements of income, comprehensive income, stockholders’ equity and cash flows for each of the years in the three-year period ended December 31, 2018, and the related notes (collectively referred to as the “financial statements”).  In our opinion, the consolidated financial statements referred to above present fairly, in all material respects, the financial position of the Company as of December 31, 2018 and 2017, and the results of its operations and its cash flows for each of the years in the three-year period ended December 31, 2018, in conformity with accounting principles generally accepted in the United States of America.

We also have audited, in accordance with the standards of the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board (United States) (PCAOB), the Company’s internal control over financial reporting as of December 31, 2018, based on Internal Control-Integrated Framework (2013) issued by the Committee of Sponsoring Organizations of the Treadway Commission (COSO) and our report dated March 7, 2019, expressed an unqualified opinion on the effectiveness of the Company’s internal control over financial reporting.

Basis for Opinion

These financial statements are the responsibility of the Company’s management.  Our responsibility is to express an opinion on the Company’s financial statements based on our audits.

We are a public accounting firm registered with the PCAOB and are required to be independent with respect to the Company in accordance with the U.S. federal securities laws and the applicable rules and regulations of the Securities and Exchange Commission and the PCAOB.

We conducted our audits in accordance with the standards of the PCAOB.  Those standards require that we plan and perform the audits to obtain reasonable assurance about whether the financial statements are free of material misstatement, whether due to error or fraud.  Our audits included performing procedures to assess the risks of material misstatement of the financial statements, whether due to error or fraud, and performing procedures that respond to those risks.  Such procedures include examining, on a test basis, evidence regarding the amounts and disclosures in the financial statements.  Our audits also included evaluating the accounting principles used and significant estimates made by management, as well as evaluating the overall presentation of the financial statements.  We believe that our audits provide a reasonable basis for our opinion.

/s/ BKD, LLP



We have served as the Company’s auditor since 1975.

Springfield, Missouri
March 7, 2019



99



Great Southern Bancorp, Inc.
Consolidated Statements of Financial Condition
December 31, 2018 and 2017
(In Thousands, Except Per Share Data)

   
2018
   
2017
 
Assets
           
Cash
 
$
110,108
   
$
115,600
 
Interest-bearing deposits in other financial institutions
   
92,634
     
126,653
 
Cash and cash equivalents
   
202,742
     
242,253
 
Available-for-sale securities
   
243,968
     
179,179
 
Held-to-maturity securities
   
     
130
 
Mortgage loans held for sale
   
1,650
     
8,203
 
Loans receivable, net of allowance for loan losses of $38,409 and $36,492 
     at December 31, 2018 and 2017, respectively
   
3,989,001
     
3,726,302
 
Interest receivable
   
13,448
     
12,338
 
Prepaid expenses and other assets
   
55,336
     
47,122
 
Other real estate owned and repossessions, net
   
8,440
     
22,002
 
Premises and equipment, net
   
132,424
     
138,018
 
Goodwill and other intangible assets
   
9,288
     
10,850
 
Federal Home Loan Bank stock
   
12,438
     
11,182
 
Current and deferred income taxes
   
7,465
     
16,942
 
Total assets
 
$
4,676,200
   
$
4,414,521
 
                 
Liabilities and Stockholders’ Equity
               
       Liabilities
               
Deposits
 
$
3,725,007
   
$
3,597,144
 
Federal Home Loan Bank advances
   
     
127,500
 
Securities sold under reverse repurchase agreements with customers
   
105,253
     
80,531
 
Short-term borrowings and other interest-bearing liabilities
   
192,725
     
16,604
 
Subordinated debentures issued to capital trust
   
25,774
     
25,774
 
Subordinated notes
   
73,842
     
73,688
 
Accrued interest payable
   
3,570
     
2,904
 
Advances from borrowers for taxes and insurance
   
5,092
     
5,319
 
Accrued expenses and other liabilities
   
12,960
     
13,395
 
Total liabilities
   
4,144,223
     
3,942,859
 
                 
Commitments and Contingencies
   
     
 
                 
Stockholders’ Equity
               
Capital stock
               
Serial preferred stock, $.01 par value; authorized 1,000,000 shares;
     issued and outstanding 2018 and 2017 – -0- shares
   
     
 
Common stock, $.01 par value; authorized 20,000,000 shares; issued
     and outstanding 2018 – 14,151,198 shares, 2017 – 14,087,533 shares
   
142
     
141
 
Additional paid-in capital
   
30,121
     
28,203
 
Retained earnings
   
492,087
     
442,077
 
Accumulated other comprehensive income, net of income taxes of $2,844
and $708 at December 31, 2018 and 2017, respectively
   
9,627
     
1,241
 
                 
Total stockholders’ equity
   
531,977
     
471,662
 
Total liabilities and stockholders’ equity
 
$
4,676,200
   
$
4,414,521
 


See Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements


100



Great Southern Bancorp, Inc.
Consolidated Statements of Income
Years Ended December 31, 2018, 2017 and 2016
(In Thousands, Except Per Share Data)

   
2018
   
2017
   
2016
 
Interest Income
                 
Loans
 
$
198,226
   
$
176,654
   
$
178,883
 
Investment securities and other
   
7,723
     
6,407
     
6,292
 
     
205,949
     
183,061
     
185,175
 
Interest Expense
                       
Deposits
   
27,957
     
20,595
     
17,387
 
Federal Home Loan Bank advances
   
3,985
     
1,516
     
1,214
 
Short-term borrowings and repurchase agreements
   
765
     
747
     
1,137
 
Subordinated debentures issued to capital trust
   
953
     
949
     
803
 
Subordinated notes
   
4,097
     
4,098
     
1,578
 
     
37,757
     
27,905
     
22,119
 
                         
Net Interest Income
   
168,192
     
155,156
     
163,056
 
Provision for Loan Losses
   
7,150
     
9,100
     
9,281
 
Net Interest Income After Provision for Loan Losses
   
161,042
     
146,056
     
153,775
 
                         
Noninterest Income
                       
Commissions
   
1,137
     
1,041
     
1,097
 
Service charges and ATM fees
   
21,695
     
21,628
     
21,666
 
Net gains on loan sales
   
1,788
     
3,150
     
3,941
 
Net realized gains on sales of available-for-sale securities
   
2
     
     
2,873
 
Late charges and fees on loans
   
1,622
     
2,231
     
1,747
 
Gain on derivative interest rate products
   
25
     
28
     
66
 
Gain on sale of business units
   
7,414
     
       
Gain (loss) on termination of loss sharing agreements
   
     
7,705
     
(584
)
Amortization of income/expense related to business acquisitions
   
     
(486
)
   
(6,351
)
Other income
   
2,535
     
3,230
     
4,055
 
     
36,218
     
38,527
     
28,510
 
                         
Noninterest Expense
                       
Salaries and employee benefits
   
60,215
     
60,034
     
60,377
 
Net occupancy expense
   
25,628
     
24,613
     
26,077
 
Postage
   
3,348
     
3,461
     
3,791
 
Insurance
   
2,674
     
2,959
     
3,482
 
Advertising
   
2,460
     
2,311
     
2,228
 
Office supplies and printing
   
1,047
     
1,446
     
1,708
 
Telephone
   
3,272
     
3,188
     
3,483
 
Legal, audit and other professional fees
   
3,423
     
2,862
     
3,191
 
Expense on other real estate and repossessions
   
4,919
     
3,929
     
4,111
 
Partnership tax credit investment amortization
   
575
     
930
     
1,681
 
Acquired deposit intangible asset amortization
   
1,562
     
1,650
     
1,910
 
Other operating expenses
   
6,187
     
6,878
     
8,388
 
     
115,310
     
114,261
     
120,427
 
                         
Income Before Income Taxes
 
81,950
   
70,322
   
61,858
 
                         
Provision for Income Taxes
   
14,841
     
18,758
     
16,516
 
                         
Net Income and Net Income Available to Common Shareholders
 
$
67,109
   
$
51,564
   
$
45,342
 
                         
Earnings Per Common Share
                       
Basic
 
$
4.75
   
$
3.67
   
$
3.26
 
                         
Diluted
 
$
4.71
   
$
3.64
   
$
3.21
 

See Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

101




Great Southern Bancorp, Inc.
Consolidated Statements of Comprehensive Income
Years Ended December 31, 2018, 2017 and 2016
(In Thousands)


   
2018
   
2017
   
2016
 
                   
Net Income
 
$
67,109
   
$
51,564
   
$
45,342
 
                         
Unrealized depreciation on available-for-sale securities, net of taxes (credit) of $(353), $(272) and $(1,346) for 2018, 2017 and 2016, respectively
   
(1,229
)
   
(478
)
   
(2,363
)
                         
Less: reclassification adjustment for gains included in net income, net of taxes (credit) of $0, $0 and $(1,043) for 2018, 2017 and 2016, respectively
   
(2
)
   
     
(1,830
)
                         
Change in fair value of cash flow hedge, net of taxes of $2,761, $93 and $50 for 2018, 2017 and 2016, respectively
   
9,345
     
161
     
87
 
                         
Other comprehensive income (loss)
   
8,114
     
(317
)
   
(4,106
)
                         
Comprehensive Income
 
$
75,223
   
$
51,247
   
$
41,236
 
                         












See Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements


102




Great Southern Bancorp, Inc.
Consolidated Statements of Stockholders’ Equity
Years Ended December 31, 2018, 2017 and 2016
(In Thousands, Except Per Share Data)

                     
Accumulated
             
                     
Other
             
         
Additional
         
Comprehensive
             
   
Common
   
Paid-in
   
Retained
   
Income
   
Treasury
       
   
Stock
   
Capital
   
Earnings
   
(Loss)
   
Stock
   
Total
 
                                     
Balance, January 1, 2016
 
$
139
   
$
24,371
   
$
368,053
   
$
5,664
   
$
   
$
398,227
 
Net income
   
     
     
45,342
     
     
     
45,342
 
Stock issued under Stock Option Plan
   
     
1,571
     
     
     
1,022
     
2,593
 
Common dividends declared, $.88 per share
   
     
     
(12,250
)
   
     
     
(12,250
)
Other comprehensive loss
   
     
     
     
(4,106
)
   
     
(4,106
)
Reclassification of treasury stock per
   Maryland law
   
1
     
     
1,021
     
     
(1,022
)
   
 
                                                 
Balance, December 31, 2016
   
140
     
25,942
     
402,166
     
1,558
     
     
429,806
 
Net income
   
     
     
51,564
     
     
     
51,564
 
Stock issued under Stock Option Plan
   
     
2,261
     
     
     
1,550
     
3,811
 
Common dividends declared, $.94 per share
   
     
     
(13,202
)
   
     
     
(13,202
)
Other comprehensive loss
   
     
     
     
(317
)
   
     
(317
)
Reclassification of treasury stock per
   Maryland law
   
1
     
     
1,549
     
     
(1,550
)
   
 
                                                 
Balance, December 31, 2017
   
141
     
28,203
     
442,077
     
1,241
     
     
471,662
 
Net income
   
     
     
67,109
     
     
     
67,109
 
Stock issued under Stock Option Plan
   
     
1,918
     
     
     
1,043
     
2,961
 
Common dividends declared, $1.20 per share
   
     
     
(16,966
)
   
     
     
(16,966
)
Purchase of the Company’s common stock
   
     
     
     
     
(903
)
   
(903
)
Reclassification of stranded tax effects resulting from
   change in Federal income tax rate
   
     
     
(272
)
   
272
     
     
 
Other comprehensive gain
   
     
     
     
8,114
     
     
8,114
 
Reclassification of treasury stock per
   Maryland law
   
1
     
     
139
     
     
(140
)
   
 
                                                 
Balance, December 31, 2018
 
$
142
   
$
30,121
   
$
492,087
   
$
9,627
   
$
   
$
531,977
 


See Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

103




Great Southern Bancorp, Inc.
Consolidated Statements of Cash Flows
Years Ended December 31, 2018, 2017 and 2016
(In Thousands)

   
2018
   
2017
   
2016
 
                   
Operating Activities
                 
Net income
 
$
67,109
   
$
51,564
   
$
45,342
 
Proceeds from sales of loans held for sale
   
92,422
     
138,659
     
156,835
 
Originations of loans held for sale
   
(83,806
)
   
(126,215
)
   
(156,036
)
Items not requiring (providing) cash
                       
Depreciation
   
9,118
     
9,120
     
9,816
 
Amortization
   
2,291
     
2,731
     
3,656
 
Compensation expense for stock option grants
   
737
     
564
     
483
 
Provision for loan losses
   
7,150
     
9,100
     
9,281
 
Net gains on loan sales
   
(1,788
)
   
(3,150
)
   
(3,941
)
Net realized gains on available-for-sale securities
   
(2
)
   
     
(2,873
)
(Gain) loss on sale of premises and equipment
   
193
     
297
     
(249
)
(Gain) loss on sale/write-down of other real estate and respossessions
   
1,886
     
(449
)
   
489
 
Gain on sale of business units
   
(7,414
)
   
     
(368
)
(Gain) loss realized on termination of loss sharing agreements
   
     
(7,705
)
   
584
 
(Accretion) amortization of deferred income, premiums, discounts and other
   
(2,918
)
   
(1,947
)
   
4,423
 
Gain on derivative interest rate products
   
(25
)
   
(28
)
   
(66
)
Deferred income taxes
    (4,450
)
   
9,423
     
(3,621
)
Changes in
                       
Interest receivable
   
(1,110
)
   
(463
)
   
(535
)
Prepaid expenses and other assets
    3,002

   
(5,227
)
   
12,655
 
Accrued expenses and other liabilities
   
280
     
1,821
     
(2,720
)
Income taxes refundable/payable
   
11,520
     
(15,278
)
   
7,484
 
                         
Net cash provided by operating activities
   
94,195
     
62,817
     
80,639
 
                         
Investing Activities
                       
Net change in loans
 
(147,945
)
 
136,596
   
(145,101
)
Purchase of loans
   
(128,038
)
   
(133,018
)
   
(145,600
)
Proceeds from sale of student loans
   
     
     
368
 
Cash received from purchase of additional business units
   
     
     
44,363
 
Cash received from FDIC loss sharing reimbursements
   
     
16,246
     
247
 
Cash paid for sale of business units
   
(50,356
)
   
     
(17,821
)
Purchase of premises and equipment
   
(9,317
)
   
(7,404
)
   
(10,878
)
Proceeds from sale of premises and equipment
   
2,328
     
565
     
1,178
 
Proceeds from sale of other real estate and repossessions
   
20,426
     
33,640
     
28,362
 
Capitalized costs on other real estate owned
   
(153
)
   
(117
)
   
(146
)
Proceeds from maturities, calls and repayments of held-to-maturity securities
   
130
     
117
     
106
 
Proceeds from sale of available-for-sale securities
   
502
     
     
55,000
 
Proceeds from maturities, calls and repayments of available-for-sale securities
   
25,734
     
36,754
     
60,827
 
Purchase of available-for-sale securities
   
(93,378
)
   
(3,852
)
   
(71,904
)
Redemption (purchase) of Federal Home Loan Bank stock
   
(1,256
)
   
1,852
     
2,269
 
                         
Net cash provided by (used in) investing activities
   
(381,323
)
   
81,379
     
(198,730
)
                         
Financing Activities
                       
Net increase (decrease) in certificates of deposit
 
242,955
   
(114,714
)
 
162,763
 
Net increase (decrease) in checking and savings accounts
   
(53,956
)
   
34,796
     
36,126
 
Proceeds from Federal Home Loan Bank advances
   
2,621,500
     
1,420,500
     
1,793,000
 
Repayments of Federal Home Loan Bank advances
   
(2,749,000
)
   
(1,324,435
)
   
(2,025,070
)
Net increase (decrease) in short‑term borrowings and other
interest-bearing liabilities
   
200,843
     
(188,888
)
   
168,546
 
Proceeds from issuance of subordinated notes
   
     
     
73,472
 
Advances from (to) borrowers for taxes and insurance
   
(227
)
   
676
     
(38
)
Purchase of the Company's common stock
   
(903
)
   
     
 
Dividends paid
   
(15,819
)
   
(12,894
)
   
(12,232
)
Stock options exercised
   
2,224
     
3,247
     
2,110
 
                         
Net cash provided by (used in) financing activities
   
247,617
     
(181,712
)
   
198,677
 
                         
Increase (Decrease) in Cash and Cash Equivalents
   
(39,511
)
   
(37,516
)
   
80,586
 
                         
Cash and Cash Equivalents, Beginning of Year
   
242,253
     
279,769
     
199,183
 
                         
Cash and Cash Equivalents, End of Year
 
$
202,742
   
$
242,253
   
$
279,769
 

See Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements


104




Great Southern Bancorp, Inc.
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements
December 31, 2018, 2017 and 2016


Note 1:
Nature of Operations and Summary of Significant Accounting Policies

Nature of Operations and Operating Segments

Great Southern Bancorp, Inc. (“GSBC” or the “Company”) operates as a one-bank holding company.  GSBC’s business primarily consists of the operations of Great Southern Bank (the “Bank”), which provides a full range of financial services to customers primarily located in Missouri, Iowa, Kansas, Minnesota, Nebraska and Arkansas.  The Bank also originates commercial loans from lending offices in Dallas, Texas, Tulsa, Okla., Chicago, Ill., Atlanta, Ga., Denver, Colo. and Omaha, Neb.  The Company and the Bank are subject to regulation by certain federal and state agencies and undergo periodic examinations by those regulatory agencies.

The Company’s banking operation is its only reportable segment.  The banking operation is principally engaged in the business of originating residential and commercial real estate loans, construction loans, commercial business loans and consumer loans and funding these loans by attracting deposits from the general public, accepting brokered deposits and borrowing from the Federal Home Loan Bank and others.  The operating results of this segment are regularly reviewed by management to make decisions about resource allocations and to assess performance.  Selected information is not presented separately for the Company’s reportable segment, as there is no material difference between that information and the corresponding information in the consolidated financial statements.

Use of Estimates

The preparation of financial statements in conformity with accounting principles generally accepted in the United States of America requires management to make estimates and assumptions that affect the reported amounts of assets and liabilities and disclosure of contingent assets and liabilities at the date of the financial statements and the reported amounts of revenues and expenses during the reporting period.  Actual results could differ from those estimates.

Material estimates that are particularly susceptible to significant change relate to the determination of the allowance for loan losses and the valuation of real estate acquired in connection with foreclosures or in satisfaction of loans, the valuation of loans acquired with indication of impairment, the valuation of the FDIC indemnification asset (prior to December 31, 2017) and other-than-temporary impairments (OTTI) and fair values of financial instruments.  In connection with the determination of the allowance for loan losses and the valuation of foreclosed assets held for sale, management obtains independent appraisals for significant properties.  The valuation of the FDIC indemnification asset was determined in relation to the fair value of assets acquired through FDIC-assisted transactions for which cash flows are monitored on an ongoing basis.  In addition, the Company considers that the determination of the carrying value of goodwill and intangible assets involves a high degree of judgment and complexity.


105





Great Southern Bancorp, Inc.
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements
December 31, 2018, 2017 and 2016



Principles of Consolidation

The consolidated financial statements include the accounts of Great Southern Bancorp, Inc., its wholly owned subsidiary, the Bank, and the Bank’s wholly owned subsidiaries, Great Southern Real Estate Development Corporation, GSB One LLC (including its wholly owned subsidiary, GSB Two LLC), Great Southern Financial Corporation, Great Southern Community Development Company, LLC (including its wholly owned subsidiary, Great Southern CDE, LLC), GS, LLC, GSSC, LLC, GSTC Investments, LLC, GS-RE Holding, LLC (including its wholly owned subsidiary, GS RE Management, LLC), GS-RE Holding II, LLC, GS-RE Holding III, LLC, VFP Conclusion Holding, LLC and VFP Conclusion Holding II, LLC.  All significant intercompany accounts and transactions have been eliminated in consolidation.

Federal Home Loan Bank Stock

Federal Home Loan Bank common stock is a required investment for institutions that are members of the Federal Home Loan Bank system.  The required investment in common stock is based on a predetermined formula, carried at cost and evaluated for impairment.

Securities

Available-for-sale securities, which include any security for which the Company has no immediate plan to sell but which may be sold in the future, are carried at fair value.  Unrealized gains and losses are recorded, net of related income tax effects, in other comprehensive income.

Held-to-maturity securities, which include any security for which the Company has the positive intent and ability to hold until maturity, are carried at historical cost adjusted for amortization of premiums and accretion of discounts.

Amortization of premiums and accretion of discounts are recorded as interest income from securities.  Realized gains and losses are recorded as net security gains (losses).  Gains and losses on sales of securities are determined on the specific-identification method.

For debt securities with fair value below carrying value when the Company does not intend to sell a debt security, and it is more likely than not the Company will not have to sell the security before recovery of its cost basis, it recognizes the credit component of an other-than-temporary impairment (“OTTI”) of a debt security in earnings and the remaining portion in other comprehensive income.  For held-to-maturity debt securities, the amount of an OTTI recorded in other comprehensive income for the noncredit portion of a previous OTTI is amortized prospectively over the remaining life of the security on the basis of the timing of future estimated cash flows of the security.

The Company’s consolidated statements of income reflect the full impairment (that is, the difference between the security’s amortized cost basis and fair value) on debt securities that the Company intends to sell or would more likely than not be required to sell before the expected recovery of the amortized cost basis.  For available-for-sale and held-to-maturity debt securities that management has no intent to sell and believes that it more likely than not will not be required to sell prior to recovery, only the credit loss component of the impairment is recognized in earnings, while the noncredit loss is recognized in accumulated other comprehensive income.  The credit loss component recognized in earnings is identified as the amount of principal cash flows not expected to be received over the remaining term of the security based on cash flow projections.

For equity securities, if any, when the Company has decided to sell an impaired available-for-sale security and the Company does not expect the fair value of the security to fully recover before the expected time of sale, the security is deemed OTTI in the period in which the decision to sell is made.  The Company recognizes an impairment loss when the impairment is deemed other-than-temporary even if a decision to sell has not been made.



106





Great Southern Bancorp, Inc.
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements
December 31, 2018, 2017 and 2016



Mortgage Loans Held for Sale

Mortgage loans originated and intended for sale in the secondary market are carried at the lower of cost or fair value in the aggregate.  Write-downs to fair value are recognized as a charge to earnings at the time the decline in value occurs.  Nonbinding forward commitments to sell individual mortgage loans are generally obtained to reduce market risk on mortgage loans in the process of origination and mortgage loans held for sale.  Gains and losses resulting from sales of mortgage loans are recognized when the respective loans are sold to investors.  Fees received from borrowers to guarantee the funding of mortgage loans held for sale and fees paid to investors to ensure the ultimate sale of such mortgage loans are recognized as income or expense when the loans are sold or when it becomes evident that the commitment will not be used.

Loans Originated by the Company

Loans that management has the intent and ability to hold for the foreseeable future or until maturity or payoff are reported at their outstanding principal balances adjusted for any charge-offs, the allowance for loan losses, any deferred fees or costs on originated loans and unamortized premiums or discounts on purchased loans.  Interest income is reported on the interest method and includes amortization of net deferred loan fees and costs over the loan term.  Past due status is based on the contractual terms of a loan.  Generally, loans are placed on nonaccrual status at 90 days past due and interest is considered a loss, unless the loan is well secured and in the process of collection.  Payments received on nonaccrual loans are applied to principal until the loans are returned to accrual status.  Loans are returned to accrual status when all payments contractually due are brought current, payment performance is sustained for a period of time, generally six months, and future payments are reasonably assured.  With the exception of consumer loans, charge-offs on loans are recorded when available information indicates a loan is not fully collectible and the loss is reasonably quantifiable.  Consumer loans are charged-off at specified delinquency dates consistent with regulatory guidelines.

Allowance for Loan Losses

The allowance for loan losses is established as losses are estimated to have occurred through a provision for loan losses charged to earnings.  Loan losses are charged against the allowance when management believes the uncollectibility of a loan balance is confirmed.  Subsequent recoveries, if any, are credited to the allowance.

The allowance for loan losses is evaluated on a regular basis by management and is based upon management’s periodic review of the collectibility of the loans in light of historical experience, the nature and volume of the loan portfolio, adverse situations that may affect the borrower’s ability to repay, estimated value of any underlying collateral and prevailing economic conditions.  This evaluation is inherently subjective as it requires estimates that are susceptible to significant revision as more information becomes available.

The allowance consists of allocated and general components.  The allocated component relates to loans that are classified as impaired.  For loans classified as impaired, an allowance is established when the discounted cash flows (or collateral value or observable market price) of the impaired loan is lower than the carrying value of that loan.  The general component covers non-classified loans and is based on historical charge-off experience and expected loss given default derived from the Company’s internal risk rating process.  Other adjustments may be made to the allowance for certain loan segments after an assessment of internal or external influences on credit quality that are not fully reflected in the historical loss or risk rating data.

A loan is considered impaired when, based on current information and events, it is probable that not all of the principal and interest due under the loan agreement will be collected in accordance with contractual terms.  For non-homogeneous loans, such as commercial loans, management determines which loans are reviewed for impairment based on information obtained by account officers, weekly past due meetings, various analyses including annual reviews of large loan relationships, calculations of loan debt coverage ratios as financial information is obtained and periodic reviews of all loans over $1.0 million.  Loans that experience insignificant payment delays and payment shortfalls generally are not classified as impaired.  Management determines the



107





Great Southern Bancorp, Inc.
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements
December 31, 2018, 2017 and 2016


significance of payment delays and payment shortfalls on a case-by-case basis, taking into consideration all of the circumstances surrounding the loan and the borrower, including the length and reasons for the delay, the borrower’s prior payment record and the amount of any collateral shortfall in relation to the principal and interest owed.

Large groups of smaller balance homogenous loans, such as consumer and residential loans, are collectively evaluated for impairment.  In accordance with regulatory guidelines, impairment in the consumer and mortgage loan portfolio is primarily identified based on past-due status.  Consumer and mortgage loans which are over 90 days past due or specifically identified as troubled debt restructurings will generally be individually evaluated for impairment.

Impairment is measured on a loan-by-loan basis for both homogeneous and non-homogeneous loans by either the present value of expected future cash flows or the fair value of the collateral if the loan is collateral dependent.  Payments made on impaired loans are treated in accordance with the accrual status of the loan.  If loans are performing in accordance with their contractual terms but the ultimate collectability of principal and interest is questionable, payments are applied to principal only.

Loans Acquired in Business Combinations

Loans acquired in business combinations under ASC Topic 805, Business Combinations, require the use of the purchase method of accounting.  Therefore, such loans are initially recorded at fair value in accordance with the fair value methodology prescribed in ASC Topic 820, Fair Value Measurements and Disclosures.  No allowance for loan losses related to the acquired loans is recorded on the acquisition date as the fair value of the loans acquired incorporates assumptions regarding credit risk.  The fair value estimates associated with the loans include estimates related to expected prepayments and the amount and timing of undiscounted expected principal, interest and other cash flows.

For acquired loans not acquired in conjunction with an FDIC-assisted transaction that are not considered to be purchased credit-impaired loans, the Company evaluates those loans acquired in accordance with the provisions of ASC Topic 310-20, Nonrefundable Fees and Other Costs.  The fair value discount on these loans is accreted into interest income over the weighted average life of the loans using a constant yield method.  These loans are not considered to be impaired loans.  The Company evaluates purchased credit-impaired loans in accordance with the provisions of ASC Topic 310-30, Loans and Debt Securities Acquired with Deteriorated Credit Quality.  Loans acquired in business combinations with evidence of credit deterioration since origination and for which it is probable that all contractually required payments will not be collected are considered to be credit impaired.  Evidence of credit quality deterioration as of the purchase dates may include information such as past-due and nonaccrual status, borrower credit scores and recent loan to value percentages.  Acquired credit-impaired loans that are accounted for under the accounting guidance for loans acquired with deteriorated credit quality are initially measured at fair value, which includes estimated future credit losses expected to be incurred over the life of the loans.

The Company evaluates all of its loans acquired in conjunction with its FDIC-assisted transactions in accordance with the provisions of ASC Topic 310-30.  For purposes of applying ASC 310-30, loans acquired in FDIC-assisted business combinations are aggregated into pools of loans with common risk characteristics.  All loans acquired in the FDIC transactions, both covered and not covered by loss sharing agreements, were deemed to be purchased credit-impaired loans as there is general evidence of credit deterioration since origination in the pools and there is some probability that not all contractually required payments will be collected.  As a result, related discounts are recognized subsequently through accretion based on changes in the expected cash flows of these acquired loans.

The expected cash flows of the acquired loan pools in excess of the fair values recorded is referred to as the accretable yield and is recognized in interest income over the remaining estimated lives of the loan pools for impaired loans accounted for under ASC Topic 310-30.  The Company continues to estimate cash flows expected to be collected on pools of loans sharing common risk characteristics, which are treated in the aggregate when applying various valuation techniques.  Increases in the Company’s cash flow expectations are recognized as



108





Great Southern Bancorp, Inc.
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements
December 31, 2018, 2017 and 2016


increases to the accretable yield while decreases are recognized as impairments through the allowance for loan losses.

FDIC Indemnification Asset

Through two FDIC-assisted transactions during 2009, one during 2011 and one during 2012, the Bank acquired certain loans and foreclosed assets which were covered under loss sharing agreements with the FDIC.  These agreements committed the FDIC to reimburse the Bank for a portion of realized losses on these covered assets.  Therefore, as of the dates of acquisitions, the Company calculated the amount of such reimbursements it expected to receive from the FDIC using the present value of anticipated cash flows from the covered assets based on the credit adjustments estimated for each pool of loans and the estimated losses on foreclosed assets.  In accordance with FASB ASC 805, each FDIC Indemnification Asset was initially recorded at its fair value, and was measured separately from the loan assets and foreclosed assets because the loss sharing agreements were not contractually embedded in them or transferrable with them in the event of disposal.  The balance of the FDIC Indemnification Asset increased and decreased as the expected and actual cash flows from the covered assets fluctuated, as loans were paid off or impaired and as loans and foreclosed assets were sold.  There were no contractual interest rates on the contractual receivables from the FDIC; however, a discount was recorded against the initial balance of the FDIC Indemnification Asset in conjunction with the fair value measurement as the receivable was to be collected over the terms of the loss sharing agreements.  This discount was accreted to income up until the termination of the loss sharing agreements.  During 2016 and 2017, the Company and the FDIC mutually agreed to terminate all of these loss sharing agreements prior to their contractual termination dates.  These acquisitions and agreements are more fully discussed in Note 4.

Other Real Estate Owned and Repossessions

Assets acquired through, or in lieu of, loan foreclosure are held for sale and are initially recorded at fair value less estimated cost to sell at the date of foreclosure, establishing a new cost basis.  Subsequent to foreclosure, valuations are periodically performed by management and the assets are carried at the lower of carrying amount or fair value less estimated cost to sell.  Revenue and expenses from operations and changes in the valuation allowance are included in net expense on foreclosed assets.  Other real estate owned also includes bank premises formerly, but no longer, used for banking, as well as property originally acquired for future expansion but no longer intended to be used for that purpose.

Premises and Equipment

Premises and equipment are stated at cost less accumulated depreciation.  Depreciation is charged to expense using the straight-line and accelerated methods over the estimated useful lives of the assets.  Leasehold improvements are capitalized and amortized using the straight-line and accelerated methods over the terms of the respective leases or the estimated useful lives of the improvements, whichever is shorter.

Long-Lived Asset Impairment

The Company evaluates the recoverability of the carrying value of long-lived assets whenever events or circumstances indicate the carrying amount may not be recoverable.  If a long-lived asset is tested for recoverability and the undiscounted estimated future cash flows expected to result from the use and eventual disposition of the asset is less than the carrying amount of the asset, the asset cost is adjusted to fair value and an impairment loss is recognized as the amount by which the carrying amount of a long-lived asset exceeds its fair value.

A valuation allowance of $1.2 million related to bank premises and furniture, fixtures and equipment was recorded during the year ended December 31, 2015, due to the Company’s announced plans to consolidate operations of 14 banking centers into other nearby Great Southern banking center locations.  The closing of these 14 facilities occurred at the close of business on January 8, 2016.  During 2016, these assets were moved from furniture, fixtures and equipment to other real estate owned.  A further valuation allowance of $430,000 related to these properties in other real estate owned not acquired through foreclosure was recorded during the year ended




109





Great Southern Bancorp, Inc.
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements
December 31, 2018, 2017 and 2016


December 31, 2016, as the Company believed that the market value of some of these properties had declined further.  No asset impairment was recognized during the years ended December 31, 2018 and 2017.  At December 31, 2018, the remaining valuation allowance related to various properties was $928,000.

Goodwill and Intangible Assets

Goodwill is evaluated annually for impairment or more frequently if impairment indicators are present.  A qualitative assessment is performed to determine whether the existence of events or circumstances leads to a determination that it is more likely than not the fair value is less than the carrying amount, including goodwill.  If, based on the evaluation, it is determined to be more likely than not that the fair value is less than the carrying value, then goodwill is tested further for impairment.  If the implied fair value of goodwill is lower than its carrying amount, a goodwill impairment is indicated and goodwill is written down to its implied fair value.  Subsequent increases in goodwill fair value are not recognized in the financial statements.

Intangible assets are being amortized on the straight-line basis generally over a period of seven years.  Such assets are periodically evaluated as to the recoverability of their carrying value.

A summary of goodwill and intangible assets is as follows:

   
December 31,
 
   
2018
   
2017
 
   
(In Thousands)
 
             
Goodwill – Branch acquisitions
 
$
5,396
   
$
5,396
 
Deposit intangibles
               
Sun Security Bank
   
     
263
 
InterBank
   
36
     
181
 
Boulevard Bank
   
275
     
397
 
Valley Bank
   
1,000
     
1,400
 
Fifth Third Bank
   
2,581
     
3,213
 
     
3,892
     
5,454
 
                 
   
$
9,288
   
$
10,850
 

Loan Servicing and Origination Fee Income

Loan servicing income represents fees earned for servicing real estate mortgage loans owned by various investors.  The fees are generally calculated on the outstanding principal balances of the loans serviced and are recorded as income when earned.  Loan origination fees, net of direct loan origination costs, are recognized as income using the level-yield method over the contractual life of the loan.

Stockholders’ Equity

The Company is incorporated in the State of Maryland.  Under Maryland law, there is no concept of “Treasury Shares.”  Instead, shares purchased by the Company constitute authorized but unissued shares under Maryland law.  Accounting principles generally accepted in the United States of America state that accounting for treasury stock shall conform to state law.  The cost of shares purchased by the Company has been allocated to common stock and retained earnings balances.

Earnings Per Common Share

Basic earnings per common share are computed based on the weighted average number of common shares outstanding during each year.  Diluted earnings per common share are computed using the weighted average common shares and all potential dilutive common shares outstanding during the period.


110





Great Southern Bancorp, Inc.
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements
December 31, 2018, 2017 and 2016

Earnings per common share (EPS) were computed as follows:

   
2018
   
2017
   
2016
 
   
(In Thousands, Except Per Share Data)
 
                   
Net income  and net income available to common shareholders
 
$
67,109
   
$
51,564
   
$
45,342
 
                         
                         
Average common shares outstanding
   
14,132
     
14,032
     
13,912
 
                         
Average common share stock options outstanding
   
128
     
148
     
229
 
                         
Average diluted common shares
   
14,260
     
14,180
     
14,141
 
                         
Earnings per common share – basic
 
$
4.75
   
$
3.67
   
$
3.26
 
                         
Earnings per common share – diluted
 
$
4.71
   
$
3.64
   
$
3.21
 
                         

Options outstanding at December 31, 2018, 2017 and 2016, to purchase 424,833, 253,711 and 108,450 shares of common stock, respectively, were not included in the computation of diluted earnings per common share for each of the years because the exercise prices of such options were greater than the average market prices of the common stock for the years ended December 31, 2018, 2017 and 2016, respectively.

Stock Compensation Plans

The Company has stock-based employee compensation plans, which are described more fully in Note 21.  In accordance with FASB ASC 718, Compensation – Stock Compensation, compensation cost related to share-based payment transactions is recognized in the Company’s consolidated financial statements based on the grant-date fair value of the award using the modified prospective transition method.  For the years ended December 31, 2018, 2017 and 2016, share-based compensation expense totaling $737,000, $564,000 and $483,000, respectively, was included in salaries and employee benefits expense in the consolidated statements of income.

Cash Equivalents

The Company considers all liquid investments with original maturities of three months or less to be cash equivalents.  At December 31, 2018 and 2017, cash equivalents consisted of interest-bearing deposits in other financial institutions.  At December 31, 2018, nearly all of the interest-bearing deposits were uninsured with nearly all of these balances held at the Federal Home Loan Bank or the Federal Reserve Bank.

Income Taxes

The Company accounts for income taxes in accordance with income tax accounting guidance (FASB ASC 740, Income Taxes).  The income tax accounting guidance results in two components of income tax expense:  current and deferred.  Current income tax expense reflects taxes to be paid or refunded for the current period by applying the provisions of the enacted tax law to the taxable income or excess of deductions over revenues.  The Company determines deferred income taxes using the liability (or balance sheet) method.  Under this method, the net deferred tax asset or liability is based on the tax effects of the differences between the book and tax bases of assets and liabilities, and enacted changes in tax rates and laws are recognized in the period in which they occur.



111





Great Southern Bancorp, Inc.
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements
December 31, 2018, 2017 and 2016

Deferred income tax expense results from changes in deferred tax assets and liabilities between periods.  Deferred tax assets are recognized if it is more likely than not, based on the technical merits, that the tax position will be realized or sustained upon examination.  The term “more likely than not” means a likelihood of more than 50 percent; the terms examined and upon examination also include resolution of the related appeals or litigation processes, if any.  A tax position that meets the more-likely-than-not recognition threshold is initially and subsequently measured as the largest amount of tax benefit that has a greater than 50 percent likelihood of being realized upon settlement with a taxing authority that has full knowledge of all relevant information.  The determination of whether or not a tax position has met the more-likely-than-not recognition threshold considers the facts, circumstances and information available at the reporting date and is subject to management’s judgment.  Deferred tax assets are reduced by a valuation allowance if, based on the weight of evidence available, it is more likely than not that some portion or all of a deferred tax asset will not be realized.  At December 31, 2018 and 2017, no valuation allowance was established.

The Company recognizes interest and penalties on income taxes as a component of income tax expense.

The Company files consolidated income tax returns with its subsidiaries.

Derivatives and Hedging Activities

FASB ASC 815, Derivatives and Hedging, provides the disclosure requirements for derivatives and hedging activities with the intent to provide users of financial statements with an enhanced understanding of: (a) how and why an entity uses derivative instruments, (b) how the entity accounts for derivative instruments and related hedged items and (c) how derivative instruments and related hedged items affect an entity’s financial position, financial performance and cash flows.  Further, qualitative disclosures are required that explain the Company’s objectives and strategies for using derivatives, as well as quantitative disclosures about the fair value of and gains and losses on derivative instruments, and disclosures about credit-risk-related contingent features in derivative instruments.  For detailed disclosures on derivatives and hedging activities, see Note 17.

As required by FASB ASC 815, the Company records all derivatives in the statement of financial condition at fair value.  The accounting for changes in the fair value of derivatives depends on the intended use of the derivative, whether the Company has elected to designate a derivative in a hedging relationship and apply hedge accounting and whether the hedging relationship has satisfied the criteria necessary to apply hedge accounting.

Restriction on Cash and Due From Banks

The Bank is required to maintain reserve funds in cash and/or on deposit with the Federal Reserve Bank.  The reserve required at December 31, 2018 and 2017, respectively, was $62.6 million and $59.1 million.

Recent Accounting Pronouncements

In August 2015, the FASB issued ASU 2015-14, Revenue from Contracts with Customers (Topic 606):  Deferral of the Effective Date, which deferred the effective date of ASU 2014-09.  In May 2014, the FASB issued ASU 2014-09, Revenue from Contracts with Customers (Topic 606): Summary and Amendments that Create Revenue from Contracts with Customers (Topic 606) and Other Assets and Deferred Costs--Contracts with Customers (Subtopic 340-40). The guidance in this Update supersedes the revenue recognition requirements in ASC Topic 605, Revenue Recognition, and most industry-specific guidance throughout the industry topics of the codification. These Updates were effective beginning January 1, 2018.  Our revenue is comprised of net interest income on financial assets and financial liabilities, which is explicitly excluded from the scope of ASU 2014-09, and non-interest income. We have determined that certain components of our non-interest income contain revenue streams which are included in the scope of these updates, such as deposit-related fees, service charges, debit card interchange fees and other charges and fees, and revenue from the sale of other real estate owned; however the adoption of these updates did not materially impact the Company’s consolidated statements of income. We adopted the guidance using the modified retrospective adoption method, and no cumulative effect adjustment to opening retained earnings was required as a result of the adoption.


112





Great Southern Bancorp, Inc.
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements
December 31, 2018, 2017 and 2016


Under ASU 2014-09, for revenue not associated with financial instruments, we apply the following steps when recognizing revenue from contracts with customers: (i) identify the contract, (ii) identify the performance obligations, (iii) determine the transaction price, (iv) allocate the transaction price to the performance obligations and (v) recognize revenue when performance obligation is satisfied. Our contracts with customers are generally short term in nature, typically due within one year or less or cancellable by us or our customer upon a short notice period. Performance obligations for our customer contracts are generally satisfied at a single point in time, typically when the transaction is complete, or over time. For performance obligations satisfied over time, we primarily use the output method, directly measuring the value of the products/services transferred to the customer, to determine when performance obligations have been satisfied. We typically receive payment from customers and recognize revenue concurrent with the satisfaction of our performance obligations. In most cases, this occurs within a single financial reporting period. For payments received in advance of the satisfaction of performance obligations, revenue recognition is deferred until such time the performance obligations have been satisfied. In cases where we have not received payment despite satisfaction of our performance obligations, we accrue an estimate of the amount due in the period our performance obligations have been satisfied. For contracts with variable components, only amounts for which collection is probable are accrued. We generally act in a principal capacity, on our own behalf, in most of our contracts with customers. In such transactions, we recognize revenue and the related costs to provide our services on a gross basis in our financial statements. In some cases, we act in an agent capacity, deriving revenue through assisting other entities in transactions with our customers. In such transactions, we recognize revenue and the related costs to provide our services on a net basis in our financial statements. These transactions primarily relate to fees derived from our customers' use of various interchange and ATM/debit card networks.

In January 2016, the FASB issued ASU No. 2016-01, Financial Instruments – Overall (Topic 825-10): Recognition and Measurement of Financial Assets and Financial Liabilities.  The Update requires investments in equity securities, except for those under the equity method of accounting, to be measured at fair value with changes in fair value recognized through net income.  The update enhances the reporting model for financial instruments to provide users of financial statements with more decision-useful information by updating certain aspects of recognition, measurement, presentation and disclosure of financial instruments. Among other changes, the update requires public business entities to use the exit price notion when measuring the fair value of financial instruments for disclosure purposes.  The Update also clarified guidance related to the valuation allowance assessment when recognizing deferred tax assets resulting from unrealized losses on available-for-sale debt securities.  The Update was effective for the Company on January 1, 2018 and did not have a material impact on the Company’s consolidated statements of financial condition or our consolidated statements of income.

In February 2016, the FASB issued ASU No. 2016-02, Leases (Topic 842) and in July 2018 FASB issued ASU No. 2018-10, Codification Improvements to Topic 842, Leases.  The amendments in this Update revise the accounting related to lessee accounting.  Under the new guidance, lessees will be required to recognize a lease liability and a right-of-use asset for all leases.  The Update was effective for the Company January 1, 2019.  Adoption of the standard requires the use of a modified retrospective transition approach for all periods presented at the time of adoption.  Based on the Company’s leases outstanding at December 31, 2018, which totaled less than 20 leased properties and no significant leased equipment, the adoption of the new standard did not have a material impact on our consolidated statements of financial condition or our consolidated statements of income, although an increase to assets and liabilities occurs at the time of adoption.  In the first quarter of 2019, the Company recognized a lease liability and a corresponding right-of-use asset for all leases of approximately $9 million based on our current lease portfolio.  Subsequent to December 31, 2018, the Company’s lease terminations, new leases and lease modifications and renewals will impact the amount of lease liability and a corresponding right-of-use asset recognized.  The Company’s leases are currently all “operating leases” as defined in the Update; therefore, no material change in the income statement presentation of lease expense is anticipated.


113





Great Southern Bancorp, Inc.
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements
December 31, 2018, 2017 and 2016



In June 2016, the FASB issued ASU No. 2016-13, Financial Instruments – Credit Losses (Topic 326).  The Update amends guidance on reporting credit losses for assets held at amortized cost basis and available for sale debt securities. For assets held at amortized cost basis, Topic 326 eliminates the probable initial recognition threshold in current GAAP and, instead, requires an entity to reflect its current estimate of all expected credit losses. This Update affects entities holding financial assets and net investment in leases that are not accounted for at fair value through net income. The amendments affect loans, debt securities, trade receivables, net investments in leases, off balance sheet credit exposures, reinsurance receivables, and any other financial assets not excluded from the scope that have the contractual right to receive cash.  For public companies, the update is effective for annual periods beginning after December 15, 2019, including interim periods within those fiscal years. Early adoption will be permitted beginning after December 15, 2018. An entity will apply the amendments in this update on a modified retrospective basis, through a cumulative-effect adjustment to retained earnings as of the beginning of the first reporting period in which the guidance is effective. The Company has formed a cross functional committee to oversee the system, data, reporting and other considerations for the purposes of meeting the requirements of this standard.  We have assessed our data and system needs and completed the upload of the necessary historical loan data to the software that will be used in meeting certain requirements of this standard.  Parallel testing of the new methodology compared to the current methodology will commence in the first quarter of 2019.  The Company is evaluating the impact of adopting the new guidance, including the implementation of new data systems to capture the information needed to comply with the new standard.  We expect to recognize a one-time cumulative effect adjustment to the allowance for loan losses as of the beginning of the first reporting period in which the new standard is effective, but cannot yet determine the magnitude of any such one-time adjustment, or the overall impact of the new guidance on the Company’s consolidated financial statements.

In August 2016, the FASB issued ASU No. 2016-15, Statement of Cash Flows (Topic 230).  The Update provides guidance on how certain cash receipts and payments are presented and classified in the statement of cash flows.  These items include: cash payments for debt prepayment or debt extinguishment costs; cash outflows for the settlement of zero-coupon debt instruments or other debt instruments with coupon interest rates that are insignificant; contingent consideration payments made after a business combination; proceeds from the settlement of insurance claims; proceeds from the settlement of corporate-owned life insurance policies, including bank-owned life insurance policies; and beneficial interests acquired in securitization transactions.  The amendments in the Update are to be applied retrospectively.  The Update was effective for the Company on January 1, 2018 and did not result in a material impact on the Company’s consolidated financial statements, including the statement of cash flows.

In October 2016, the FASB issued ASU No. 2016-16, Income Taxes (Topic 740).  The Update provides guidance on the accounting for the income tax consequences of intra-entity transfers of assets other than inventory.  Under this guidance, companies will be required to recognize the income tax consequences of an intra-entity asset transfer when the transfer occurs.  The Update was effective for the Company on January 1, 2018.  The adoption of this ASU did not have a material impact on the Company’s consolidated financial statements.

In January 2017, the FASB issued ASU No. 2017-01, Business Combinations - Clarifying the Definition of a Business (Topic 805). The amendments in this Update provide a more robust framework to use in determining when a set of assets and activities is a business. The amendments provide more consistency in applying the guidance, reduce the costs of application, and make the definition of a business more operable. The amendments in this Update were effective for the Company on January 1, 2018. The adoption of this new guidance must be applied on a prospective basis and did not have a material impact on the Company’s consolidated financial statements.

In January 2017, the FASB issued ASU No. 2017-04, Intangibles: Goodwill and Other: Simplifying the Test for Goodwill Impairment (Topic 350). To simplify the subsequent measurement of goodwill, the amendments eliminate Step 2 from the goodwill impairment test. The annual, or interim, goodwill impairment test should be performed by comparing the fair value of a reporting unit with its carrying amount and an impairment charge should be recognized for the amount by which the carrying amount exceeds the reporting unit’s fair value.  An entity still has the option to perform the qualitative assessment for a reporting unit to determine if the qualitative impairment test is necessary.  The nature of and reason for the change in accounting principle should be disclosed upon transition. The amendments in this update should be adopted for annual or any interim goodwill impairment tests in fiscal years beginning after December 15, 2019. Early adoption is permitted on testing dates after January 1, 2017.  We are currently evaluating the impact of adopting the new guidance, including consideration of early adoption, on the consolidated financial statements, but it is not expected to have a material impact.


114





Great Southern Bancorp, Inc.
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements
December 31, 2018, 2017 and 2016


In May 2017, the FASB issued ASU 2017-09, Compensation --Stock Compensation (Topic 718): Scope of Modification Accounting. The amendment provides guidance on determining which changes to the terms and conditions of share-based payment awards require an entity to apply modification accounting under Topic 7l8. The amendments clarify that modification accounting only applies to an entity if the fair value, vesting conditions, or classification of the award changes as a result of changes in the terms or conditions of a share-based payment award. The ASU should be applied prospectively to awards modified on or after the adoption date.  The guidance was effective for the Company on January 1, 2018.  The adoption of the ASU did not impact the Company’s consolidated financial statements.

In August 2017, the FASB issued ASU 2017-12, Derivatives and Hedging (Topic 815): Targeted Improvements to Accounting for Hedging Activities. The objective of ASU 2017-12 is to improve the financial reporting of hedging relationships by better aligning an entity's risk management activity with the economic objectives in undertaking those activities. In addition, the amendments in this update simplify the application of hedge accounting for preparers of financial statements, as well as improve the understandability of an entity's risk management activities being conveyed to financial statement users. The Company early adopted the ASU on a prospective basis effective October 1, 2018, and the adoption did not have a material effect on the Company’s consolidated financial statements.

In February 2018, the FASB issued ASU 2018-02, Reclassification of Certain Tax Effects from Accumulated Other Comprehensive Income (Topic 220). The amendment allows an entity to elect to reclassify the stranded tax effects resulting from the change in income tax rate from H.R.1, originally known as the “Tax Cuts and Jobs Act,” from accumulated other comprehensive income to retained earnings.  The amendments in this update are effective for periods beginning after December 15, 2018.  Early adoption is permitted.  The Company chose to early adopt ASU 2018-02 effective January 1, 2018.  The stranded tax amount related to unrealized gains and losses on available for sale securities, which was reclassified from accumulated other comprehensive income to retained earnings at the time of adoption, was $272,000.  There were no other income tax effects related to the application of the Act to be reclassified from AOCI to retained earnings.

In August 2018, the FASB issued ASU 2018-13, Fair Value Measurement (Topic 820) - Disclosure Framework-Changes to the Disclosure Requirements for Fair Value Measurement. ASU 2018-13 modifies the disclosure requirements on fair value measurements in Topic 820. The amendments in this update remove disclosures that no longer are considered cost beneficial, modify/clarify the specific requirements of certain disclosures, and add disclosure requirements identified as relevant. ASU 2018-13 is effective for periods beginning after December 15, 2019, with early adoption permitted for certain removed and modified disclosures, and is not expected to have a significant impact on our financial statements.

Note 2:
Investments in Securities

The amortized cost and fair values of securities classified as available-for-sale were as follows:

   
December 31, 2018
 
         
Gross
   
Gross
       
   
Amortized
   
Unrealized
   
Unrealized
   
Fair
 
   
Cost
   
Gains
   
Losses
   
Value
 
   
(In Thousands)
 
                         
Agency mortgage-backed securities
 
$
154,557
   
$
1,272
   
$
2,571
   
$
153,258
 
Agency collateralized mortgage obligations
   
39,024
     
250
     
14
     
39,260
 
States and political subdivisions
   
50,022
     
1,428
     
     
51,450
 
                                 
   
$
243,603
   
$
2,950
   
$
2,585
   
$
243,968
 


115





Great Southern Bancorp, Inc.
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements
December 31, 2018, 2017 and 2016



   
December 31, 2017
 
         
Gross
   
Gross
       
   
Amortized
   
Unrealized
   
Unrealized
   
Fair
 
   
Cost
   
Gains
   
Losses
   
Value
 
   
(In Thousands)
 
                         
Agency mortgage-backed securities
 
$
123,300
   
$
871
   
$
1,638
   
$
122,533
 
States and political subdivisions
   
53,930
     
2,716
     
     
56,646
 
                                 
   
$
177,230
   
$
3,587
   
$
1,638
   
$
179,179
 

At December 31, 2018, the Company’s agency mortgage-backed securities portfolio consisted of FHLMC securities totaling $37.2 million, FNMA securities totaling $92.1 million and GNMA securities totaling $23.9 million.  At December 31, 2018, agency collateralized mortgage obligations consisted of GNMA securities totaling $39.3 million, all of which are commercial multi-family fixed rate securities.  At December 31, 2018, $108.5 million of the Company’s agency mortgage-backed securities had fixed rates of interest and $84.0 million had variable rates of interest.  Of the total FNMA securities at December 31, 2018, $56.3 million are commercial multi-family fixed rate securities.

The amortized cost and fair value of available-for-sale securities at December 31, 2018, by contractual maturity, are shown below.  Expected maturities will differ from contractual maturities because issuers may have the right to call or prepay obligations with or without call or prepayment penalties.

   
Amortized
   
Fair
 
   
Cost
   
Value
 
   
(In Thousands)
 
             
After one through five years
 
$
849
   
$
919
 
After five through ten years
   
9,959
     
10,139
 
After ten years
   
39,214
     
40,392
 
Securities not due on a single maturity date
   
193,581
     
192,518
 
                 
   
$
243,603
   
$
243,968
 

The amortized cost and fair values of securities classified as held to maturity were as follows.  There were no securities classified as held to maturity at December 31, 2018:

   
December 31, 2017
 
         
Gross
   
Gross
       
   
Amortized
   
Unrealized
   
Unrealized
   
Fair
 
   
Cost
   
Gains
   
Losses
   
Value
 
   
(In Thousands)
 

                       
States and political subdivisions
 
$
130
   
$
1
   
$
   
$
131
 
                                 

116





Great Southern Bancorp, Inc.
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements
December 31, 2018, 2017 and 2016


The amortized cost and fair values of securities pledged as collateral was as follows at December 31, 2018 and 2017:

   
2018
   
2017
 
                         
   
Amortized
   
Fair
   
Amortized
   
Fair
 
   
Cost
   
Value
   
Cost
   
Value
 
   
(In Thousands)
 
                         
          Public deposits
 
$
9,482
   
$
9,802
   
$
10,958
   
$
11,490
 
          Collateralized borrowing accounts
   
148,050
     
146,337
     
120,622
     
119,776
 
          Other
   
763
     
761
     
1,579
     
1,601
 
                                 
   
$
158,295
   
$
156,900
   
$
133,159
   
$
132,867
 

Certain investments in debt securities are reported in the financial statements at an amount less than their historical cost.  Total fair value of these investments at December 31, 2018 and 2017, was approximately $95.7 million and $89.7 million, respectively, which is approximately 39.2% and 50.0% of the Company’s available-for-sale and held-to-maturity investment portfolio, respectively.

Based on evaluation of available evidence, including recent changes in market interest rates, credit rating information and information obtained from regulatory filings, management believes the declines in fair value for these debt securities are temporary.

The following table shows the Company’s gross unrealized losses and fair value, aggregated by investment category and length of time that individual securities have been in a continuous unrealized loss position at December 31, 2018 and 2017:

   
2018
 
   
Less than 12 Months
   
12 Months or More
   
Total
 
   
Fair
   
Unrealized
   
Fair
   
Unrealized
   
Fair
   
Unrealized
 
Description of Securities
 
Value
   
Losses
   
Value
   
Losses
   
Value
   
Losses
 
   
(In Thousands)
 
Agency mortgage-backed securities
 
$
11,255
   
$
(82
)
 
$
74,186
   
$
(2,489
)
 
$
85,441
   
$
(2,571
)
Agency collateralized mortgage obligations
   
9,725
     
(14
)
   
     
     
9,725
     
(14
)
States and political subdivisions
   
511
     
     
     
     
511
     
 
                                                 
   
$
21,491
   
$
(96
)
 
$
74,186
   
$
(2,489
)
 
$
95,677
   
$
(2,585
)
       



117





Great Southern Bancorp, Inc.
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements
December 31, 2018, 2017 and 2016


   
2017
 
   
Less than 12 Months
   
12 Months or More
   
Total
 
   
Fair
   
Unrealized
   
Fair
   
Unrealized
   
Fair
   
Unrealized
 
Description of Securities
 
Value
   
Losses
   
Value
   
Losses
   
Value
   
Losses
 
   
(In Thousands)
 
Agency mortgage-backed securities
 
$
33,862
   
$
(384
)
 
$
55,845
   
$
(1,254
)
 
$
89,707
   
$
(1,638
)
States and political subdivisions
   
     
     
     
     
     
 
                                                 
   
$
33,862
   
$
(384
)
 
$
55,845
   
$
(1,254
)
 
$
89,707
   
$
(1,638
)

Other-than-Temporary Impairment

Upon acquisition of a security, the Company decides whether it is within the scope of the accounting guidance for beneficial interests in securitized financial assets or will be evaluated for impairment under the accounting guidance for investments in debt and equity securities.

The accounting guidance for beneficial interests in securitized financial assets provides incremental impairment guidance for a subset of the debt securities within the scope of the guidance for investments in debt and equity securities.  For securities where the security is a beneficial interest in securitized financial assets, the Company uses the beneficial interests in securitized financial asset impairment model.  For securities where the security is not a beneficial interest in securitized financial assets, the Company uses the debt and equity securities impairment model.  The Company does not currently have securities within the scope of this guidance for beneficial interests in securitized financial assets.

The Company routinely conducts periodic reviews to identify and evaluate each investment security to determine whether an other-than-temporary impairment has occurred.  The Company considers the length of time a security has been in an unrealized loss position, the relative amount of the unrealized loss compared to the carrying value of the security, the type of security and other factors.  If certain criteria are met, the Company performs additional review and evaluation using observable market values or various inputs in economic models to determine if an unrealized loss is other than temporary.  The Company uses quoted market prices for marketable equity securities and uses broker pricing quotes based on observable inputs for equity investments that are not traded on a stock exchange.  For nonagency collateralized mortgage obligations, to determine if the unrealized loss is other than temporary, the Company projects total estimated defaults of the underlying assets (mortgages) and multiplies that calculated amount by an estimate of realizable value upon sale in the marketplace (severity) in order to determine the projected collateral loss.  The Company also evaluates any current credit enhancement underlying these securities to determine the impact on cash flows.  If the Company determines that a given security position will be subject to a write-down or loss, the Company records the expected credit loss as a charge to earnings.

During 2018, 2017 and 2016, no securities were determined to have impairment that had become other than temporary.

Credit Losses Recognized on Investments

During 2018, 2017 and 2016, there were no debt securities that have experienced fair value deterioration due to credit losses, as well as due to other market factors, but are not otherwise other-than-temporarily impaired.



118





Great Southern Bancorp, Inc.
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements
December 31, 2018, 2017 and 2016



Note 3:
Loans and Allowance for Loan Losses

Classes of loans at December 31, 2018 and 2017, included:

   
2018
   
2017
 
   
(In Thousands)
 
             
One- to four-family residential construction
 
$
26,177
   
$
20,793
 
Subdivision construction
   
13,844
     
18,062
 
Land development
   
44,492
     
43,971
 
Commercial construction
   
1,417,166
     
1,068,352
 
Owner occupied one- to four-family residential
   
276,866
     
190,515
 
Non-owner occupied one- to four-family residential
   
122,438
     
119,468
 
Commercial real estate
   
1,371,435
     
1,235,329
 
Other residential
   
784,894
     
745,645
 
Commercial business
   
322,118
     
353,351
 
Industrial revenue bonds
   
13,940
     
21,859
 
Consumer auto
   
253,528
     
357,142
 
Consumer other
   
57,350
     
63,368
 
Home equity lines of credit
   
121,352
     
115,439
 
Loans acquired and accounted for under ASC 310-30, net of discounts
   
167,651
     
209,669
 
     
4,993,251
     
4,562,963
 
Undisbursed portion of loans in process
   
(958,441
)
   
(793,669
)
Allowance for loan losses
   
(38,409
)
   
(36,492
)
Deferred loan fees and gains, net
   
(7,400
)
   
(6,500
)
   
$
3,989,001
   
$
3,726,302
 







119





Great Southern Bancorp, Inc.
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements
December 31, 2018, 2017 and 2016



Classes of loans by aging were as follows:

   
December 31, 2018
 
                                       
Total Loans
 
                                 
Total
   
> 90 Days Past
 
   
30-59 Days
   
60-89 Days
   
Over 90
   
Total Past
         
Loans
   
Due and
 
   
Past Due
   
Past Due
   
Days
   
Due
   
Current
   
Receivable
   
Still Accruing
 
   
(In Thousands)
 
One- to four-family
                                         
residential construction
 
$
   
$
   
$
   
$
   
$
26,177
   
$
26,177
   
$
 
Subdivision construction
   
     
     
     
     
13,844
     
13,844
     
 
Land development
   
13
     
     
49
     
62
     
44,430
     
44,492
     
 
Commercial construction
   
     
     
     
     
1,417,166
     
1,417,166
     
 
Owner occupied one- to four-
                                                       
family residential
   
1,431
     
806
     
1,206
     
3,443
     
273,423
     
276,866
     
 
Non-owner occupied one- to
                                                       
four-family residential
   
1,142
     
144
     
1,458
     
2,744
     
119,694
     
122,438
     
 
Commercial real estate
   
3,940
     
53
     
334
     
4,327
     
1,367,108
     
1,371,435
     
 
Other residential
   
     
     
     
     
784,894
     
784,894
     
 
Commercial business
   
72
     
54
     
1,437
     
1,563
     
320,555
     
322,118
     
 
Industrial revenue bonds
   
3
     
     
     
3
     
13,937
     
13,940
     
 
Consumer auto
   
2,596
     
722
     
1,490
     
4,808
     
248,720
     
253,528
     
 
Consumer other
   
691
     
181
     
240
     
1,112
     
56,238
     
57,350
     
 
Home equity lines of credit
   
229
     
     
86
     
315
     
121,037
     
121,352
     
 
Loans acquired and accounted for under ASC 310-30, net of discounts
   
2,195
     
1,416
     
6,827
     
10,438
     
157,213
     
167,651
     
 
     
12,312
     
3,376
     
13,127
     
28,815
     
4,964,436
     
4,993,251
     
 
Less loans acquired and
                                                       
accounted for under ASC 310-30, net of discounts
   
2,195
     
1,416
     
6,827
     
10,438
     
157,213
     
167,651
     
 
                                                         
Total
 
$
10,117
   
$
1,960
   
$
6,300
   
$
18,377
   
$
4,807,223
   
$
4,825,600
   
$
 




120





Great Southern Bancorp, Inc.
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements
December 31, 2018, 2017 and 2016




   
December 31, 2017
 
                                       
Total Loans
 
                                 
Total
   
> 90 Days
 
   
30-59 Days
   
60-89 Days
   
Over 90
   
Total Past
         
Loans
   
Past Due and
 
   
Past Due
   
Past Due
   
Days
   
Due
   
Current
   
Receivable
   
Still Accruing
 
   
(In Thousands)
 
One- to four-family
                                         
residential construction
 
$
250
   
$
   
$
   
$
250
   
$
20,543
   
$
20,793
   
$
 
Subdivision construction
   
     
     
98
     
98
     
17,964
     
18,062
     
 
Land development
   
54
     
37
     
     
91
     
43,880
     
43,971
     
 
Commercial construction
   
     
     
     
     
1,068,352
     
1,068,352
     
 
Owner occupied one- to four-
                                                       
family residential
   
1,927
     
71
     
904
     
2,902
     
187,613
     
190,515
     
 
Non-owner occupied one- to
                                                       
four-family residential
   
947
     
190
     
1,816
     
2,953
     
116,515
     
119,468
     
58
 
Commercial real estate
   
8,346
     
993
     
1,226
     
10,565
     
1,224,764
     
1,235,329
     
 
Other residential
   
540
     
353
     
1,877
     
2,770
     
742,875
     
745,645
     
 
Commercial business
   
2,623
     
1,282
     
2,063
     
5,968
     
347,383
     
353,351
     
 
Industrial revenue bonds
   
     
     
     
     
21,859
     
21,859
     
 
Consumer auto
   
5,196
     
1,230
     
2,284
     
8,710
     
348,432
     
357,142
     
12
 
Consumer other
   
464
     
64
     
557
     
1,085
     
62,283
     
63,368
     
 
Home equity lines of credit
   
58
     
     
430
     
488
     
114,951
     
115,439
     
26
 
Loans acquired and accounted
     for under ASC 310-30,
                                                       
net of discounts
   
4,449
     
1,951
     
10,675
     
17,075
     
192,594
     
209,669
     
272
 
     
24,854
     
6,171
     
21,930
     
52,955
     
4,510,008
     
4,562,963
     
368
 
Less loans acquired and accounted
     for under ASC 310-30,
                                                       
     net of discounts
   
4,449
     
1,951
     
10,675
     
17,075
     
192,594
     
209,669
     
272
 
                                                         
Total
 
$
20,405
   
$
4,220
   
$
11,255
   
$
35,880
   
$
4,317,414
   
$
4,353,294
   
$
96
 





121





Great Southern Bancorp, Inc.
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements
December 31, 2018, 2017 and 2016



Nonaccruing loans are summarized as follows:

   
December 31,
 
   
2018
   
2017
 
   
(In Thousands)
 
             
One- to four-family residential construction
 
$
   
$
 
Subdivision construction
   
49
     
98
 
Land development
   
     
 
Commercial construction
   
     
 
Owner occupied one- to four-family residential
   
1,206
     
904
 
Non-owner occupied one- to four-family
               
residential
   
1,458
     
1,758
 
Commercial real estate
   
334
     
1,226
 
Other residential
   
     
1,877
 
Commercial business
   
1,437
     
2,063
 
Industrial revenue bonds
   
     
 
Consumer auto
   
1,490
     
2,272
 
Consumer other
   
240
     
557
 
Home equity lines of credit
   
86
     
404
 
                 
Total
 
$
6,300
   
$
11,159
 









122





Great Southern Bancorp, Inc.
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements
December 31, 2018, 2017 and 2016



The following tables present the activity in the allowance for loan losses by portfolio segment for the years ended December 31, 2018, 2017 and 2016, respectively.  Also presented are the balance in the allowance for loan losses and the recorded investment in loans based on portfolio segment and impairment method as of the years ended December 31, 2018, 2017, and 2016, respectively:

   
December 31, 2018
 
   
One- to Four-
                                     
   
Family
                                     
   
Residential
                                     
   
and
   
Other
   
Commercial
   
Commercial
   
Commercial
             
   
Construction
   
Residential
   
Real Estate
   
Construction
   
Business
   
Consumer
   
Total
 
   
(In Thousands)
 
Allowance for Loan Losses
                                         
Balance, January 1, 2018
 
$
2,108
   
$
2,839
   
$
18,639
   
$
1,767
   
$
3,581
   
$
7,558
   
$
36,492
 
Provision (benefit) charged to expense
   
742
     
1,982
     
1,094
     
1,031
     
(1,613
)
   
3,914
     
7,150
 
Losses charged off
   
(62
)
   
(525
)
   
(102
)
   
(87
)
   
(1,155
)
   
(9,425
)
   
(11,356
)
Recoveries
   
334
     
417
     
172
     
394
     
755
     
4,051
     
6,123
 
                                                         
Balance,
                                                       
December 31, 2018
 
$
3,122
   
$
4,713
   
$
19,803
   
$
3,105
   
$
1,568
   
$
6,098
   
$
38,409
 
                                                         
Ending balance:
                                                       
Individually evaluated
                                                       
for impairment
 
$
694
   
$
   
$
613
   
$
   
$
309
   
$
425
   
$
2,041
 
Collectively evaluated
                                                       
for impairment
 
$
2,392
   
$
4,681
   
$
18,958
   
$
3,029
   
$
1,247
   
$
5,640
   
$
35,947
 
Loans acquired and
                                                       
accounted for under
                                                       
ASC 310-30
 
$
36
   
$
32
   
$
232
   
$
76
   
$
12
   
$
33
   
$
421
 
                                                         
Loans
                                                       
Individually evaluated
                                                       
for impairment
 
$
6,116
   
$
   
$
3,501
   
$
14
   
$
1,844
   
$
2,464
   
$
13,939
 
Collectively evaluated
                                                       
for impairment
 
$
433,209
   
$
784,894
   
$
1,367,934
   
$
1,461,644
   
$
334,214
   
$
429,766
   
$
4,811,661
 
Loans acquired and
                                                       
accounted for under
                                                       
ASC 310-30
 
$
93,841
   
$
12,790
   
$
33,620
   
$
4,093
   
$
4,347
   
$
18,960
   
$
167,651
 






123





Great Southern Bancorp, Inc.
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements
December 31, 2018, 2017 and 2016




   
December 31, 2017
 
   
One- to Four-
                                     
   
Family
                                     
   
Residential
                                     
   
and
   
Other
   
Commercial
   
Commercial
   
Commercial
             
   
Construction
   
Residential
   
Real Estate
   
Construction
   
Business
   
Consumer
   
Total
 
   
(In Thousands)
 
Allowance for Loan Losses
                                         
Balance, January 1, 2017
 
$
2,322
   
$
5,486
   
$
15,938
   
$
2,284
   
$
3,015
   
$
8,355
   
$
37,400
 
Provision (benefit) charged
  to expense
   
(158
)
   
(2,356
)
   
4,234
     
(643
)
   
1,475
     
6,548
     
9,100
 
Losses charged off
   
(165
)
   
(488
)
   
(1,656
)
   
(420
)
   
(1,489
)
   
(11,859
)
   
(16,077
)
Recoveries
   
109
     
197
     
123
     
546
     
580
     
4,514
     
6,069
 
                                                         
Balance,
                                                       
December 31, 2017
 
$
2,108
   
$
2,839
   
$
18,639
   
$
1,767
   
$
3,581
   
$
7,558
   
$
36,492
 
                                                         
Ending balance:
                                                       
Individually evaluated
                                                       
for impairment
 
$
513
   
$
   
$
599
   
$
   
$
2,140
   
$
699
   
$
3,951
 
Collectively evaluated
                                                       
for impairment
 
$
1,564
   
$
2,813
   
$
17,843
   
$
1,690
   
$
1,369
   
$
6,802
   
$
32,081
 
Loans acquired and
                                                       
accounted for under
                                                       
ASC 310-30
 
$
31
   
$
26
   
$
197
   
$
77
   
$
72
   
$
57
   
$
460
 
                                                         
Loans
                                                       
Individually evaluated
                                                       
for impairment
 
$
6,950
   
$
2,907
   
$
8,315
   
$
15
   
$
3,018
   
$
4,129
   
$
25,334
 
Collectively evaluated
                                                       
for impairment
 
$
341,888
   
$
742,738
   
$
1,227,014
   
$
1,112,308
   
$
372,192
   
$
531,820
   
$
4,327,960
 
Loans acquired and
                                                       
accounted for under
                                                       
ASC 310-30
 
$
120,295
   
$
14,877
   
$
39,210
   
$
3,806
   
$
5,275
   
$
26,206
   
$
209,669
 







124





Great Southern Bancorp, Inc.
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements
December 31, 2018, 2017 and 2016




   
December 31, 2016
 
   
One- to Four-
                                     
   
Family
                                     
   
Residential
                                     
   
and
   
Other
   
Commercial
   
Commercial
   
Commercial
             
   
Construction
   
Residential
   
Real Estate
   
Construction
   
Business
   
Consumer
   
Total
 
   
(In Thousands)
 
Allowance for Loan Losses
                                         
Balance, January 1, 2016
 
$
4,900
   
$
3,190
   
$
14,738
   
$
3,019
   
$
4,203
   
$
8,099
   
$
38,149
 
Provision (benefit) charged
   to expense
   
(2,407
)
   
2,260
     
5,632
     
(827
)
   
(926
)
   
5,549
     
9,281
 
Losses charged off
   
(229
)
   
(16
)
   
(5,653
)
   
(31
)
   
(589
)
   
(8,751
)
   
(15,269
)
Recoveries
   
58
     
52
     
1,221
     
123
     
327
     
3,458
     
5,239
 
                                                         
Balance,
                                                       
December 31, 2016
 
$
2,322
   
$
5,486
   
$
15,938
   
$
2,284
   
$
3,015
   
$
8,355
   
$
37,400
 
                                                         
Ending balance:
                                                       
Individually evaluated
                                                       
for impairment
 
$
570
   
$
   
$
2,209
   
$
1,291
   
$
1,295
   
$
997
   
$
6,362
 
Collectively evaluated
                                                       
for impairment
 
$
1,628
   
$
5,396
   
$
13,507
   
$
953
   
$
1,681
   
$
7,248
   
$
30,413
 
Loans acquired and
                                                       
accounted for under
                                                       
ASC 310-30
 
$
124
   
$
90
   
$
222
   
$
40
   
$
39
   
$
110
   
$
625
 
                                                         
Loans
                                                       
Individually evaluated
                                                       
for impairment
 
$
6,015
   
$
3,812
   
$
10,507
   
$
6,023
   
$
4,539
   
$
3,385
   
$
34,281
 
Collectively evaluated
                                                       
for impairment
 
$
370,172
   
$
659,566
   
$
1,176,399
   
$
825,215
   
$
369,154
   
$
669,602
   
$
4,070,108
 
Loans acquired and
                                                       
accounted for under
                                                       
ASC 310-30
 
$
155,378
   
$
29,600
   
$
54,208
   
$
2,191
   
$
6,429
   
$
35,353
   
$
283,159
 


The portfolio segments used in the preceding three tables correspond to the loan classes used in all other tables in Note 3 as follows:

The one- to four-family residential and construction segment includes the one- to four-family residential construction, subdivision construction, owner occupied one- to four-family residential and non-owner occupied one- to four-family residential classes.

The other residential segment corresponds to the other residential class.


The commercial real estate segment includes the commercial real estate and industrial revenue bonds classes.

The commercial construction segment includes the land development and commercial construction classes.

The commercial business segment corresponds to the commercial business class.

The consumer segment includes the consumer auto, consumer other and home equity lines of credit classes.




125





Great Southern Bancorp, Inc.
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements
December 31, 2018, 2017 and 2016



The weighted average interest rate on loans receivable at December 31, 2018 and 2017, was 5.16% and 4.74%, respectively.

Loans serviced for others are not included in the accompanying consolidated statements of financial condition.  The unpaid principal balance of loans serviced for others at December 31, 2018, was $260.2 million, consisting of $181.5 million of commercial loan participations sold to other financial institutions and $78.7 million of residential mortgage loans sold.  The unpaid principal balance of loans serviced for others at December 31, 2017, was $254.0 million, consisting of $164.8 million of commercial loan participations sold to other financial institutions and $89.2 million of residential mortgage loans sold.  In addition, available lines of credit on these loans were $121.0 million and $37.8 million at December 31, 2018 and 2017, respectively.

A loan is considered impaired, in accordance with the impairment accounting guidance (FASB ASC 310-10-35-16) when, based on current information and events, it is probable the Company will be unable to collect all amounts due from the borrower in accordance with the contractual terms of the loan.  Impaired loans include not only nonperforming loans but also loans modified in troubled debt restructurings where concessions have been granted to borrowers experiencing financial difficulties.

The following summarizes information regarding impaired loans at and during the years ended December 31, 2018, 2017 and 2016:

         
Year Ended
 
   
December 31, 2018
   
December 31, 2018
 
                     
Average
       
         
Unpaid
         
Investment
   
Interest
 
   
Recorded
   
Principal
   
Specific
   
in Impaired
   
Income
 
   
Balance
   
Balance
   
Allowance
   
Loans
   
Recognized
 
   
(In Thousands)
 
                               
One- to four-family residential construction
 
$
   
$
   
$
   
$
   
$
 
Subdivision construction
   
318
     
318
     
105
     
321
     
17
 
Land development
   
14
     
18
     
     
14
     
1
 
Commercial construction
   
     
     
     
     
 
Owner occupied one- to four-family
                                       
residential
   
3,576
     
3,926
     
285
     
3,406
     
197
 
Non-owner occupied one- to four-family
                                       
residential
   
2,222
     
2,519
     
304
     
2,870
     
158
 
Commercial real estate
   
3,501
     
3,665
     
613
     
6,216
     
337
 
Other residential
   
     
     
     
1,026
     
20
 
Commercial business
   
1,844
     
2,207
     
309
     
2,932
     
362
 
Industrial revenue bonds
   
     
     
     
     
 
Consumer auto
   
1,874
     
2,114
     
336
     
2,069
     
167
 
Consumer other
   
479
     
684
     
72
     
738
     
59
 
Home equity lines of credit
   
111
     
128
     
17
     
412
     
28
 
                                         
Total
 
$
13,939
   
$
15,579
   
$
2,041
   
$
20,004
   
$
1,346
 





126





Great Southern Bancorp, Inc.
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements
December 31, 2018, 2017 and 2016




         
Year Ended
 
   
December 31, 2017
   
December 31, 2017
 
                     
Average
       
         
Unpaid
         
Investment
   
Interest
 
   
Recorded
   
Principal
   
Specific
   
in Impaired
   
Income
 
   
Balance
   
Balance
   
Allowance
   
Loans
   
Recognized
 
   
(In Thousands)
 
                               
One- to four-family residential construction
 
$
   
$
   
$
   
$
193
   
$
 
Subdivision construction
   
349
     
367
     
114
     
584
     
22
 
Land development
   
15
     
18
     
     
1,793
     
24
 
Commercial construction
   
     
     
     
     
 
Owner occupied one- to four-family
                                       
residential
   
3,405
     
3,723
     
331
     
3,405
     
166
 
Non-owner occupied one- to four-family
                                       
residential
   
3,196
     
3,465
     
68
     
2,419
     
165
 
Commercial real estate
   
8,315
     
8,490
     
599
     
9,075
     
567
 
Other residential
   
2,907
     
2,907
     
     
3,553
     
147
 
Commercial business
   
3,018
     
4,222
     
2,140
     
5,384
     
173
 
Industrial revenue bonds
   
     
     
     
     
 
Consumer auto
   
2,713
     
2,898
     
484
     
2,383
     
222
 
Consumer other
   
825
     
917
     
124
     
906
     
69
 
Home equity lines of credit
   
591
     
648
     
91
     
498
     
33
 
                                         
Total
 
$
25,334
   
$
27,655
   
$
3,951
   
$
30,193
   
$
1,588
 

         
Year Ended
 
   
December 31, 2016
   
December 31, 2016
 
                     
Average
       
         
Unpaid
         
Investment
   
Interest
 
   
Recorded
   
Principal
   
Specific
   
in Impaired
   
Income
 
   
Balance
   
Balance
   
Allowance
   
Loans
   
Recognized
 
   
(In Thousands)
 
                               
One- to four-family residential construction
 
$
   
$
   
$
   
$
   
$
 
Subdivision construction
   
818
     
829
     
131
     
948
     
46
 
Land development
   
6,023
     
6,120
     
1,291
     
8,020
     
304
 
Commercial construction
   
     
     
     
     
 
Owner occupied one- to four-family
                                       
residential
   
3,290
     
3,555
     
374
     
3,267
     
182
 
Non-owner occupied one- to four-family
                                       
residential
   
1,907
     
2,177
     
65
     
1,886
     
113
 
Commercial real estate
   
10,507
     
12,121
     
2,209
     
23,928
     
984
 
Other residential
   
3,812
     
3,812
     
     
6,813
     
258
 
Commercial business
   
4,539
     
4,652
     
1,295
     
2,542
     
185
 
Industrial revenue bonds
   
     
     
     
     
 
Consumer auto
   
2,097
     
2,178
     
629
     
1,307
     
141
 
Consumer other
   
812
     
887
     
244
     
884
     
70
 
Home equity lines of credit
   
476
     
492
     
124
     
417
     
32
 
                                         
Total
 
$
34,281
   
$
36,823
   
$
6,362
   
$
50,012
   
$
2,315
 


127





Great Southern Bancorp, Inc.
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements
December 31, 2018, 2017 and 2016



At December 31, 2018, $8.4 million of impaired loans had specific valuation allowances totaling $2.0 million.  At December 31, 2017, $12.7 million of impaired loans had specific valuation allowances totaling $4.0 million.  At December 31, 2016, $18.1 million of impaired loans had specific valuation allowances totaling $6.4 million.  For impaired loans which were nonaccruing, interest of approximately $1.0 million, $1.2 million and $1.5 million would have been recognized on an accrual basis during the years ended December 31, 2018, 2017 and 2016, respectively.

Included in certain loan categories in the impaired loans are troubled debt restructurings that were classified as impaired.  Troubled debt restructurings are loans that are modified by granting concessions to borrowers experiencing financial difficulties.  These concessions could include a reduction in the interest rate on the loan, payment extensions, forgiveness of principal, forbearance or other actions intended to maximize collection.  The types of concessions made are factored into the estimation of the allowance for loan losses for troubled debt restructurings primarily using a discounted cash flows or collateral adequacy approach.

The following table presents newly restructured loans during 2018 and 2017 by type of modification:

   
2018
 
                     
Total
 
   
Interest Only
   
Term
   
Combination
   
Modification
 
   
(In Thousands)
 
             
Mortgage loans on real estate:
                       
Residential one-to-four family
 
$
1,348
   
$
   
$
   
$
1,348
 
Construction and land development
   
     
31
     
     
31
 
Commercial
   
     
     
106
     
106
 
Consumer
   
     
535
     
     
535
 
                                 
   
$
1,348
   
$
566
   
$
106
   
$
2,020
 

   
2017
 
                     
Total
 
   
Interest Only
   
Term
   
Combination
   
Modification
 
   
(In Thousands)
 
             
Mortgage loans on real estate:
                       
Commercial
 
$
   
$
   
$
5,759
   
$
5,759
 
Commercial business
   
     
16
     
274
     
290
 
Consumer
   
     
245
     
     
245
 
                                 
   
$
   
$
261
   
$
6,033
   
$
6,294
 





128





Great Southern Bancorp, Inc.
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements
December 31, 2018, 2017 and 2016


At December 31, 2018, the Company had $6.9 million of loans that were modified in troubled debt restructurings and impaired, as follows:  $283,000 of construction and land development loans, $3.9 million of single family residential mortgage loans, $1.3 million of commercial real estate loans, $548,000 of commercial business loans and $803,000 of consumer loans.  Of the total troubled debt restructurings at December 31, 2018, $4.7 million were accruing interest and $2.5 million were classified as substandard using the Company’s internal grading system which is described below. The Company had no troubled debt restructurings which were modified in the previous 12 months and subsequently defaulted during the year ended December 31, 2018.  When loans modified as troubled debt restructuring have subsequent payment defaults, the defaults are factored into the determination of the allowance for loan losses to ensure specific valuation allowances reflect amounts considered uncollectible.  At December 31, 2017, the Company had $15.0 million of loans that were modified in troubled debt restructurings and impaired, as follows:  $266,000 of construction and land development loans, $6.2 million of single family and multi-family residential mortgage loans, $7.1 million of commercial real estate loans, $867,000 million of commercial business loans and $617,000 of consumer loans.  Of the total troubled debt restructurings at December 31, 2017, $12.3 million were accruing interest and $8.8 million were classified as substandard using the Company’s internal grading system. During the year ended December 31, 2018, borrowers with loans designated as troubled debt restructurings totaling $87,000, all of which consisted of consumer loans, met the criteria for placement back on accrual status.  This criteria is generally a minimum of six months of consistent and timely payment performance under original or modified terms.

The Company reviews the credit quality of its loan portfolio using an internal grading system that classifies loans as “Satisfactory,” “Watch,” “Special Mention,” “Substandard” and “Doubtful.”  Loans classified as watch are being monitored because of indications of potential weaknesses or deficiencies that may require future classification as special mention or substandard.  Special mention loans possess potential weaknesses that deserve management’s close attention but do not expose the Bank to a degree of risk that warrants substandard classification.  Substandard loans are characterized by the distinct possibility that the Bank will sustain some loss if certain deficiencies are not corrected.  Doubtful loans are those having all the weaknesses inherent to those classified Substandard with the added characteristics that the weaknesses make collection or liquidation in full, on the basis of currently existing facts, conditions and values, highly questionable and improbable.  Loans not meeting any of the criteria previously described are considered satisfactory.  The FDIC-assisted acquired loans are evaluated using this internal grading system.  These loans are accounted for in pools.   Minimal adverse classification in these acquired loan pools was identified as of December 31, 2018 and 2017, respectively.  See Note 4 for further discussion of the acquired loan pools and termination of the loss sharing agreements.

The Company evaluates the loan risk internal grading system definitions and allowance for loan loss methodology on an ongoing basis.  The general component of the allowance for loan losses is affected by several factors, including, but not limited to, average historical losses, average life of the loans, the current composition of the loan portfolio, current and expected economic conditions, collateral values and internal risk ratings.  Management considers all these factors in determining the adequacy of the Company’s allowance for loan losses.  No significant changes were made to the loan risk grading system definitions and allowance for loan loss methodology during the past year.






129





Great Southern Bancorp, Inc.
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements
December 31, 2018, 2017 and 2016



The loan grading system is presented by loan class below:

   
December 31, 2018
 
               
Special
                   
   
Satisfactory
   
Watch
   
Mention
   
Substandard
   
Doubtful
   
Total
 
   
(In Thousands)
 
One- to four-family residential
                                   
construction
 
$
25,803
   
$
374
   
$
   
$
   
$
   
$
26,177
 
Subdivision construction
   
12,077
     
1,718
     
     
49
     
     
13,844
 
Land development
   
39,892
     
4,600
     
     
     
     
44,492
 
Commercial construction
   
1,417,166
     
     
     
     
     
1,417,166
 
Owner occupied one- to-four-
                                               
family residential
   
274,661
     
43
     
     
2,162
     
     
276,866
 
Non-owner occupied one- to-
                                               
four-family residential
   
119,951
     
941
     
     
1,546
     
     
122,438
 
Commercial real estate
   
1,357,987
     
11,061
     
     
2,387
     
     
1,371,435
 
Other residential
   
784,393
     
501
     
     
     
     
784,894
 
Commercial business
   
315,518
     
5,163
     
     
1,437
     
     
322,118
 
Industrial revenue bonds
   
13,940
     
     
     
     
     
13,940
 
Consumer auto
   
251,824
     
116
     
     
1,588
     
     
253,528
 
Consumer other
   
56,859
     
157
     
     
334
     
     
57,350
 
Home equity lines of credit
   
121,134
     
118
     
     
100
     
     
121,352
 
Loans acquired and accounted
                                               
for under ASC 310-30,
                                               
net of discounts
   
167,632
     
     
     
19
     
     
167,651
 
                                                 
Total
 
$
4,958,837
   
$
24,792
   
$
   
$
9,622
   
$
   
$
4,993,251
 








130





Great Southern Bancorp, Inc.
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements
December 31, 2018, 2017 and 2016




   
December 31, 2017
 
               
Special
                   
   
Satisfactory
   
Watch
   
Mention
   
Substandard
   
Doubtful
   
Total
 
   
(In Thousands)
 
One- to four-family residential
                                   
construction
 
$
20,275
   
$
518
   
$
   
$
   
$
   
$
20,793
 
Subdivision construction
   
15,602
     
2,362
     
     
98
     
     
18,062
 
Land development
   
39,171
     
4,800
     
     
     
     
43,971
 
Commercial construction
   
1,068,352
     
     
     
     
     
1,068,352
 
Owner occupied one- to-four-
                                               
family residential
   
188,706
     
     
     
1,809
     
     
190,515
 
Non-owner occupied one- to-
                                               
four-family residential
   
117,103
     
389
     
     
1,976
     
     
119,468
 
Commercial real estate
   
1,218,431
     
9,909
     
     
6,989
     
     
1,235,329
 
Other residential
   
742,237
     
1,532
     
     
1,876
     
     
745,645
 
Commercial business
   
344,479
     
6,306
     
     
2,066
     
500
     
353,351
 
Industrial revenue bonds
   
21,859
     
     
     
     
     
21,859
 
Consumer auto
   
354,588
     
     
     
2,554
     
     
357,142
 
Consumer other
   
62,682
     
     
     
686
     
     
63,368
 
Home equity lines of credit
   
114,860
     
     
     
579
     
     
115,439
 
Loans acquired and accounted
                                               
for under ASC 310-30,
                                               
net of discounts
   
209,657
     
     
     
12
     
     
209,669
 
                                                 
Total
 
$
4,518,002
   
$
25,816
   
$
   
$
18,645
   
$
500
   
$
4,562,963
 

Certain of the Bank’s real estate loans are pledged as collateral for borrowings as set forth in Notes 9 and 11.

Certain directors and executive officers of the Company and the Bank are customers of and had transactions with the Bank in the ordinary course of business.  Except for the interest rates on loans secured by personal residences, in the opinion of management, all loans included in such transactions were made on substantially the same terms as those prevailing at the time for comparable transactions with unrelated parties.  Generally, residential first mortgage loans and home equity lines of credit to all employees and directors have been granted at interest rates equal to the Bank’s cost of funds, subject to annual adjustments in the case of residential first mortgage loans and monthly adjustments in the case of home equity lines of credit.  At December 31, 2018 and 2017, loans outstanding to these directors and executive officers are summarized as follows:

   
2018
   
2017
 
   
(In Thousands)
 
             
Balance, beginning of year
 
$
40,041
   
$
24,793
 
New loans
   
17,141
     
19,734
 
Payments
   
(28,165
)
   
(4,486
)
                 
Balance, end of year
 
$
29,017
   
$
40,041
 



131





Great Southern Bancorp, Inc.
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements
December 31, 2018, 2017 and 2016





Note 4:
Acquired Loans, Loss Sharing Agreements and FDIC Indemnification Assets

TeamBank

On March 20, 2009, Great Southern Bank entered into a purchase and assumption agreement with loss share with the Federal Deposit Insurance Corporation (FDIC) to assume all of the deposits (excluding brokered deposits) and acquire certain assets of TeamBank, N.A., a full service commercial bank headquartered in Paola, Kansas.

The loans, commitments and foreclosed assets purchased in the TeamBank transaction were covered by a loss sharing agreement between the FDIC and Great Southern Bank.  This agreement originally was to extend for ten years for 1-4 family real estate loans and for five years for other loans.  The five-year period ended March 31, 2014 and the ten-year period was terminated early, effective April 26, 2016, by mutual agreement of Great Southern Bank and the FDIC.  See “Loss Sharing Agreements” below. Based upon the acquisition date fair values of the net assets acquired, no goodwill was recorded.

Vantus Bank

On September 4, 2009, Great Southern Bank entered into a purchase and assumption agreement with loss share with the FDIC to assume all of the deposits and acquire certain assets of Vantus Bank, a full service thrift headquartered in Sioux City, Iowa.

The loans, commitments and foreclosed assets purchased in the Vantus Bank transaction were covered by a loss sharing agreement between the FDIC and Great Southern Bank.  This agreement originally was to extend for ten years for 1-4 family real estate loans and for five years for other loans.  The five-year period ended September 30, 2014 and the ten-year period was terminated early, effective April 26, 2016, by mutual agreement of Great Southern Bank and the FDIC.  See “Loss Sharing Agreements” below.  Based upon the acquisition date fair values of the net assets acquired, no goodwill was recorded.

Sun Security Bank

On October 7, 2011, Great Southern Bank entered into a purchase and assumption agreement with loss share with the FDIC to assume all of the deposits and acquire certain assets of Sun Security Bank, a full service bank headquartered in Ellington, Missouri.

The loans and foreclosed assets purchased in the Sun Security Bank transaction were covered by a loss sharing agreement between the FDIC and Great Southern Bank.  This agreement originally was to extend for ten years for 1-4 family real estate loans and for five years for other loans but was terminated early, effective April 26, 2016, by mutual agreement of Great Southern Bank and the FDIC.  See “Loss Sharing Agreements” below.  Based upon the acquisition date fair values of the net assets acquired, no goodwill was recorded.

InterBank

On April 27, 2012, Great Southern Bank entered into a purchase and assumption agreement with loss share with the FDIC to assume all of the deposits and acquire certain assets of Inter Savings Bank, FSB (“InterBank”), a full service bank headquartered in Maple Grove, Minnesota.

The loans and foreclosed assets purchased in the InterBank transaction were covered by a loss sharing agreement between the FDIC and Great Southern Bank.  This agreement originally was to extend for ten years for 1-4 family real estate loans and for five years for other loans but was terminated early, effective June 9, 2017, by mutual agreement of Great Southern Bank and the FDIC.  See “Loss Sharing Agreements” below.  Based upon the acquisition date fair values of the net assets acquired, no goodwill was recorded.  A premium was recorded in conjunction with the fair value of the acquired loans and the amount amortized to yield during 2018, 2017 and 2016 was $175,000, $269,000 and $359,000, respectively.




132





Great Southern Bancorp, Inc.
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements
December 31, 2018, 2017 and 2016



Valley Bank

On June 20, 2014, Great Southern Bank entered into a purchase and assumption agreement with the FDIC to purchase a substantial portion of the loans and investment securities, as well as certain other assets, and assume all of the deposits, as well as certain other liabilities, of Valley Bank, a full-service bank headquartered in Moline, Illinois, with significant operations in Iowa. This transaction did not include a loss sharing agreement.

Based upon the acquisition date fair values of the net assets acquired, no goodwill was recorded.  A premium was recorded in conjunction with the fair value of the acquired loans and the amount amortized to yield during 2018, 2017 and 2016 was $11,000, $217,000 and $491,000, respectively.

Loss Sharing Agreements

On April 26, 2016, Great Southern Bank executed an agreement with the FDIC to terminate the loss sharing agreements for Team Bank, Vantus Bank and Sun Security Bank, effective immediately.  The agreement required the FDIC to pay $4.4 million to settle all outstanding items related to the terminated loss sharing agreements.  As a result of entering into the termination agreement, assets that were covered by the terminated loss sharing agreements were reclassified as non-covered assets effective April 26, 2016.  All rights and obligations of the Bank and the FDIC under the terminated loss sharing agreements, including the settlement of all existing loss sharing and expense reimbursement claims, have been resolved and terminated.

On June 9, 2017, Great Southern Bank executed an agreement with the FDIC to terminate the loss sharing agreements for InterBank, effective immediately.  Pursuant to the termination agreement, the FDIC paid $15.0 million to the Bank to settle all outstanding items related to the terminated loss sharing agreements.  The Company recorded a pre-tax gain on the termination of $7.7 million.  As a result of entering into the termination agreement, assets that were covered by the terminated loss sharing arrangements were reclassified as non-covered assets effective June 9, 2017.  All rights and obligations of the Bank and the FDIC under the terminated loss sharing agreements, including the settlement of all existing loss sharing and expense reimbursement claims, have been resolved and terminated.

The termination of the loss sharing agreements for the TeamBank, Vantus Bank, Sun Security Bank and InterBank transactions has no impact on the yields for the loans that were previously covered under these agreements. All post-termination recoveries, gains, losses and expenses related to these previously covered assets are recognized entirely by Great Southern Bank since the FDIC no longer shares in such gains or losses. Accordingly, the Company’s earnings are positively impacted to the extent the Company recognizes gains on any sales or recoveries in excess of the carrying value of such assets. Similarly, the Company’s future earnings are negatively impacted to the extent the Company recognizes expenses, losses or charge-offs related to such assets.

Fair Value and Expected Cash Flows

At the time of these acquisitions, the Company determined the fair value of the loan portfolios based on several assumptions.  Factors considered in the valuations were projected cash flows for the loans, type of loan and related collateral, classification status, fixed or variable interest rate, term of loan, current discount rates and whether or not the loan was amortizing.  Loans were grouped together according to similar characteristics and were treated in the aggregate when applying various valuation techniques.  Management also estimated the amount of credit losses that were expected to be realized for the loan portfolios.  The discounted cash flow approach was used to value each pool of loans.  For non-performing loans, fair value was estimated by calculating the present value of the recoverable cash flows using a discount rate based on comparable corporate bond rates.  This valuation of the acquired loans is a significant component leading to the valuation of the loss sharing assets recorded.

The amount of the estimated cash flows expected to be received from the acquired loan pools in excess of the fair values recorded for the loan pools is referred to as the accretable yield.  The accretable yield is recognized as interest income over the estimated lives of the loans.  The Company continues to evaluate the fair value of the loans including cash flows expected to be collected.  Increases in the Company’s cash flow expectations are recognized as increases to the accretable yield while decreases are recognized as impairments through the



133





Great Southern Bancorp, Inc.
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements
December 31, 2018, 2017 and 2016



allowance for loan losses.  During the years ended December 31, 2018, 2017 and 2016, improvements in expected cash flows related to the acquired loan portfolios resulted in adjustments to the accretable yield to be spread over the estimated remaining lives of the loans on a level-yield basis.  The increases in expected cash flows also reduced the amount of expected reimbursements under the loss sharing agreements, when applicable, until they were terminated or expired.  This resulted in corresponding adjustments during the years ended December 31, 2017 and 2016, to the indemnification assets (which during 2017 were reduced to $-0- due to the termination of the loss sharing agreements).  The amounts of these adjustments were as follows:

   
Year Ended December 31,
 
   
2018
   
2017
   
2016
 
   
(In Thousands)
 
Increase in accretable yield due to increased
                 
cash flow expectations
 
$
5,202
   
$
1,333
   
$
10,598
 
Decrease in FDIC indemnification asset
                       
as a result of accretable yield increase
   
     
     
(2,744
)


The adjustments, along with those made in previous years, impacted the Company’s Consolidated Statements of Income as follows:

   
Year Ended December 31,
 
   
2018
   
2017
   
2016
 
   
(In Thousands)
 
Interest income
 
$
5,134
   
$
5,014
   
$
16,393
 
Noninterest income
   
     
(634
)
   
(7,033
)
                         
Net impact to pre-tax income
 
$
5,134
   
$
4,380
   
$
9,360
 

On an on-going basis the Company estimates the cash flows expected to be collected from the acquired loan pools.  For each of the loan portfolios acquired, the cash flow estimates have increased, based on payment histories and reduced credit loss expectations.  This resulted in increased income that has been spread, on a level-yield basis, over the remaining expected lives of the loan pools (and, therefore, has decreased over time).  Increases in expected cash flows also reduced the amount of expected reimbursements under the loss sharing agreements with the FDIC (when such agreements were in place), which were recorded as indemnification assets.  Therefore, the expected indemnification assets had also been reduced, resulting in adjustments to be amortized on a comparable basis over the remainder of the loss sharing agreements or the remaining expected lives of the loan pools, whichever was shorter.  Additional estimated cash flows totaling approximately $5.2 million were recorded in the year ended December 31, 2018 related to these loan pools, with no corresponding reduction in expected reimbursement from the FDIC as the remaining loss sharing agreements were terminated in 2017.

Because these adjustments to accretable yield will be recognized generally over the remaining lives of the loan pools, they will impact future periods as well. As of December 31, 2018, the remaining accretable yield adjustment that will affect interest income was $2.7 million.  Of the remaining adjustments affecting interest income, we expect to recognize $2.0 million of interest income during 2019. Additional adjustments to accretable yield may be recorded in future periods from the FDIC-assisted transactions, as the Company continues to estimate expected cash flows from the acquired loan pools.  As there is no longer, nor will there be in the future, indemnification asset amortization related to TeamBank, Vantus Bank, Sun Security Bank or InterBank due to the termination or expiration of the related loss sharing agreements for those transactions, there is no remaining indemnification asset or related adjustments that will affect non-interest income (expense).


134





Great Southern Bancorp, Inc.
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements
December 31, 2018, 2017 and 2016


TeamBank Loans and Foreclosed Assets.  The following tables present the balances of the acquired loans and foreclosed assets related to the TeamBank transaction at December 31, 2018 and 2017.  Through December 31, 2018, gross loan balances (due from borrowers) were reduced approximately $425.6 million since the transaction date because of $293.0 million of repayments by the borrowers, $61.7 million of transfers to foreclosed assets and $70.9 million of charge-downs to customer loan balances.  Based upon the collectability analyses performed at the time of the acquisition, we expected certain levels of foreclosures and charge-offs and actual results have been better than our expectations.  As a result, cash flows expected to be received from the acquired loan pools have increased, resulting in adjustments that were made to the related accretable yield as described above.

   
December 31, 2018
 
         
Foreclosed
 
   
Loans
   
Assets
 
   
(In Thousands)
 
Initial basis for loss sharing determination,
           
net of activity since acquisition date
 
$
10,602
   
$
 
Reclassification from nonaccretable discount
               
to accretable discount due to change in
   
(399
)
   
 
expected losses (net of accretion to date)
               
Original estimated fair value of assets, net of
               
activity since acquisition date
   
(10,106
)
   
 
                 
Expected loss remaining
 
$
97
   
$
 

   
December 31, 2017
 
         
Foreclosed
 
   
Loans
   
Assets
 
   
(In Thousands)
 
Initial basis for loss sharing determination,
           
net of activity since acquisition date
 
$
13,668
   
$
35
 
Reclassification from nonaccretable discount
               
to accretable discount due to change in
   
(589
)
   
 
expected losses (net of accretion to date)
               
Original estimated fair value of assets, net of
               
activity since acquisition date
   
(12,948
)
   
(35
)
                 
Expected loss remaining
 
$
131
   
$
 



135





Great Southern Bancorp, Inc.
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements
December 31, 2018, 2017 and 2016



Vantus Bank Loans and Foreclosed Assets.  The following tables present the balances of the acquired loans and foreclosed assets related to the Vantus Bank transaction at December 31, 2018 and 2017.  Through December 31, 2018, gross loan balances (due from borrowers) were reduced approximately $317.5 million since the transaction date because of $271.9 million of repayments by the borrowers, $16.7 million of transfers to foreclosed assets and $28.9 million of charge-downs to customer loan balances.  Based upon the collectability analyses performed at the time of the acquisition, we expected certain levels of foreclosures and charge-offs and actual results have been better than our expectations.  As a result, cash flows expected to be received from the acquired loan pools have increased, resulting in adjustments that were made to the related accretable yield as described above.

   
December 31, 2018
 
         
Foreclosed
 
   
Loans
   
Assets
 
   
(In Thousands)
 
Initial basis for loss sharing determination,
           
net of activity since acquisition date
 
$
14,097
   
$
 
Reclassification from nonaccretable discount
               
to accretable discount due to change in
               
expected losses (net of accretion to date)
   
(58
)
   
 
Original estimated fair value of assets, net of
               
activity since acquisition date
   
(13,809
)
   
 
                 
Expected loss remaining
 
$
230
   
$
 

   
December 31, 2017
 
         
Foreclosed
 
   
Loans
   
Assets
 
   
(In Thousands)
 
Initial basis for loss sharing determination,
           
net of activity since acquisition date
 
$
18,965
   
$
15
 
Reclassification from nonaccretable discount
               
to accretable discount due to change in
               
expected losses (net of accretion to date)
   
(131
)
   
 
Original estimated fair value of assets, net of
               
activity since acquisition date
   
(18,605
)
   
(15
)
                 
Expected loss remaining
 
$
229
   
$
 




136





Great Southern Bancorp, Inc.
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements
December 31, 2018, 2017 and 2016


Sun Security Bank Loans and Foreclosed Assets.  The following tables present the balances of the acquired loans and foreclosed assets related to the Sun Security Bank transaction at December 31, 2018 and 2017.  Through December 31, 2018, gross loan balances (due from borrowers) were reduced approximately $213.3 million since the transaction date because of $153.9 million of repayments by the borrowers, $28.6 million of transfers to foreclosed assets and $30.8 million of charge-downs to customer loan balances.  Based upon the collectability analyses performed at the time of the acquisition, we expected certain levels of foreclosures and charge-offs and actual results have been better than our expectations.  As a result, cash flows expected to be received from the acquired loan pools have increased, resulting in adjustments that were made to the related accretable yield as described above.

   
December 31, 2018
 
         
Foreclosed
 
   
Loans
   
Assets
 
   
(In Thousands)
 
Initial basis for loss sharing determination,
           
net of activity since acquisition date
 
$
21,171
   
$
91
 
Reclassification from nonaccretable discount
               
to accretable discount due to change in
               
expected losses (net of accretion to date)
   
(342
)
   
 
Original estimated fair value of assets, net of
               
activity since acquisition date
   
(20,171
)
   
(61
)
                 
Expected loss remaining
 
$
658
   
$
30
 

   
December 31, 2017
 
         
Foreclosed
 
   
Loans
   
Assets
 
   
(In Thousands)
 
Initial basis for loss sharing determination,
           
net of activity since acquisition date
 
$
26,787
   
$
306
 
Reclassification from nonaccretable discount
               
to accretable discount due to change in
               
expected losses (net of accretion to date)
   
(494
)
   
 
Original estimated fair value of assets, net of
               
activity since acquisition date
   
(25,348
)
   
(299
)
                 
Expected loss remaining
 
$
945
   
$
7
 




137





Great Southern Bancorp, Inc.
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements
December 31, 2018, 2017 and 2016



InterBank Loans and Foreclosed Assets.  The following tables present the balances of the acquired loans and foreclosed assets related to the InterBank transaction at December 31, 2018 and 2017.  Through December 31, 2018, gross loan balances (due from borrowers) were reduced approximately $308.2 million since the transaction date because of $265.8 million of repayments by the borrowers, $20.0 million of transfers to foreclosed assets and $22.4 million of charge-offs to customer loan balances.  Based upon the collectability analyses performed at the time of the acquisition, we expected certain levels of foreclosures and charge-offs and actual results have been better than our expectations.  As a result, cash flows expected to be received from the acquired loan pools have increased, resulting in adjustments that were made to the related accretable yield as described above.

   
December 31, 2018
 
         
Foreclosed
 
   
Loans
   
Assets
 
   
(In Thousands)
 
Initial basis for loss sharing determination,
           
net of activity since acquisition date
 
$
85,106
   
$
121
 
Noncredit premium/(discount), net of
               
activity since acquisition date
   
99
     
 
Reclassification from nonaccretable discount
               
to accretable discount due to change in
               
expected losses (net of accretion to date)
   
(1,695
)
   
 
Original estimated fair value of assets, net of
               
activity since acquisition date
   
(74,436
)
   
(106
)
                 
Expected loss remaining
 
$
9,074
   
$
15
 

   
December 31, 2017
 
         
Foreclosed
 
   
Loans
   
Assets
 
   
(In Thousands)
 
Initial basis for loss sharing determination,
           
net of activity since acquisition date
 
$
112,399
   
$
2,012
 
Noncredit premium/(discount), net of
               
activity since acquisition date
   
274
     
 
Reclassification from nonaccretable discount
               
to accretable discount due to change in
               
expected losses (net of accretion to date)
   
(972
)
   
 
Original estimated fair value of assets, net of
               
activity since acquisition date
   
(98,321
)
   
(1,785
)
                 
Expected loss remaining
 
$
13,380
   
$
227
 




138





Great Southern Bancorp, Inc.
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements
December 31, 2018, 2017 and 2016


Valley Bank Loans and Foreclosed Assets.  The following tables present the balances of the acquired loans and foreclosed assets related to the Valley Bank transaction at December 31, 2018 and 2017.  Through December 31, 2018, gross loan balances (due from borrowers) were reduced approximately $139.7 million since the transaction date because of $127.7 million of repayments by the borrowers, $4.0 million of transfers to foreclosed assets and $8.0 million of charge-offs to customer loan balances.  Based upon the collectability analyses performed at the time of the acquisition, we expected certain levels of foreclosures and charge-offs and actual results have been better than our expectations.  As a result, cash flows expected to be received from the acquired loan pools have increased, resulting in adjustments that were made to the related accretable yield as described above.

   
December 31, 2018
 
         
Foreclosed
 
   
Loans
   
Assets
 
   
(In Thousands)
 
Initial basis, net of activity
           
since acquisition date
 
$
53,470
   
$
1,233
 
Reclassification from nonaccretable discount
               
to accretable discount due to change in
               
expected losses (net of accretion to date)
   
(169
)
   
 
Original estimated fair value of assets, net of
               
activity since acquisition date
   
(49,124
)
   
(1,233
)
Expected loss remaining
 
$
4,177
   
$
 

   
December 31, 2017
 
         
Foreclosed
 
   
Loans
   
Assets
 
   
(In Thousands)
 
Initial basis, net of activity
           
since acquisition date
 
$
59,997
   
$
1,673
 
Noncredit premium/(discount), net of
               
activity since acquisition date
   
11
     
 
Reclassification from nonaccretable discount
               
to accretable discount due to change in
               
expected losses (net of accretion to date)
   
(411
)
   
 
Original estimated fair value of assets, net of
               
activity since acquisition date
   
(54,442
)
   
(1,667
)
Expected loss remaining
 
$
5,155
   
$
6
 




139





Great Southern Bancorp, Inc.
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements
December 31, 2018, 2017 and 2016


 

Changes in the accretable yield for acquired loan pools were as follows for the years ended December 31, 2018, 2017 and 2016:


               
Sun
             
   
TeamBank
   
Vantus Bank
   
Security Bank
   
InterBank
   
Valley Bank
 
   
(In Thousands)
 
                               
Balance, January 1, 2016
  $
3,805
    $
3,360
    $
5,924
    $
16,347
    $
8,316
 
Accretion
   
(1,834
)
   
(1,877
)
   
(3,832
)
   
(13,964
)
   
(11,933
)
Reclassification from nonaccretable difference(1)
   
506
     
1,064
     
2,185
     
6,129
     
8,414
 
                                         
Balance, December 31, 2016
   
2,477
     
2,547
     
4,277
     
8,512
     
4,797
 
Accretion
   
(1,563
)
   
(1,373
)
   
(2,251
)
   
(7,505
)
   
(5,823
)
Reclassification from nonaccretable difference(1)
   
1,157
     
676
     
875
     
4,067
     
3,721
 
                                         
Balance, December 31, 2017
   
2,071
     
1,850
     
2,901
     
5,074
     
2,695
 
Accretion
   
(1,042
)
   
(1,196
)
   
(1,667
)
   
(8,349
)
   
(3,892
)
Reclassification from nonaccretable difference(1)
   
327
     
778
     
1,008
     
8,269
     
4,260
 
                                         
Balance, December 31, 2018
 
$
1,356
   
$
1,432
   
$
2,242
   
$
4,994
   
$
3,063
 

 

(1)
Represents increases in estimated cash flows expected to be received from the acquired loan pools, primarily due to lower estimated credit losses.  The numbers also include changes in expected accretion of the loan pools for TeamBank, Vantus Bank, Sun Security Bank, InterBank and Valley Bank for the year ended December 31, 2018, totaling $312,000, $778,000, $756,000, $4.1 million and $3.5 million, respectively; for TeamBank, Vantus Bank, Sun Security Bank, InterBank and Valley Bank for the year ended December 31, 2017, totaling $1.1 million, $663,000, $850,000, $3.5 million and $3.0 million, respectively; and for TeamBank, Vantus Bank, Sun Security Bank, InterBank and Valley Bank for the year ended December 31, 2016, totaling $506,000, $1.0 million, $1.8 million, $2.7 million and $1.6 million, respectively.




140





Great Southern Bancorp, Inc.
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements
December 31, 2018, 2017 and 2016

 

Note 5:
Other Real Estate Owned and Repossessions

Major classifications of other real estate owned at December 31, 2018 and 2017, were as follows:

   
2018
   
2017
 
   
(In Thousands)
 
Foreclosed assets held for sale and repossessions
           
One- to four-family construction
 
$
   
$
 
Subdivision construction
   
1,092
     
5,413
 
Land development
   
3,191
     
7,229
 
Commercial construction
   
     
 
One- to four-family residential
   
269
     
112
 
Other residential
   
     
140
 
Commercial real estate
   
     
1,694
 
Commercial business
   
     
 
Consumer
   
928
     
1,987
 
     
5,480
     
16,575
 
Acquired foreclosed assets no longer covered by
               
FDIC loss sharing agreements, net of discounts
   
167
     
2,133
 
Acquired foreclosed assets not covered by FDIC
               
loss sharing agreements, net of discounts (Valley Bank)
   
1,234
     
1,666
 
                 
Foreclosed assets held for sale and repossessions, net
   
6,881
     
20,374
 
                 
Other real estate owned not acquired through foreclosure
   
1,559
     
1,628
 
                 
Other real estate owned and repossessions
 
$
8,440
   
$
22,002
 

At December 31, 2018, other real estate owned not acquired through foreclosure included nine properties, eight of which were branch locations that were closed and are held for sale, and one of which is land acquired for a potential branch location.  During the year ended December 31, 2018, one former branch location was sold at a loss of $24,000, which is included in the net gains on sales of other real estate owned and repossessions amount in the table below.

At December 31, 2017, other real estate owned not acquired through foreclosure included 10 properties, nine of which were branch locations that were closed and are held for sale, and one of which is land acquired for a potential branch location.  During the year ended December 31, 2017, seven former branch locations were sold at an aggregate gain of $250,000, which is included in the net gains on sales of other real estate owned and repossessions amount in the table below.

At December 31, 2018, residential mortgage loans totaling $1.3 million were in the process of foreclosure, $1.0 million of which were acquired loans.  Of the $1.0 million of acquired loans, $873,000 were previously covered by loss sharing agreements and $171,000 were acquired in the Valley Bank transaction.

At December 31, 2017, residential mortgage loans totaling $3.2 million were in the process of foreclosure, $3.0 million of which were acquired loans.  Of the $3.0 million of acquired loans, $2.8 million were previously covered by loss sharing agreements and $208,000 were acquired in the Valley Bank transaction.



141





Great Southern Bancorp, Inc.
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements
December 31, 2018, 2017 and 2016

 

Expenses applicable to other real estate owned and repossessions for the years ended December 31, 2018, 2017 and 2016, included the following:

 
2018
 
2017
 
2016
 
 
(In Thousands)
 
             
Net gains on sales of other real estate owned and repossessions
 
$
(2,522
)
 
$
(2,212
)
 
$
(68
)
Valuation write-downs
   
3,897
     
1,585
     
431
 
Operating expenses, net of rental income
   
3,544
     
4,556
     
3,748
 
                         
   
$
4,919
   
$
3,929
   
$
4,111
 

Note 6:
Premises and Equipment

Major classifications of premises and equipment at December 31, 2018 and 2017, stated at cost, were as follows:

   
2018
   
2017
 
   
(In Thousands)
 
             
Land
 
$
40,508
   
$
42,312
 
Buildings and improvements
   
95,039
     
97,464
 
Furniture, fixtures and equipment
   
54,327
     
53,841
 
     
189,874
     
193,617
 
Less accumulated depreciation
   
57,450
     
55,599
 
                 
   
$
132,424
   
$
138,018
 


Note 7:
Investments in Limited Partnerships

Investments in Affordable Housing Partnerships

The Company has invested in certain limited partnerships that were formed to develop and operate apartments and single-family houses designed as high-quality affordable housing for lower income tenants throughout Missouri and contiguous states.  At December 31, 2018 the Company had 17 such investments, with a net carrying value of $22.9 million.  At December 31, 2017, the Company had 16 such investments, with a net carrying value of $18.2 million.  Due to the Company’s inability to exercise any significant influence over any of the investments in Affordable Housing Partnerships, they all are accounted for using the proportional amortization method.  Each of the partnerships must meet the regulatory requirements for affordable housing for a minimum 15-year compliance period to fully utilize the tax credits.  If the partnerships cease to qualify during the compliance period, the credits may be denied for any period in which the projects are not in compliance and a portion of the credits previously taken may be subject to recapture with interest.

The remaining federal affordable housing tax credits to be utilized through 2029 were $33.1 million as of December 31, 2018, assuming no tax credit recapture events occur and all projects currently under construction are completed as planned.  Amortization of the investments in partnerships is expected to be approximately $29.3 million, assuming all projects currently under construction are completed and funded as planned.  The Company’s usage of federal affordable housing tax credits approximated $6.6 million, $6.6 million and $6.2 million during 2018, 2017 and 2016, respectively.  Investment amortization amounted to $5.0 million, $5.2 million and $4.4 million for the years ended December 31, 2018, 2017 and 2016, respectively.

142





Great Southern Bancorp, Inc.
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements
December 31, 2018, 2017 and 2016

 

Investments in Community Development Entities

The Company has invested in certain limited partnerships that were formed to develop and operate business and real estate projects located in low-income communities.  At December 31, 2018, the Company had one such investment, with a net carrying value of $365,000.  At December 31, 2017, the Company had two such investments, with a net carrying value of $940,000.  Due to the Company’s inability to exercise any significant influence over any of the investments in qualified Community Development Entities, they are all accounted for using the cost method.  Each of the partnerships provides federal New Market Tax Credits over a seven-year credit allowance period.  In each of the first three years, credits totaling five percent of the original investment are allowed on the credit allowance dates and for the final four years, credits totaling six percent of the original investment are allowed on the credit allowance dates.  Each of the partnerships must be invested in a qualified Community Development Entity on each of the credit allowance dates during the seven-year period to utilize the tax credits.  If the Community Development Entities cease to qualify during the seven-year period, the credits may be denied for any credit allowance date and a portion of the credits previously taken may be subject to recapture with interest.  The investments in the Community Development Entities cannot be redeemed before the end of the seven-year period.

The remaining federal New Market Tax Credits to be utilized through 2019 were $480,000 as of December 31, 2018.  Amortization of the investments in partnerships is expected to be approximately $365,000.  The Company’s usage of federal New Market Tax Credits approximated $480,000, $1.2 million and $2.3 million during 2018, 2017 and 2016, respectively.  Investment amortization amounted to $575,000, $930,000 and $1.7 million for the years ended December 31, 2018, 2017 and 2016, respectively.

Investments in Limited Partnerships for Federal Rehabilitation/Historic Tax Credits

From time to time, the Company has invested in certain limited partnerships that were formed to provide certain federal rehabilitation/historic tax credits.  The Company utilizes these credits in their entirety in the year the project is placed in service and the impact to the Consolidated Statements of Income has not been material.

Investments in Limited Partnerships for State Tax Credits

From time to time, the Company has invested in certain limited partnerships that were formed to provide certain state tax credits.  The Company has primarily syndicated these tax credits and the impact to the Consolidated Statements of Income has not been material.





143





Great Southern Bancorp, Inc.
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements
December 31, 2018, 2017 and 2016

 

Note 8:
Deposits

Deposits at December 31, 2018 and 2017, are summarized as follows:

   
Weighted Average
       
   
Interest Rate
   
2018
   
2017
 
         
(In Thousands, Except
Interest Rates)
 
                   
      Noninterest-bearing accounts
   
   
$
661,061
   
$
661,589
 

                       
      Interest-bearing checking and savings accounts
   
0.46% - 0.32%

   
1,472,535
     
1,565,711
 
             
2,133,596
     
2,227,300
 
                         
      Certificate accounts
   
0% - 0.99%

   
150,656
     
254,502
 
     
1% - 1.99%

   
511,873
     
1,006,373
 
     
2% - 2.99%

   
857,973
     
106,888
 
     
3% - 3.99%

   
69,793
     
701
 
     
4% - 4.99%

   
1,116
     
1,108
 
   
5% and above      
     
272
 
             
1,591,411
     
1,369,844
 
                         
           
$
3,725,007
   
$
3,597,144
 


The weighted average interest rate on certificates of deposit was 1.98% and 1.24% at December 31, 2018 and 2017, respectively.

The aggregate amount of certificates of deposit originated by the Bank in denominations greater than $100,000 was approximately $733.9 million and $598.2 million at December 31, 2018 and 2017, respectively.  The Bank utilizes brokered deposits as an additional funding source.  The aggregate amount of brokered deposits was approximately $326.9 million and $260.0 million at December 31, 2018 and 2017, respectively.

At December 31, 2018, scheduled maturities of certificates of deposit were as follows:

   
Retail
   
Brokered
   
Total
 
   
(In Thousands)
 
                   
2019
 
$
928,900
   
$
286,922
   
$
1,215,822
 
2020
   
219,704
     
40,000
     
259,704
 
2021
   
73,724
     
     
73,724
 
2022
   
26,012
     
     
26,012
 
2023
   
14,705
     
     
14,705
 
Thereafter
   
1,444
     
     
1,444
 
                         
   
$
1,264,489
   
$
326,922
   
$
1,591,411
 



144





Great Southern Bancorp, Inc.
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements
December 31, 2018, 2017 and 2016


A summary of interest expense on deposits for the years ended December 31, 2018, 2017 and 2016, is as follows:

   
2018
   
2017
   
2016
 
   
(In Thousands)
 
                   
Checking and savings accounts
 
$
5,982
   
$
4,699
   
$
3,888
 
Certificate accounts
   
22,149
     
16,009
     
13,598
 
Early withdrawal penalties
   
(174
)
   
(113
)
   
(99
)
                         
   
$
27,957
   
$
20,595
   
$
17,387
 

Note 9:
Advances From Federal Home Loan Bank

Advances from the Federal Home Loan Bank at December 31, 2018 and 2017, consisted of the following:

   
December 31, 2018
   
December 31, 2017
 
         
Weighted
         
Weighted
 
         
Average
         
Average
 
         
Interest
         
Interest
 
Due In
 
Amount
   
Rate
   
Amount
   
Rate
 
   
(In Thousands)
 
                         
2018
 
$
     
%
 
$
127,500
     
1.53
%
                                 

The Bank has pledged FHLB stock, investment securities and first mortgage loans free of pledges, liens and encumbrances as collateral for outstanding advances.  No investment securities were specifically pledged as collateral for advances at December 31, 2018 and 2017.  Loans with carrying values of approximately $1.36 billion and $1.11 billion were pledged as collateral for outstanding advances at December 31, 2018 and 2017, respectively.  The Bank had potentially available $666.8 million remaining on its line of credit under a borrowing arrangement with the FHLB of Des Moines at December 31, 2018.




145





Great Southern Bancorp, Inc.
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements
December 31, 2018, 2017 and 2016



Note 10:
Short-Term Borrowings

Short-term borrowings at December 31, 2018 and 2017, are summarized as follows:

   
2018
   
2017
 
   
(In Thousands)
 
             
Notes payable – Community Development
           
Equity Funds
 
$
1,625
   
$
1,604
 
Other interest-bearing liabilities
   
13,100
     
 
Overnight borrowings from the Federal Home Loan Bank
   
178,000
     
15,000
 
Securities sold under reverse repurchase agreements
   
105,253
     
80,531
 
                 
   
$
297,978
   
$
97,135
 

The Bank enters into sales of securities under agreements to repurchase (reverse repurchase agreements).  Reverse repurchase agreements are treated as financings, and the obligations to repurchase securities sold are reflected as a liability in the statements of financial condition.  The dollar amount of securities underlying the agreements remains in the asset accounts.  Securities underlying the agreements are being held by the Bank during the agreement period.  All agreements are written on a term of one-month or less.

At December 31, 2018, other interest-bearing liabilities consist of cash collateral held by the Company to satisfy minimum collateral posting thresholds with its derivative dealer counterparties representing the termination value of derivatives, which at such time were in a net asset position.  Under the collateral agreements between the parties, either party may choose to provide cash or securities to satisfy its collateral requirements.

Short-term borrowings had weighted average interest rates of 1.68% and 0.30% at December 31, 2018 and 2017, respectively.  Short-term borrowings averaged approximately $137.3 million and $186.4 million for the years ended December 31, 2018 and 2017, respectively.  The maximum amounts outstanding at any month end were $298.0 million and $297.4 million, respectively, during those same periods.

The following table represents the Company’s securities sold under reverse repurchase agreements, by collateral type and remaining contractual maturity at December 31, 2018 and 2017:

   
2018
   
2017
 
   
Overnight and
   
Overnight and
 
   
Continuous
   
Continuous
 
   
(In Thousands)
 
             
Mortgage-backed securities – GNMA, FNMA, FHLMC
 
$
105,253
   
$
80,531
 
                 

Note 11:
Federal Reserve Bank Borrowings

At December 31, 2018 and 2017, the Bank had $460.7 million and $528.9 million, respectively, available under a line-of-credit borrowing arrangement with the Federal Reserve Bank.  The line is secured primarily by commercial loans.  There were no amounts borrowed under this arrangement at December 31, 2018 or 2017.



146





Great Southern Bancorp, Inc.
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements
December 31, 2018, 2017 and 2016




Note 12:
Subordinated Debentures Issued to Capital Trusts

In November 2006, Great Southern Capital Trust II (Trust II), a statutory trust formed by the Company for the purpose of issuing the securities, issued a $25.0 million aggregate liquidation amount of floating rate cumulative trust preferred securities.  The Trust II securities bear a floating distribution rate equal to 90-day LIBOR plus 1.60%.  The Trust II securities became redeemable at the Company’s option in February 2012, and if not sooner redeemed, mature on February 1, 2037.  The Trust II securities were sold in a private transaction exempt from registration under the Securities Act of 1933, as amended.  The gross proceeds of the offering were used to purchase Junior Subordinated Debentures from the Company totaling $25.8 million and bearing an interest rate identical to the distribution rate on the Trust II securities.  The initial interest rate on the Trust II debentures was 6.98%.  The interest rate was 4.14% and 2.98% at December 31, 2018 and 2017, respectively.

At December 31, 2018 and 2017, subordinated debentures issued to capital trusts are summarized as follows:

   
2018
   
2017
 
   
(In Thousands)
 
             
Subordinated debentures
 
$
25,774
   
$
25,774
 


Note 13:
Subordinated Notes

On August 8, 2016, the Company completed the public offering and sale of $75.0 million of its subordinated notes.  The notes are due August 15, 2026, and have a fixed interest rate of 5.25% until August 15, 2021, at which time the rate becomes floating at a rate equal to three-month LIBOR plus 4.087%.  The Company may call the notes at par beginning on August 15, 2021, and on any scheduled interest payment date thereafter.  The notes were sold at par, resulting in net proceeds, after underwriting discounts and commissions, legal, accounting and other professional fees, of approximately $73.5 million.  Total debt issuance costs, totaling approximately $1.5 million, were deferred and are being amortized over the expected life of the notes, which is 10 years.  Amortization of the debt issuance costs during the years ended December 31, 2018 and 2017, totaled $154,000 and $151,000, respectively, and is included in interest expense on subordinated notes in the consolidated statements of income, resulting in an imputed interest rate of 5.47%.

At December 31, 2018 and, 2017, subordinated notes are summarized as follows:

   
2018
   
2017
 
   
(In Thousands)
 
             
Subordinated notes
 
$
75,000
   
$
75,000
 
Less: unamortized debt issuance costs
   
1,158
     
1,312
 
   
$
73,842
   
$
73,688
 

Note 14:
Income Taxes

The Company files a consolidated federal income tax return.  As of December 31, 2018 and 2017, retained earnings included approximately $17.5 million for which no deferred income tax liability had been recognized.  This amount represents an allocation of income to bad debt deductions for tax purposes only for tax years prior to 1988.  If the Bank were to liquidate, the entire amount would have to be recaptured and would create income for tax purposes only, which would be subject to the then-current corporate income tax rate.  The unrecorded deferred income tax liability on the above amount was approximately $3.9 million at both December 31, 2018 and 2017, respectively.


147





Great Southern Bancorp, Inc.
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements
December 31, 2018, 2017 and 2016



During the years ended December 31, 2018, 2017 and 2016, the provision for income taxes included these components:

   
2018
   
2017
   
2016
 
   
(In Thousands)
 
                   
Taxes currently payable
 
$
19,291
   
$
9,335
   
$
20,137
 
Deferred income taxes
   
(4,450
)
    11,528
     
(3,621
)
Adjustment of deferred tax asset or liability for enacted changes in tax laws
   
     
(2,105
)
   
 
                         
Income taxes
 
$
14,841
   
$
18,758
   
$
16,516
 


The tax effects of temporary differences related to deferred taxes shown on the statements of financial condition were:

   
December 31,
 
   
2018
   
2017
 
   
(In Thousands)
 
Deferred tax assets
           
Allowance for loan losses
 
$
8,758
   
$
8,154
 
Tax credit carryforward
   
     
5,816
 
Interest on nonperforming loans
   
320
     
288
 
Accrued expenses
   
726
     
684
 
Write-down of foreclosed assets
   
600
     
1,694
 
Write-down of fixed assets
   
191
     
207
 
Difference in basis for acquired assets and
    liabilities
   
4,031
     
4,725
 
     
14,626
     
21,568
 
                 
Deferred tax liabilities
               
Tax depreciation in excess of book depreciation
   
(5,409
)
   
(4,483
)
FHLB stock dividends
   
(798
)
   
(356
)
Partnership tax credits
   
(404
)
   
(706
)
Prepaid expenses
   
(569
)
   
(775
)
Unrealized gain on available-for-sale securities
   
(83
)
   
(435
)
Book revenue in excess of tax revenue
   
     
(12,177
)
Unrealized gain on cash flow derivatives
   
(2,761
)
   
 
Other
   
(113
)
   
(190
)
     
(10,137
)
   
(19,122
)
                 
Net deferred tax asset
 
$
4,489
   
$
2,446
 



148





Great Southern Bancorp, Inc.
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements
December 31, 2018, 2017 and 2016


Reconciliations of the Company’s effective tax rates from continuing operations to the statutory corporate tax rates were as follows:

   
2018
   
2017
   
2016
 
                   
          Tax at statutory rate
   
21.0
%
   
35.0
%
   
35.0
%
          Nontaxable interest and dividends
   
(0.8
)
   
(1.6
)
   
(2.1
)
          Tax credits
   
(3.4
)
   
(6.1
)
   
(7.3
)
          State taxes
   
1.1
     
1.1
     
1.1
 
          Initial impact of enactment of 2017 Tax Act
   
     
(0.4
)
   
 
          Other
   
0.2
     
(1.3
)
   
 
                         
     
18.1
%
   
26.7
%
   
26.7
%

The Tax Cuts and Jobs Act (“Tax Act”) was signed into law on December 22, 2017, making several changes to U. S. corporate income tax laws, including reducing the corporate Federal income tax rate from 35% to 21% effective for tax years beginning on or after January 1, 2018.  U. S. GAAP requires that the impact of the provisions of the Tax Act be accounted for in the period of enactment. The Company recognized the income tax effects of the Tax Act in its 2017 financial statements. The Tax Act is complex and required significant detailed analysis.  During the preparation of the Company’s 2017 income tax returns in 2018, no additional adjustments related to enactment of the Tax Act were identified.

The Company and its consolidated subsidiaries have not been audited recently by the Internal Revenue Service (IRS) and, as such, tax years through December 31, 2005, have been closed without audit.  The Company, through one of its subsidiaries, is a partner in two partnerships which have been under Internal Revenue Service examination for 2006 and 2007.  As a result, the Company’s 2006 and subsequent tax years remain open for examination.  The examinations of these partnerships advanced during 2016, 2017, and 2018.  One of the partnerships has advanced to Tax Court and has entered a Motion for Entry of Decision with an agreed upon settlement.  The other partnership examination was recently completed by the IRS with no change impacting the Company’s tax positions.  The Company does not currently expect significant adjustments to its financial statements from the partnership matter at the Tax Court.

The Company is currently under State of Missouri income and franchise tax examinations for its 2014 through 2015 tax years.  The Company does not currently expect significant adjustments to its financial statements from this state examination.

Note 15:
Disclosures About Fair Value of Financial Instruments

ASC Topic 820, Fair Value Measurements, defines fair value as the price that would be received to sell an asset or paid to transfer a liability in an orderly transaction between market participants at the measurement date.  Topic 820 also specifies a fair value hierarchy which requires an entity to maximize the use of observable inputs and minimize the use of unobservable inputs when measuring fair value.  The standard describes three levels of inputs that may be used to measure fair value:


 •
Quoted prices in active markets for identical assets or liabilities (Level 1): Inputs that are quoted unadjusted prices in active markets for identical assets that the Company has the ability to access at the measurement date. An active market for the asset is a market in which transactions for the asset or liability occur with sufficient frequency and volume to provide pricing information on an ongoing basis.



149





Great Southern Bancorp, Inc.
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements
December 31, 2018, 2017 and 2016



 •
Other observable inputs (Level 2): Inputs that reflect the assumptions market participants would use in pricing the asset or liability developed based on market data obtained from sources independent of the reporting entity including quoted prices for similar assets, quoted prices for securities in inactive markets and inputs derived principally from or corroborated by observable market data by correlation or other means.


 •
Significant unobservable inputs (Level 3): Inputs that reflect assumptions of a source independent of the reporting entity or the reporting entity's own assumptions that are supported by little or no market activity or observable inputs.

Financial instruments are broken down as follows by recurring or nonrecurring measurement status. Recurring assets are initially measured at fair value and are required to be remeasured at fair value in the financial statements at each reporting date. Assets measured on a nonrecurring basis are assets that, due to an event or circumstance, were required to be remeasured at fair value after initial recognition in the financial statements at some time during the reporting period.

The Company considers transfers between the levels of the hierarchy to be recognized at the end of related reporting periods.

Recurring Measurements

The following table presents the fair value measurements of assets recognized in the accompanying balance sheets measured at fair value on a recurring basis and the level within the fair value hierarchy in which the fair value measurements fall at December 31, 2018 and 2017:

         
Fair Value Measurements Using
 
         
Quoted Prices
             
         
in Active
             
         
Markets
   
Other
   
Significant
 
         
for Identical
   
Observable
   
Unobservable
 
         
Assets
   
Inputs
   
Inputs
 
   
Fair Value
   
(Level 1)
   
(Level 2)
   
(Level 3)
 
   
(In Thousands)
 
December 31, 2018
                       
Agency mortgage-backed securities
 
$
153,258
   
$
   
$
153,258
   
$
 
Agency collateralized mortgage obligations
   
39,260
     
     
39,260
     
 
States and political subdivisions
   
51,450
     
     
51,450
     
 
Interest rate derivative asset
   
12,800
     
     
12,800
     
 
Interest rate derivative liability
   
(716
)
   
     
(716
)
   
 
                                 
December 31, 2017
                               
Agency mortgage-backed securities
 
$
122,533
   
$
   
$
122,533
   
$
 
States and political subdivisions
   
56,646
     
     
56,646
     
 
Interest rate derivative asset
   
981
     
     
981
     
 
Interest rate derivative liability
   
(1,030
)
   
     
(1,030
)
   
 

The following is a description of inputs and valuation methodologies used for assets recorded at fair value on a recurring basis and recognized in the accompanying statements of financial condition at December 31, 2018 and 2017, as well as the general classification of such assets pursuant to the valuation hierarchy.  There have been no significant changes in the valuation techniques during the year ended December 31, 2018.



150





Great Southern Bancorp, Inc.
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements
December 31, 2018, 2017 and 2016


Available-for-Sale Securities

Investment securities available for sale are recorded at fair value on a recurring basis.  The fair values used by the Company are obtained from an independent pricing service, which represent either quoted market prices for the identical asset or fair values determined by pricing models, or other model-based valuation techniques, that consider observable market data, such as interest rate volatilities, LIBOR yield curve, credit spreads and prices from market makers and live trading systems.  Recurring Level 1 securities include exchange traded equity securities.  Recurring Level 2 securities include U.S. government agency securities, mortgage-backed securities, state and municipal bonds and certain other investments.  Inputs used for valuing Level 2 securities include observable data that may include dealer quotes, benchmark yields, market spreads, live trading levels and market consensus prepayment speeds, among other things.  Additional inputs include indicative values derived from the independent pricing service’s proprietary computerized models.  There were no recurring Level 3 securities at December 31, 2018 or 2017.

Interest Rate Derivatives

The fair value is estimated using forward-looking interest rate curves and is determined using observable market rates and, therefore, are classified within Level 2 of the valuation hierarchy.

Nonrecurring Measurements

The following tables present the fair value measurement of assets measured at fair value on a nonrecurring basis and the level within the fair value hierarchy in which the fair value measurements fall at December 31, 2018 and 2017:

         
Fair Value Measurements Using
 
         
Quoted
             
         
Prices
             
         
in Active
             
         
Markets
   
Other
   
Significant
 
         
for Identical
   
Observable
   
Unobservable
 
         
Assets
   
Inputs
   
Inputs
 
   
Fair Value
   
(Level 1)
   
(Level 2)
   
(Level 3)
 
   
(In Thousands)
 
December 31, 2018
                       
Impaired loans
 
$
2,805
   
$
   
$
   
$
2,805
 
                                 
Foreclosed assets held for sale
 
$
1,776
   
$
   
$
   
$
1,776
 
                                 
December 31, 2017
                               
Impaired loans
 
$
1,590
   
$
   
$
   
$
1,590
 
                                 
Foreclosed assets held for sale
 
$
1,758
   
$
   
$
   
$
1,758
 


Following is a description of the valuation methodologies used for assets measured at fair value on a nonrecurring basis and recognized in the accompanying statements of financial condition, as well as the general classification of such assets pursuant to the valuation hierarchy.  For assets classified within Level 3 of the fair value hierarchy, the process used to develop the reported fair value is described below.




151





Great Southern Bancorp, Inc.
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements
December 31, 2018, 2017 and 2016




Loans Held for Sale

Mortgage loans held for sale are recorded at the lower of carrying value or fair value.  The fair value of mortgage loans held for sale is based on what secondary markets are currently offering for portfolios with similar characteristics.  As such, the Company classifies mortgage loans held for sale as Nonrecurring Level 2.  Write-downs to fair value typically do not occur as the Company generally enters into commitments to sell individual mortgage loans at the time the loan is originated to reduce market risk.  The Company typically does not have commercial loans held for sale.  At December 31, 2018 and 2017, the aggregate fair value of mortgage loans held for sale exceeded their cost.  Accordingly, no mortgage loans held for sale were marked down and reported at fair value.

Impaired Loans

A loan is considered to be impaired when it is probable that all of the principal and interest due may not be collected according to its contractual terms.  Generally, when a loan is considered impaired, the amount of reserve required under FASB ASC 310, Receivables, is measured based on the fair value of the underlying collateral.  The Company makes such measurements on all material loans deemed impaired using the fair value of the collateral for collateral dependent loans.  The fair value of collateral used by the Company is determined by obtaining an observable market price or by obtaining an appraised value from an independent, licensed or certified appraiser, using observable market data.  This data includes information such as selling price of similar properties and capitalization rates of similar properties sold within the market, expected future cash flows or earnings of the subject property based on current market expectations, and other relevant factors.  All appraised values are adjusted for market-related trends based on the Company’s experience in sales and other appraisals of similar property types as well as estimated selling costs.  Each quarter management reviews all collateral dependent impaired loans on a loan-by-loan basis to determine whether updated appraisals are necessary based on loan performance, collateral type and guarantor support.  At times, the Company measures the fair value of collateral dependent impaired loans using appraisals with dates more than one year prior to the date of review.  These appraisals are discounted by applying current, observable market data about similar property types such as sales contracts, estimations of value by individuals familiar with the market, other appraisals, sales or collateral assessments based on current market activity until updated appraisals are obtained.  Depending on the length of time since an appraisal was performed and the data provided through our reviews, these appraisals are typically discounted 10-40%.  The policy described above is the same for all types of collateral dependent impaired loans.

The Company records impaired loans as Nonrecurring Level 3.  If a loan’s fair value as estimated by the Company is less than its carrying value, the Company either records a charge-off for the portion of the loan that exceeds the fair value or establishes a reserve within the allowance for loan losses specific to the loan.  Loans for which such charge-offs or reserves were recorded during the years ended December 31, 2018 and 2017, are shown in the table above (net of reserves).

Foreclosed Assets Held for Sale

Foreclosed assets held for sale are initially recorded at fair value less estimated cost to sell at the date of foreclosure.  Subsequent to foreclosure, valuations are periodically performed by management and the assets are carried at the lower of carrying amount or fair value less estimated cost to sell.  Foreclosed assets held for sale are classified within Level 3 of the fair value hierarchy.  The foreclosed assets represented in the table above have been re-measured during the years ended December 31, 2018 and 2017, subsequent to their initial transfer to foreclosed assets.

Fair Value of Financial Instruments

The following methods were used to estimate the fair value of all other financial instruments recognized in the accompanying statements of financial condition at amounts other than fair value.




152





Great Southern Bancorp, Inc.
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements
December 31, 2018, 2017 and 2016


Cash and Cash Equivalents and Federal Home Loan Bank Stock

The carrying amount approximates fair value.

Loans and Interest Receivable

For 2018, the fair value of loans is estimated on an exit price basis incorporating contractual cash flow, prepayments discount spreads, credit loss and liquidity premiums.  For 2017, the fair value of loans is estimated by discounting the future cash flows using the current rates at which similar loans would be made to borrowers with similar credit ratings and for the same remaining maturities.  Loans with similar characteristics are aggregated for purposes of the calculations.  The carrying amount of accrued interest receivable approximates its fair value.

Deposits and Accrued Interest Payable

The fair value of demand deposits and savings accounts is the amount payable on demand at the reporting date, i.e., their carrying amounts.  For 2018, the fair value of fixed maturity certificates of deposit is estimated using a discounted cash flow calculation using the average advances yield curve from 11 districts of the FHLB for the as of date.  For 2017, the discounted cash flow calculation applied the rates currently offered for deposits of similar remaining maturities.  The carrying amount of accrued interest payable approximates its fair value.

Federal Home Loan Bank Advances

Rates currently available to the Company for debt with similar terms and remaining maturities are used to estimate fair value of existing advances.

Short-Term Borrowings

The carrying amount approximates fair value.

Subordinated Debentures Issued to Capital Trusts

The subordinated debentures have floating rates that reset quarterly.  The carrying amount of these debentures approximates their fair value.

Subordinated Notes

The fair values used by the Company are obtained from independent sources and are derived from quoted market prices of the Company’s subordinated notes and quoted market prices of other subordinated debt instruments with similar characteristics.

Commitments to Originate Loans, Letters of Credit and Lines of Credit

The fair value of commitments is estimated using the fees currently charged to enter into similar agreements, taking into account the remaining terms of the agreements and the present creditworthiness of the counterparties.  For fixed rate loan commitments, fair value also considers the difference between current levels of interest rates and the committed rates.  The fair value of letters of credit is based on fees currently charged for similar agreements or on the estimated cost to terminate them or otherwise settle the obligations with the counterparties at the reporting date.

The following table presents estimated fair values of the Company’s financial instruments.  The fair values of certain of these instruments were calculated by discounting expected cash flows, which method involves significant judgments by management and uncertainties.  Fair value is the estimated amount at which financial assets or liabilities could be exchanged in a current transaction between willing parties, other than in a forced or liquidation sale.  Because no market exists for certain of these financial instruments and because management does not intend to sell these financial instruments, the Company does not know whether the fair values shown below represent values at which the respective financial instruments could be sold individually or in the aggregate.




153





Great Southern Bancorp, Inc.
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements
December 31, 2018, 2017 and 2016

   
December 31, 2018
   
December 31, 2017
 
   
Carrying
   
Fair
   
Hierarchy
   
Carrying
   
Fair
   
Hierarchy
 
   
Amount
   
Value
   
Level
   
Amount
   
Value
   
Level
 
   
(Dollars in Thousands)
 
Financial assets
                                   
Cash and cash equivalents
 
$
202,742
   
$
202,742
     
1
   
$
242,253
   
$
242,253
     
1
 
Held-to-maturity securities
   
     
     
2
     
130
     
131
     
2
 
Mortgage loans held for sale
   
1,650
     
1,650
     
2
     
8,203
     
8,203
     
2
 
Loans, net of allowance for loan losses
   
3,989,001
     
3,955,786
     
3
     
3,726,302
     
3,735,216
     
3
 
Accrued interest receivable
   
13,448
     
13,448
     
3
     
12,338
     
12,338
     
3
 
Investment in FHLB stock
   
12,438
     
12,438
     
3
     
11,182
     
11,182
     
3
 
                                                 
Financial liabilities
                                               
Deposits
   
3,725,007
     
3,717,899
     
3
     
3,597,144
     
3,606,400
     
3
 
FHLB advances
   
     
     
3
     
127,500
     
127,500
     
3
 
Short-term borrowings
   
297,978
     
297,978
     
3
     
97,135
     
97,135
     
3
 
Subordinated debentures
   
25,774
     
25,774
     
3
     
25,774
     
25,774
     
3
 
Subordinated notes
   
73,842
     
75,188
     
2
     
73,688
     
76,500
     
2
 
Accrued interest payable
   
3,570
     
3,570
     
3
     
2,904
     
2,904
     
3
 
                                                 
Unrecognized financial instruments (net of
                                               
contractual value)
                                               
Commitments to originate loans
   
     
     
3
     
     
     
3
 
Letters of credit
   
146
     
146
     
3
     
85
     
85
     
3
 
Lines of credit
   
     
     
3
     
     
     
3
 

Note 16:
Operating Leases

The Company has entered into various operating leases at several of its locations.  Some of the leases have renewal options.

At December 31, 2018, future minimum lease payments were as follows (in thousands):

2019
 
$
958
 
2020
   
821
 
2021
   
648
 
2022
   
571
 
2023
   
443
 
Thereafter
   
837
 
         
   
$
4,278
 

Rental expense was $816,000, $912,000 and $973,000 for the years ended December 31, 2018, 2017 and 2016, respectively.




154





Great Southern Bancorp, Inc.
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements
December 31, 2018, 2017 and 2016




Note 17:
Derivatives and Hedging Activities

Risk Management Objective of Using Derivatives

The Company is exposed to certain risks arising from both its business operations and economic conditions.  The Company principally manages its exposures to a wide variety of business and operational risks through management of its core business activities.  The Company manages economic risks, including interest rate, liquidity and credit risk, primarily by managing the amount, sources and duration of its assets and liabilities.  In the normal course of business, the Company may use derivative financial instruments (primarily interest rate swaps) from time to time to assist in its interest rate risk management.  The Company has interest rate derivatives that result from a service provided to certain qualifying loan customers that are not used to manage interest rate risk in the Company’s assets or liabilities and are not designated in a qualifying hedging relationship.  The Company manages a matched book with respect to its derivative instruments in order to minimize its net risk exposure resulting from such transactions.  In addition, the Company has interest rate derivatives that are designated in a qualified hedging relationship.

Nondesignated Hedges

The Company has interest rate swaps that are not designated in a qualifying hedging relationship.  Derivatives not designated as hedges are not speculative and result from a service the Company provides to certain loan customers, which the Company began offering during 2011.  The Company executes interest rate swaps with commercial banking customers to facilitate their respective risk management strategies.  Those interest rate swaps are simultaneously hedged by offsetting interest rate swaps that the Company executes with a third party, such that the Company minimizes its net risk exposure resulting from such transactions.  As the interest rate swaps associated with this program do not meet the strict hedge accounting requirements, changes in the fair value of both the customer swaps and the offsetting swaps are recognized directly in earnings.

As part of the Valley Bank FDIC-assisted acquisition, the Company acquired seven loans with related interest rate swaps.  Valley’s swap program differed from the Company’s in that Valley did not have back to back swaps with the customer and a counterparty.  Five of the seven acquired loans with interest rate swaps have paid off.  The notional amount of the two remaining Valley swaps was $774,000 at December 31, 2018.  At December 31, 2018, excluding the Valley Bank swaps, the Company had 18 interest rate swaps totaling $78.5 million in notional amount with commercial customers, and 18 interest rate swaps with the same notional amount with third parties related to its program.  In addition, the Company has three participation loans purchased totaling $31.2 million, in which the lead institution has an interest rate swap with their customer and the economics of the counterparty swap are passed along to us through the loan participation.  As of December 31, 2017, excluding the Valley Bank swaps, the Company had 22 interest rate swaps totaling $92.7 million in notional amount with commercial customers, and 22 interest rate swaps with the same notional amount with third parties related to its program.  During the years ended December 31, 2018, 2017 and 2016, the Company recognized net gains of $25,000, $28,000 and $66,000, respectively, in noninterest income related to changes in the fair value of these swaps.

Cash Flow Hedges

Interest Rate Swap.  As a strategy to maintain acceptable levels of exposure to the risk of changes in future cash flows due to interest rate fluctuations, in October 2018, the Company entered into an interest rate swap transaction as part of its ongoing interest rate management strategies to hedge the risk of its floating rate loans.  The notional amount of the swap is $400 million with a termination date of October 6, 2025.  Under the terms of the swap, the Company will receive a fixed rate of interest of 3.018% and will pay a floating rate of interest equal to one-month USD-LIBOR.  The floating rate will be reset monthly and net settlements of interest due to/from the counterparty will also occur monthly.  The floating rate of interest was 2.383% as of December 31, 2018.  Therefore, in the near term, the Company will receive net interest settlements which will be recorded as loan interest income, to the extent that the fixed rate of interest continues to exceed one-month USD-LIBOR.  If USD-LIBOR exceeds the fixed rate of interest in future periods, the Company will be required to pay net settlements to the counterparty and will record those net payments as a reduction of interest



155





Great Southern Bancorp, Inc.
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements
December 31, 2018, 2017 and 2016



income on loans.  The Company recorded interest income of $673,000 on this interest rate swap during the year ended December 31, 2018.  The effective portion of the gain or loss on the derivative is reported as a component of other comprehensive income and reclassified into earnings in the same period or periods during which the hedged transaction affected earnings.  Gains and losses on the derivative representing either hedge ineffectiveness or hedge components excluded from the assessment of effectiveness are recognized in current earnings.  During the year ended December 31, 2018, the Company recognized $-0- in noninterest income related to changes in the fair value of this derivative.

Interest Rate Cap.  Previously, the Company entered into two interest rate cap agreements for a portion of its floating rate debt associated with its trust preferred securities.  One agreement terminated in 2015 and one agreement terminated in 2017.  The effective portion of the gain or loss on the derivative is reported as a component of other comprehensive income and reclassified into earnings in the same period or periods during which the hedged transaction affected earnings.  Gains and losses on the derivative representing either hedge ineffectiveness or hedge components excluded from the assessment of effectiveness are recognized in current earnings.  During the years ended December 31, 2017 and 2016, the Company recognized $-0- in noninterest income related to changes in the fair value of these derivatives.  During the years ended December 31, 2017 and 2016, the Company recognized $244,000 and $225,000, respectively, in interest expense related to the amortization of the cost of these interest rate caps.

The table below presents the fair value of the Company’s derivative financial instruments as well as their classification on the Consolidated Statements of Financial Condition:

 
Location in
 
Fair Value
 
 
Consolidated Statements
 
December 31,
   
December 31,
 
 
of Financial Condition
 
2018
   
2017
 
      
(In Thousands)
 
Derivatives designated as
             
  hedging instruments
             
Interest rate swap
Prepaid expenses and other assets
 
$
12,106
   
$
 
                   
Total derivatives designated
                 
  as hedging instruments
   
$
12,106
   
$
 
                   
Derivatives not designated
                 
  as hedging instruments
                 
                   
Derivative Assets
                 
Derivatives not designated
                 
  as hedging instruments
                 
Interest rate products
Prepaid expenses and other assets
 
$
694
   
$
981
 
                   
Total derivatives not
                 
designated as hedging
                 
instruments
   
$
694
   
$
981
 
                   
Derivative Liabilities
                 
Derivatives not designated
                 
  as hedging instruments
                 
Interest rate products
Accrued expenses and other liabilities
 
$
716
   
$
1,030
 
                   
Total derivatives not
                 
designated as hedging
                 
instruments
   
$
716
   
$
1,030
 


156





Great Southern Bancorp, Inc.
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements
December 31, 2018, 2017 and 2016


The following table presents the effect of  cash flow hedge accounting on the statements of comprehensive income:

   
Year Ended December 31
 
Cash Flow Hedges
 
Amount of Gain (Loss)
Recognized in AOCI
 
 
2018
   
2017
   
2016
 
   
(In Thousands)
 
                   
Interest rate swap (2018) and interest rate cap (2017 and 2016), net of income taxes
 
$
9,345
   
$
161
   
$
87
 
                         

The following table presents the effect of cash flow hedge accounting on the statements of operations:

 
Year Ended December 31
 
Cash Flow Hedges
 
2018
   
2017
   
2016
 
                                     
   
Interest Income
   
Interest Expense
   
Interest Income
   
Interest Expense
   
Interest Income
   
Interest Expense
 
   
(In Thousands)
 
                                     
Interest rate swap (2018) and interest rate cap (2017 and 2016)
 
$
673
   
$
   
$
   
$
244
   
$
   
$
225
 
                                                 

Agreements with Derivative Counterparties

The Company has agreements with its derivative counterparties.  If the Company defaults on any of its indebtedness, including a default where repayment of the indebtedness has not been accelerated by the lender, then the Company could also be declared in default on its derivative obligations.  If the Bank fails to maintain its status as a well-capitalized institution, then the counterparty could terminate the derivative positions and the Company would be required to settle its obligations under the agreements.  Similarly, the Company could be required to settle its obligations under certain of its agreements if certain regulatory events occurred, such as the issuance of a formal directive, or if the Company’s credit rating is downgraded below a specified level.

As of December 31, 2018, the termination value of derivatives with our derivative dealer counterparties (related to loan level swaps with commercial lending customers) in a net asset position, which included accrued interest but excluded any adjustment for nonperformance risk, related to these agreements was $396,000.  In addition, as of December 31, 2018, the termination value of derivatives with our derivative dealer counterparty (related to the balance sheet hedge commenced in October 2018) in a net asset position, which included accrued interest but excluded any adjustment for nonperformance risk, related to these agreements was $12.3 million.  The Company has minimum collateral posting thresholds with its derivative dealer counterparties.  At December 31, 2018, the Company’s activity with certain of its derivative counterparties met the level at which the minimum collateral posting thresholds take effect (collateral to be received by the Company) and the derivative counterparties had posted collateral of $704,000 to the Company to satisfy the loan level agreements and collateral of $12.8 million to the Company to satisfy the balance sheet hedge.   As of December 31, 2017, the termination value of derivatives in a net liability position, which included accrued interest but excluded any adjustment for nonperformance risk, related to these agreements was $336,000.  At December 31, 2017,


157





Great Southern Bancorp, Inc.
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements
December 31, 2018, 2017 and 2016


the Company’s activity with its derivative counterparties met the level at which the minimum collateral posting thresholds take effect and the Company posted $809,000 of collateral to satisfy the agreements.  If the Company had breached any of these provisions at December 31, 2018 or December 31, 2017, it could have been required to settle its obligations under the agreements at the termination value.

Note 18:
Commitments and Credit Risk

Commitments to Originate Loans

Commitments to extend credit are agreements to lend to a customer as long as there is no violation of any condition established in the contract.  Commitments generally have fixed expiration dates or other termination clauses and may require payment of a fee.  Since a significant portion of the commitments may expire without being drawn upon, the total commitment amounts do not necessarily represent future cash requirements.  The Bank evaluates each customer’s creditworthiness on a case‑by‑case basis.  The amount of collateral obtained, if deemed necessary by the Bank upon extension of credit, is based on management’s credit evaluation of the counterparty.  Collateral held varies but may include accounts receivable, inventory, property and equipment, commercial real estate and residential real estate.

At December 31, 2018 and 2017, the Bank had outstanding commitments to originate loans and fund commercial construction loans aggregating approximately $105.3 million and $164.0 million, respectively.  The commitments extend over varying periods of time with the majority being disbursed within a 30- to 180-day period.

Mortgage loans in the process of origination represent amounts that the Bank plans to fund within a normal period of 60 to 90 days, many of which are intended for sale to investors in the secondary market.  Total mortgage loans in the process of origination amounted to approximately $24.3 million and $20.8 million at December 31, 2018 and 2017, respectively.

Letters of Credit

Standby letters of credit are irrevocable conditional commitments issued by the Bank to guarantee the performance of a customer to a third party.  Financial standby letters of credit are primarily issued to support public and private borrowing arrangements, including commercial paper, bond financing and similar transactions.  Performance standby letters of credit are issued to guarantee performance of certain customers under nonfinancial contractual obligations.  The credit risk involved in issuing standby letters of credit is essentially the same as that involved in extending loans to customers.  Fees for letters of credit issued are initially recorded by the Bank as deferred revenue and are included in earnings at the termination of the respective agreements.  Should the Bank be obligated to perform under the standby letters of credit, the Bank may seek recourse from the customer for reimbursement of amounts paid.

The Company had total outstanding standby letters of credit amounting to approximately $28.9 million and $20.0 million at December 31, 2018 and 2017, respectively, with $28.4 million and $19.1 million, respectively, of the letters of credit having terms up to five years and $476,000 and $885,000, respectively, of the letters of credit having terms over five years.  Of the amount having terms over five years, $476,000 and $885,000 at December 31, 2018 and 2017, respectively, consisted of an outstanding letter of credit to guarantee the payment of principal and interest on a Multifamily Housing Refunding Revenue Bond Issue.

Purchased Letters of Credit

The Company has purchased letters of credit from the Federal Home Loan Bank as security for certain public deposits.  The amount of the letters of credit was $2.1 million and $2.1 million at December 31, 2018 and 2017, respectively, and they expire in less than one year from issuance.


158





Great Southern Bancorp, Inc.
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements
December 31, 2018, 2017 and 2016


Lines of Credit

Lines of credit are agreements to lend to a customer as long as there is no violation of any condition established in the contract.  Lines of credit generally have fixed expiration dates.  Since a portion of the line may expire without being drawn upon, the total unused lines do not necessarily represent future cash requirements.  The Bank evaluates each customer’s creditworthiness on a case‑by‑case basis.  The amount of collateral obtained, if deemed necessary by the Bank upon extension of credit, is based on management’s credit evaluation of the counterparty.  Collateral held varies but may include accounts receivable, inventory, property and equipment, commercial real estate and residential real estate.  The Bank uses the same credit policies in granting lines of credit as it does for on-balance-sheet instruments.

At December 31, 2018, the Bank had granted unused lines of credit to borrowers aggregating approximately $1.1 billion and $150.9 million for commercial lines and open‑end consumer lines, respectively.  At December 31, 2017, the Bank had granted unused lines of credit to borrowers aggregating approximately $912.2 million and $133.6 million for commercial lines and open‑end consumer lines, respectively.

Credit Risk

The Bank grants collateralized commercial, real estate and consumer loans primarily to customers in its market areas.  Although the Bank has a diversified portfolio, loans (excluding those covered by loss sharing agreements) aggregating approximately $750.3 million and $674.0 million at December 31, 2018 and 2017, respectively, are secured primarily by apartments, condominiums, residential and commercial land developments, industrial revenue bonds and other types of commercial properties in the St. Louis, Missouri, area.

Note 19:
Additional Cash Flow Information
   
2018
   
2017
   
2016
 
   
(In Thousands)
 
Noncash Investing and Financing Activities
                 
Real estate acquired in settlement of
                 
loans
 
$
12,044
   
$
23,780
   
$
26,076
 
Sale and financing of foreclosed assets
   
2,578
     
603
     
3,334
 
Conversion of premises and equipment
                       
to foreclosed assets
   
     
     
6,985
 
Dividends declared but not paid
   
4,528
     
3,381
     
3,073
 
                         
Additional Cash Payment Information
                       
Interest paid
   
37,091
     
27,724
     
20,476
 
Income taxes paid
   
2,569
     
17,563
     
9,554
 


Note 20:
Employee Benefits

The Company participates in the Pentegra Defined Benefit Plan for Financial Institutions (Pentegra DB Plan), a multiemployer defined benefit pension plan covering all employees who have met minimum service requirements.  Effective July 1, 2006, this plan was closed to new participants.  Employees already in the plan continue to accrue benefits.  The Pentegra DB Plan’s Employer Identification Number is 13-5645888 and the Plan Number is 333.  The Company’s policy is to fund pension cost accrued.  Employer contributions charged to expense for this plan for the years ended December 31, 2018, 2017 and 2016, were approximately $1.3 million, $1.1 million and $725,000, respectively.  The Company’s contributions to the Pentegra DB Plan were not more than 5% of the total contributions to the plan.  The funded status of the plan as of July 1, 2018 and 2017, was 96.3% and 98.2%, respectively.  The funded status was calculated by taking the market value of plan assets, which reflected contributions received through June 30, 2018 and 2017, respectively, divided by the funding target.  No collective bargaining agreements are in place that require contributions to the Pentegra DB Plan.



159





Great Southern Bancorp, Inc.
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements
December 31, 2018, 2017 and 2016



The Company has a defined contribution retirement plan covering substantially all employees.  The Company matches 100% of the employee’s contribution on the first 3% of the employee’s compensation and also matches an additional 50% of the employee’s contribution on the next 2% of the employee’s compensation.  Employer contributions charged to expense for this plan for the years ended December 31, 2018, 2017 and 2016, were approximately $1.4 million, $1.3 million and $1.2 million, respectively.

Note 21:
Stock Compensation Plans

The Company established the 2003 Stock Option and Incentive Plan (the “2003 Plan”) for employees and directors of the Company and its subsidiaries.  Under the plan, stock options or other awards could be granted with respect to 598,224 shares of common stock.  On May 15, 2013, the Company’s stockholders approved the Great Southern Bancorp, Inc. 2013 Equity Incentive Plan (the “2013 Plan”).  Upon the stockholders’ approval of the 2013 Plan, the Company’s 2003 Plan was frozen.  As a result, no new stock options or other awards may be granted under the 2003 Plan; however, existing outstanding awards under the 2003 Plan were not affected.  At December 31, 2018, 81,023 options were outstanding under the 2003 Plan.

The Company established the 2013 Stock Option and Incentive Plan (the “2013 Plan”) for employees and directors of the Company and its subsidiaries.  Under the plan, stock options or other awards could be granted with respect to 700,000 shares of common stock.  On May 9, 2018, the Company’s stockholders approved the Great Southern Bancorp, Inc. 2018 Omnibus Incentive Plan (the “2018 Plan”).  Upon the stockholders’ approval of the 2018 Plan, the Company’s 2013 Plan was frozen.  As a result, no new stock options or other awards may be granted under the 2013 Plan; however, existing outstanding awards under the 2003 Plan were not affected.  At December 31, 2018, 507,063 options were outstanding under the 2013 Plan.

The 2018 Plan provides for the grant from time to time to directors, emeritus directors, officers, employees and advisory directors of stock options, stock appreciation rights, restricted stock, restricted stock units, performance shares and performance units.  The number of shares of Common Stock available for awards under the 2018 Plan is 800,000 (the “2018 Plan Limit”).  Shares utilized for awards other than stock options and stock appreciation rights will be counted against the 2018 Plan Limit on a 2.5-to-1 basis.  At December 31, 2018, 185,150 options were outstanding under the 2018 Plan.

Stock options may be either incentive stock options or nonqualified stock options, and the option price must be at least equal to the fair value of the Company’s common stock on the date of grant.  Options generally are granted for a 10‑year term and generally become exercisable in four cumulative annual installments of 25% commencing two years from the date of grant.  The Stock Option Committee may accelerate a participant’s right to purchase shares under the plan.

Stock awards may be granted to key officers and employees upon terms and conditions determined solely at the discretion of the Stock Option Committee.





160





Great Southern Bancorp, Inc.
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements
December 31, 2018, 2017 and 2016


The table below summarizes transactions under the Company’s stock compensation plans, all of which related to stock options granted under such plans:

               
Weighted
 
   
Available to
Grant
   
Shares Under
Option
   
Average Exercise Price
 
                   
Balance, January 1, 2016
   
331,450
     
633,732
   
$
31.297
 
Granted from 2013 Plan
   
(131,000
)
   
131,000
     
41.228
 
Exercised
   
     
(81,812
)
   
26.472
 
Forfeited from terminated plan(s)
   
     
(2,692
)
   
22.654
 
Forfeited from current plan(s)
   
19,025
     
(19,025
)
   
39.123
 
                         
Balance, December 31, 2016
   
219,475
     
661,203
     
33.672
 
Granted from 2013 Plan
   
(157,800
)
   
157,800
     
52.118
 
Exercised
   
     
(119,692
)
   
27.352
 
Forfeited from terminated plan(s)
   
     
(675
)
   
24.690
 
Forfeited from current plan(s)
   
15,837
     
(15,837
)
   
41.916
 
                         
Balance, December 31, 2017
   
77,512
     
682,799
     
38.860
 
Granted from 2013 Plan
   
(1,000
)
   
1,000
     
52.500
 
Exercised
   
     
(81,940
)
   
27.597
 
Forfeited from 2013 Plan
   
13,773
     
(13,773
)
   
45.692
 
Termination of 2013 Plan
   
(90,285
)
   
         
     
     
588,086
         
Available to grant from 2018 Plan
   
800,000
     
         
Granted from 2018 Plan
   
(185,750
)
   
185,750
     
55.297
 
Forfeited from current plan(s)
   
600
     
(600
)
   
55.000
 
                         
Balance, December 31, 2018
   
614,850
     
773,236
   
$
43.886
 

The Company’s stock option grants contain terms that provide for a graded vesting schedule whereby portions of the options vest in increments over the requisite service period.  These options typically vest one-fourth at the end of years two, three, four and five from the grant date.  As provided for under FASB ASC 718, the Company has elected to recognize compensation expense for options with graded vesting schedules on a straight-line basis over the requisite service period for the entire option grant.  In addition, ASC 718 requires companies to recognize compensation expense based on the estimated number of stock options for which service is expected to be rendered.  The Company’s historical forfeitures of its share-based awards have not been material.

The fair value of each option award is estimated on the date of the grant using the Black-Scholes option pricing model with the following assumptions for the years ended December 31, 2018, 2017 and 2016:

   
2018
   
2017
   
2016
 
                   
Expected dividends per share
 
$
1.27
   
$
0.95
   
$
0.88
 
Risk-free interest rate
   
2.86
%
   
2.03
%
   
1.27
%
Expected life of options
 
5 years
   
5 years
   
5 years
 
Expected volatility
   
17.61
%
   
23.49
%
   
22.08
%
Weighted average fair value of
                       
options granted during year
 
$
8.30
   
$
10.04
   
$
6.59
 



161





Great Southern Bancorp, Inc.
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements
December 31, 2018, 2017 and 2016


Expected volatilities are based on the historical volatility of the Company’s stock, based on the monthly closing stock price.  The expected term of options granted is based on actual historical exercise behavior of all employees and directors and approximates the graded vesting period of the options.  Expected dividends are based on the annualized dividends declared at the time of the option grant.  The risk-free interest rate is based on the five-year treasury rate on the grant date of the options.

The following table presents the activity related to options under all plans for the year ended December 31, 2018:

             
Weighted
         
Weighted
 
Average
         
Average
 
Remaining
         
Exercise
 
Contractual
   
Options
   
Price
 
Term
                  
Options outstanding, January 1, 2018
   
682,799
   
$
38.860
 
7.38 years
Granted
   
186,750
     
55.282
   
Exercised
   
(81,940
)
   
27.597
   
Forfeited
   
(14,373
)
   
46.081
   
Options outstanding, December 31, 2018
   
773,236
     
43.886
 
7.44 years
                      
Options exercisable, December 31, 2018
   
266,742
     
32.233
 
5.15 years

For the years ended December 31, 2018, 2017 and 2016, options granted were 186,750, 157,800, and 131,000, respectively.  The total intrinsic value (amount by which the fair value of the underlying stock exceeds the exercise price of an option on exercise date) of options exercised during the years ended December 31, 2018, 2017 and 2016, was $2.2 million, $3.0 million and $1.4 million, respectively.  Cash received from the exercise of options for the years ended December 31, 2018, 2017 and 2016, was $2.3 million, $3.3 million and $2.1 million, respectively.  The actual tax benefit realized for the tax deductions from option exercises totaled $1.6 million, $2.7 million and $1.3 million for the years ended December 31, 2018, 2017 and 2016, respectively.  The total intrinsic value of options outstanding at December 31, 2018, 2017 and 2016, was $4.7 million, $8.8 million and $13.9 million, respectively.  The total intrinsic value of options exercisable at December 31, 2018, 2017 and 2016, was $3.9 million, $5.7 million and $7.5 million, respectively.

The following table presents the activity related to nonvested options under all plans for the year ended December 31, 2018.

         
Weighted
   
Weighted
 
         
Average
   
Average
 
         
Exercise
   
Grant Date
 
   
Options
   
Price
   
Fair Value
 
                   
Nonvested options, January 1, 2018
   
441,937
   
$
44.842
   
$
7.981
 
Granted
   
186,750
     
55.282
     
8.297
 
Vested this period
   
(107,895
)
   
38.433
     
6.398
 
Nonvested options forfeited
   
(14,298
)
   
46.057
     
8.143
 
                         
Nonvested options, December 31, 2018
   
506,494
     
50.023
     
8.431
 

At December 31, 2018, there was $3.8 million of total unrecognized compensation cost related to nonvested options granted under the Company’s plans.  This compensation cost is expected to be recognized through 2023, with the majority of this expense recognized in 2019 and 2020.


162





Great Southern Bancorp, Inc.
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements
December 31, 2018, 2017 and 2016


The following table further summarizes information about stock options outstanding at December 31, 2018:

   
Options Outstanding
       
       
Weighted
       
Options Exercisable
 
       
Average
 
Weighted
         
Weighted
 
       
Remaining
 
Average
         
Average
 
Range of
 
Number
 
Contractual
 
Exercise
   
Number
   
Exercise
 
Exercise Prices
 
Outstanding
 
Term
 
Price
   
Exercisable
   
Price
 
                           
$16.810 to 29.640
   
139,920
 
3.89 years
 
$
25.093
     
139,920
   
$
25.093
 
$32.590 to 38.610
   
97,047
 
5.87 years
   
33.038
     
62,291
     
32.819
 
$41.300 to 47.800
   
111,436
 
7.80 years
   
41.357
     
24,658
     
41.386
 
$50.710 to 52.500
   
239,683
 
8.11 years
   
51.608
     
39,873
     
50.710
 
$55.000 to 59.750
   
185,150
 
9.88 years
   
55.298
     
     
 
                                   
     
773,236
 
7.44 years
   
43.886
     
266,742
     
32.233
 

Note 22:
Significant Estimates and Concentrations

Accounting principles generally accepted in the United States of America require disclosure of certain significant estimates and current vulnerabilities due to certain concentrations.  Estimates related to the allowance for loan losses are reflected in Note 3.  Estimates used in valuing acquired loans, loss sharing agreements and FDIC indemnification assets and in continuing to monitor related cash flows of acquired loans are discussed in Note 4.  Current vulnerabilities due to certain concentrations of credit risk are discussed in the footnotes on loans, deposits and on commitments and credit risk.

Other significant estimates not discussed in those footnotes include valuations of foreclosed assets held for sale.  The carrying value of foreclosed assets reflects management’s best estimate of the amount to be realized from the sales of the assets.  While the estimate is generally based on a valuation by an independent appraiser or recent sales of similar properties, the amount that the Company realizes from the sales of the assets could differ materially in the near term from the carrying value reflected in these financial statements.

Note 23:
Accumulated Other Comprehensive Income

The components of accumulated other comprehensive income (AOCI), included in stockholders’ equity, are as follows:

   
2018
   
2017
 
   
(In Thousands)
 
             
Net unrealized gain on available-for-sale securities
 
$
365
   
$
1,949
 
                 
Net unrealized gain on derivatives used for cash flow hedges
   
12,106
     
 
     
12,471
     
1,949
 
                 
Tax effect
   
(2,844
)
   
(708
)
                 
Net-of-tax amount
 
$
9,627
   
$
1,241
 



163





Great Southern Bancorp, Inc.
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements
December 31, 2018, 2017 and 2016


Amounts reclassified from AOCI and the affected line items in the statements of income during the years ended December 31, 2018, 2017 and 2016, were as follows:

   
Amounts Reclassified
from AOCI
 
   
2018
   
2017
   
2016
 
Affected Line Item in the Statements of Income
   
(In Thousands)
   
                         
Unrealized gains on available-for-sale securities
 
$
2
   
$
   
$
2,873
 
Net realized gains on available-for-sale securities (total reclassified amount before tax)
                               
Income taxes
   
     
     
(1,043
)
Tax (expense) benefit
                               
Total reclassifications out of AOCI
 
$
2
   
$
   
$
1,830
   

Note 24:
Regulatory Matters

The Company and the Bank are subject to various regulatory capital requirements administered by the federal banking agencies.  Failure to meet minimum capital requirements can result in certain mandatory and possibly additional discretionary actions by regulators that, if undertaken, could have a direct and material effect on the Company’s financial statements.  Under capital adequacy guidelines and the regulatory framework for prompt corrective action, the Company and the Bank must meet specific capital guidelines that involve quantitative measures of the Company’s and the Bank’s assets, liabilities and certain off-balance-sheet items as calculated under U.S. GAAP, regulatory reporting practices, and regulatory capital standards.  The Company’s and the Bank’s capital amounts and classification are also subject to qualitative judgments by the regulators about components, risk weightings and other factors.

Quantitative measures established by regulatory reporting standards to ensure capital adequacy require the Bank to maintain minimum amounts and ratios (set forth in the table below as of December 31, 2018) of Total and Tier I Capital (as defined) to risk-weighted assets (as defined), of Tier I Capital (as defined) to adjusted tangible assets (as defined) and of Common Equity Tier 1 Capital (as defined) to risk-weighted assets (as defined).  Management believes, as of December 31, 2018, that the Bank met all capital adequacy requirements to which it was then subject.

As of December 31, 2018, the most recent notification from the Bank’s regulators categorized the Bank as well capitalized under the regulatory framework for prompt corrective action.  To be categorized as well capitalized as of December 31, 2018, the Bank must have maintained minimum Total capital, Tier I capital, Tier 1 Leverage capital and Common Equity Tier 1 capital ratios as set forth in the table.  There are no conditions or events since that notification that management believes have changed the Bank’s category.

The Company and the Bank are subject to certain restrictions on the amount of dividends that may be declared without prior regulatory approval.  At December 31, 2018 and 2017, the Company and the Bank exceeded their minimum capital requirements then in effect.  The entities may not pay dividends which would reduce capital below the minimum requirements shown above. In addition to the minimum capital ratios, the new capital rules include a capital conservation buffer, under which a banking organization must have CET1 more than 2.5% above each of its minimum risk-based capital ratios in order to avoid restrictions on paying dividends, repurchasing shares, and paying certain discretionary bonuses.  The net unrealized gain or loss on available-for-sale securities is not included in computing regulatory capital.



164





Great Southern Bancorp, Inc.
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements
December 31, 2018, 2017 and 2016


The Company’s and the Bank’s actual capital amounts and ratios are presented in the following table.  No amount was deducted from capital for interest-rate risk.

                           
Minimum To Be Well
 
                           
Capitalized Under
 
               
Minimum For Capital
   
Prompt Corrective
 
   
Actual
   
Adequacy Purposes
   
Action Provisions
 
   
Amount
   
Ratio
   
Amount
   
Ratio
   
Amount
   
Ratio
 
   
(Dollars In Thousands)
 
As of December 31, 2018
                                   
Total capital
                                   
Great Southern Bancorp, Inc.
 
$
651,469
     
14.4
%
 
360,826
     

8.0
%
   
N/A
     
N/A
 
Great Southern Bank
 
$
599,509
     
13.3
%
 
360,767
     
8.0
%
 
450,959
     
10.0
%
                                                 
Tier I capital
                                               
Great Southern Bancorp, Inc.
 
$
538,060
     
11.9
%
 
270,619
     
6.0
%
   
N/A
     
N/A
 
Great Southern Bank
 
$
561,100
     
12.4
%
 
270,575
     
6.0
%
 
360,767
     
8.0
%
                                                 
Tier I leverage capital
                                               
Great Southern Bancorp, Inc.
 
$
538,060
     
11.7
%
 
184,088
     
4.0
%
   
N/A
     
N/A
 
Great Southern Bank
 
$
561,100
     
12.2
%
 
184,050
     
4.0
%
 
230,062
     
5.0
%
                                                 
Common equity Tier I capital
                                               
Great Southern Bancorp, Inc.
 
$
513,060
     
11.4
%
 
202,965
     
4.5
%
   
N/A
     
N/A
 
Great Southern Bank
 
$
561,100
     
12.4
%
 
202,931
     
4.5
%
 
293,123
     
6.5
%
                                                 
As of December 31, 2017
                                               
Total capital
                                               
Great Southern Bancorp, Inc.
 
$
597,177
     
14.1
%
 
339,649
     
8.0
%
   
N/A
     
N/A
 
Great Southern Bank
 
$
558,668
     
13.2
%
 
339,575
     
8.0
%
 
424,468
     
10.0
%
                                                 
Tier I capital
                                               
Great Southern Bancorp, Inc.
 
$
485,685
     
11.4
%
 
254,737
     
6.0
%
   
N/A
     
N/A
 
Great Southern Bank
 
$
522,176
     
12.3
%
 
254,681
     
6.0
%
 
339,575
     
8.0
%
                                                 
Tier I leverage capital
                                               
Great Southern Bancorp, Inc.
 
$
485,685
     
10.9
%
 
177,881
     
4.0
%
   
N/A
     
N/A
 
Great Southern Bank
 
$
522,176
     
11.7
%
 
177,844
     
4.0
%
 
222,305
     
5.0
%
                                                 
Common equity Tier I capital
                                               
Great Southern Bancorp, Inc.
 
$
460,661
     
10.9
%
 
191,053
     
4.5
%
   
N/A
     
N/A
 
Great Southern Bank
 
$
522,152
     
12.3
%
 
191,011
     
4.5
%
 
275,904
     
6.5
%
                                                 

Note 25:
Litigation Matters

In the normal course of business, the Company and its subsidiaries are subject to pending and threatened legal actions, some of which seek substantial relief or damages.  While the ultimate outcome of such legal proceedings cannot be predicted with certainty, after reviewing pending and threatened litigation with counsel, management believes at this time that, except as noted below, the outcome of such litigation will not have a material adverse effect on the Company’s business, financial condition or results of operations.



165





Great Southern Bancorp, Inc.
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements
December 31, 2018, 2017 and 2016



Note 26:
Summary of Unaudited Quarterly Operating Results

Following is a summary of unaudited quarterly operating results for the years 2018, 2017 and 2016:

   
2018
 
   
Three Months Ended
 
   
March 31
   
June 30
   
September 30
   
December 31
 
   
(In Thousands, Except Per Share Data)
 
       
Interest income
 
$
46,882
   
$
49,943
   
$
52,982
   
$
56,142
 
Interest expense
   
7,444
     
8,731
     
9,997
     
11,585
 
Provision for loan losses
   
1,950
     
1,950
     
1,300
     
1,950
 
Net realized gains on
                               
available-for-sale securities
   
     
     
2
     
 
Noninterest income
   
6,935
     
7,459
     
14,604
     
7,220
 
Noninterest expense
   
28,312
     
29,915
     
28,309
     
28,774
 
Provision for income taxes
   
2,645
     
2,967
     
5,464
     
3,765
 
Net income available to common
                               
shareholders
   
13,466
     
13,839
     
22,516
     
17,288
 
Earnings per common share – diluted
   
0.95
     
0.97
     
1.57
     
1.21
 

   
2017
 
   
Three Months Ended
 
   
March 31
   
June 30
   
September 30
   
December 31
 
   
(In Thousands, Except Per Share Data)
 
       
Interest income
 
$
45,413
   
$
44,744
   
$
46,368
   
$
46,536
 
Interest expense
   
6,712
     
6,843
     
7,087
     
7,263
 
Provision for loan losses
   
2,250
     
1,950
     
2,950
     
1,950
 
Net realized gains (losses)
                               
on available-for-sale securities
   
     
     
     
 
Noninterest income
   
7,698
     
15,800
     
7,655
     
7,374
 
Noninterest expense
   
28,573
     
28,371
     
28,034
     
29,283
 
Provision for income taxes
   
4,058
     
7,204
     
4,289
     
3,207
 
Net income
   
11,518
     
16,176
     
11,663
     
12,207
 
Net income available to common
                               
shareholders
   
11,518
     
16,176
     
11,663
     
12,207
 
Earnings per common share – diluted
   
0.81
     
1.14
     
0.82
     
0.86
 




166





Great Southern Bancorp, Inc.
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements
December 31, 2018, 2017 and 2016




   
2016
 
   
Three Months Ended
 
   
March 31
   
June 30
   
September 30
   
December 31
 
   
(In Thousands, Except Per Share Data)
 
       
Interest income
 
$
45,746
   
$
45,636
   
$
46,856
   
$
46,937
 
Interest expense
   
4,627
     
4,974
     
5,828
     
6,690
 
Provision for loan losses
   
2,101
     
2,300
     
2,500
     
2,380
 
Net realized gains (losses) on
                               
available-for-sale securities
   
3
     
2,735
     
144
     
(9
)
Noninterest income
   
4,974
     
8,916
     
7,090
     
7,530
 
Noninterest expense
   
30,920
     
29,807
     
30,657
     
29,043
 
Provision (credit) for income taxes
   
3,279
     
4,937
     
3,740
     
4,560
 
Net income
   
9,793
     
12,534
     
11,221
     
11,794
 
Net income available to common
                               
shareholders
   
9,793
     
12,534
     
11,221
     
11,794
 
Earnings per common share – diluted
   
0.70
     
0.89
     
0.80
     
0.83
 

Note 27:
Condensed Parent Company Statements

The condensed statements of financial condition at December 31, 2018 and 2017, and statements of income, comprehensive income and cash flows for the years ended December 31, 2018, 2017 and 2016, for the parent company, Great Southern Bancorp, Inc., were as follows:

   
December 31,
 
   
2018
   
2017
 
   
(In Thousands)
 
             
Statements of Financial Condition
           
             
Assets
           
Cash
 
$
56,648
   
$
41,977
 
Investment in subsidiary bank
   
580,016
     
533,153
 
Deferred and accrued income taxes
   
411
     
133
 
Prepaid expenses and other assets
   
889
     
903
 
                 
   
$
637,964
   
$
576,166
 
                 
Liabilities and Stockholders’ Equity
               
Accounts payable and accrued expenses
 
$
6,371
   
$
5,042
 
Subordinated debentures issued to capital trust
   
25,774
     
25,774
 
Subordinated notes
   
73,842
     
73,688
 
Common stock
   
142
     
141
 
Additional paid-in capital
   
30,121
     
28,203
 
Retained earnings
   
492,087
     
442,077
 
Accumulated other comprehensive income
   
9,627
     
1,241
 
                 
   
$
637,964
   
$
576,166
 



167





Great Southern Bancorp, Inc.
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements
December 31, 2018, 2017 and 2016



   
2018
   
2017
   
2016
 
   
(In Thousands)
 
Statements of Income
                 
Income
                 
Dividends from subsidiary bank
 
$
34,000
   
$
17,500
   
$
12,000
 
Interest and dividend income
   
     
48
     
 
Gain on redemption of trust
    preferred securities and sale of
    non-marketable securities
   
     
     
2,735
 
Other income
   
     
     
2
 
                         
     
34,000
     
17,548
     
14,737
 
                         
Expense
                       
Operating expenses
   
1,793
     
1,330
     
1,322
 
Interest expense
   
5,050
     
5,047
     
2,381
 
                         
     
6,843
     
6,377
     
3,703
 
                         
Income before income tax and
                       
equity in undistributed earnings
                       
of subsidiaries
   
27,157
     
11,171
     
11,034
 
Credit for income taxes
   
(1,204
)
   
(1,709
)
   
(241
)
                         
Income before equity in earnings
                       
of subsidiaries
   
28,361
     
12,880
     
11,275
 
                         
Equity in undistributed earnings of
                       
subsidiaries
   
38,748
     
38,684
     
34,067
 
                         
Net income
 
$
67,109
   
$
51,564
   
$
45,342
 



168





Great Southern Bancorp, Inc.
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements
December 31, 2018, 2017 and 2016



   
2018
   
2017
   
2016
 
   
(In Thousands)
 
Statements of Cash Flows
                 
Operating Activities
                 
Net income
 
$
67,109
   
$
51,564
   
$
45,342
 
Items not requiring (providing) cash
                       
Equity in undistributed earnings of subsidiary
   
(38,748
)
   
(38,684
)
   
(34,067
)
Compensation expense for stock option grants
   
737
     
564
     
483
 
Net realized gains on sales of available-for-sale
                       
securities
   
     
     
(2,735
)
Amortization of interest rate derivative and deferred
costs on subordinated notes
   
154
     
441
     
289
 
Changes in
                       
Prepaid expenses and other assets
   
13
     
132
     
175
 
Accounts payable and accrued expenses
   
182
     
(115
)
   
1,495
 
Income taxes
   
(278
)
   
6
     
(206
)
Net cash provided by operating activities
   
29,169
     
13,908
     
10,776
 
                         
Investing Activities
                       
Proceeds from sales of available-for-sale securities
   
     
     
3,583
 
Investment in subsidiary
   
     
     
(60,000
)
(Investment)/Return of principal - other investments
   
     
     
(2
)
Net cash used in investing activities
   
     
     
(56,419
)
                         
Financing Activities
                       
Proceeds from issuance of subordinated notes
   
     
     
73,472
 
Purchases of the Company’s common stock
   
(903
)
   
     
 
Dividends paid
   
(15,819
)
   
(12,894
)
   
(12,232
)
Stock options exercised
   
2,224
     
3,247
     
2,110
 
Net cash provided by (used in) financing activities
   
(14,498
)
   
(9,647
)
   
63,350
 
                         
Increase in Cash
   
14,671
     
4,261
     
17,707
 
                         
Cash, Beginning of Year
   
41,977
     
37,716
     
20,009
 
                         
Cash, End of Year
 
$
56,648
   
$
41,977
   
$
37,716
 
                         
Additional Cash Payment Information
                       
Interest paid
 
$
5,001
   
$
5,059
   
$
846
 



169





Great Southern Bancorp, Inc.
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements
December 31, 2018, 2017 and 2016



   
2018
   
2017
   
2016
 
   
(In Thousands)
 
Statements of Comprehensive Income
                 
                   
Net Income
 
$
67,109
   
$
51,564
   
$
45,342
 
                         
Unrealized appreciation on available-for-sale securities,
    net of taxes (credit) of $0, $0 and $(90), for 2018,
    2017 and 2016, respectively
   
     
     
(158
)
                         
Reclassification adjustment for gains included in net
    income, net of taxes of $0, $0 and $(993), for 2018,
    2017 and 2016, respectively
   
     
     
(1,742
)
                         
Change in fair value of cash flow hedge, net of taxes
                       
of $0, $93 and $50  for 2018, 2017 and
                       
2016, respectively
   
     
161
     
87
 
                         
Comprehensive income (loss) of subsidiaries
   
8,114
     
(478
)
   
(2,293
)
                         
Comprehensive Income
 
$
75,223
   
$
51,247
   
$
41,236
 
                         


Note 28:
Sale of Branches and Related Deposits

On July 20, 2018, the Company closed on the sale of four banking centers and related deposits in the Omaha, Neb., metropolitan market to Lincoln, Neb.-based West Gate Bank. Pursuant to the purchase and assumption agreement, the Bank sold branch deposits of approximately $56 million and sold substantially all branch-related real estate, fixed assets and ATMs. The Company recorded a pre-tax gain (excluding transaction expenses of $165,000) of $7.4 million on the sale based on the contractual deposit premium and the sales price of the branch assets.


170



 ITEM 9.
CHANGES IN AND DISAGREEMENTS WITH ACCOUNTANTS ON
ACCOUNTING AND FINANCIAL DISCLOSURE.

None.

 ITEM 9A.
CONTROLS AND PROCEDURES.

We maintain a system of disclosure controls and procedures (as defined in Rule 13(a)-15(e) under the Securities Exchange Act (the "Exchange Act")) that is designed to provide reasonable assurance that information required to be disclosed by us in the reports that we file under the Exchange Act is recorded, processed, summarized and reported accurately and within the time periods specified in the SEC's rules and forms, and that such information is accumulated and communicated to our management, including our principal executive officer and principal financial officer, as appropriate. An evaluation of our disclosure controls and procedures was carried out as of December 31, 2018, under the supervision and with the participation of our principal executive officer, principal financial officer and several other members of our senior management. Our principal executive officer and principal financial officer concluded that, as of December 31, 2018, our disclosure controls and procedures were effective in ensuring that the information we are required to disclose in the reports we file or submit under the Act is (i) accumulated and communicated to our management (including the principal executive officer and principal financial officer) to allow timely decisions regarding required disclosure, and (ii) recorded, processed, summarized and reported within the time periods specified in the SEC's rules and forms.

There were no changes in our internal control over financial reporting (as defined in Rule 13a-15(f) under the Act) that occurred during the quarter ended December 31, 2018, that have materially affected, or are reasonably likely to materially affect, our internal control over financial reporting. The annual report of management on the effectiveness of internal control over financial reporting and the attestation report thereon issued by our independent registered public accounting firm are set forth below under "Management's Report on Internal Control Over Financial Reporting" and "Report of the Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm."

We do not expect that our internal control over financial reporting will prevent all errors and all fraud. A control procedure, no matter how well conceived and operated, can provide only reasonable, not absolute, assurance that the objectives of the control procedure are met. Because of the inherent limitations in all control procedures, no evaluation of controls can provide absolute assurance that all control issues and instances of fraud, if any, within the Company have been detected. These inherent limitations include the realities that judgments in decision-making can be faulty, and that breakdowns in controls or procedures can occur because of simple error or mistake. Additionally, controls can be circumvented by the individual acts of some persons, by collusion of two or more people, or by management override of the control. The design of any control procedure also is based in part upon certain assumptions about the likelihood of future events, and there can be no assurance that any design will succeed in achieving its stated goals under all potential future conditions; over time, controls may become inadequate because of changes in conditions, or the degree of compliance with the policies or procedures may deteriorate. Because of the inherent limitations in a cost-effective control procedure, misstatements due to error or fraud may occur and not be detected.

MANAGEMENT'S REPORT ON INTERNAL CONTROL
 OVER FINANCIAL REPORTING

The management of Great Southern Bancorp, Inc. (the "Company") is responsible for establishing and maintaining adequate internal control over financial reporting, as such term is defined in Exchange Act Rule 13a-15(f). The Company's internal control over financial reporting is a process designed to provide reasonable assurance regarding the reliability of financial reporting and the preparation of the financial statements for external purposes in accordance with accounting principles generally accepted in the United States of America. The Company's internal control over financial reporting includes those policies and procedures that (i) pertain to the maintenance of records that, in reasonable detail, accurately and fairly reflect the transactions and dispositions of the assets of the Company; (ii) provide reasonable assurance that transactions are recorded as necessary to permit preparation of financial statements in accordance with accounting principles generally accepted in the United States of America, and that receipts and expenditures of the Company are being made only in accordance with authorizations of management and directors of the Company; and (iii) provide reasonable assurance regarding prevention or timely detection of unauthorized acquisition, use, or disposition of the Company's assets that could have a material effect on the financial statements.

Because of its inherent limitations, internal control over financial reporting may not prevent or detect misstatements. All internal control systems, no matter how well designed, have inherent limitations, including the possibility of human error and the circumvention of overriding controls. Accordingly, even effective internal control over financial reporting can provide only reasonable assurance with respect to financial statement preparation. Also, projections of any evaluation of effectiveness to future periods are subject to the risk that controls may become inadequate because of changes in conditions, or that the degree of compliance with the policies or procedures may deteriorate.


171





Management assessed the effectiveness of the Company's internal control over financial reporting as of December 31, 2018, based on the framework set forth by the Committee of Sponsoring Organizations of the Treadway Commission (COSO) in Internal Control-Integrated Framework (2013).  Based on that assessment, management concluded that, as of December 31, 2018, the Company's internal control over financial reporting was effective.

The Company's internal control over financial reporting as of December 31, 2018, has been audited by BKD, LLP, an independent registered public accounting firm. Their attestation report on the effectiveness of the Company's internal control over financial reporting as of December 31, 2018 is set forth below.


Report of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm


Audit Committee, Board of Directors and Stockholders
Great Southern Bancorp, Inc.
Springfield, Missouri


Opinion on the Internal Control over Financial Reporting

We have audited Great Southern Bancorp, Inc.’s (the “Company”) internal control over financial reporting as of December 31, 2018, based on criteria established in Internal Control – Integrated Framework:  (2013) issued by the Committee of Sponsoring Organizations of the Treadway Commission (COSO).

In our opinion, the Company maintained, in all material respects, effective internal control over financial reporting as of December 31, 2018, based on criteria established in Internal Control – Integrated Framework:  (2013) issued by COSO.

We also have audited, in accordance with the standards of the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board (United States) (PCAOB), the consolidated financial statements of the Company and our report dated March 7, 2019, expressed an unqualified opinion thereon.

Basis for Opinion

The Company’s management is responsible for maintaining effective internal control over financial reporting and for its assessment of the effectiveness of internal control over financial reporting, included in the accompanying Management’s Report on Internal Control over Financial Reporting.  Our responsibility is to express an opinion on the Company’s internal control over financial reporting based on our audit.

We are a public accounting firm registered with the PCAOB and are required to be independent with respect to the Company in accordance with the U.S. federal securities laws and the applicable rules and regulations of the Securities and Exchange Commission and the PCAOB.

We conducted our audit in accordance with the standards of the PCAOB.  Those standards require that we plan and perform the audit to obtain reasonable assurance about whether effective internal control over financial reporting was maintained in all material respects.

Our audit included obtaining an understanding of internal control over financial reporting, assessing the risk that a material weakness exists and testing and evaluating the design and operating effectiveness of internal control based on the assessed risk.  Our audit also included performing such other procedures as we considered necessary in the circumstances.  We believe that our audit provides a reasonable basis for our opinion.


172





Definitions and Limitations of Internal Control over Financial Reporting

A company’s internal control over financial reporting is a process designed to provide reasonable assurance regarding the reliability of financial reporting and the preparation of financial statements for external purposes in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles.  A company’s internal control over financial reporting includes those policies and procedures that (1) pertain to the maintenance of records that, in reasonable detail, accurately and fairly reflect the transactions and dispositions of the assets of the company; (2) provide reasonable assurance that transactions are recorded as necessary to permit preparation of financial statements in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles, and that receipts and expenditures of the company are being made only in accordance with authorizations of management and directors of the company; and (3) provide reasonable assurance regarding prevention or timely detection of unauthorized acquisition, use or disposition of the company’s assets that could have a material effect on the financial statements.

Because of its inherent limitations, internal control over financial reporting may not prevent or detect misstatements.  Also, projections of any evaluation of effectiveness to future periods are subject to the risk that controls may become inadequate because of changes in conditions or that the degree of compliance with the policies or procedures may deteriorate.

/s/ BKD, LLP

Springfield, Missouri
March 7, 2019

 
ITEM 9B.
OTHER INFORMATION.

None.












173




PART III

ITEM 10.
DIRECTORS, EXECUTIVE OFFICERS AND CORPORATE GOVERNANCE.

Directors and Executive Officers. The information concerning our directors and executive officers and corporate governance matters required by this item is incorporated herein by reference from our definitive proxy statement for our 2019 Annual Meeting of Stockholders, a copy of which will be filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission not later than 120 days after the end of our fiscal year.

Section 16(a) Beneficial Ownership Reporting Compliance. The information concerning compliance with the reporting requirements of Section 16(a) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934 by our directors, officers and ten percent stockholders required by this item is incorporated herein by reference from our definitive proxy statement for our 2019 Annual Meeting of Stockholders, a copy of which will be filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission not later than 120 days after the end of our fiscal year.

Code of Ethics. We have adopted a code of ethics that applies to our principal executive officer, principal financial officer, principal accounting officer, and persons performing similar functions, and to all of our other employees and our directors. A copy of our code of ethics was filed as an exhibit to our Annual Report on Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 2007.

 ITEM 11.
EXECUTIVE COMPENSATION.

The information concerning compensation and other matters required by this item is incorporated herein by reference from our definitive proxy statement for our 2019 Annual Meeting of Stockholders, a copy of which will be filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission not later than 120 days after the end of our fiscal year.

 ITEM 12.
SECURITY OWNERSHIP OF CERTAIN BENEFICIAL OWNERS AND
MANAGEMENT AND RELATED STOCKHOLDER MATTERS.

The information concerning security ownership of certain beneficial owners and management required by this item is incorporated herein by reference from our definitive proxy statement for our 2019 Annual Meeting of Stockholders, a copy of which will be filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission not later than 120 days after the end of our fiscal year.

The following table sets forth information as of December 31, 2018 with respect to compensation plans under which shares of our common stock may be issued:

Equity Compensation Plan Information 
 
Plan Category
Number of Shares
 to be issued upon
 Exercise of
 Outstanding
 Options, Warrants
 and Rights 
Weighted Average
 Exercise Price of
 Outstanding
 Options, Warrants
 and Rights
Number of Shares Remaining
 Available for Future Issuance
 Under Equity Compensation
 Plans (Excluding Shares
 Reflected in the First Column)
Equity compensation plans approved by stockholders
773,236
$43.886
614,850(1)
Equity compensation plans not approved by stockholders
N/A
N/A
N/A
Total
773,236
$43.886
614,850
 _________________________
 (1)  Represents shares available for future awards under the Company's 2018 Omnibus Incentive Plan.  Awards in the form of restricted stock, restricted stock units, performance shares and performance units will reduce the number of shares available under the Company’s 2018 Omnibus Incentive Plan on a 2.5-to-1 basis.

 ITEM 13.
CERTAIN RELATIONSHIPS AND RELATED TRANSACTIONS, AND DIRECTOR INDEPENDENCE.

The information concerning certain relationships and related transactions and director independence required by this item is incorporated herein by reference from our definitive proxy statement for our 2019 Annual Meeting of Stockholders, a copy of which will be filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission not later than 120 days after the end of our fiscal year.


174




 ITEM 14.
PRINCIPAL ACCOUNTING FEES AND SERVICES.

The information concerning principal accounting fees and services required by this item is incorporated herein by reference from our definitive proxy statement for our 2019 Annual Meeting of Stockholders, a copy of which will be filed not later than 120 days after the end of our fiscal year.
 
























175




PART IV
 
ITEM 15.  EXHIBITS AND FINANCIAL STATEMENT SCHEDULES.
 

(a)
List of Documents Filed as Part of This Report
       
 
(1)
Financial Statements
       
   
The Consolidated Financial Statements and Independent Auditor's Report are included in Item 8.
       
 
(2)
Financial Statement Schedules
       
   
Inapplicable.
       
 
(3)
List of Exhibits
       
   
Exhibits incorporated by reference below are incorporated by reference pursuant to Rule 12b-32.
       
 
(2)
Plan of acquisition, reorganization, arrangement, liquidation, or succession
       
   
The Purchase and Assumption Agreement, dated as of March 20, 2009, among Federal Deposit Insurance Corporation, Receiver of TeamBank, N.A., Paola, Kansas, Federal Deposit Insurance Corporation and Great Southern Bank, previously filed with the Commission (File no. 000-18082) as Exhibit 2.1 to the Registrant's Current Report on Form 8-K filed on March 26, 2009 is incorporated herein by reference as Exhibit 2(i).
       
   
The Purchase and Assumption Agreement, dated as of September 4, 2009, among Federal Deposit Insurance Corporation, Receiver of Vantus Bank, Sioux City, Iowa, Federal Deposit Insurance Corporation and Great Southern Bank, previously filed with the Commission (File no. 000-18082) as Exhibit 2.1 to the Registrant's Current Report on Form 8-K filed on September 11, 2009 is incorporated herein by reference as Exhibit 2(ii).
       
   
The Purchase and Assumption Agreement, dated as of October 7, 2011, among Federal Deposit Insurance Corporation, Receiver of Sun Security Bank, Ellington, Missouri, Federal Deposit Insurance Corporation and Great Southern Bank, previously filed with the Commission (File no. 000-18082) as Exhibit 2.1(iii) to the Registrant's Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for the quarter ended September 30, 2011 is incorporated herein by reference as Exhibit 2(iii).
       
   
The Purchase and Assumption Agreement, dated as of April 27, 2012, among Federal Deposit Insurance Corporation, Receiver of Inter Savings Bank, FSB, Maple Grove, Minnesota, Federal Deposit Insurance Corporation and Great Southern Bank, previously filed with the Commission (File no. 000-18082) as Exhibit 2.1(iv) to the Registrant's Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for the quarter ended March 31, 2012 is incorporated herein by reference as Exhibit 2(iv).
       
   
The Purchase and Assumption Agreement All Deposits, dated as of June 20, 2014, among Federal Deposit Insurance Corporation, Receiver of Valley Bank, Moline, Illinois, Federal Deposit Insurance Corporation and Great Southern Bank, previously filed with the Commission (File no. 000-18082) as Exhibit 2.1(iv) to the Registrant's Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for the quarter ended June 30, 2014 is incorporated herein by reference as Exhibit 2(v)
       
 
176


 



 
(3)
Articles of incorporation and Bylaws
       
   
The Registrant's Charter previously filed with the Commission as Appendix D to the Registrant's Definitive Proxy Statement on Schedule 14A filed on March 31, 2004 (File No. 000-18082), is incorporated herein by reference as Exhibit 3.1.
       
   
The Articles Supplementary to the Registrant's Charter setting forth the terms of the Registrant's Senior Non-Cumulative Perpetual Preferred Stock, Series A, previously filed with the Commission as Exhibit 3.1 to the Registrant's Current Report on Form 8-K filed on August 18, 2011, are incorporated herein by reference as Exhibit 3(i). 
       
   
The Registrant's Bylaws, previously filed with the Commission (File no. 000-18082) as Exhibit 3.2 to the Registrant's Current Report on Form 8-K filed on October 19, 2007, are incorporated herein by reference as Exhibit 3.2.
       
 
(4)
Instruments defining the rights of security holders, including indentures
       
   
The Company hereby agrees to furnish the SEC upon request, copies of the instruments defining the rights of the holders of each issue of the Registrant's long-term debt.
       
 
(9)
Voting trust agreement
       
   
Inapplicable.
       
 
(10)
Material contracts
       
   
The Registrant's 2003 Stock Option and Incentive Plan previously filed with the Commission (File No. 000-18082) as Annex A to the Registrant's Definitive Proxy Statement on Schedule 14A filed on April 14, 2003, is incorporated herein by reference as Exhibit 10.2.
       
   
The employment agreement dated September 18, 2002 between the Registrant and William V. Turner previously filed with the Commission (File no. 000-18082) as Exhibit 10.2 to the Registrant's Annual Report on Form 10-K for the fiscal year ended December 31, 2003, is incorporated herein by reference as Exhibit 10.3.
       
   
The employment agreement dated September 18, 2002 between the Registrant and Joseph W. Turner previously filed with the Commission (File no. 000-18082) as Exhibit 10.4 to the Registrant's Annual Report on Form 10-K for the fiscal year ended December 31, 2003, is incorporated herein by reference as Exhibit 10.4.
       
   
The form of incentive stock option agreement under the Registrant's 2003 Stock Option and Incentive Plan previously filed with the Commission as Exhibit 10.1 to the Registrant's Current Report on Form 8-K (File no. 000-18082) filed on February 24, 2005 is incorporated herein by reference as Exhibit 10.5.
       
   
The form of non-qualified stock option agreement under the Registrant's 2003 Stock Option and Incentive Plan previously filed with the Commission as Exhibit 10.2 to the Registrant's Current Report on Form 8-K (File no. 000-18082) filed on February 24, 2005 is incorporated herein by reference as Exhibit 10.6.
       
 
 
177


 
 
 
 

   
A description of the current salary and bonus arrangements for the Registrant's executive officers for 2019 is attached as Exhibit 10.7.
       
   
A description of the current fee arrangements for the Registrant's directors is attached as Exhibit 10.8.
       
   
Small Business Lending Fund – Securities Purchase Agreement, dated August 18, 2011, between the Registrant and the Secretary of the United States Department of the Treasury, previously filed with the Commission as Exhibit 10.1 to the Registrant's Current Report on Form 8-K filed on August 18, 2011, is incorporated herein by reference as Exhibit 10.9.
       
   
The Registrant's 2013 Equity Incentive Plan previously filed with the Commission (File No. 000-18082) as Appendix A to the Registrant's Definitive Proxy Statement on Schedule 14A filed on April 4, 2013, is incorporated herein by reference as Exhibit 10.10.
       
   
The form of incentive stock option award agreement under the Registrant's 2013 Equity Incentive Plan previously filed with the Commission as Exhibit 10.2 to the Registrant's Registration Statement on Form S-8 (No. 333-189497) filed on June 20, 2013 is incorporated herein by reference as Exhibit 10.11.
       
   
The form of non-qualified stock option award agreement under the Registrant's 2013 Equity Incentive Plan previously filed with the Commission as Exhibit 10.3 to the Registrant's Registration Statement on Form S-8 (No. 333-189497) filed on June 20, 2013 is incorporated herein by reference as Exhibit 10.12.
       
   
The form of stock appreciation right award agreement under the Registrant's 2013 Equity Incentive Plan previously filed with the Commission as Exhibit 10.4 to the Registrant's Registration Statement on Form S-8 (No. 333-189497) filed on June 20, 2013 is incorporated herein by reference as Exhibit 10.13.
       
   
The form of restricted stock award agreement under the Registrant's 2013 Equity Incentive Plan previously filed with the Commission as Exhibit 10.5 to the Registrant's Registration Statement on Form S-8 (No. 333-189497) filed on June 20, 2013 is incorporated herein by reference as Exhibit 10.14.
       
   
The Registrant's 2018 Omnibus Incentive Plan previously filed with the Commission (File No. 000-18082) as Appendix A to the Registrant's Definitive Proxy Statement on Schedule 14A filed on March 27, 2018, is incorporated herein by reference as Exhibit 10.15.
     
   
The form of incentive stock option award agreement under the Registrant's 2018 Omnibus Incentive Plan previously filed with the Commission as Exhibit 10.2 to the Registrant's Registration Statement on Form S-8 (File no. 333-225665) filed on June 15, 2018 is incorporated herein by reference as Exhibit 10.16.
     
   
The form of non-qualified stock option award agreement under the Registrant's 2018 Omnibus Incentive Plan previously filed with the Commission as Exhibit 10.3 to the Registrant's Registration Statement on Form S-8 (File no. 333-225665) filed on June 15, 2018 is incorporated herein by reference as Exhibit 10.17.
       
       

 
 
178





 
(13)
Annual report to security holders, Form 10-Q or quarterly report to security holders
       
   
Inapplicable.
       
 
(14)
Code of Ethics
       
   
The Registrant's Code of Business Conduct and Ethics previously filed with the Commission as Exhibit 14 to the Registrant's Annual Report on Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 2007 is incorporated herein by reference as Exhibit 14.
       
 
(16)
Letter re change in certifying accountant
       
   
Inapplicable.
 
 
(18)
Letter re change in accounting principles
       
   
Inapplicable.
       
 
(21)
Subsidiaries of the registrant
       
   
A list of the Registrant's subsidiaries is attached hereto as Exhibit 21.
       
 
(22)
Published report regarding matters submitted to vote of security holders
       
   
Inapplicable.
       
 
(23)
Consents of experts and counsel
       
   
The consent of BKD, LLP to the incorporation by reference into the Form S-3 (File no. 333-212444) and Form S-8s (File nos. 333-104930, 333-106190, 333-189497 and 333-225665) previously filed with the Commission of their report on the financial statements included in this Form 10-K, is attached hereto as Exhibit 23.
       
 
(24)
Power of attorney
       
   
Included as part of signature page.
       
 
(31.1)
Rule 13a-14(a) Certification of Chief Executive Officer
       
   
Attached as Exhibit 31.1
       
 
(31.2)
Rule 13a-14(a) Certification of Treasurer
       
   
Attached as Exhibit 31.2
       
 
(32)
Certification pursuant to Section 906 of Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002 (18 U.S.C. Section 1350)
       
   
Attached as Exhibit 32.
       
 
(101)
Attached as Exhibit 101 are the following financial statements from the Great Southern Bancorp, Inc. Annual Report on Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 2018, formatted in Extensive Business Reporting Language (XBRL): (i) consolidated statements of financial condition, (ii) consolidated statements of income, (iii) consolidated statements of cash flows and (iv) the notes to consolidated financial statements.



179

 

 
SIGNATURES

Pursuant to the requirements of Section 13 or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, the Registrant has duly caused this report to be signed on its behalf by the undersigned thereunto duly authorized.

 
GREAT SOUTHERN BANCORP, INC.
 
 
 
 
Date: March 7, 2019
By:
/s/ Joseph W. Turner                                
Joseph W. Turner
 President, Chief Executive Officer and
 Director
 ( Duly Authorized Representative )

POWER OF ATTORNEY

We, the undersigned officers and directors of Great Southern Bancorp, Inc., hereby severally and individually constitute and appoint Joseph W. Turner and Rex A. Copeland, and each of them, the true and lawful attorneys and agents of each of us to execute in the name, place and stead of each of us (individually and in any capacity stated below) any and all amendments to this Annual Report on Form 10-K and all instruments necessary or advisable in connection therewith and to file the same with the Securities and Exchange Commission, each of said attorneys and agents to have the power to act with or without the others and to have full power and authority to do and perform in the name and on behalf of each of the undersigned every act whatsoever necessary or advisable to be done in the premises as fully and to all intents and purposes as any of the undersigned might or could do in person, and we hereby ratify and confirm our signatures as they may be signed by our said attorneys and agents or each of them to any and all such amendments and instruments.
 
 
 
 
180


 

Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, this report has been signed below by the following persons on behalf of the Registrant and in the capacities and on the date indicated.

Signature
Capacity in Which Signed
Date
 
 
 
 
 
 
/s/ Joseph W. Turner                                   
Joseph W. Turner
President, Chief Executive Officer and Director
 (Principal Executive Officer)
March 7, 2019
 
 
 
 
 
 
/s/ William V. Turner                                     
William V. Turner
Chairman of the Board
March 7, 2019
 
 
 
 
 
 
/s/ Rex A. Copeland                                      
Rex A. Copeland
Treasurer
 (Principal Financial Officer and
 Principal Accounting Officer)
March 7, 2019
     
     
/s/ Kevin R. Ausburn                                   
Kevin R. Ausburn
Director
March 7, 2019
 
 
 
 
 
 
/s/ Julie T. Brown                                          
Julie T. Brown
Director
March 7, 2019
 
 
 
 
 
 
/s/ Thomas J. Carlson                                   
Thomas J. Carlson
Director
March 7, 2019
 
 
 
 
 
 
/s/ Larry D. Frazier                                         
Larry D. Frazier
Director
March 7, 2019
 
 
 
 
 
 
/s/ Debra M. Hart                                           
Debra M. Hart
Director
March 7, 2019
 
 
 
 
 
 
/s/ Douglas M. Pitt                                        
Douglas M. Pitt
Director
March 7, 2019
     
     
/s/ Earl A. Steinert, Jr.                                   
Earl A. Steinert, Jr.
Director
March 7, 2019
     
     








181